* Your assessment is very important for improving the workof artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project
Download 2.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task
Multiprotocol Label Switching wikipedia , lookup
Network tap wikipedia , lookup
Computer network wikipedia , lookup
Wake-on-LAN wikipedia , lookup
Airborne Networking wikipedia , lookup
Parallel port wikipedia , lookup
Recursive InterNetwork Architecture (RINA) wikipedia , lookup
Spanning Tree Protocol wikipedia , lookup
Cracking of wireless networks wikipedia , lookup
Serial digital interface wikipedia , lookup
IEEE 802.1aq wikipedia , lookup
Routing in delay-tolerant networking wikipedia , lookup
S9700 Core Routing Switch V200R001C00 Configuration Guide - Multicast Issue 01 Date 2012-03-15 HUAWEI TECHNOLOGIES CO., LTD. Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 2012. All rights reserved. No part of this document may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any means without prior written consent of Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Trademarks and Permissions and other Huawei trademarks are trademarks of Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. All other trademarks and trade names mentioned in this document are the property of their respective holders. Notice The purchased products, services and features are stipulated by the contract made between Huawei and the customer. All or part of the products, services and features described in this document may not be within the purchase scope or the usage scope. Unless otherwise specified in the contract, all statements, information, and recommendations in this document are provided "AS IS" without warranties, guarantees or representations of any kind, either express or implied. The information in this document is subject to change without notice. Every effort has been made in the preparation of this document to ensure accuracy of the contents, but all statements, information, and recommendations in this document do not constitute the warranty of any kind, express or implied. Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Address: Huawei Industrial Base Bantian, Longgang Shenzhen 518129 People's Republic of China Website: http://www.huawei.com Email: [email protected] Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. i S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast About This Document About This Document Intended Audience This document describes the multicast service supported by the S9700, including basic knowledge, protocol implementation, configuration procedures, and configuration examples. This document guides you through the configuration of the multicast service of the S9700. This document is intended for: l Data configuration engineer l Commissioning engineer l Network monitoring engineer l System maintenance engineer Symbol Conventions The symbols that may be found in this document are defined as follows. Symbol Description DANGER WARNING CAUTION Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Indicates a hazard with a high level of risk, which if not avoided, will result in death or serious injury. Indicates a hazard with a medium or low level of risk, which if not avoided, could result in minor or moderate injury. Indicates a potentially hazardous situation, which if not avoided, could result in equipment damage, data loss, performance degradation, or unexpected results. TIP Indicates a tip that may help you solve a problem or save time. NOTE Provides additional information to emphasize or supplement important points of the main text. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. ii S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast About This Document Command Conventions The command conventions that may be found in this document are defined as follows. Convention Description Boldface The keywords of a command line are in boldface. Italic Command arguments are in italics. [] Items (keywords or arguments) in brackets [ ] are optional. { x | y | ... } Optional items are grouped in braces and separated by vertical bars. One item is selected. [ x | y | ... ] Optional items are grouped in brackets and separated by vertical bars. One item is selected or no item is selected. { x | y | ... }* Optional items are grouped in braces and separated by vertical bars. A minimum of one item or a maximum of all items can be selected. [ x | y | ... ]* Optional items are grouped in brackets and separated by vertical bars. Several items or no item can be selected. &<1-n> The parameter before the & sign can be repeated 1 to n times. # A line starting with the # sign is comments. Change History Updates between document issues are cumulative. Therefore, the latest document issue contains all updates made in previous issues. Changes in Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Initial commercial release. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. iii S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast Contents Contents About This Document.....................................................................................................................ii 1 IP Multicast Configuration Guide.............................................................................................1 1.1 IP Multicast Overview........................................................................................................................................2 1.2 IP Multicast Features Supported by the S9700..................................................................................................2 1.3 IPv4 Multicast Configuration Guide..................................................................................................................2 1.3.1 IPv4 Multicast Addresses..........................................................................................................................2 1.3.2 IPv4 Multicast Protocols...........................................................................................................................3 1.3.3 Typical Configuration Solution.................................................................................................................4 1.3.4 Controlling Multicast Forwarding.............................................................................................................5 1.4 IPv6 Multicast Configuration Guide..................................................................................................................5 1.4.1 IPv6 Multicast Addresses..........................................................................................................................5 1.4.2 IPv6 Multicast Protocols...........................................................................................................................8 1.4.3 Typical Configuration Solution.................................................................................................................9 1.4.4 Controlling Multicast Forwarding.............................................................................................................9 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration................................................................................................10 2.1 IGMP Snooping Overview...............................................................................................................................11 2.2 IGMP Snooping Supported by the S9700........................................................................................................12 2.3 Configuring IGMP Snooping...........................................................................................................................13 2.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.......................................................................................................13 2.3.2 Enabling IGMP Snooping.......................................................................................................................14 2.3.3 (Optional) Configuring a Static Router Interface....................................................................................15 2.3.4 (Optional) Configuring Multicast Group Member Interfaces.................................................................16 2.3.5 (Optional) Configuring IGMP Snooping Querier...................................................................................17 2.3.6 (Optional) Configuring IGMP Message Suppression.............................................................................19 2.3.7 (Optional) Disabling Users from Dynamically Joining Multicast Groups..............................................19 2.3.8 (Optional) Adjusting IGMP Snooping Parameters..................................................................................20 2.3.9 Checking the Configuration.....................................................................................................................22 2.4 Configuring a Static Multicast MAC Address.................................................................................................24 2.5 Configuring the IGMP Snooping Proxy for the VLAN...................................................................................26 2.6 Configuring a Layer 2 Multicast Policy...........................................................................................................27 2.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.......................................................................................................27 2.6.2 Configuring a Multicast Group Policy....................................................................................................28 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. iv S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast Contents 2.6.3 Configuring Prompt Leave for Interfaces................................................................................................29 2.6.4 Filtering Layer 2 Multicast Data on an Interface.....................................................................................30 2.6.5 Enabling the Discarding of Unknown Multicast Data Packets in a VLAN............................................30 2.6.6 Checking the Configuration.....................................................................................................................31 2.7 Configuring Layer 2 Multicast CAC................................................................................................................31 2.7.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.......................................................................................................32 2.7.2 Limiting the Number of Multicast Groups of a VLAN, a Layer 2 Interface, or an Interface in a VLAN ..........................................................................................................................................................................33 2.7.3 Limiting the Number of Multicast Groups in a Channel for a VLAN, an Interface, or an Interface in a VLAN...............................................................................................................................................................34 2.7.4 Configuring Channels on a VLAN..........................................................................................................35 2.7.5 Checking the Configuration.....................................................................................................................36 2.8 Configuring Layer 2 Multicast SSM Mapping.................................................................................................37 2.8.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.......................................................................................................37 2.8.2 (Optional) Configuring an SSM Group Policy........................................................................................38 2.8.3 Configuring Layer 2 Multicast SSM Mapping........................................................................................38 2.8.4 Checking the Configuration.....................................................................................................................39 2.9 Maintaining Layer 2 Multicast.........................................................................................................................40 2.9.1 Clearing Static Entries in a Multicast Forwarding Table........................................................................40 2.9.2 Clearing Multicast Forwarding Entries...................................................................................................41 2.9.3 Clearing the Statistics on IGMP Snooping..............................................................................................41 2.9.4 Debugging IGMP Snooping....................................................................................................................42 2.9.5 Debugging Layer 2 Multicast CAC.........................................................................................................42 2.10 Configuration examples..................................................................................................................................42 2.10.1 Example for Configuring IGMP Snooping...........................................................................................43 2.10.2 Example for Configuring Layer 2 Multicast CAC for a VLAN............................................................45 2.10.3 Example for Configuring IGMP Snooping SSM Mapping...................................................................49 3 Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration..........................................................................53 3.1 Multicast VLAN Replication Overview...........................................................................................................54 3.2 Multicast VLAN Replication Supported by the S9700....................................................................................54 3.3 Configuring Multicast VLAN Replication Based on User VLANs.................................................................56 3.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.......................................................................................................56 3.3.2 Configuring Multicast VLAN Replication Based on User VLANs........................................................57 3.3.3 Adding Interfaces to VLANs...................................................................................................................58 3.3.4 Checking the Configuration.....................................................................................................................58 3.4 Configuring Multicast VLAN Replication Based on Interfaces.......................................................................59 3.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.......................................................................................................59 3.4.2 Creating a Multicast VLAN....................................................................................................................60 3.4.3 Binding User VLANs to a Multicast VLAN on an Interface..................................................................60 3.4.4 Adding Interfaces to VLANs...................................................................................................................61 3.4.5 Checking the Configuration.....................................................................................................................61 3.5 Configuration Examples...................................................................................................................................61 3.5.1 Example for Configuring Multicast VLAN Replication Based on User VLANs...................................62 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. v S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast Contents 3.5.2 Example for Configuring Multicast VLAN Replication Based on Interfaces.........................................64 4 IGMP Configuration...................................................................................................................68 4.1 Introduction to IGMP.......................................................................................................................................69 4.2 IGMP Features Supported by the S9700..........................................................................................................69 4.3 Configuring Basic IGMP Functions.................................................................................................................70 4.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.......................................................................................................70 4.3.2 Enabling IP Multicast..............................................................................................................................71 4.3.3 Enabling the IGMP Function...................................................................................................................72 4.3.4 (Optional) Specifying the IGMP Version................................................................................................72 4.3.5 (Optional) Configuring a Static IGMP Group.........................................................................................73 4.3.6 (Optional) Configuring an IGMP Multicast Group Policy......................................................................74 4.3.7 Checking the Configuration.....................................................................................................................74 4.4 Setting the Parameters of IGMP Features........................................................................................................75 4.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.......................................................................................................75 4.4.2 Configuring IGMP Message Options......................................................................................................76 4.4.3 Configuring the IGMPv1 Querier............................................................................................................78 4.4.4 Configuring the IGMPv2 or IGMPv3 Querier........................................................................................79 4.4.5 Configuring IGMP Prompt Leave...........................................................................................................81 4.4.6 Checking the Configuration.....................................................................................................................82 4.5 Configuring SSM Mapping..............................................................................................................................83 4.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.......................................................................................................83 4.5.2 Enabling SSM Mapping..........................................................................................................................84 4.5.3 Configuring the SSM Mapping Policy....................................................................................................84 4.5.4 Checking the Configuration.....................................................................................................................85 4.6 Configuration IGMP Limit Function................................................................................................................86 4.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.......................................................................................................86 4.6.2 Configuring the Maximum Number of Global IGMP Group Memberships...........................................86 4.6.3 Setting the Maximum Number of Global IGMP Entries for an Instance................................................87 4.6.4 Configuring the Maximum Number of IGMP Group Memberships on an Interface..............................87 4.6.5 Checking the Configuration.....................................................................................................................88 4.7 Maintaining IGMP............................................................................................................................................88 4.7.1 Clearing the Information About an IGMP Group...................................................................................88 4.7.2 Monitoring the Running Status of IGMP................................................................................................88 4.7.3 Debugging IGMP....................................................................................................................................89 4.8 Configuration Examples...................................................................................................................................89 4.8.1 Example for Configuring Basic IGMP Functions...................................................................................89 4.8.2 Example for Configuring SSM Mapping................................................................................................93 4.8.3 Example for Configuring IGMP Limit....................................................................................................99 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration................................................................................................104 5.1 PIM-DM Overview.........................................................................................................................................106 5.2 PIM-DM Features Supported by the S9700...................................................................................................107 5.3 Configuring Basic PIM-DM Functions..........................................................................................................108 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. vi S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast Contents 5.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................108 5.3.2 Enabling IPv4 Multicast Routing..........................................................................................................109 5.3.3 Enabling PIM-DM.................................................................................................................................109 5.3.4 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................110 5.4 Adjusting Control Parameters of a Multicast Source.....................................................................................112 5.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................112 5.4.2 Configuring the Lifetime of a Source....................................................................................................112 5.4.3 Configuring Filtering Rules Based on Source Addresses.....................................................................113 5.4.4 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................114 5.5 Adjusting Control Parameters for Maintaining Neighbor Relationships.......................................................114 5.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................114 5.5.2 Configuring the Interval for Sending Hello Messages..........................................................................115 5.5.3 Configuring the Timeout Period of a Neighbor.....................................................................................116 5.5.4 Refusing to Receive the Hello Message Without the Generation ID Option........................................117 5.5.5 Configuring PIM Neighbor Filtering.....................................................................................................118 5.5.6 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................119 5.6 Adjusting Control Parameters for Prune........................................................................................................119 5.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................119 5.6.2 Configuring the Period for an Interface to Keep the Prune State..........................................................120 5.6.3 Configuring the Delay for Transmitting Prune Messages in a LAN.....................................................121 5.6.4 Configuring the Interval for Overriding the Prune Action....................................................................122 5.6.5 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................123 5.7 Adjusting Control Parameters for State-Refresh............................................................................................123 5.7.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................124 5.7.2 Disabling State-Refresh.........................................................................................................................124 5.7.3 Configuring the Interval for Sending State-Refresh Messages.............................................................125 5.7.4 Configuring the Period for Receiving the Next State-Refresh Message...............................................126 5.7.5 Configuring the TTL Value Carried in a State-Refresh Message.........................................................126 5.7.6 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................127 5.8 Adjusting Control Parameters for Graft.........................................................................................................128 5.8.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................128 5.8.2 Configuring the Interval for Retransmitting Graft Messages................................................................128 5.8.3 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................129 5.9 Adjusting Control Parameters for Assert........................................................................................................130 5.9.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................130 5.9.2 Configuring the Period for Keeping the Assert State............................................................................131 5.9.3 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................132 5.10 Configuring PIM Silent Function.................................................................................................................132 5.10.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................133 5.10.2 Configuring PIM Silent.......................................................................................................................134 5.10.3 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................134 5.11 Maintaining PIM-DM (IPv4)........................................................................................................................135 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. vii S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast Contents 5.11.1 Clearing Statistics of PIM Control Messages......................................................................................135 5.11.2 Monitoring the Running Status of PIM...............................................................................................136 5.11.3 Debugging PIM...................................................................................................................................137 5.12 Configuration Example.................................................................................................................................137 5.12.1 Example for Configuring the PIM-DM Network................................................................................137 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration................................................................................................143 6.1 PIM-SM Overview.........................................................................................................................................145 6.2 PIM-SM Features Supported by the S9700....................................................................................................146 6.3 Configuring Basic PIM-SM Functions...........................................................................................................148 6.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................148 6.3.2 Enabling IP Multicast Routing..............................................................................................................149 6.3.3 Enabling Basic PIM-SM Functions.......................................................................................................150 6.3.4 (Optional) Configuring a Static RP.......................................................................................................151 6.3.5 (Optional) Configuring a Dynamic RP..................................................................................................152 6.3.6 (Optional) Configuring the SSM Group Address Range.......................................................................154 6.3.7 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................154 6.4 Adjusting Control Parameters for a Multicast Source....................................................................................155 6.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................155 6.4.2 Configuring the Lifetime of a Source....................................................................................................156 6.4.3 Configuring Filtering Rules Based on Source Addresses.....................................................................156 6.4.4 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................157 6.5 Adjusting Control Parameters of the C-RP and C-BSR.................................................................................158 6.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................158 6.5.2 Adjusting C-RP Parameters...................................................................................................................159 6.5.3 Adjusting C-BSR Parameters................................................................................................................159 6.5.4 Configuring the BSR Boundary............................................................................................................160 6.5.5 (Optional) Configuring the BSR Address Range..................................................................................161 6.5.6 (Optional) Configuring the Range of Valid C-RP Addresses...............................................................162 6.5.7 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................162 6.6 Configuring a BSR Administrative Domain..................................................................................................163 6.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................163 6.6.2 Enabling a BSR Administrative Domain...............................................................................................164 6.6.3 Configuring the Boundary of a BSR Administrative Domain..............................................................164 6.6.4 Adjusting C-BSR Parameters................................................................................................................165 6.6.5 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................166 6.7 Adjusting Control Parameters for Establishing the Neighbor Relationship...................................................166 6.7.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................166 6.7.2 Configuring Control Parameters for Establishing the Neighbor Relationship......................................167 6.7.3 Configuring Control Parameters for Electing a DR..............................................................................169 6.7.4 Enabling the Function of Tracking a Downstream Neighbor................................................................170 6.7.5 Configuring PIM Neighbor Filtering.....................................................................................................171 6.7.6 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................172 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. viii S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast Contents 6.8 Adjusting Control Parameters for Source Registering...................................................................................172 6.8.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................172 6.8.2 Configuring PIM-SM Register Messages..............................................................................................173 6.8.3 Configuring PIM-SM Register Suppression..........................................................................................174 6.8.4 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................175 6.9 Adjusting Control Parameters for Forwarding...............................................................................................175 6.9.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................175 6.9.2 Configuring Control Parameters for Keeping the Forwarding State.....................................................176 6.9.3 Configuring Control Parameters for Prune............................................................................................177 6.9.4 Configuring Join Information Filtering.................................................................................................179 6.9.5 (Optional) Configuring Parameters for Join/Prune Messages...............................................................179 6.9.6 Configuring Neighbor Check................................................................................................................180 6.9.7 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................181 6.10 Adjusting Control Parameters for Assert......................................................................................................181 6.10.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................182 6.10.2 Configuring the Period for Keeping the Assert State..........................................................................182 6.10.3 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................183 6.11 Configuring the SPT Switchover..................................................................................................................184 6.11.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................184 6.11.2 (Optional) Configuring the Interval for Checking the Forwarding Rate of Multicast Data................185 6.11.3 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................186 6.12 Configuring PIM BFD..................................................................................................................................187 6.12.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................187 6.12.2 Enabling PIM BFD..............................................................................................................................187 6.12.3 (Optional) Adjusting BFD Parameters................................................................................................188 6.12.4 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................189 6.13 Configuring PIM GR....................................................................................................................................189 6.13.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................189 6.13.2 Enabling PIM GR................................................................................................................................190 6.13.3 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................191 6.14 Configuring PIM Silent................................................................................................................................191 6.14.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................191 6.14.2 Configuring PIM Silent.......................................................................................................................192 6.14.3 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................193 6.15 Maintaining PIM-SM (IPv4)........................................................................................................................194 6.15.1 Clearing Statistics of PIM Control Messages......................................................................................194 6.15.2 Clearing the PIM Status of the Specified Downstream Interfaces of PIM Entries.............................194 6.15.3 Monitoring the Running Status of PIM-SM........................................................................................195 6.15.4 Debugging PIM...................................................................................................................................196 6.16 Configuration Examples...............................................................................................................................197 6.16.1 Example for Configuring the PIM-SM Network.................................................................................197 6.16.2 Example for Configuring SPT Switchover in PIM-SM Domain........................................................207 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. ix S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast Contents 6.16.3 Example for Configuring PIM BFD....................................................................................................212 6.16.4 Example for Configuring PIM GR......................................................................................................216 7 MSDP Configuration................................................................................................................224 7.1 MSDP Overview.............................................................................................................................................226 7.2 MSDP Features Supported by the S9700.......................................................................................................226 7.3 Configuring PIM-SM Inter-domain Multicast...............................................................................................228 7.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................228 7.3.2 Configuring Intra-AS MSDP Peers.......................................................................................................229 7.3.3 Configuring Inter-AS MSDP Peers on MBGP Peers............................................................................231 7.3.4 Configuring Static RPF Peers................................................................................................................232 7.3.5 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................233 7.4 Configuring an Anycast RP in a PIM-SM Domain........................................................................................234 7.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................234 7.4.2 Configuring the Interface Address of an RP.........................................................................................235 7.4.3 Configuring a C-RP...............................................................................................................................236 7.4.4 Statically Configuring an RP.................................................................................................................236 7.4.5 Configuring an MSDP Peer...................................................................................................................237 7.4.6 Specifying the Logical RP Address for an SA Message.......................................................................238 7.4.7 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................239 7.5 Managing MSDP Peer Connections...............................................................................................................240 7.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................240 7.5.2 Controlling the Sessions Between MSDP Peers....................................................................................240 7.5.3 Adjusting the interval for Retrying Setting up an MSDP Peer Connection..........................................241 7.5.4 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................242 7.6 Configuring SA Cache....................................................................................................................................242 7.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................242 7.6.2 Configuring the Maximum Number of (S, G) Entries in the Cache......................................................243 7.6.3 Disabling the SA Cache Function.........................................................................................................244 7.6.4 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................244 7.7 Configuring the SA Request...........................................................................................................................245 7.7.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................245 7.7.2 Configuring "Sending SA Request Messages" on the Local switch.....................................................246 7.7.3 (Optional) Configuring the Filtering Rules for Receiving SA Request Messages................................247 7.7.4 Check the Configuration........................................................................................................................247 7.8 Transmitting Burst Multicast Data Between Domains...................................................................................248 7.8.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................248 7.8.2 Encapsulating a Multicast Data Packet in an SA message....................................................................249 7.8.3 (Optional) Setting the TTL Threshold for Forwarding an SA Message Containing a Multicast Data Packet ........................................................................................................................................................................250 7.8.4 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................250 7.9 Configuring the Filtering Rules for SA Messages..........................................................................................252 7.9.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................252 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. x S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast Contents 7.9.2 Setting Rules for Creating an SA Message...........................................................................................253 7.9.3 Setting Rules for Receiving an SA Message.........................................................................................254 7.9.4 Setting Rules for Forwarding an SA Message.......................................................................................254 7.9.5 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................255 7.10 Configuring MSDP Authentication..............................................................................................................256 7.10.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................256 7.10.2 Configuring MSDP MD5 Authentication............................................................................................257 7.10.3 Configuring MSDP Key-Chain Authentication..................................................................................258 7.10.4 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................259 7.11 Maintaining MSDP.......................................................................................................................................259 7.11.1 Clearing Statistics of MSDP Peers......................................................................................................259 7.11.2 Clearing (S, G) Information in SA Cache...........................................................................................260 7.11.3 Monitoring the Running Status of MSDP...........................................................................................260 7.11.4 Debugging MSDP................................................................................................................................261 7.12 Configuration Examples...............................................................................................................................262 7.12.1 Example for Configuring Basic MSDP Functions..............................................................................262 7.12.2 Example for Configuring Inter-AS Multicast by Using Static RPF Peers..........................................272 7.12.3 Example for Configuring Anycast RP.................................................................................................278 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration........................................................................................285 8.1 Overview of IPv4 Multicast VPN..................................................................................................................286 8.2 IPv4 Multicast VPN Supported by the S9700................................................................................................287 8.3 Configuring Basic MD VPN Functions..........................................................................................................288 8.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................288 8.3.2 Enabling IP Multicast Routing..............................................................................................................289 8.3.3 Configuring the Eth-Trunk as a Multicast Loopback Interface.............................................................289 8.3.4 Configuring Share-Group and Binding an MTI....................................................................................290 8.3.5 Configuring an MTI...............................................................................................................................291 8.3.6 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................292 8.4 Configuring Switch-MDT Switchover...........................................................................................................292 8.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................292 8.4.2 (Optional) Setting Switching Parameters of Switch-MDT....................................................................293 8.4.3 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................294 8.5 Maintaining IPv4 Multicast VPN...................................................................................................................295 8.5.1 Monitoring the Running Status of IPv4 Multicast VPN........................................................................295 8.5.2 Debugging IPv4 Multicast VPN............................................................................................................296 8.5.3 Controlling the Output of Logs.............................................................................................................296 8.6 Configuration Examples.................................................................................................................................297 8.6.1 Example for Configuring a Single-AS MD VPN..................................................................................297 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management....................................................................................321 9.1 Overview of IPv4 Multicast Routing Management........................................................................................323 9.2 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management Features Supported by the S9700.......................................................323 9.3 Configuring a Static Multicast Route.............................................................................................................325 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. xi S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast Contents 9.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................326 9.3.2 Configuring a Static Multicast Route Function.....................................................................................326 9.3.3 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................327 9.4 Configuring the Multicast Routing Policy......................................................................................................328 9.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................328 9.4.2 Configuring Longest Match of Multicast Route....................................................................................329 9.4.3 Configuring Multicast Load Splitting....................................................................................................330 9.4.4 Configuring a Multicast Load Splitting Weight....................................................................................332 9.4.5 (Optional) Optimizing Storage for Multicast Forwarding Entries........................................................332 9.4.6 (Optional) Configuring the Multicast Hash Algorithm.........................................................................333 9.4.7 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................334 9.5 Configuring the Multicast Forwarding Scope................................................................................................334 9.5.1 Establish the Configuration Task..........................................................................................................335 9.5.2 Configuring the Multicast Forwarding Boundary.................................................................................335 9.5.3 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................336 9.6 Configuring Control Parameters of the Multicast Forwarding Table.............................................................336 9.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................336 9.6.2 Setting the Maximum Number of Entries in Multicast Forwarding Table............................................337 9.6.3 Setting the Maximum Number of Downstream Nodes of Multicast Forwarding Entry.......................338 9.6.4 Checking the Configuration...................................................................................................................340 9.7 Maintaining the Multicast Policy...................................................................................................................340 9.7.1 Testing Multicast Routing.....................................................................................................................340 9.7.2 Check RPF Paths and Multicast Paths...................................................................................................340 9.7.3 Clearing Multicast Routing and Forwarding Entries.............................................................................341 9.7.4 Monitoring the Status of Multicast Routing and Forwarding................................................................342 9.7.5 Debugging Multicast Routing and Forwarding.....................................................................................343 9.8 Configuration Examples.................................................................................................................................343 9.8.1 Example for Changing Static Multicast Routes to RPF Routes............................................................343 9.8.2 Example for Connecting RPF Routes Through Static Multicast Routes...............................................347 9.8.3 Example for Configuring Multicast Load Splitting...............................................................................352 10 MLD Configuration................................................................................................................361 10.1 MLD Overview.............................................................................................................................................363 10.2 MLD Features Supported by the S9700.......................................................................................................363 10.3 Configuring Basic MLD Functions..............................................................................................................364 10.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................364 10.3.2 Enabling IPv6 Multicast Routing........................................................................................................365 10.3.3 Enabling MLD.....................................................................................................................................365 10.3.4 (Optional) Configuring the MLD Version...........................................................................................366 10.3.5 (Optional) Configuring an Interface to Statically Join a Group..........................................................367 10.3.6 (Optional) Configuring the Range of Groups an Interface Can Join...................................................367 10.3.7 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................368 10.4 Configuring Options of an MLD Packet......................................................................................................368 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. xii S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast Contents 10.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................368 10.4.2 Configuring the Router-Alert Option of an MLD Packet....................................................................369 10.4.3 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................370 10.5 Configuring MLD Query Control.................................................................................................................370 10.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................370 10.5.2 (Optional) Configuring MLD Query and Response............................................................................371 10.5.3 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................374 10.6 Configuring SSM Mapping..........................................................................................................................374 10.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................374 10.6.2 Enabling SSM Mapping......................................................................................................................375 10.6.3 Configuring a Static SSM Mapping Policy.........................................................................................376 10.6.4 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................377 10.7 Configuration MLD Limit Function.............................................................................................................377 10.7.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................377 10.7.2 Configuring the Maximum Number of Global MLD Group Memberships........................................378 10.7.3 Configuring the Maximum Number of Global MLD Entries in a Single Instance.............................379 10.7.4 Configuring the Maximum Number of MLD Group Memberships on an Interface...........................379 10.7.5 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................380 10.8 Maintaining MLD.........................................................................................................................................380 10.8.1 Clearing Information about MLD Groups...........................................................................................381 10.8.2 Monitoring the Running Status of MLD.............................................................................................381 10.8.3 Debugging MLD..................................................................................................................................382 10.9 Configuration Example.................................................................................................................................383 10.9.1 Example for Configuring Basic MLD Functions................................................................................383 10.9.2 Example for Configuring MLD Limit.................................................................................................386 11 MLD Snooping Configuration..............................................................................................391 11.1 Overview of MLD Snooping........................................................................................................................392 11.2 MLD Snooping Features Supported by the S9700.......................................................................................392 11.3 Configuring Basic Functions of MLD Snooping.........................................................................................393 11.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................393 11.3.2 Enabling MLD snooping on the S9700...............................................................................................393 11.3.3 (Optional) Configuring an Interface as a Static Router Interface........................................................394 11.3.4 (Optional) Adding an Interface to a Multicast Group Statically.........................................................395 11.3.5 Enabling the MLD Snooping Querier.................................................................................................395 11.3.6 (Optional) Configuring MLD Message Suppression...........................................................................397 11.3.7 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................397 11.4 Configuring MLD Snooping Proxy..............................................................................................................398 11.5 Configuring an IPv6 Layer 2 Multicast Policy.............................................................................................399 11.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................399 11.5.2 Configuring a Multicast Group Policy................................................................................................400 11.5.3 Configuring Prompt Leave of Interfaces.............................................................................................401 11.5.4 Setting the Maximum Number of Multicast Groups That an Interface Can Dynamically Join..........401 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. xiii S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast Contents 11.5.5 Enabling IGMP Snooping...................................................................................................................402 11.5.6 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................402 11.6 (Optional) Modifying Parameters of MLD Snooping..................................................................................403 11.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................403 11.6.2 (Optional) Setting the Aging Time of the Router Interface.................................................................404 11.6.3 Setting the Duration for Suppressing the Same MLD Messages........................................................404 11.6.4 (Optional) Configuring the Router Alert Option in MLD Messages..................................................405 11.6.5 Enabling the MLD Snooping Module to Respond to Changes of the Layer 2 Network Topology ........................................................................................................................................................................405 11.6.6 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................406 11.7 Maintaining MLD Snooping........................................................................................................................407 11.7.1 Clearing MLD Snooping Entries.........................................................................................................407 11.7.2 Clearing the Statistics on MLD Snooping...........................................................................................407 11.7.3 Debugging MLD Snooping.................................................................................................................408 11.8 Configuration Examples...............................................................................................................................408 11.8.1 Example for Configuring a Multicast Group Policy...........................................................................408 11.8.2 Example for Configuring Prompt Leave of Interfaces in a VLAN.....................................................411 11.8.3 Example for Configuring a Static Router Interface.............................................................................413 11.8.4 Example for Enabling the MLD Snooping Module to Respond to Changes of the Layer 2 Network Topology.........................................................................................................................................................414 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration..............................................................................................419 12.1 PIM-IPv6 Overview.....................................................................................................................................421 12.2 PIM-DM Features Supported by the S9700.................................................................................................421 12.3 Configuring Basic PIM-DM (IPv6) Functions.............................................................................................422 12.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................422 12.3.2 Enabling IPv6 Multicast Routing........................................................................................................423 12.3.3 Enabling Basic PIM-DM (IPv6) Functions.........................................................................................423 12.3.4 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................424 12.4 Adjusting Control Parameters of a Source...................................................................................................425 12.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................425 12.4.2 Configuring the Keepalive Period of a Source....................................................................................425 12.4.3 Configuring Filtering Rules Based on Source Addresses...................................................................426 12.4.4 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................427 12.5 Adjusting Control Parameters for Maintaining Neighbors...........................................................................427 12.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................427 12.5.2 Configuring the Interval for Sending Hello Messages........................................................................428 12.5.3 Configuring the Timeout Period of a Neighbor...................................................................................429 12.5.4 Refusing to Receive the Hello Message Without the Generation ID Option......................................430 12.5.5 Configuring PIM Neighbor Filtering...................................................................................................431 12.5.6 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................431 12.6 Adjusting Control Parameters for Prune......................................................................................................432 12.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................432 12.6.2 Configuring the Period for an Interface to Keep the Prune State........................................................433 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. xiv S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast Contents 12.6.3 Configuring the Delay for Transmitting Prune Messages in a LAN...................................................434 12.6.4 Configuring the Interval for Overriding the Prune Action..................................................................435 12.6.5 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................436 12.7 Adjusting Control Parameters for State-Refresh..........................................................................................436 12.7.1 Estalishing the Configuration Task.....................................................................................................436 12.7.2 Disabling State-Refresh.......................................................................................................................437 12.7.3 Configuring the Interval for Sending State-Refresh Messages...........................................................438 12.7.4 Configuring the Period for Receiving the Next State-Refresh Message.............................................438 12.7.5 Configuring the TTL Value of a State-Refresh Message....................................................................439 12.7.6 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................439 12.8 Adjusting Control Messages for Graft..........................................................................................................440 12.8.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................440 12.8.2 Setting the Interval for Retransmitting Graft Messages......................................................................441 12.8.3 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................441 12.9 Adjusting Control Messages for Assert........................................................................................................442 12.9.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................442 12.9.2 Configuring the Period for Keeping the Assert State..........................................................................443 12.9.3 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................444 12.10 Configuring PIM-IPv6 Silent Function......................................................................................................444 12.10.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.................................................................................................445 12.10.2 Configuring PIM-IPv6 Silent............................................................................................................446 12.10.3 Checking the Configuration...............................................................................................................446 12.11 Maintaining PIM-DM.................................................................................................................................447 12.11.1 Clearing Statistics of PIM Control Messages....................................................................................447 12.11.2 Monitoring Running Status of PIM-DM...........................................................................................447 12.11.3 Debugging PIM-IPv6........................................................................................................................448 12.12 Configuration Example...............................................................................................................................449 12.12.1 Example for Configuring the IPv6 PIM-DM Network.....................................................................449 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration..............................................................................................454 13.1 PIM-IPv6 Overview.....................................................................................................................................456 13.2 PIM-SM Features Supported by the S9700..................................................................................................456 13.3 Configuring Basic PIM-SM (IPv6) Functions..............................................................................................458 13.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................459 13.3.2 Enabling IPv6 Multicast Routing........................................................................................................460 13.3.3 Enabling Basic PIM-SM (IPv6) Functions..........................................................................................460 13.3.4 (Optional) Configuring an Embedded-RP...........................................................................................461 13.3.5 (Optional) Configuring a Static RP.....................................................................................................462 13.3.6 (Optional) Configuring a Dynamic RP................................................................................................463 13.3.7 (Optional) Configuring the SSM Group Address Range.....................................................................464 13.3.8 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................465 13.4 Adjusting Control Parameters of a Source...................................................................................................466 13.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................466 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. xv S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast Contents 13.4.2 Configuring the Keepalive Period of a Source....................................................................................466 13.4.3 Configuring Filtering Rules Based on Source Addresses...................................................................467 13.4.4 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................468 13.5 Adjusting Control Parameters of a C-RP and a C-BSR...............................................................................468 13.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................468 13.5.2 Adjusting Control Parameters of a C-RP............................................................................................469 13.5.3 Adjusting Control Parameters of a C-BSR..........................................................................................470 13.5.4 Configuring the BSR Service Boundary.............................................................................................471 13.5.5 (Optional) Configuring the Range of Legal BSR addresses................................................................472 13.5.6 (Optional) Configuring the Range of Legal C-RP Addresses.............................................................472 13.5.7 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................473 13.6 Adjusting Control Parameters for Maintaining Neighbors...........................................................................473 13.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................474 13.6.2 Configuring Control Parameters for Maintaining PIM-IPv6 Neighbors.............................................474 13.6.3 Configuring Control Parameters for Electing a DR............................................................................476 13.6.4 Enabling the Function of Tracking a Downstream Neighbor..............................................................477 13.6.5 Configuring PIM Neighbor Filtering...................................................................................................478 13.6.6 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................479 13.7 Adjusting Control Parameters of Source Registering...................................................................................479 13.7.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................479 13.7.2 Configuring Rules for Filtering PIM-SM (IPv6) Register Messages..................................................480 13.7.3 Configuring PIM-SM (IPv6) Registering Suppression.......................................................................481 13.7.4 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................481 13.8 Adjusting Control Parameters for Forwarding.............................................................................................482 13.8.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................482 13.8.2 Configuring Control Parameters for Keeping the Forwarding Relationship.......................................483 13.8.3 Configuring Control Parameters for Prune..........................................................................................484 13.8.4 Configuring Join Information Filtering...............................................................................................485 13.8.5 (Optional) Configuring Parameters for Join/Prune Messages.............................................................486 13.8.6 Configuring Neighbor Check..............................................................................................................487 13.8.7 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................487 13.9 Configuring Control Parameters for Assert..................................................................................................488 13.9.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................488 13.9.2 Configuring the Period for Keeping the Assert State..........................................................................489 13.9.3 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................490 13.10 Adjusting Control Parameters for the SPT Switchover..............................................................................490 13.10.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.................................................................................................490 13.10.2 (Optional) Adjusting Conditions of the SPT Switchover..................................................................492 13.10.3 (Optional) Configuring the Interval for Checking the Forwarding Rate of Multicast Data..............492 13.10.4 Checking the Configuration...............................................................................................................493 13.11 Configuring PIM GR (IPv6).......................................................................................................................493 13.11.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.................................................................................................493 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. xvi S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast Contents 13.11.2 Enabling PIM GR (IPv6)...................................................................................................................494 13.11.3 Checking the Configuration...............................................................................................................495 13.12 Configuring PIM-IPv6 Silent.....................................................................................................................495 13.12.1 Establishing the Configuration Task.................................................................................................495 13.12.2 Configuring PIM-IPv6 Silent............................................................................................................496 13.12.3 Checking the Configuration...............................................................................................................497 13.13 Maintaining PIM-SM.................................................................................................................................497 13.13.1 Clearing Statistics of PIM-IPv6 Control Messages...........................................................................498 13.13.2 Clearing the PIM Status of the Specified Downstream Interfaces of PIM Entries...........................498 13.13.3 Monitoring the Running Status of PIM-SM......................................................................................499 13.13.4 Debugging PIM-IPv6........................................................................................................................499 13.14 Configuration Example...............................................................................................................................500 13.14.1 Example for Configuring the IPv6 PIM-SM Network......................................................................500 13.14.2 Example for Configuring PIM GR (IPv6).........................................................................................508 14 IPv6 Multicast Routing Management..................................................................................516 14.1 Overview of IPv6 Multicast Routing Management......................................................................................518 14.2 IPv6 Multicast Routing Management Features Supported by the S9700.....................................................518 14.3 Configuring the IPv6 Multicast Routing Policy...........................................................................................519 14.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................519 14.3.2 Configuring IPv6 Multicast Load Splitting.........................................................................................520 14.3.3 Configuring an IPv6 Multicast Load Splitting Weight.......................................................................521 14.3.4 (Optional) Optimizing Storage for Multicast Forwarding Entries......................................................522 14.3.5 Configuring the Multicast Hash Algorithm.........................................................................................523 14.3.6 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................523 14.4 Limiting the Range of Multicast Forwarding...............................................................................................524 14.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................524 14.4.2 Configuring the IPv6 Multicast Forwarding Boundary on an Interface..............................................524 14.4.3 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................525 14.5 Configuring Control Parameters of the IPv6 Multicast Forwarding Table..................................................525 14.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task...................................................................................................525 14.5.2 Configuring the Maximum Number of Entries in the IPv6 Multicast Forwarding Table...................526 14.5.3 Configuring the Maximum Number of Downstream Nodes of a Single Forwarding Entry...............527 14.5.4 Checking the Configuration.................................................................................................................527 14.6 Maintaining IPv6 Multicast Routing Management......................................................................................528 14.6.1 Clearing IPv6 Multicast Forwarding Entries and Routing Entries......................................................528 14.6.2 Monitoring the Running Status of IPv6 Multicast Forwarding and Routing......................................528 14.6.3 Debugging IPv6 Multicast Forwarding and Routing..........................................................................529 14.7 Configuration Examples...............................................................................................................................530 14.7.1 Example for Configuring IPv6 Multicast Load Splitting....................................................................530 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. xvii S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 1 1 IP Multicast Configuration Guide IP Multicast Configuration Guide About This Chapter The system supports the construction of multicast services through multicast protocols in IPv4 and IPv6 networks. In addition, the typical configuration solutions of multicast networks are provided. 1.1 IP Multicast Overview 1.2 IP Multicast Features Supported by the S9700 1.3 IPv4 Multicast Configuration Guide This section describes multicast addresses, protocols, and typical configuration solutions in IPv4 networks. 1.4 IPv6 Multicast Configuration Guide This section describes multicast addresses, protocols, and typical configuration solutions on an IPv6 network. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 1 IP Multicast Configuration Guide 1.1 IP Multicast Overview Multicast is a Point to Multi-Point (P2MP) data transmission mode. During data transmission, multicast can ensure the security of information. Multicast consumes limited network bandwidth. The multicast technology applied to IPv4 and IPv6 is called IP multicast. The Internet services implemented through IP multicast include IPTV, Video and Audio Conferences, e-learning, and remote medicine. 1.2 IP Multicast Features Supported by the S9700 In the S9700, IPv4 networks and IPv6 networks can support multicast services, but networks that run IPv4 and IPv6 simultaneously do not support multicast services. 1.3 IPv4 Multicast Configuration Guide This section describes multicast addresses, protocols, and typical configuration solutions in IPv4 networks. 1.3.1 IPv4 Multicast Addresses The IPv4 multicast addresses range from 224.0.0.0 to 239.255.255.255. Table 1-1 shows the ranges of various IPv4 multicast addresses. The multicast group address available for multicast data services ranges from 224.0.1.0 to 239.255.255.255. Any host (or other receiving device) that joins a multicast group within this range becomes a member of the group, and can identify and receive IP packets with the IP multicast address as the destination address. The members of a group can be distributed at any position in the network. The hosts can join or leave a multicast group at any time. Table 1-1 Class D addresses Class D Address Range Description 224.0.0.0 to 224.0.0.255 Indicates the reserved group addresses for local links. The addresses are reserved by Internet Assigned Number Authority (IANA) for routing protocols, and are called permanent multicast group addresses. The addresses are used to identify a group of specific network devices rather than being used for multicast forwarding. 224.0.1.0 to 231.255.255.255 Indicates Any-Source Multicast (ASM) addresses. The addresses are valid in the entire network. 233.0.0.0 to 238.255.255.255 232.0.0.0 to 232.255.255.255 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Indicates Source-Specific Multicast (SSM) addresses. This is the default SSM group address scope, and is valid in the entire network. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 2 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 1 IP Multicast Configuration Guide Class D Address Range Description 239.0.0.0 to 239.255.255.255 Indicates administration multicast addresses. The default range of BSR administrative domain group addresses is valid only in the local BSR administration domain. The addresses are private addresses. You can configure the same address in different BSR administration domains. 1.3.2 IPv4 Multicast Protocols To implement a complete set of IPv4 multicast services, various multicast protocols deployed in the network need to cooperate with each other, as shown in Figure 1-1. Figure 1-1 Location of each IPv4 multicast protocol IPv4 Network AS1 IPv4 Network AS2 Source PIM MSDP PIM IGMP IGMP User Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. User 3 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 1 IP Multicast Configuration Guide Table 1-2 Multicast protocols Applied Location Objectives Multicast Protocol Between hosts and multicast switches Connecting hosts to a multicast network: Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) l Ensure that the members can dynamically join and leave a group at the host side. l Manage and maintain the member relationship at the switch side and exchange information with the upper-layer multicast routing protocols. Between intra-domain multicast switches Multicast routing and forwarding: l Create multicast routes on demand. l Respond to the changes of the network topology and maintain the multicast routing table. Protocol Independent Multicast (PIM), including Protocol Independent Multicast-Dense Mode (PIM-DM) and Protocol Independent MulticastSparse Mode (PIM-SM) l Forward packets according to the routing table. Between inter-domain multicast switches Sharing information about interdomain multicast sources: l Switches in the domain where the source resides transmit the local source information to switches in other domains. Multicast Source Discovery Protocol (MSDP) l Switches in different domains transmit the source information. 1.3.3 Typical Configuration Solution CAUTION Customize configuration solutions according to the actual network conditions and service requirements. The configuration solution in this section functions only as a reference. The network environments are classified into two types, which need different configuration solutions. For details, refer to the S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide Multicast. NOTE Ensure that unicast routes work normally in the network before configuring IP multicast. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 4 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 1 IP Multicast Configuration Guide Small-Scale Network A small-scale network, such as a test network, is suitable to implement multicast data transmission in a Local Area Network (LAN), and does not interconnect with the Internet. Perform the following configurations: 1. Enable multicast on all S9700s in the network. 2. Enable PIM-DM on all interfaces of the S9700s. 3. Enable IGMP on the S9700 interface connected to hosts. 4. If multicast needs to be deployed in a VPN, perform the preceding configurations in the private network and public network respectively, and configure the Multicast Domain (MD) on PEs. Large-Scale Network A large-scale network is suitable to transmit multicast services on an ISP network, and interconnects with the Internet. Perform the following configurations: 1. Enable multicast on all S9700s in the network. 2. Enable PIM-SM on all interfaces of the S9700s. 3. Enable IGMP on the S9700 interface connected to hosts. 4. Configure an RP, specify a static RP, or elect an RP from C-RPs. 5. Divide a network into PIM-SM domains. 6. Configure MSDP in the PIM-SM domain and implement the anycast RP. 7. Configure MSDP between PIM-SM domains. Generally, MSDP cooperates with MBGP. 1.3.4 Controlling Multicast Forwarding IP multicast guides the forwarding of multicast packets by using the multicast routing table and forwarding table. You can adjust the transmission path of multicast data by configuring the Reverse Path Forwarding (RPF) routing policy, and limit multicast forwarding by configuring the forwarding policy and the capacity of the forwarding table. For details, refer to the chapter 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management in the S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast. 1.4 IPv6 Multicast Configuration Guide This section describes multicast addresses, protocols, and typical configuration solutions on an IPv6 network. 1.4.1 IPv6 Multicast Addresses Figure 1-2 shows the format of an IPv6 multicast address. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 5 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 1 IP Multicast Configuration Guide Figure 1-2 Format of an IPv6 multicast address 0 7 FF 11 flags 15 scope 31 reserved (80bit) group ID (32bit) The meaning of each field is as follows: l The IPv6 multicast address begins with FF. l Flags (four-bit): The meaning of the last bit is as follows: – 0: indicates that the address is a well-known multicast address defined by IANA. – 1 or 2: indicates multicast addresses within the ASM group address range. – 3: indicates multicast addresses within the SSM group address range. – Other: indicates unallocated ones. It can also indicate the multicast addresses within the ASM group address range. l Scope (four-bit): indicates that the multicast group contains only the nodes of the same local network, the same site, and the same organization. The meaning of each field is as follows: – 0: reserved – 1: node/interface-local scope – 2: link-local scope – 3: reserved – 4: admin-local scope – 5: site-local scope – 8: organization-local scope – E: global scope – F: reserved – Other: unassigned Table 1-3 shows the scopes and meanings of fixed IPv6 multicast addresses. Table 1-3 Description of IPv6 Multicast Addresses Scope Description FF0x::/32 Indicates the well-known multicast addresses defined by the IANA. For details, see Table 1-4. FF1x::/32 (x cannot be 1 or 2) Indicates ASM addresses. The addresses are valid in the entire network. FF2x::/32 (x cannot be 1 or 2) FF3x::/32 (x cannot be 1 or 2) Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Indicates SSM addresses. This is the default SSM group address scope, and is valid in the entire network. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 6 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 1 IP Multicast Configuration Guide Table 1-4 Description of commonly-used IPv6 multicast Addresses Scope IPv6 Multicast Address Description Node/interface-local scope FF01:0:0:0:0:0:0:1 Indicates all node (interface) addresses. FF01:0:0:0:0:0:0:2 Indicates all router addresses. Link-local scope FF02:0:0:0:0:0:0:1 Indicates all node addresses. FF02:0:0:0:0:0:0:2 Indicates all router addresses. FF02:0:0:0:0:0:0:3 Indicates the undefined address. FF02:0:0:0:0:0:0:4 Indicates the Distance Vector Multicast Routing Protocol (DVMRP) routers. FF02:0:0:0:0:0:0:5 Indicates OSPF IGP routers. FF02:0:0:0:0:0:0:6 Indicates OSPF IGP designated routers. FF02:0:0:0:0:0:0:7 Indicates ST routers. FF02:0:0:0:0:0:0:8 Indicates ST hosts. FF02:0:0:0:0:0:0:9 Indicates RIP routers. FF02:0:0:0:0:0:0:A Indicates EIGRP routers. FF02:0:0:0:0:0:0:B Indicates mobile agents. FF02:0:0:0:0:0:0:D Indicates all PIM routers. FF02:0:0:0:0:0:0:E Indicates RSVP encapsulation. FF02:0:0:0:0:0:1:1 Indicates the link name. FF02:0:0:0:0:0:1:2 Indicates all DHCP agents. FF02:0:0:0:0:1:FFXX:X XXX Indicates the solicited node address. XX:XXXX indicates the last 24 bits of the IPv6 address of a node. FF05:0:0:0:0:0:0:2 Indicates all router addresses. FF05:0:0:0:0:0:1:3 Indicates all DHCP severs. FF05:0:0:0:0:0:1:4 Indicates all DHCP relays. FF05:0:0:0:0:0:1:1000 to FF05:0:0:0:0:0:1:13FF Indicates the service location. Site-local scope Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 7 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 1 IP Multicast Configuration Guide 1.4.2 IPv6 Multicast Protocols To implement a complete set of IPv6 multicast services, various multicast protocols deployed in a network need to cooperate with each other, as shown in Figure 1-3. Figure 1-3 Location of each IPv6 multicast protocol IPv6 Network MLD Receiver UserA PIM Source Multicast Receiver UserB PIM Server PIM MLD Receiver UserC UserD Table 1-5 IPv6 multicast protocols Location Objectives Multicast Protocol Between hosts and multicast switches Connecting hosts to a multicast network: Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD) l Implement the dynamic join and leaving of members at the host side. l Manage and maintain the member relationship at the switch side and exchange information with the upperlayer multicast routing protocols. Between multicast switches Multicast routing and forwarding: l Create multicast routes on demand. PIM-IPv6, including the PIMDM and PIM-SM modes l Dynamically respond to the changes of the network topology and maintain the multicast routing table. l Forward packets according to the routing table. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 8 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 1 IP Multicast Configuration Guide 1.4.3 Typical Configuration Solution CAUTION Customize configuration solutions according to the actual network conditions and service requirements. The configuration solution in this section functions only as a reference. The network environments are classified into two types, which are suitable for different configuration solutions. For details, refer to the S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast. NOTE Ensure that IPv6 unicast routes work normally in the network before configuring IP multicast. Small-Scale Network A small-scale network, such as a test network, is suitable to implement multicast data transmission in a Local Area Network (LAN), and does not interconnect with the Internet. Perform the following configurations: 1. Enable multicast on all switches in the network. 2. Enable PIM-DM (IPv6) on all switch interfaces. 3. Enable MLD on switch interfaces connected to hosts. Large-Scale Network A large-scale network is suitable to transmit multicast services on an ISP network, and interconnects with the Internet. Perform the following configurations: 1. Enable multicast on all switches in the network. 2. Enable PIM-SM (IPv6) on all switch interfaces. 3. Enable MLD on switch interfaces connected to hosts. 4. Configure an RP. You can configure an embedded RP, a static RP, or a BSR-RP. 1.4.4 Controlling Multicast Forwarding IP multicast guides the forwarding of multicast packets by using the multicast routing table and forwarding table. You can adjust the transmission path of multicast data by configuring the RPF routing policy, and limit multicast forwarding by configuring the forwarding policy and the capacity of the forwarding table. For details, refer to the chapter 14 IPv6 Multicast Routing Management in the S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 9 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration About This Chapter This chapter describes the procedure for configuring IGMP snooping and maintenance commands, and provides configuration examples. 2.1 IGMP Snooping Overview This section describes the functions and advantages of the IGMP snooping protocol. 2.2 IGMP Snooping Supported by the S9700 This section describes IGMP snooping features supported by the S9700. 2.3 Configuring IGMP Snooping This section describes how to configure IGMP snooping in a VLAN. 2.4 Configuring a Static Multicast MAC Address This section describes how to configure a static multicast MAC address. 2.5 Configuring the IGMP Snooping Proxy for the VLAN This section describes how to configure IGMP snooping proxy. 2.6 Configuring a Layer 2 Multicast Policy This section describes how to configure a Layer 2 multicast policy. 2.7 Configuring Layer 2 Multicast CAC This section describes how to configure the Layer 2 multicast CAC function. 2.8 Configuring Layer 2 Multicast SSM Mapping This section describes how to configure the Layer 2 multicast SSM mapping function. 2.9 Maintaining Layer 2 Multicast Maintaining Layer 2 multicast involves resetting Layer 2 Multicast statistics, and debugging IGMP Snooping. 2.10 Configuration examples This section provides several configuration examples of Layer 2 multicast. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 10 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration 2.1 IGMP Snooping Overview This section describes the functions and advantages of the IGMP snooping protocol. IGMP Snooping Function Internet Group Management Protocol Snooping (IGMP snooping) is a Layer 2 multicast protocol. The IGMP snooping protocol maintains information about the outgoing interfaces of multicast packets by listening to multicast protocol packets exchanged between the router and hosts. Thus the IGMP snooping protocol manages and controls the forwarding of multicast packets. After receiving multicast packets from an upstream device, an Ethernet device at the edge of the access network forwards the multicast packets to multicast receivers. As shown in Figure 2-1, multicast data is broadcast at the data link layer by default, which wastes network bandwidth and causes multicast data to be sent to unpaid subscribers. If IGMP snooping is configured on the Layer 2 device, multicast data of a known group is forwarded to specified receivers (paid subscribers) but not broadcast at the data link layer. Figure 2-1 Comparison before and after IGMP snooping is configured on a Layer 2 device Multicast packet transmission without IGMP Snooping Multicast packet transmission when IGMP Snooping runs Source Source Router Router PIM PIM Switch Reciever A Reciever B Switch Reciever A Reciever B Multicast Packet Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 11 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration IGMP Snooping Advantages The IGMP snooping protocol forwards multicast information only to the specified receivers through Layer 2 multicast. It has the following advantages: l Reducing broadcast packets on Layer 2 networks, and thus saving network bandwidth l Enhancing the security of multicast information l Performing accounting for each host independently 2.2 IGMP Snooping Supported by the S9700 This section describes IGMP snooping features supported by the S9700. Basic Features of IGMP Snooping The S9700 supports VLAN-based IGMP snooping. IGMP snooping implements Layer 2 multicast and controls multicast data forwarding by listening to multicast protocol packets sent between an upstream router and a downstream host and maintaining downstream interface information. The S9700 supports the following IGMP snooping functions: l Configures a router interface as a static router interface. l Adds interfaces to a multicast group statically. l Supports the IGMP snooping querier function. l Suppresses IGMP snooping messages. l Adjusts IGMP snooping parameters to optimize the Layer 2 multicast network. Static Multicast MAC Address In Layer 2 multicast, you can dynamically create multicast MAC address entries using Layer 2 multicast protocols such as IGMP snooping or manually configure multicast MAC address entries. After a multicast MAC address is configured on an interface, the MAC address is bound to the interface and multicast packets destined for this MAC address are forwarded only by this interface. IGMP Snooping Proxy Configuring IGMP snooping proxy on an edge device can reduce the number of IGMP Report and Leave messages received by an upstream Layer 3 device and improve performance of the upstream Layer 3 device. The device configured with IGMP snooping proxy functions as a host for its upstream device and a querier for its downstream host. Layer 2 Multicast Policy The S9700 uses Layer 2 multicast policies according to networking requirements: l Configures a multicast group policy to control the multicast groups that users can join. l Enables interfaces to quickly leave multicast groups. l Configures multicast entry overwriting. l Filters Layer 2 multicast data on an interface. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 12 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast l 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration Discards unknown multicast data packets, preventing them from being broadcast in VLANs. IGMP Snooping SSM Mapping In the SSM model, if IGMPv3 is run on a receiver host, you can specify the multicast source for IGMPv3 multicast data packets; if only IGMPv1 or IGMPv2 can be run on the receiver host, you cannot specify the multicast source for IGMPv1 or IGMPv2 multicast data packets. IGMP snooping SSM mapping is a solution. It generates a mapping between a multicast group and a multicast source. (*, G) information in IGMPv1 or IGMPv2 multicast data packets is then mapped to (S, G) information, providing SSM services for the hosts running IGMPv1 or IGMPv2. Layer 2 Multicast CAC CAC is short for Call Admission Control. The Layer 2 multicast CAC is a part of the IPTV multicast solution. This function limits the number of IPTV programs in Layer 2 multicast, ensuring the service quality for most users. This function has the following advantages: l Controls multicast service accurately. l Ensures the service quality for most VoD users. l Reduces the impact of multicast attack. 2.3 Configuring IGMP Snooping This section describes how to configure IGMP snooping in a VLAN. 2.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task Applicable Environment Internet Group Management Protocol Snooping (IGMP snooping) is a Layer 2 multicast protocol. The IGMP snooping protocol maintains information about the outgoing interfaces of multicast packets by listening to multicast protocol packets exchanged between the router and hosts. Thus the IGMP snooping protocol manages and controls the forwarding of multicast packets. If IGMP snooping is configured on the Layer 2 device, multicast data of a known group is forwarded to specified receivers (paid subscribers) but not broadcast at the data link layer. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring IGMP snooping in a VLAN, complete the following tasks: l Connecting interfaces and configuring the physical parameters of each interface to make the physical layer in Up state l Creating a VLAN l Adding interfaces to the VLAN Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 13 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration Data Preparation To configure IGMP snooping in a VLAN, you need the following data. No. Data 1 ID of the VLAN 2 (Optional) Version of IGMP messages 3 (Optional) Types and numbers of interfaces 4 (Optional) Parameters of a querier: interval for sending IGMP General Query messages, robustness variable, maximum response time, and interval for sending Last Member Query messages 5 (Optional) Suppression duration of IGMP messages 6 (Optional) Aging time of the router interface 7 (Optional) Source IP address of IGMP Query messages 2.3.2 Enabling IGMP Snooping Context By default, IGMP snooping is disabled on the S9700. You need to enable IGMP snooping on the S9700. You can set the forwarding mode of multicast data so that the multicast flows can be forwarded based on IP addresses or MAC addresses. When multicast IP addresses are mapped to MAC addresses, up to 32 IP addresses can be mapped to one MAC address. Therefore, it is recommended that multicast data be forwarded based on IP addresses; otherwise, unregistered users may receive the multicast data. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 (Optional) Run: assign multicast-resource-mode optimize The multicast forwarding table is optimized. If a multicast forwarding table needs to contain more than 4096 entries, run this command to optimize the multicast forwarding table before enabling IGMP snooping. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 14 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration Step 3 Run: igmp-snooping enable IGMP snooping is enabled globally. Step 4 Run: vlan vlan-id The VLAN view is displayed. Step 5 (Optional)Run: l2-multicast forwarding-mode { ip | mac } The multicast flows in the VLAN are forwarded based on IP addresses or MAC addresses. By default, multicast flows are forwarded based on IP addresses. CAUTION Before setting the forwarding mode of multicast data in a VLAN, disable IGMP snooping in the VLAN. After setting the forwarding mode, enable IGMP snooping in the VLAN for the configuration to take effect. Step 6 Run: igmp-snooping enable IGMP snooping is enabled in the VLAN. NOTE To enable the IGMP Snooping function of multi-VLANs, run the igmp-snooping enable [ vlan vlan-id1 [ to vlan-id2 ] & <1-10> ] command in the system-view. Step 7 (Optional)Run: igmp-snooping version { 1 | 2 |3 } The version of IGMP messages that the S9700 can process is set. By default, the S9700 can process messages of IGMPv1 and IGMPv2 but cannot process messages of IGMPv3. NOTE When the forwarding in a VLAN is based on the MAC address, the IGMP message version cannot be set to IGMPv3. ----End 2.3.3 (Optional) Configuring a Static Router Interface Context By default, dynamic interface learning is enabled in a VLAN. A switch decides whether to add dynamic router interfaces by monitoring IGMP Query or PIM Hello messages. When a dynamic router interface does not receive an IGMP Query or a PIM Hello message before it times out, the switch deletes the interface from the router interface list. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 15 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration If a switch needs to forward multicast data from an interface for a long period of time, configure this interface as a static router interface. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: vlan vlan-id The VLAN view is displayed. Step 3 Run: (Optional)undo igmp-snooping router-learning Dynamic learning of router interfaces is disabled in the VLAN. Step 4 Run: quit The system view is displayed. Step 5 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be an Ethernet interface, a GE interface, an XGE interface, or an Eth-Trunk interface. It is the interface that connects the S9700 to the upstream router. Step 6 Run: igmp-snooping static-router-port vlan { { vlan-id [ to vlan-id ] } &<1-10> } The interface is configured as a static router interface. ----End 2.3.4 (Optional) Configuring Multicast Group Member Interfaces Context By default, an interface dynamically learns forwarding entries. A switch decides whether to add dynamic member interfaces by monitoring IGMP Membership Report messages. If a dynamic member interface does not receive an IGMP Membership Report message from a multicast group before the interface times out, the switch deletes the interface from the outbound interface list. If the hosts connected to an interface need to receive the multicast data of a specific multicast group or multicast source group, add the interface statically to the multicast group or multicast source group. The interface is called a static member interface. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 16 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be an Ethernet interface, a GE interface, an XGE interface, or an Eth-Trunk interface. Step 3 (Optional) Run: undo igmp-snooping learning vlan { vlan-id { [ &<1-10> ][to vlan-id ] | all } } The interface is disabled from learning forwarding entries. Step 4 Run: l2-multicast static-group { [ source-address source-ip-address ] group-address group-ip-address } vlan { { vlan-id1 [ to vlan-id2 ] } &<1-10> } The interface is added to a multicast group statically. It is then a static member interface. You can also run the l2-multicast static-group [ source-address source-ip-address ] groupaddress group-ip-address1 to group-ip-address2 vlan vlan-id command to add the interface to multiple multicast groups. ----End 2.3.5 (Optional) Configuring IGMP Snooping Querier Context If IGMP messages sent from the upstream router cannot reach the S9700 for certain reasons, for example, IGMP is not enabled or if the multicast forwarding entries on the upstream router are statically configured and do not need to be dynamically learned, you can configure the IGMP snooping querier on the S9700. The IGMP snooping querier then sends IGMP Query messages. You can adjust parameters of the IGMP snooping querier as required. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: vlan vlan-id The VLAN view is displayed. Step 3 Run: igmp-snooping querier enable The IGMP snooping querier is enabled for the VLAN. By default, an IGMP snooping querier is disabled. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 17 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration NOTE After IGMP snooping querier is enabled in a VLAN, the switch periodically broadcasts IGMP Query messages to all the interfaces in the VLAN, including router interfaces. This may result in IGMP snooping querier reelection. If an IGMP snooping querier already exists on a multicast network, configuring IGMP snooping querier is not recommended. IGMP snooping querier cannot be enabled in a VLAN if the corresponding VLANIF interface has IGMP enabled. IGMP snooping querier and IGMP snooping proxy cannot be enabled in the same VLAN. Step 4 (Optional) Run: igmp-snooping query-interval query-interval The interval at which the querier sends IGMP General Query messages is set. By default, the interval for sending IGMP General Query messages is 60 seconds. Step 5 (Optional) Run: igmp-snooping robust-count robust-count The robustness variable of the querier is set. By default, the IGMP robustness variable is 2. Step 6 (Optional) Run: igmp-snooping max-response-time max-response-time The maximum response time of IGMP Query messages is set. By default, the maximum response time of IGMP Query messages is 10 seconds. NOTE The maximum response time must be shorter than the interval at which General Query messages are sent. When receiving IGMP Report messages from hosts, the S9700 sets the aging time of member interfaces using the following formula: Aging time = IGMP robustness variable x Interval at which IGMP General Query messages are sent + Maximum response time. Step 7 (Optional) Run: igmp-snooping lastmember-queryinterval lastmember-queryinterval The interval at which the querier sends Last Member Query (IGMP Group-Specific Query) messages is set. By default, the interval at which IGMP Group-Specific Query messages are sent is 1 second. NOTE After receiving IGMP Leave messages from hosts, the S9700 sets the aging time of member interfaces by using the following formula: Interval at which IGMP Group-Specific Query messages are sent x IGMP robustness variable. IGMPv1 hosts do not send Leave messages when leaving multicast groups. Therefore, the igmp-snooping lastmember-queryinterval command is valid only when the IGMP snooping version is set to 2 in the VLAN. Step 8 (Optional) Run: quit Return to the system view. Step 9 (Optional) Run: igmp-snooping send-query source-address ip-address Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 18 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration The source IP address of an IGMP General Query message is set. By default, the source address of an IGMP General Query message is 192.168.0.1. When 192.168.0.1 has been used by other devices on the network, run this command to change the source IP address of an IGMP General Query message. ----End 2.3.6 (Optional) Configuring IGMP Message Suppression Context Hosts running IGMP in a VLAN use a snooping mechanism to suppress Report messages that member hosts send to join the same multicast group. However, many duplicate Report messages may be sent when the suppression time expires. In addition, hosts running IGMPv2 and IGMPv3 send duplicate Leave messages when they leave a multicast group. After a Layer 2 device is enabled to suppress Report and Leave messages, it sends Membership Report messages only when the first member joins a multicast group or the last member of a multicast group leaves the group. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: vlan vlan-id The VLAN view is displayed. Step 3 Run: igmp-snooping report-suppress IGMP message suppression is enabled. NOTE When configuring IGMP message suppression, pay attention to the following points: l When IGMP message suppression is configured in a VLAN, IGMP cannot be enabled on the corresponding VLANIF interface. l The functions of IGMP snooping proxy and IGMP message suppression cannot be configured in the same VLAN. l The switch can suppress duplicate Membership Report messages even when IGMP message suppression is disabled. The default message suppression time is 10 seconds. To change the suppression time, run the igmp-snooping suppress-time suppress-time command. To disable IGMP message suppression, set the suppression time to 0. ----End 2.3.7 (Optional) Disabling Users from Dynamically Joining Multicast Groups Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 19 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration Context If an upstream multicast group is a non-Huawei device and has static multicast groups configured on the interface connected to the S9700, multicast users are not allowed to dynamically join or leave the multicast groups. In this case, disable the S9700 from sending IGMP Membership Report messages to the upstream router. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: vlan vlan-id The VLAN view is displayed. Step 3 Run: igmp-snooping static-group suppress-dynamic-join The S9700 is disabled from sending IGMP Membership Report messages to the upstream router so that multicast users cannot dynamically join or leave multicast groups. ----End 2.3.8 (Optional) Adjusting IGMP Snooping Parameters Context You can adjust the following IGMP snooping parameters to optimize the S9700 multicast performance according to the actual network situation. l Aging time of a router interface When a short-term congestion occurs on the network, it takes a longer time to transmit Query messages from the IGMP querier to the S9700. If a router interface on the S9700 ages within this period, the S9700 does not send Report or Leave messages to the router interface. As a result, multicast data forwarding may be interrupted. To solve this problem, set a longer aging time for the router interface on an unstable network. l Router-Alert option By default, the S9700 does not check whether IGMP messages contain the Router-Alert option and sends all the IGMP messages to the upper-layer routing protocol. Discarding IGMP messages without the Router-Alert option improves device performance, reduces cost, and enhances security of the upper-layer routing protocol. l Response to Layer 2 topology change events This function enables the S9700 to detect Layer 2 topology changes and correctly forward multicast data according to the new topology. l Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Source IP address of IGMP Query messages sent by the S9700 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 20 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: vlan vlan-id The VLAN view is displayed. Step 3 Run: igmp-snooping router-aging-time router-aging-time The aging time is set for router interfaces. By default: l If a router interface receives an IGMP Query message, the S9700 sets the remaining aging time of the interface to 180 seconds. l If the router interface receives a PIM Hello packet and the Holdtime value of the Hello packet is larger than the remaining aging time of the interface, the S9700 sets the aging time of the interface to the Holdtime value contained in the PIM Hello packet. If the Holdtime value of the Hello packet is smaller than the remaining aging time of the interface, the S9700 does not reset the aging time of the interface. Step 4 Run: igmp-snooping require-router-alert The S9700 is configured to process only the IGMP messages with the Router-Alert option in the IP header. By default, the S9700 can process the IGMP messages without the Router-Alert option in the IP header received from a VLAN. Step 5 Run: igmp-snooping send-router-alert The S9700 is configured to send the IGMP messages with the Router-Alert option in the IP header. By default, the S9700 sends the IGMP messages with the Router-Alert option in the IP header. Step 6 Run: quit Exit the VLAN view. Step 7 Run: igmp-snooping send-query enable The S9700 is configured to send IGMP General Query messages when receiving topology change events. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 21 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration NOTE This command is generally used on a ring network. When the ring network topology changes, the S9700 sends IGMP General Query messages with source IP address 0.0.0.0. If the source IP address of IGMP General Query messages is not 0.0.0.0, run the igmp-snooping send-query source-address ip-address command to set the source IP address to 0.0.0.0. ----End 2.3.9 Checking the Configuration Prerequisites The configuration of IGMP snooping in a VLAN is complete. Procedure l Run the display igmp-snooping configuration command to check the non-default configurations of IGMP snooping. l Run the display igmp-snooping [ vlan vlan-id ] command to check the configuration of IGMP snooping in a VLAN. l Run the display igmp-snooping statistics vlan [ vlan-id ] command to check the statistics of IGMP snooping in a VLAN. l Run the display igmp-snooping port-info [ vlan vlan-id [ group-address groupaddress ] ] [ verbose ] command to check the information about member interfaces of a multicast group. l Run the display igmp-snooping router-port vlan vlan-idcommand to check the information about router interfaces. l Run the display l2-multicast forwarding-table vlan [ [ source-address sourceaddress ] group-address { group-address | router-group } ] command to check the multicast forwarding table of a VLAN. l Run the display igmp-snooping querier vlan [ vlan-id ] command to check the enabling information about the IGMP snooping querier. ----End Example Run the display igmp-snooping configuration command, and you can view the information about the non-default IGMP snooping configurations of all VLANs. <Quidway> display igmp-snooping configuration IGMP Snooping Configuration for VLAN 7 igmp-snooping enable igmp-snooping version 3 igmp-snooping querier enable If the configurations succeed, you can obtain the following information after running the display igmp-snooping [ vlan vlan-id ] command: l IGMP snooping is enabled in the VLAN. l The IGMP version is set correctly. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 22 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration l Aging time of the router interface, interval for sending Last Member Query messages, interval for sending IGMP General Query messages, maximum response time, suppression duration of IGMP messages, and IGMP robustness variable are correctly set. l The Router Alert option is set correctly. l The function that sends IGMP Query messages to member interfaces in a VLAN and packet suppression function are configured correctly. l Router interface learning is configured correctly. The following is an example. <Quidway> display igmp-snooping vlan 3 IGMP Snooping Information for VLAN 3 IGMP Snooping is Enabled IGMP Version is Set to default 2 IGMP Query Interval is Set to default 60 IGMP Max Response Interval is Set to default 10 IGMP Robustness is Set to default 2 IGMP Last Member Query Interval is Set to default 1 IGMP Router Port Aging Interval is Set to 180s or holdtime in hello IGMP Filter Group-Policy is Set to default : Permit All IGMP Prompt Leave Disable IGMP Router Alert is Not Required IGMP Send Router Alert Enable IGMP Proxy Disable IGMP Report Suppress Disable IGMP Suppress Time is set to default 10 seconds IGMP Querier Disable IGMP Router Port Learning Enable IGMP SSM-Mapping Disable IGMP Suppress-dynamic-join Disable Run the display igmp-snooping router-port vlan vlan-id command, and you can view the information about router interfaces. <Quidway> display igmp-snooping router-port vlan 3 Port Name UpTime Expires Flags -------------------------------------------------------------VLAN 3, 2 router-port(s) GE2/0/1 03:28:16 00:01:20 DYNAMIC GE2/0/3 2d:10h -STATIC Run the display igmp-snooping port-info [ vlan vlan-id ] [ group-address group-address ] [ verbose ] command, and you can view the information about member interfaces. <Quidway> display igmp-snooping port-info ----------------------------------------------------------------------(Source, Group) Port Flag Flag: S:Static D:Dynamic M: Ssm-mapping ----------------------------------------------------------------------VLAN 101, 1 Entry(s) (*, 225.0.0.1) GE1/0/1 -S1 port(s) VLAN 102, 1 Entry(s) (*, 225.0.0.1) GE1/0/2 -D1 port(s) ----------------------------------------------------------------------- Run the display l2-multicast forwarding-table vlan 7 command, and you can view the multicast forwarding table of VLAN 7. <Quidway> display l2-multicast forwarding-table vlan 7 VLAN ID : 7, Forwarding Mode : IP ----------------------------------------------------------------------(Source, Group) Interface Out-Vlan ----------------------------------------------------------------------Router-port GigabitEthernet1/0/0 7 (1.1.1.1, 232.1.1.1) GigabitEthernet1/0/0 7 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 23 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration GigabitEthernet2/0/0 7 ----------------------------------------------------------------------Total Group(s) : 1 Run the display igmp-snooping querier vlan [ vlan-id ] command. If the querier is displayed as Enabled, it indicates that the querier is successfully enabled. <Quidway> display igmp-snooping querier vlan VLAN Querier-state ----------------------------------------------3 Enable total entry 1 2.4 Configuring a Static Multicast MAC Address This section describes how to configure a static multicast MAC address. Applicable Environment If a Layer 2 switch receives a multicast data packet whose destination MAC address is not a multicast MAC address, the switch cannot find the matching entry in the MAC address table. Therefore, the switch broadcasts the multicast packet in the VLAN. This wastes bandwidth and threatens network security. To save bandwidth and ensure network security, configure a static multicast MAC address on an interface so that multicast packets destined for the multicast MAC address are forwarded only by this interface. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring a static multicast MAC address, complete the following task: l Creating a VLAN and adding the interface that needs to be configured with a static multicast MAC address to the VLAN Data Preparation To configure a static multicast MAC address, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Number of the interface to be configured with a static multicast MAC address 2 ID of the VLAN that the interface belongs to Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Configure a static multicast MAC address: Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 24 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration l Configure a static multicast MAC address on an interface: 1. Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface type can be Ethernet, GE, XGE, or Eth-Trunk. 2. Run: mac-address multicast mac-address vlan vlan-id A static multicast MAC address is configured on the interface. l Configure a static multicast MAC address on multiple interfaces: Run: mac-address multicast mac-address interface { interface-type interface-number1 [ to interface-type interface-number2 ] } &<1-10> vlan vlan-id The static multicast MAC address is configured on multiple interfaces. The interface numbers must be consecutive; the specified interfaces must be on the same board; interface-number2 must be greater than interface-number1. After a static multicast MAC address is configured on interfaces, multicast packets destined for the multicast MAC address are forwarded only to the interfaces. Note the following points when configuring a static multicast MAC address: l The specified VLAN exists and the interfaces have been added to the VLAN. l The value of mac-address must be a multicast MAC address, which starts with 01. l The MAC address cannot be in the range from 0100-5E00-0000 to 0100-5E00-7FFF (used for IPv4 multicast) or 3333-xxxx-xxxx (used for IPv6 multicast). l The VLAN cannot be a super-VLAN, a leased line VLAN, or the control VLAN of a Smart Ethernet Protocol (SEP) segment or Rapid Ring Protection Protocol (RRPP) ring. ----End Checking the Configuration l Run the display mac-address multicast [ [ mac-address ] vlan vlan-id ] command to check the configured static multicast MAC addresses. l Run the display mac-address multicast [ vlan vlan-id ] total-number command to check the number of configured static multicast MAC addresses. # View static multicast MAC address entries in VLAN 10. <Quidway> display mac-address multicast vlan 10 -------------------------------------------------------------------MAC Address VLANID Out-Interface -------------------------------------------------------------------0111-1111-2222 10 GigabitEthernet1/0/1 GigabitEthernet1/0/2 2 port(s) -------------------------------------------------------------------Total Group(s) : 1 # View the number of static multicast MAC address entries in VLAN 10. <Quidway> display mac-address multicast vlan 10 total-number Total number of mac-address : 3 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 25 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration 2.5 Configuring the IGMP Snooping Proxy for the VLAN This section describes how to configure IGMP snooping proxy. Applicable Environment After the IGMP snooping proxy is configured on the S9700, the S9700 replaces the upstream router to send IGMP Query messages to the downstream devices, and receives the IGMP Report and IGMP Leave messages from the downstream devices. In this way, bandwidth consumption between the upstream router and the S9700 is reduced and the workload on the upstream router is also reduced. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring the IGMP snooping proxy, enable IGMP snooping globally and in a specified VLAN. Data Preparation None Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: vlan vlan-id The VLAN view is displayed. Step 3 Run: igmp-snooping proxy The IGMP snooping proxy is configured. NOTE IGMP snooping proxy cannot be enabled in a VLAN if the corresponding VLANIF interface has IGMP enabled. The IGMP snooping querier and IGMP message suppression functions can be enabled in the same VLAN to implement the IGMP snooping proxy function. After you configure the IGMP snooping proxy function in a VLAN, do not configure the IGMP snooping querier or IGMP message suppression function in the VLAN. For detailed configurations of IGMP snooping querier and IGMP message suppression, see 2.3.5 (Optional) Configuring IGMP Snooping Querier and 2.3.6 (Optional) Configuring IGMP Message Suppression. Step 4 Run: quit Return to the system view. Step 5 Run: interface interface-type interface-number Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 26 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration The interface view is displayed. The interface can be an Ethernet interface, a GE interface, an XGE interface, or an Eth-Trunk interface. Step 6 Run: igmp-snooping proxy-uplink-port The S9700 is prohibited from sending IGMP Query messages to router interfaces. NOTE After IGMP snooping proxy is enabled in a VLAN, the switch periodically broadcasts IGMP Query messages to all interfaces in the VLAN, including the router interface in the VLAN. This may result in IGMP querier reelection. To prevent IGMP querier reelection, run the igmp-snooping proxy-uplinkport command on the router interface to disable the switch from sending IGMP Query messages to the router interface. ----End Checking the Configuration Run the display igmp-snooping configuration command to check the non-default IGMP snooping configuration. If the command output shows that the IGMP snooping proxy function has been enabled, the configuration succeeds. # View the non-default IGMP snooping configuration in VLAN 10. <Quidway> display igmp-snooping vlan 10 configuration IGMP Snooping Configuration for VLAN 10 igmp-snooping enable igmp-snooping proxy 2.6 Configuring a Layer 2 Multicast Policy This section describes how to configure a Layer 2 multicast policy. 2.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task Applicable Environment A Layer 2 multicast policy controls the multicast programs that users can order on a switch with IGMP snooping enabled. This policy improves multicast network controllability and security. The S9700 supports the following Layer 2 multicast policies: l Configures multicast group policy, prohibiting multicast member interfaces from joining the specified multicast group. l Enables interfaces to quickly leave multicast groups. l Configures multicast entry overwriting. l Filters out multicast data packets sent from specified VLANs on an interface. l Discards unknown multicast data packets, preventing them from being broadcast in VLANs. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 27 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration You can use Layer 2 multicast policies according to network requirements. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring a Layer 2 multicast policy, complete the following tasks: l Enabling IGMP snooping globally and in a VLAN l Creating VLANs and adding interfaces to these VLANs Data Preparation To configure a Layer 2 multicast policy, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Types and numbers of interfaces 2 ACL rules applied to a multicast group policy 3 ACL rules applied to prompt leave of multicast member interfaces 2.6.2 Configuring a Multicast Group Policy Context A multicast group policy determines which multicast groups the hosts in a VLAN can join. NOTE When creating an ACL in a multicast group policy for a VLAN, specify the deny parameter in the rule command to prohibit the hosts in the VLAN from joining all or specified multicast groups. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: vlan vlan-id The VLAN view is displayed. Step 3 Run: igmp-snooping group-policy acl-number [ version number ] A multicast group policy is configured to prohibit the hosts in the specified VLANs from joining the specified multicast group. By default, the hosts in a VLAN can join any multicast group. If the IGMP version is not specified for a multicast group policy, the S9700 applies the policy to all the received IGMP messages regardless of their versions. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 28 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration NOTE A multicast group policy does not apply to static multicast entries. ----End 2.6.3 Configuring Prompt Leave for Interfaces Prerequisites A basic ACL is configured to specify the IP multicast groups that hosts can leave. For the configuration of the ACL, see ACL Configuration in the S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Security. Context When an interface on the S9700 receives an IGMP Leave message from a host, the S9700 deletes the forwarding entry that corresponds to the interface from the multicast forwarding table immediately without waiting for the aging of the forwarding entry. This is called prompt leave. When each interface in a VLAN is connected to only one host, you can enable prompt leave for interfaces in the VLAN. NOTE Prompt leave takes effect for interfaces in a VLAN only when the S9700 can process IGMPv2 or IGMPv3 messages. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: vlan vlan-id The VLAN view is displayed. Step 3 Run: igmp-snooping prompt-leave [ group-policy acl-number ] Prompt leave is enabled for interfaces in the VLAN. If group-policy acl-number is not specified, the S9700 immediately deletes the forwarding entry corresponding to a member interface after receiving the Leave message from the interface. By default, prompt leave is disabled for interfaces. NOTE On the S9700, the permit rule is applicable to all multicast groups by default. To configure prompt leave for a specified multicast group, you need to use the rule deny source any command. ----End Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 29 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration 2.6.4 Filtering Layer 2 Multicast Data on an Interface Context To reject certain types of multicast data, a network administrator can filter UDP packets from a certain VLAN on an interface of the S9700. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be an Ethernet interface, a GE interface, an XGE interface, or an Eth-Trunk interface. Step 3 Run: multicast-source-deny vlan { vlan-id1 [ to vlan-id2 ] } & <1-10> The Layer 2 multicast data from a certain VLAN on the interface is rejected. ----End 2.6.5 Enabling the Discarding of Unknown Multicast Data Packets in a VLAN Context Unknown multicast data packets are broadcast in a VLAN by default. If multicast services are stable, for example, the static Layer 2 multicast service, unknown multicast data packets do not need to be processed. You can enable the discarding of multicast data packets in such a case. If multicast services are unstable, for example, users frequently join or leave multicast groups, unknown multicast data packets need to be processed; otherwise some users cannot receive multicast data. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: vlan vlan-id The VLAN view is displayed. Step 3 Run: multicast drop-unknown Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 30 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration Discarding unknown multicast data packets is enabled. ----End 2.6.6 Checking the Configuration Prerequisites All the configurations of the Layer 2 multicast policy are complete. Procedure l Run the display igmp-snooping configuration command to check the non-default IGMP snooping configuration. You can view the configuration of a Layer 2 multicast policy in a VLAN by viewing the non-default IGMP snooping configuration in the VLAN. l Run the display l2-multicast forwarding-table vlan vlan-id [ [ source-address sourceaddress ] group-address { group-address | router-group } ] command to view the Layer 2 multicast forwarding table in a specified VLAN. You can check whether a Layer 2 multicast policy is used correctly by viewing Layer 2 multicast forwarding entries. ----End Example # View the non-default IGMP snooping configuration in VLAN 10. <Quidway> display igmp-snooping vlan 10 configuration IGMP Snooping Configuration for VLAN 10 igmp-snooping enable igmp-snooping group-policy 2002 2.7 Configuring Layer 2 Multicast CAC This section describes how to configure the Layer 2 multicast CAC function. As shown in Figure 2-2, the UPE is connected to downlink devices through a Layer 2 network. IGMP snooping is deployed on the UPE to implement multicast CAC on the VLAN, allowing the UPE to control the number of IPTV channels requested by the downstream DSLAM or switch. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 31 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration Figure 2-2 Networking diagram of multicast CAC BTV NPE IP/MPLS Core Switch UPE CE DSLAM NOTE You can choose to configure multicast CAC for a VLAN, a Layer 2 interface, or an interface in a VLAN, or you can configure multicast CAC for all of them. 2.7.1 Establishing the Configuration Task Applicable Environment The UPE can work in either of the following scenarios to provide multicast services based on VLANs: l Static multicast groups are configured on the NPE and the UPE is configured as the querier. In this scenario, the UPE does not process Query messages from the NPE. Instead, the UPE only learns the Report messages sent from the user side to generate corresponding multicast forwarding entries. The UPE sends General Query messages periodically. If the UPE does not receive Report messages from the user side, the corresponding entries on the UPE ages. When receiving Leave messages, the UPE sends Group-Specific Query messages. You can also configure static multicast groups on the UPE. l Issue 01 (2012-03-15) IGMP snooping is enabled on the UPE. When receiving Query messages from the NPE, the UPE forwards the Query messages to all members on the VLAN. After receiving Report Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 32 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration messages from the user side, the UPE creates corresponding multicast forwarding entries. If the later received Query message is from the same group and the corresponding multicast forwarding entry does not reach the aging time, the UPE directly sends a Report message to the NPE. NOTE This section describes only the scenario where IGMP snooping is deployed. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring multicast CAC for a VLAN, a Layer 2 interface, or an interface in a VLAN, complete the following tasks: l Connecting interfaces between devices correctly l Configuring interfaces on the switches to ensure that the link layer protocol between the switches is Up Data Preparation To configuring Layer 2 multicast CAC for a VLAN, a Layer 2 interface, or an interface in a VLAN, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Channel name 2 Number of multicast group members 3 Number of multicast group members in a channel 4 ID of the VLAN or the type and number of the interface where multicast CAC needs to be configured 2.7.2 Limiting the Number of Multicast Groups of a VLAN, a Layer 2 Interface, or an Interface in a VLAN Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: l2-multicast limit max-entry count [ except acl-number ] Limitation on the number of global multicast groups is configured. Step 3 Run: l2-multicast limit max-entry count [ vlan { vlan-id1 [ to vlan-id2 ] } & <1-10> ] [ except acl-number ] Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 33 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration Limitation on the number of multicast groups in a VLAN is configured. Step 4 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The Ethernet, GigabitEthernet, XGigabitEthernet, or Eth-Trunk interface view is displayed. Step 5 Run: l2-multicast limit max-entry count [ except acl-number ] Limitation on the number of multicast groups on a Layer 2 interface is configured. Step 6 Run: l2-multicast limit max-entry count [ vlan { vlan-id1 [ to vlan-id2 ] } & <1-10> ] [ except acl-number ] Limitation on the number of multicast groups on an interface of a VLAN is configured. NOTE The except acl-number parameters exclude the multicast groups that are not limited. The parameters have the same function in other configuration commands. ----End 2.7.3 Limiting the Number of Multicast Groups in a Channel for a VLAN, an Interface, or an Interface in a VLAN Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: l2-multicast limit channel channel-name max-entry count [ vlan { vlan-id1 [ to vlanid2 ] } &<1-10> ] Limitation on the number of multicast groups in a channel is configured for the entire system or a VLAN. Step 3 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The Ethernet, GigabitEthernet, XGigabitEthernet, or Eth-Trunk interface view is displayed. Step 4 Run: l2-multicast limit channel channel-name max-entry count Limitation on the number of multicast groups in a channel is configured on the interface. Step 5 Run: l2-multicast limit channel channel-name max-entry count [ vlan { vlan-id1 [ to vlanid2 ] } &<1-10> ] Limitation on the number of multicast groups in a channel is configured for the interface in a specified VLAN. ----End Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 34 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration 2.7.4 Configuring Channels on a VLAN Context Do as follows on the UPE. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 (Optional) Configure the global channels. 1. Run: l2-multicast-channel The global channel view is displayed. 2. Run: channel channel-name [ type [ asm | ssm ] ] A global channel is configured and the channel view is displayed. 3. Run: group group-address { group-mask-length | group-mask } The multicast group member in the global channel is configured. Step 3 Run: quit Return to the system view. Step 4 Run: l2-multicast-channel vlan vlan-id The VLAN channel view is displayed. Step 5 Run: channel channel-name The channel name is created. The name of a VLAN channel must be different from the name of a global channel. Step 6 Run: group group-address { group-mask-length | group-mask } The multicast group member in the channel is configured. The specified group address must be different from the group addresses specified for other channels in this VLAN or the group address of the global channel. ----End Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 35 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration 2.7.5 Checking the Configuration Prerequisites The configurations of Layer 2 multicast CAC for a VLAN, a Layer 2 interface, or an interface in a VLAN are complete. Procedure l Run the display l2-multicast limit configuration command to check the configuration of Layer 2 multicast CAC. l Run the display l2-multicast limit configuration vlan [ vlan-id ] command to check the configuration of multicast CAC in a VLAN. l Run the display l2-multicast limit vlan [ vlan-id] [ channel channel-name ] command to check the multicast CAC configuration of a channel in the VLAN. l Run the display l2-multicast limit interface interface-type interface-number command to check the configuration of multicast CAC on an interface. l Run the display l2-multicast limit channel channel-name command to check the multicast CAC configuration in a channel. l Run the display l2-multicast-channel channel channel-name command to check the channel configuration. ----End Example Run the display l2-multicast limit configuration command, and you can check the configuration of Layer 2 multicast CAC. <Quidway> display l2-multicast limit configuration L2-multicast limit information, The unit of bandwidth is kbits/sec --------------------------------------------------------------------ConfigEntries ConfigBandwidth CurrentEntries CurrentBandwidth --------------------------------------------------------------------Global limit information: --------------------------------------------------------------------100 ---------------VLAN 20 limit information: --------------------------------------------------------------------50 ---------------VLAN 20 channel limit information: --------------------------------------------------------------------bjtv 15 ---------------interface GigabitEthernet1/0/1 VLAN 10 limit information: --------------------------------------------------------------------30 ---------interface GigabitEthernet1/0/1 VLAN 10 channel limit information: --------------------------------------------------------------------cctv 20 ---------- Run the display l2-multicast-channel vlan 10 command, and you can check the channel configuration of a VLAN. <Quidway> display l2-multicast-channel vlan 10 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 36 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration Channel information on VLAN 10 ChannelName Group/Mask Source/Mask Bandwidth ------------------------------------------------------------------------------njtv 226.1.1.0/24 * 0 226.1.2.0/24 * 0 226.1.3.0/24 * 0 --------------------------------------------------------------------njtv1 226.2.1.0/24 * 0 226.2.2.0/24 * 0 Run the display l2-multicast limit vlan 20 command, and you can check the configuration of multicast CAC of a VLAN. <Quidway> display l2-multicast limit vlan 20 L2-multicast limit information, The unit of bandwidth is kbits/sec --------------------------------------------------------------------ConfigEntries ConfigBandwidth CurrentEntries CurrentBandwidth --------------------------------------------------------------------VLAN 20 limit information: --------------------------------------------------------------------50 ---0 ---VLAN 20 channel limit information: --------------------------------------------------------------------bjtv 15 ---0 ---- Run the displayl2-multicast limit vlan 10 interface gigabitethernet 1/0/1 command, and you can check the configuration of multicast CAC on an interface in a VLAN. <Quidway> display l2-multicast limit vlan 10 interface gigabitethernet 1/0/1 L2-multicast limit information, The unit of bandwidth is kbits/sec --------------------------------------------------------------------ConfigEntries ConfigBandwidth CurrentEntries CurrentBandwidth --------------------------------------------------------------------interface GigabitEthernet1/0/1 VLAN 10 channel limit information: --------------------------------------------------------------------cctv 20 ------------- 2.8 Configuring Layer 2 Multicast SSM Mapping This section describes how to configure the Layer 2 multicast SSM mapping function. 2.8.1 Establishing the Configuration Task Applicable Environment If the switch connected to user hosts is configured with IGMPv3, SSM mapping needs to be configured on the switch to map the multicast group addresses not in the SSM group to the specified source addresses. When the switch running IGMPv3 receives an IGMPv2 packet whose address is in the SSM group, the SSM mapping function can automatically map the address of the packet to the specified source. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring SSM mapping, complete the following task: Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 37 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast l 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration Enabling global IGMP snooping Data Preparation To configure SSM mapping, you need the following data. No. Data 1 (Optional) ACL rule 2 (Optional) SSM policy 3 Source addresses mapped to the multicast group addresses 2.8.2 (Optional) Configuring an SSM Group Policy Context If a user joins an ASM multicast group, you need to configure an SSM group policy in the VLAN to add the multicast group address to the range of SSM group addresses. NOTE When you create an ACL for an SSM policy, the configuration takes effect only if you select permit and specify a multicast address in the rule command. The configuration does not take effect if deny is selected or if the specified address is not a multicast address. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: vlan vlan-id The VLAN view is displayed. Step 3 Run: igmp-snooping ssm-policy basic-acl-number An SSM group policy is configured. By default, the address of an SSM group ranges from 232.0.0.0 to 232.255.255.255. After you configure an SSM policy, the multicast groups specified in the SSM policy are considered as SSM groups. ----End 2.8.3 Configuring Layer 2 Multicast SSM Mapping Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 38 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration Context By configuring SSM mapping, you can set up one-to-one mappings between multicast groups and multicast sources. SSM mapping can be configured only when IGMP snooping is enabled globally and in the corresponding VLAN and when the IGMP messages version is set to IGMPv3 in the VLAN. If the multicast replication function is configured, you only need to configure SSM mapping in the multicast VLAN. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: vlan vlan-id The VLAN view is displayed. Step 3 Run: igmp-snooping version 3 The version number of IGMP is set to 3. The default version number of IGMP snooping is 2, but IGMPv2 version does not support SSM mapping. Step 4 Run: igmp-snooping ssm-mapping enable SSM mapping is enabled in the VLAN. By default, SSM mapping is disabled. Step 5 Run: igmp-snooping ssm-mapping ip-group-address { ip-group-mask | mask-length } ipsource-address The mapping between a multicast group address and a multicast source is configured. The specified multicast group address must be in the range of multicast group addresses specified by the SSM policy. For the configuration of the SSM policy, see 2.8.2 (Optional) Configuring an SSM Group Policy. ----End 2.8.4 Checking the Configuration Prerequisites The configurations of SSM mapping are complete. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 39 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration Procedure l Run the display igmp-snooping port-info command to view the IGMP snooping entries on an interface. ----End Example Run the display igmp-snooping port-info command, and you can view the IGMP snooping entries on the interface. For example: <Quidway> display igmp-snooping port-info vlan 10 ----------------------------------------------------------------------(Source, Group) Port Flag Flag: S:Static D:Dynamic M: Ssm-mapping ----------------------------------------------------------------------VLAN 10, 3 Entry(s) (*, 225.1.1.1) GE1/0/2 --M 1 port(s) (*, 225.1.1.2) GE1/0/2 --M 1 port(s) (*, 225.1.1.3) GE1/0/2 --M 1 port(s) ----------------------------------------------------------------------- 2.9 Maintaining Layer 2 Multicast Maintaining Layer 2 multicast involves resetting Layer 2 Multicast statistics, and debugging IGMP Snooping. 2.9.1 Clearing Static Entries in a Multicast Forwarding Table Context CAUTION Static entries in a forwarding table cannot be restored after you clear them and you have to configure them again. Confirm the operation before you run the following command. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 40 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration The interface can be an Ethernet interface, a GE interface, an XGE interface, or an Eth-Trunk interface. Step 3 Run: undo l2-multicast static-group [ source-address source-ip-address ] group-address group-ip-address vlan { all | { vlan-id1 [ to vlan-id2 ] } & <1-10> } The interface is removed from a multicast group. Or run: undo l2-multicast static-group [ source-address source-ip-address ] group-address group-ip-address1 to group-ip-address2 vlan vlan-id The interface is removed from multiple multicast groups in a batch. ----End 2.9.2 Clearing Multicast Forwarding Entries Context CAUTION Running this command disables hosts in a VLAN from receiving certain multicast flows. The hosts in the VLAN receive the multicast flows again only after the S9700 receives IGMP Report messages from the hosts again and the forwarding entries are regenerated on the S9700. Procedure l Run the reset igmp-snooping group { all | vlan { vlan-id | all } } command in the user view to clear the dynamic forwarding entries in the multicast forwarding table. NOTE This command cannot clear static forwarding entries and dynamic router port entries. ----End 2.9.3 Clearing the Statistics on IGMP Snooping Context CAUTION The statistics on IGMP snooping cannot be restored after you clear them. So, confirm the action before you use the command. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 41 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration Procedure l Run the reset igmp-snooping statistics { all | vlan { vlan-id | all } } command in the user view to clear the statistics on IGMP snooping. ----End 2.9.4 Debugging IGMP Snooping Context CAUTION Debugging affects the performance of the system. So, after debugging, run the undo debugging igmp-snooping all command to disable it immediately. Procedure l Run the debugging igmp-snooping { all | aps | event | fwd | general | leave [ basic-aclnumber ] | mvlan | packet [ advance-acl-number ] | query [ advance-acl-number ] | report [ advance-acl-number ] | syn | timer } command in the user view to enable debugging of IGMP snooping. ----End 2.9.5 Debugging Layer 2 Multicast CAC Context CAUTION Debugging affects the performance of the system. So, after debugging, run the undo debugging all command to disable it immediately. Procedure l Run the debugging l2-multicast limit { all | check | configuration | event }command to enable the debugging of multicast CAC. ----End 2.10 Configuration examples This section provides several configuration examples of Layer 2 multicast. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 42 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration 2.10.1 Example for Configuring IGMP Snooping Networking Requirements As shown in Figure 2-3, GE 3/0/1 of the S9700 is connected to a router on the multicast source side, and GE 1/0/1 is connected to hosts. You are required to configure IGMP snooping to ensure that three hosts in VLAN 3 can receive multicast data from multicast groups in the range of 225.1.1.1 to 225.1.1.3 permanently. Figure 2-3 Networking diagram for configuring VLAN-based IGMP snooping DHCP server Multicast source IP/MPLS core VLAN3 GE3/0/1 Switch GE1/0/1 Host3 Host4 Host5 Configuration Roadmap The configuration roadmap is as follows: 1. Create a VLAN and add interfaces to the VLAN. 2. Enable IGMP snooping globally and in the VLAN. 3. Configure a static router interface. 4. Configure static multicast groups 225.1.1.1, 225.1.1.2, and 225.1.1.3. Data Preparation To complete the configuration, you need the following data: l ID of the VLAN that GE 1/0/1 and GE 3/0/1 belong to: VLAN 3 l Static router interface: GE 3/0/1 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 43 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast l 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration Addresses of static multicast groups: 225.1.1.1, 225.1.1.2, 225.1.1.3 Procedure Step 1 Create a VLAN and add interfaces to the VLAN. <Switch> system-view [Switch] vlan 3 [Switch-vlan3] quit [Switch] interface gigabitethernet [Switch-GigabitEthernet3/0/1] port [Switch-GigabitEthernet3/0/1] quit [Switch] interface gigabitethernet [Switch-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] port [Switch-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] quit 3/0/1 hybrid tagged vlan 3 1/0/1 hybrid tagged vlan 3 Step 2 Enable IGMP snooping. # Enable IGMP snooping globally. [Switch] igmp-snooping enable # Enable IGMP snooping in VLAN 3. [Switch] vlan 3 [Switch-vlan3] igmp-snooping enable [Switch-vlan3] quit Step 3 Configure GE 3/0/1 as the static router interface of VLAN 3. [Switch] interface gigabitethernet 3/0/1 [Switch-GigabitEthernet3/0/1] igmp-snooping static-router-port vlan 3 [Switch-GigabitEthernet3/0/1] quit Step 4 Configure static multicast groups. [Switch] interface gigabitethernet 1/0/1 [Switch-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] l2-multicast static-group group-address 225.1.1.1 vlan 3 [Switch-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] l2-multicast static-group group-address 225.1.1.2 vlan 3 [Switch-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] l2-multicast static-group group-address 225.1.1.3 vlan 3 [Switch-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] quit Step 5 Verify the configuration. # Check all configurations of IGMP snooping. <Switch> display igmp-snooping vlan configuration IGMP Snooping Configuration for VLAN 3 igmp-snooping enable According to the preceding information, the IGMP snooping of the VLAN is enabled. # Check the configuration of the static router interface. Run the display igmp-snooping router-port vlan 3 command on the S9700. <Switch> display igmp-snooping router-port vlan 3 Port Name UpTime Expires Flags --------------------------------------------------------------------VLAN 3, 1 router-port(s) GigabitEthernet3/0/1 00:01:02 -STATIC According to the preceding information, GE 3/0/1 is configured as a static router interface. # Verify the information about member interfaces of a static multicast group. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 44 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration [Switch] display igmp-snooping port-info ----------------------------------------------------------------------(Source, Group) Port Flag Flag: S:Static D:Dynamic M: Ssm-mapping ----------------------------------------------------------------------VLAN 3, 3 Entry(s) (*, 225.1.1.1) GE1/0/1 S-1 port(s) (*, 225.1.1.2) GE1/0/1 S-1 port(s) (*, 225.1.1.3) GE1/0/1 S-1 port(s) ----------------------------------------------------------------------- According to the preceding information, multicast groups 225.1.1.1 to 225.1.1.3 are configured with static forwarding entries. # View the multicast forwarding table. [Switch] display l2-multicast forwarding-table vlan 3 VLAN ID : 10, Forwarding Mode : IP -------------------------------------------------------------------(Source, Group) Interface Out-Vlan -------------------------------------------------------------------Router-port GigabitEthernet3/0/1 3 (*, 225.1.1.1) GigabitEthernet1/0/1 3 GigabitEthernet3/0/1 3 (*, 225.1.1.2) GigabitEthernet1/0/1 3 GigabitEthernet3/0/1 3 (*, 225.1.1.3) GigabitEthernet1/0/1 3 GigabitEthernet3/0/1 3 -------------------------------------------------------------------Total Group(s) : 3 The preceding information shows the VLAN ID and outgoing interface mapping the data from multicast groups 225.1.1.1 to 225.1.1.3. ----End Configuration Files l Configuration file of the S9700 # sysname Switch # vlan batch 3 # igmp-snooping enable # vlan 3 igmp-snooping enable # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/1 port hybrid tagged vlan 3 l2-multicast static-group group-address 225.1.1.1 to 225.1.1.3 vlan 3 # interface GigabitEthernet3/0/1 port hybrid tagged vlan 3 igmp-snooping static-router-port vlan 3 # return 2.10.2 Example for Configuring Layer 2 Multicast CAC for a VLAN Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 45 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration Networking Requirements As shown in the figure, Switch A and Switch B are connected through VLAN 20; Switch B and Switch C are connected through the MPLS/VPLS network and Switch C is connected to the TV server on the Internet. The Layer 2 multicast CAC based on VLAN 20 is configured on GE1/0/0 of Switch B. The multicast CAC limits the number of multicast groups in VLAN 20 to 50 and the number of multicast group members in channel bjtv in VLAN 20 to 15. An intranet is connected to GE1/0/1 of Switch B through VLAN 10. The VLAN-based multicast CAC is configured on GE1/0/1 in VLAN 10 to limit the channel that users can join to cctv and the number of members in the channel to 20. Figure 2-4 Networking diagram of Layer 2 multicast CAC for a VLAN SwitchB GE1/0/1 VLAN20 GE1/0/0 SwitchA MPLS/ VPLS GE1/0/1 Internet SwitchC TV Server VLAN10 Configuration Roadmap The configuration roadmap is as follows: 1. Configure VLAN 20 on Switch A and Switch B. 2. Enable global IGMP snooping. 3. Configure Layer 2 multicast CAC in the system view and the VLAN view. 4. Configure multicast groups for the channel in VLAN 10 on Switch B. 5. Configure VLAN-based Layer 2 multicast CAC on an interface of Switch B in VLAN 10. 6. Set the global group address range for the channel bjtv to 224.0.0.1-224.0.0.255, and the global group address range for the channel cctv to 225.0.0.1-225.0.0.255. Data Preparation To complete the configuration, you need the following data: 1. VLAN ID between Switch A and Switch B 2. Limits of Layer 2 multicast CAC, including number of multicast groups and number of channels Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 46 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration Procedure Step 1 Configure VLAN 20 on Switch A and Switch B. # Configure Switch A. <SwitchA> system-view [SwitchA] vlan 20 [SwitchA-vlan20] quit [SwitchA] interface gigabitethernet 1/0/1 [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] port link-type trunk [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] port trunk allow-pass vlan 20 [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] quit # Configure Switch B. <SwitchB> system-view [SwitchB] vlan 20 [SwitchB-vlan20] quit [SwitchB] interface gigabitethernet [SwitchB-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port [SwitchB-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port [SwitchB-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] quit [SwitchB] interface gigabitethernet [SwitchB-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] port [SwitchB-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] port 1/0/0 link-type access default vlan 20 1/0/1 link-type trunk trunk allow-pass vlan 10 Step 2 Enable global IGMP snooping on Switch A and Switch B. [SwitchA] igmp-snooping enable [SwitchB] igmp-snooping enable Step 3 Enable IGMP snooping in VLANs. # Enable IGMP snooping for VLAN 10 and VLAN 20 on Switch B. [SwitchB] vlan 20 [SwitchB-vlan20] igmp-snooping enable [SwitchB-vlan20] quit [SwitchB] vlan 10 [SwitchB-vlan10] igmp-snooping enable # Enable IGMP snooping for VLAN 20 on Switch A. [SwitchA] vlan 20 [SwitchA-vlan20] igmp-snooping enable Step 4 Configure Layer 2 multicast CAC in the system view and configure the group limit to 100 globally. The multicast CAC limits the number of multicast groups in VLAN 20 to 50 and the number of multicast groups in channel bjtv in VLAN 20 to 15 [SwitchB] l2-multicast limit max-entry 100 [SwitchB] l2-multicast limit max-entry 50 vlan 20 [SwitchB] l2-multicast limit channel bjtv max-entry 15 vlan 20 Step 5 Configure Layer 2 multicast CAC on GE1/0/1 of Switch B. The VLAN-based multicast CAC is configured on GE1/0/1 in VLAN 10 to limit the channel that users can join to cctv and the number of members in the channel to 20 [SwitchB]interface gigabitethernet 1/0/1 [SwitchB-GigabitEthernet1/0/1]l2-multicast limit channel cctv max-entry 20 vlan 10 Step 6 On SwitchB, set the global group address range for the channel bjtv to 224.0.0.1-224.0.0.255, and the global group address range for the channel cctv to 225.0.0.1-225.0.0.255. [SwitchB] l2-multicast-channel [SwitchB-l2-channel-glb] channel bjtv type asm [SwitchB-l2-channel-glb-bjtv] group 224.0.0.0 24 [SwitchB-l2-channel-glb-bjtv] quit Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 47 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration [SwitchB-l2-channel-glb] channel cctv type asm [SwitchB-l2-channel-glb-cctv] group 225.0.0.0 24 Step 7 Verify the configuration. Run the display l2-multicast limit configuration command to check the configurations of Layer 2 multicast CAC. The following are the configurations of Switch B. [SwitchB] display l2-multicast limit configuration L2-multicast limit information, The unit of bandwidth is kbits/sec --------------------------------------------------------------------ConfigEntries ConfigBandwidth CurrentEntries CurrentBandwidth --------------------------------------------------------------------Global limit information: --------------------------------------------------------------------100 ------------VLAN 20 limit information: --------------------------------------------------------------------50 ------------VLAN 20 channel limit information: --------------------------------------------------------------------bjtv 15 ------------interface GigabitEthernet1/0/1 VLAN 10 channel limit information: --------------------------------------------------------------------cctv 20 ------------- Run the display l2-multicast limit vlan 20 command to check the configurations of Layer 2 multicast CAC in VLAN 20. The following are the configurations of Switch B. [SwitchB] display l2-multicast limit vlan 20 L2-multicast limit information, The unit of bandwidth is kbits/sec --------------------------------------------------------------------ConfigEntries ConfigBandwidth CurrentEntries CurrentBandwidth --------------------------------------------------------------------VLAN 20 limit information: --------------------------------------------------------------------50 0 VLAN 20 channel limit information: --------------------------------------------------------------------bjtv 15 0 - Run the displayl2-multicast limit vlan 10 interface command to check the configurations of multicast CAC of an interface in the VLAN. The following are the configurations of Switch B. [SwitchB] display l2-multicast limit vlan 10 interface gigabitethernet 1/0/1 L2-multicast limit information, The unit of bandwidth is Mbits/sec --------------------------------------------------------------------ConfigEntries ConfigBandwidth CurrentEntries CurrentBandwidth --------------------------------------------------------------------interface GigabitEthernet1/0/1 VLAN 10 channel limit information: --------------------------------------------------------------------cctv 20 - Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 48 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration 20 - ----End Configuration Files l Configuration file of SwitchA # sysname SwitchA # vlan batch 20 # igmp-snooping enable # vlan 20 igmp-snooping enable # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/1 port link-type trunk port trunk allow-pass vlan 20 # return l Configuration file of Switch B # sysname SwitchB # vlan batch 10 20 # igmp-snooping enable l2-multicast limit max-entry 100 l2-multicast limit max-entry 50 vlan 20 l2-multicast limit channel bjtv max-entry 15 vlan 20 # vlan 10 igmp-snooping enable # vlan 20 igmp-snooping enable # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port link-type access port default vlan 20 # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/1 port link-type trunk port trunk allow-pass vlan 10 l2-multicast limit channel cctv max-entry 20 vlan 10 # l2-multicast-channel channel bjtv type asm group 224.0.0.0 255.255.255.0 channel cctv type asm group 225.0.0.0 255.255.255.0 return 2.10.3 Example for Configuring IGMP Snooping SSM Mapping Networking Requirements On the network shown in Figure 2-5, IGMPv2 is run on Switch and Host 1 and Host 2, and IGMPv3 is run on the last-hop router Router A on the multicast source side. Switch A is the S9700 device. GE 1/0/0 on Switch A is connected to Router A and GE 1/0/1 on Switch A is connected to a switch directly connected with users. GE 1/0/0 on Switch A is a static router Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 49 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration interface and GE 1/0/1 is statically added to multicast group 224.1.1.1. GE 1/0/0 and GE 1/0/1 both join VLAN 10 and IGMP SSM mapping is deployed on Router A. It is required that IGMP snooping SSM mapping be configured on Switch A in the VLAN to work jointly with IGMP SSM mapping. IGMP snooping SSM mapping also generates a mapping between a multicast group and a multicast source. (*, G) information in IGMPv1 or IGMPv2 multicast data packets is then mapped to (S, G) information, providing SSM services for the hosts running IGMPv1 or IGMPv2. Figure 2-5 Networking diagram for configuring IGMP snooping SSM mapping Source 2 10.1.1.2 Internet/ Intranet Source 1 10.1.1.1 RouterA SwitchA GE1/0/0 GE1/0/1 Switch SSM Mapping VLAN10 Host1 Host2 Configuration Roadmap The configuration roadmap is as follows: 1. Configure basic IGMP snooping functions so that users can receive multicast data from multicast sources. 2. Configure an SSM group policy for IGMP snooping to add the ASM group addresses of users to the SSM group address range. 3. Configure IGMP snooping SSM mapping so that users can receive multicast data from a specified multicast source. Data Preparation To complete the configuration, you need the following data: l VLAN 10 to which GE 1/0/0 and GE 1/0/1 on Switch A are added l IGMPv3 run on Switch A and IGMPv2 run on Switch, Host 1, and Host 2 l Multicast source address 10.1.1.2 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 50 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast l 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration Address of the multicast group to which GE 1/0/1 is statically added (224.1.1.1 is used in this example) Procedure Step 1 Configure a VLAN. # Configure Switch A. <Quidway> system-view [Quidway] sysname SwitchA [SwitchA] vlan 10 [SwitchA-vlan10] quit [SwitchA] interface gigabitethernet [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] quit [SwitchA] interface gigabitethernet [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] port [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] port [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] quit 1/0/0 hybrid pvid vlan 10 hybrid untagged vlan 10 1/0/1 hybrid pvid vlan 10 hybrid untagged vlan 10 Step 2 Enable global IGMP snooping and IGMP snooping in the VLAN. # Configure Switch A. [SwitchA] igmp-snooping enable [SwitchA] vlan 10 [SwitchA-vlan10] igmp-snooping enable Step 3 Configure IGMPv3 on Switch A and configure IGMPv2 on hosts. The hosts are not allowed to upgrade the IGMP version to 3. # Configure Switch A. [SwitchA-vlan10] igmp-snooping version 3 [SwitchA-vlan10] quit Step 4 Configure GE 1/0/0 as a static router interface in VLAN 10 and add GE 1/0/1 statically to multicast group 224.1.1.1. [SwitchA] interface gigabitethernet 1/0/0 [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] igmp-snooping static-router-port vlan 10 [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] quit [SwitchA] interface gigabitethernet 1/0/1 [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] l2-multicast static-group group-address 224.1.1.1 vlan 10 [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] quit Step 5 Configure an SSM group policy for IGMP snooping and enable IGMP snooping SSM mapping. [SwitchA] acl number 2008 [SwitchA-acl-basic-2008] rule 5 permit source 224.1.1.1 0 [SwitchA-acl-basic-2008] quit [SwitchA] vlan 10 [SwitchA-vlan10] igmp-snooping ssm-policy 2008 [SwitchA-vlan10] igmp-snooping ssm-mapping enable [SwitchA-vlan10] igmp-snooping ssm-mapping 224.1.1.1 24 10.1.1.2 [SwitchA-vlan10] quit Step 6 Verify the configuration. # Run the display igmp-snooping vlan configuration command on Switch A. You can view IGMP snooping configurations in the VLAN. [SwitchA] display igmp-snooping vlan configuration IGMP Snooping Configuration for VLAN 10 igmp-snooping enable Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 51 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 2 IGMP Snooping Configuration igmp-snooping igmp-snooping igmp-snooping igmp-snooping version 3 ssm-mapping enable ssm-policy 2008 ssm-mapping 224.1.1.0 255.255.255.0 10.1.1.2 # After SwitchA receives a Report message, run the display igmp-snooping port-info command to view the configurations on the interface. [SwitchA] display igmp-snooping port-info ----------------------------------------------------------------------(Source, Group) Port Flag Flag: S:Static D:Dynamic M: Ssm-mapping ----------------------------------------------------------------------VLAN 10, 1 Entry(s) (10.1.1.2, 224.1.1.1) GE1/0/1 --M 1 port(s) ----End Configuration Files l Configuration file of Switch A # sysname SwitchA # vlan batch 10 # igmp-snooping enable # acl number 2008 rule 5 permit source 224.1.1.1 0 # vlan 10 igmp-snooping enable igmp-snooping ssm-mapping enable igmp-snooping version 3 igmp-snooping ssm-policy 2008 igmp-snooping ssm-mapping 224.1.1.0 255.255.255.0 10.1.1.2 # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 10 port hybrid untagged vlan 10 igmp-snooping static-router-port vlan 10 # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/1 port hybrid pvid vlan 10 port hybrid untagged vlan 10 l2-multicast static-group group-address 224.1.1.1 vlan 10 # return Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 52 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 3 3 Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration About This Chapter This chapter describes the procedure for configuring multicast VLAN replication and maintenance commands, and provides configuration examples. 3.1 Multicast VLAN Replication Overview After multicast VLAN replication is configured on a switch, the upstream router only needs to transmit multicast data to a multicast VLAN. This function saves bandwidth because the upstream router does not need to send a copy of multicast data to each user VLAN. 3.2 Multicast VLAN Replication Supported by the S9700 This section describes the multicast VLAN replication features supported by the S9700. 3.3 Configuring Multicast VLAN Replication Based on User VLANs This section describes how to implement multicast VLAN replication based on user VLANs. 3.4 Configuring Multicast VLAN Replication Based on Interfaces This section describes how to configure multicast VLAN replication based on interfaces. 3.5 Configuration Examples This section provides configuration examples of multicast VLAN replication. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 53 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 3 Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration 3.1 Multicast VLAN Replication Overview After multicast VLAN replication is configured on a switch, the upstream router only needs to transmit multicast data to a multicast VLAN. This function saves bandwidth because the upstream router does not need to send a copy of multicast data to each user VLAN. In traditional multicast transmission mode, the upstream router must copy multicast data for each user VLAN and send all copies to the switch when users in different VLANs request the program provided by the same multicast source. This mode wastes network bandwidth and adds workload on the router. When users in multiple VLANs require the program of the same multicast source, you can configure the VLANs as the user VLANs of a multicast VLAN on the switch. The upstream router only needs to send multicast data to the multicast VLAN and does not need to send a copy to each user VLAN. When the switch receives multicast data packets from the upstream router, it distributes multicast data packets to the user VLANs that have multicast receivers. 3.2 Multicast VLAN Replication Supported by the S9700 This section describes the multicast VLAN replication features supported by the S9700. Multicast VLAN Replication Based on User VLANs and reduces workload of the router Figure 3-1 shows the traditional multicast data transmission mode. When HostA, HostB, and HostC in different VLANs join the same multicast group, the Layer 3 device (router) must copy multicast data for each VLAN and send all copies to the Layer 2 device (switch). This wastes bandwidth and burdens the router. Figure 3-1 Traditional multicast data transmission Multicast Packet VLAN 2 VLAN 3 Receiver HostA VLAN 2 VLAN 4 Receiver HostB Source Router Switch VLAN 3 Receiver HostC VLAN 4 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 54 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 3 Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration Figure 3-2 shows multicast data transmission after multicast VLAN replication is configured. The router only needs to copy multicast data for the multicast VLAN and sends the data to the switch. This saves network bandwidth and reduces workload of the router. Figure 3-2 Multicast VLAN replication Multicast Packet Multicast VLAN VLAN 2 VLAN 3 Receiver HostA VLAN 2 VLAN 4 Receiver HostB Source Router Switch VLAN 3 Receiver HostC VLAN 4 On the S9700, a multicast VLAN can have multiple user VLANs. Multicast VLAN Replication Based on Interfaces A carrier provides the multicast service for multiple Internet service providers (ISPs) and assigns a multicast VLAN to each ISP to isolate multicast data and routes. The ISPs provide multicast services for users on different interfaces. The interfaces may be added to the same user VLAN, so multicast packets of an ISP may be sent to users that do not subscribe to services of this ISP. To protect interests of ISPs, the carrier can bind user VLANs to multicast VLANs on the userside interfaces. As shown in Figure 3-3, after multicast VLANs are bound to user VLANs on user-side interfaces, multicast data packets are only sent to user VLANs on the specified interfaces. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 55 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 3 Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration Figure 3-3 Multicast data transmission before and after multicast VLAN replication is configured on interfaces Multicast Packet Multicast VLAN 2 Multicast VLAN 3 Multicast Packet Multicast VLAN 2 Multicast VLAN 3 Router Source Router Source Switch ISP1 VLAN4 Receiver HostA Switch ISP1 VLAN4 ISP2 VLAN4 HostA Receiver HostA ISP2 VLAN4 HostA 3.3 Configuring Multicast VLAN Replication Based on User VLANs This section describes how to implement multicast VLAN replication based on user VLANs. 3.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task Applicable Environment In traditional multicast transmission mode, a router must copy multicast data for each user VLAN and send all copies to the downstream device when users in different VLANs request the program provided by the same multicast source. This mode wastes network bandwidth and adds workload on the router. Multicast VLAN replication helps to manage and control the multicast source and the multicast group members. This function enables users in different VLANs to receive the same multicast flow and saves bandwidth. In multicast VLAN replication implementation, VLANs are classified into multicast VLANs and multiple user VLANs. The S9700 interface connected to a multicast source belongs to a multicast VLAN, and interfaces connected to members of a multicast group belong to user VLANs. The multicast VLAN aggregates multicast flows, and user VLANs receive data from the multicast VLAN. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 56 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 3 Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring multicast VLAN replication based on user VLANs, complete the following tasks: l Connecting interfaces and setting physical parameters for the interfaces to ensure that the physical status of the interfaces is Up l Enabling IGMP snooping globally Data Preparation To configure multicast VLAN replication based on user VLANs, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Multicast VLAN ID 2 User VLAN IDs 3 Types and numbers of interfaces 3.3.2 Configuring Multicast VLAN Replication Based on User VLANs Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: vlan vlan-id A VLAN is created and the VLAN view is displayed. Step 3 Run: igmp-snooping enable IGMP snooping is enabled in the VLAN. Step 4 Run: multicast-vlan enable Multicast VLAN replication is enabled, and the VLAN is configured as a multicast VLAN. By default, multicast VLAN replication is disabled. After IP multicast is configured on the S9700, no multicast VLAN can be configured. Step 5 Run: multicast-vlan user-vlan { { vlan-id1 [ to vlan-id2 ] } & <1-10> } User VLANs are bound to the multicast VLAN. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 57 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 3 Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration The vlan-id1 and vlan-id2 parameters specify user VLAN IDs. The value of vlan-id2 must be greater than the value of vlan-id1. NOTE The user VLANs specified in the command must be existing VLANs enabled with IGMP snooping and cannot be multicast VLANs or user VLANs of another multicast VLAN. ----End 3.3.3 Adding Interfaces to VLANs Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Add a network-side interface to a multicast VLAN. 1. Run the interface interface-type interface-number command to enter the network-side interface view. 2. Configure the network-side interface as a trunk or hybrid interface and add the interface to the multicast VLAN. For the configuration procedure, see Dividing a LAN into VLANs Based on Ports. 3. Run the quit command to return to the system view. Step 3 Add a user-side interface to a user VLAN. 1. Run the interface interface-type interface-number command to enter the user-side interface view 2. Configure the user-side interface as a trunk or hybrid interface and add the interface to the user VLAN. For the configuration procedure, see Dividing a LAN into VLANs Based on Ports. ----End 3.3.4 Checking the Configuration Prerequisites The configuration of multicast VLAN replication is complete. Procedure l Run the display multicast-vlan vlan [ vlan-id ] command to view information about a multicast VLAN. ----End Example Run the display multicast-vlan vlan [ vlan-id ] command to view information about a multicast VLAN. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 58 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 3 Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration <Quidway> display multicast-vlan vlan 3 Multicast-vlan : 3 User-vlan Number : 2 IGMP snooping state : Enable MLD snooping state : Disable User-vlan Snooping-state ----------------------------------------------100 IGMP Enable /MLD Disable 200 IGMP Enable /MLD Disable Run the display user-vlan vlan [ vlan-id ] command to view information about user VLANs. <Quidway> display user-vlan vlan Total user vlan 2 user-vlan snooping-state multicast-vlan snooping-state ----------------------------------------------------------------------------100 IGMP Enable /MLD Disable 3 IGMP Enable /MLD Disable 200 IGMP Enable /MLD Disable 3 IGMP Enable /MLD Disable 3.4 Configuring Multicast VLAN Replication Based on Interfaces This section describes how to configure multicast VLAN replication based on interfaces. 3.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task Applicable Environment A carrier provides the multicast service for multiple Internet service providers (ISPs) and assigns a multicast VLAN to each ISP to isolate multicast data and routes. The ISPs provide multicast services for users on different interfaces. The interfaces may be added to the same user VLAN, so multicast packets of an ISP may be sent to users that do not subscribe to services of this ISP. To protect interests of ISPs, the carrier can bind user VLANs to multicast VLANs on the userside interfaces. Multicast data packets of a user VLAN are then sent to the specified interface. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring multicast VLAN replication based on interfaces, complete the following tasks: l Connecting interfaces and setting physical parameters for the interfaces to ensure that the physical status of the interfaces is Up l Enabling IGMP snooping globally Data Preparation To configure multicast VLAN replication based on interfaces, you need the following data. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) No. Data 1 Multicast VLAN ID 2 User VLAN IDs Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 59 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 3 Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration No. Data 3 Types and numbers of interfaces 3.4.2 Creating a Multicast VLAN Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: vlan vlan-id A VLAN is created and the VLAN view is displayed. Step 3 Run: igmp-snooping enable IGMP snooping is enabled in the VLAN. ----End 3.4.3 Binding User VLANs to a Multicast VLAN on an Interface Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. Step 3 Run: l2-multicast-bind vlan vlanid1 [ to vlanid2 ] mvlan mvlanid User VLANs are bound to a multicast VLAN on the interface. This command is used on user-side interfaces. NOTE After a user VLAN is bound to a multicast VLAN on an interface, Layer 2 multicast call admission control (CAC) based on the interface and Layer 2 multicast CAC based on the interface and user VLAN do not take effect on the interface. However, you can configure Layer 2 multicast CAC based on the interface and a non-user VLAN. The user VLANs must exist, and cannot be multicast VLANs or user VLANs of another multicast VLAN. ----End Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 60 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 3 Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration 3.4.4 Adding Interfaces to VLANs Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Add a network-side interface to a multicast VLAN. 1. Run the interface interface-type interface-number command to enter the network-side interface view. 2. Configure the network-side interface as a trunk or hybrid interface and add the interface to the multicast VLAN. For the configuration procedure, see Dividing a LAN into VLANs Based on Ports. 3. Run the quit command to return to the system view. Step 3 Add a user-side interface to a user VLAN. 1. Run the interface interface-type interface-number command to enter the user-side interface view 2. Configure the user-side interface as a trunk or hybrid interface and add the interface to the user VLAN. For the configuration procedure, see Dividing a LAN into VLANs Based on Ports. ----End 3.4.5 Checking the Configuration Procedure l Run the display l2-multicast-bind [ mvlan vlan-id ] command to view information about a multicast VLAN and user VLANs bound to the multicast VLAN on an interface. ----End Example Run the display l2-multicast-bind [ mvlan vlan-id ] command to view information about a multicast VLAN and its user VLANs. <Quidway> display l2-multicast-bind mvlan 90 ------------------------------------------------------------------Port Startvlan Endvlan Mvlan ------------------------------------------------------------------GigabitEthernet1/0/9 901 -90 ------------------------------------------------------------------Total Table(s) : 1 3.5 Configuration Examples This section provides configuration examples of multicast VLAN replication. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 61 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 3 Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration 3.5.1 Example for Configuring Multicast VLAN Replication Based on User VLANs Networking Requirements As shown in Figure 3-4, RouterA is connected to the multicast source. GE1/0/0 of RouterA is connected to GE1/0/0 of SwitchA. GE1/0/0 of SwitchA belongs to VLAN 10. HostA, HostB, and HostC are connected to GE1/0/1, GE1/0/2, and GE1/0/3 of SwitchA and belong to VLAN 100, VLAN 200, and VLAN 300 respectively. To save network bandwidth, you can configure multicast VLAN replication based on user VLANs on SwitchA. RouterA then only needs to send one copy of multicast data to the multicast VLAN, and SwitchA distributes multicast data to user VLANs. Figure 3-4 Networking diagram for configuring multicast VLAN replication based on user VLANs Source GE1/0/0 RouterA VLAN10 GE1/0/0 SwitchA GE1/0/1 GE1/0/3 GE1/0/2 VLAN100 VLAN200 HostA Reciever HostB Reciever VLAN300 HostC Reciever Configuration Roadmap The configuration roadmap is as follows: 1. Enable IGMP snooping globally. 2. Create a multicast VLAN and enable IGMP snooping in the multicast VLAN. 3. Create user VLANs. 4. Bind the user VLANs to the multicast VLAN. 5. Add the network-side interface and user-side interfaces to VLANs as hybrid interfaces. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 62 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 3 Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration Data Preparation To complete the configuration, you need the following data: l Interface connected to RouterA and the VLAN that the interface belongs to l User-side interfaces and the VLANs that the interfaces belong to Procedure Step 1 Enable IGMP snooping globally. <SwitchA> system-view [SwitchA] igmp-snooping enable Step 2 Create a multicast VLAN and enable IGMP snooping in the multicast VLAN. [SwitchA] vlan 10 [SwitchA-vlan10] igmp-snooping enable [SwitchA-vlan10] multicast-vlan enable [SwitchA-vlan10] quit Step 3 Create user VLANs and enable IGMP snooping in the user VLANs. [SwitchA] vlan 100 [SwitchA-vlan100] igmp-snooping enable [SwitchA-vlan100] quit [SwitchA] vlan 200 [SwitchA-vlan200] igmp-snooping enable [SwitchA-vlan200] quit [SwitchA] vlan 300 [SwitchA-vlan300] igmp-snooping enable [SwitchA-vlan300] quit Step 4 Bind user VLANs 100, 200, and 300 to multicast VLAN 10. [Switch] vlan 10 [Switch-vlan3] multicast-vlan user-vlan 100 200 300 [Switch-vlan3] quit Step 5 Add interfaces to VLANs as hybrid interfaces. # Add GE1/0/0 to multicast VLAN 10. [SwitchA] interface gigabitethernet1/0/0 [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 10 [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 10 [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] quit # Add GE1/0/1 to VLAN 100, GE1/0/2 to VLAN 200, and GE1/0/3 to VLAN 300. [SwitchA] interface gigabitethernet1/0/1 [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] port hybrid [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] port hybrid [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] quit [SwitchA] interface gigabitethernet1/0/2 [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/2] port hybrid [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/2] port hybrid [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/2] quit [SwitchA] interface gigabitethernet1/0/3 [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/3] port hybrid [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/3] port hybrid [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/3] quit pvid vlan 100 untagged vlan 100 pvid vlan 200 untagged vlan 200 pvid vlan 300 untagged vlan 300 Step 6 Verify the configuration. View information about the multicast VLAN and user VLANs on SwitchA. [SwitchA] display multicast-vlan vlan Total multicast vlan 1 multicast-vlan user-vlan number Issue 01 (2012-03-15) snooping-state Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 63 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 3 Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration ---------------------------------------------------------------10 3 IGMP Enable /MLD Disable [SwitchA] display user-vlan vlan Total user vlan 3 user-vlan snooping-state multicast-vlan snooping-state ----------------------------------------------------------------------------100 IGMP Enable /MLD Disable 10 IGMP Enable /MLD Disable 200 IGMP Enable /MLD Disable 10 IGMP Enable /MLD Disable 300 IGMP Enable /MLD Disable 10 IGMP Enable /MLD Disable ----End Configuration Files l Configuration file of SwitchA # sysname SwitchA # vlan batch 10 100 200 300 # igmp-snooping enable # vlan 10 igmp-snooping enable multicast-vlan enable multicast-vlan user-vlan 100 200 300 # vlan 100 igmp-snooping enable # vlan 200 igmp-snooping enable # vlan 300 igmp-snooping enable # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 10 port hybrid untagged vlan 10 # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/1 port hybrid pvid vlan 100 port hybrid untagged vlan 100 # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/2 port hybrid pvid vlan 200 port hybrid untagged vlan 200 # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/3 port hybrid pvid vlan 300 port hybrid untagged vlan 300 # return 3.5.2 Example for Configuring Multicast VLAN Replication Based on Interfaces Networking Requirements As shown in Figure 3-5, the Router is connected to the multicast source. GE1/0/0 of the Switch A is connected to the Router. GE1/0/1 provides services for ISP1, and GE1/0/2 provides services for ISP2. ISP1 and ISP2 use multicast VLAN 2 and VLAN 3 respectively to provide multicast services for users. GE1/0/1 and GE1/0/2 belong to user VLAN 10. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 64 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 3 Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration To protect interests of the ISPs and ensure that multicast packets of each ISP are only sent to users of the ISP, multicast VLANs and user VLANs can be bound on the user-side interfaces. After the configuration is complete, multicast data of an ISP will be sent only to the interface connected to the ISP. Figure 3-5 Networking diagram for configuring multicast VLAN replication based on interfaces Router GE1/0/0 Source GE1/0/0 GE1/0/1 GE1/0/2 SwitchA ISP1 VLAN10 ISP2 VLAN10 Receiver HostB Receiver HostA Mulcast Packet Mulcast VLAN 2 Mulcast VLAN 3 Configuration Roadmap The configuration roadmap is as follows: 1. Create multicast VLANs 2 and 3 and enable IGMP snooping in the multicast VLANs. 2. Create user VLAN 10. 3. Bind the user VLAN to multicast VLANs on GE1/0/1 and GE1/0/2. 4. Add the network-side interface and user-side interfaces to VLANs as hybrid interfaces. Data Preparation To complete the configuration, you need the following data: l Interface connected to the Router and the VLAN that the interface belongs to l User-side interfaces and the VLANs that the interfaces belong to Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 65 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 3 Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration Procedure Step 1 Create multicast VLANs 2 and 3 and enable IGMP snooping in the multicast VLANs. <SwitchA> system-view [SwitchA] igmp-snooping enable [SwitchA] vlan 2 [SwitchA-vlan2] igmp-snooping enable [SwitchA-vlan2] quit [SwitchA] vlan 3 [SwitchA-vlan3] igmp-snooping enable [SwitchA-vlan3] quit Step 2 Create user VLAN 10. [SwitchA] vlan batch 10 Step 3 Bind the user VLAN to multicast VLANs on GE1/0/1 and GE1/0/2. [SwitchA] interface gigabitethernet1/0/1 [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] l2-multicast-bind vlan 10 mvlan 2 [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] quit [SwitchA] interface gigabitethernet1/0/2 [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/2] l2-multicast-bind vlan 10 mvlan 3 [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/2] quit Step 4 Add GE1/0/0 to the multicast VLANs, and add GE1/0/1 and GE1/0/2 to the user VLAN. # Add GE1/0/0 to multicast VLANs 2 and 3 as a trunk interface. [SwitchA] interface gigabitethernet1/0/0 [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port link-type trunk [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port trunk allow-pass vlan 2 3 [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] quit # Add GE1/0/1 and GE1/0/2 to VLAN 10 as hybrid interfaces. [SwitchA] interface gigabitethernet1/0/1 [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] port hybrid [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] port hybrid [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/1] quit [SwitchA] interface gigabitethernet1/0/2 [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/2] port hybrid [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/2] port hybrid [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/2] quit pvid vlan 10 untagged vlan 10 pvid vlan 10 untagged vlan 10 Step 5 Verify the configuration. Run the display l2-multicast-bind [ mvlan vlan-id ] command on the Switch A to view binding between user VLANs and multicast VLANs. <SwitchA> display l2-multicast-bind ------------------------------------------------------------------Port Startvlan Endvlan Mvlan ------------------------------------------------------------------GigabitEthernet1/0/1 10 -2 GigabitEthernet1/0/2 10 -3 ------------------------------------------------------------------Total Table(s) : 2 ----End Configuration Files l Configuration file of the Switch A # sysname SwitchA # vlan batch 2 to 3 10 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 66 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 3 Multicast VLAN Replication Configuration # igmp-snooping enable # vlan 2 igmp-snooping enable multicast-vlan enable # vlan 3 igmp-snooping enable multicast-vlan enable # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port link-type trunk port trunk allow-pass vlan 2 to 3 # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/1 port hybrid pvid vlan 10 port hybrid untagged vlan 10 l2-multicast-bind vlan 10 mvlan 2 # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/2 port hybrid pvid vlan 10 port hybrid untagged vlan 10 l2-multicast-bind vlan 10 mvlan 3 # Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 67 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration 4 IGMP Configuration About This Chapter This chapter describes the procedure for configuring IGMP and commands for maintaining IGMP, and provides configuration examples. 4.1 Introduction to IGMP This section describes the principle of IGMP. 4.2 IGMP Features Supported by the S9700 This section describes IGMP features supported by the S9700. 4.3 Configuring Basic IGMP Functions This section describes how to configure and apply IGMP. 4.4 Setting the Parameters of IGMP Features This section describes how to set the parameters of IGMP features. 4.5 Configuring SSM Mapping This section describes the applications of SSM mapping and the method of configuring SSM mapping. 4.6 Configuration IGMP Limit Function This section describes how to configure the IGMP limit function. 4.7 Maintaining IGMP This section describes how to maintain IGMP. 4.8 Configuration Examples This section provides several configuration examples of IGMP. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 68 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration 4.1 Introduction to IGMP This section describes the principle of IGMP. In the TCP/IP protocol suite, the Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) manages IPv4 multicast members. It sets up and maintains the multicast membership between IP hosts and adjacent multicast routers. As a routing switch, the S9700 supports IP multicast. When IGMP is configured, the S9700 can be used as a multicast switch. IGMP is the signaling mechanism of the host towards the S9700, which is used by IP multicast in an end user network. IGMP needs to be enabled on hosts and on S9700s. NOTE l Whether the host supports IGMP depends on the used operating system. l The switch mentioned in the following contents is an S9700 supporting the Layer 3 multicast protocol and multicast router function. l All receiver hosts that participate in multicast transmission must be enabled with IGMP. A host can join or leave a multicast group at any time and from any position. The number of members of a multicast group is not limited. l Through IGMP, a multicast L3 device can know whether there is a multicast group receiver, namely, a group member, on the network segment to which an interface of the router is connected. Each host needs to save only the information about the groups that the host itself joins. At present, IGMP has three versions: IGMPv1 (defined by RFC 1112), IGMPv2 (defined by RFC 2236), and IGMPv3 (defined by RFC 3376). All IGMP versions support the Any-Source Multicast (ASM) model. IGMPv3 can be directly applied to the Source-Specific Multicast (SSM) model, while IGMPv1 and IGMPv2 require the support of SSM mapping. 4.2 IGMP Features Supported by the S9700 This section describes IGMP features supported by the S9700. Basic IGMP Functions The basic IGMP features that the S9700 supports are as follows: l Supporting IGMPv1, IGMPv2, and IGMPv3 and configurable version. l Supporting the static IGMP. l Configuring the range of multicast groups that an interface can join. Router-Alert Option IGMPv2 and IGMPv3 have the Group-Specific and Source/Group-Specific Query messages. The groups are varied and an S9700 cannot join all groups. Therefore, the IGMP needs to use the Router-Alert option. Then the IGMP can send messages for the groups that the local S9700 does not join to the upper-level protocol for processing. You can determine whether to set the Router-Alert option in the IGMP messages to be sent and whether the received IGMP messages must contain the Router-Alert option. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 69 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration IGMP Query Controller For IGMPv1, you can set the interval for sending General Query messages and robustness variable. NOTE IGMPv1 does not support querier election. Therefore, you need to enable PIM for querier election. For IGMPv2, you can set the interval for sending General Query messages, robustness variable, maximum response duration of IGMP Query messages, and IGMP prompt leave. For IGMPv3, you can set the interval for sending General Query messages, robustness variable, and maximum response time of IGMP Query messages. SSM-Mapping An S9700 can serve hosts of IGMPv1 and IGMPv2 after you configure SSM-Mapping on the S9700. IGMP Limit l The function of IGMP Limit is applicable to IPv4 PIM-SM and IPv4 PIM-DM networks. To limit the number of users accessing IP core networks, you can configure the IGMP limit function. – Configure the maximum number of global IGMP group memberships on a S9700. – Configure the maximum number of IGMP group memberships on an interface. NOTE If the IGMP limit function is required to be configured globally, and for an interface on the same S9700, it is recommended that the limits on the number of global IGMP group memberships, and the number of IGMP group memberships on the interface should be in descending order. 4.3 Configuring Basic IGMP Functions This section describes how to configure and apply IGMP. 4.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task Applicable Environment IGMP is applied to the network segment in which a host is connected to an S9700. IGMP needs to run on both the S9700 and the host. The following contents describe how to configure IGMP on an S9700. You must enable IP multicast routing before configuring IGMP. IP multicast routing is the prerequisite of configuring all multicast functions. If IP multicast routing is disabled, the multicast-related configurations cannot take effect. IGMP needs to be enabled on the VLANIF interface that is connected to the host. The matching IGMP version needs to be configured on the S9700 and host because the IGMP messages vary according to version. The later version on the S9700 side is compatible with the earlier version on the host side. Other configurations can be performed only after IGMP is enabled. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 70 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration The host where the IGMP is run responds to the IGMP Query message of the S9700. If the host gives no response and the operation times out, the S9700 considers that the multicast group does not contain any member on the network segment and cancels data forwarding. To enable hosts on the network segment of the interface to join the specified groups and receive packets from the groups, you can set an ACL on the related interface to limit the range of groups that the interface serves. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring basic IGMP functions, complete the following tasks: l Configuring the parameters of the link layer protocol and the IP address of the interface to enable the link-layer protocol l Configuring the unicast routing protocol to ensure that IP routes between nodes are reachable Data Preparation To configure basic IGMP functions, you need the following data. No. Data 1 ID of the VLAN to which the interface communicating with the host belongs 2 IGMP version 3 IP addresses of the multicast group and multicast source 4 ACL rule for filtering multicast groups 4.3.2 Enabling IP Multicast Context The IP multicast function is the prerequisite of configuring other multicast protocols. Do as follows on the S9700 connected to a host. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 (Optional) Run: assign multicast-resource-mode optimize The multicast forwarding table is optimized. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 71 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration If a multicast forwarding table needs to contain more than 4096 entries, run this command to optimize the multicast forwarding table before enabling IP multicast routing. Step 3 Run: multicast routing-enable IP multicast routing is enabled. By default, the IP multicast routing function is disabled on an S9700 ----End 4.3.3 Enabling the IGMP Function Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface. Step 3 Run: igmp enable The IGMP function is enabled. By default, the IGMP function is disabled on an interface. NOTE If PIM-SM or PIM-DM is also required on this interface, PIM-SM or PIM-DM must be enabled before IGMP is enabled. ----End 4.3.4 (Optional) Specifying the IGMP Version Context CAUTION Make sure that all the interfaces on S9700s are configured with IGMP of the same version on one network segment. By default, IGMPv2 is adopted. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 72 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface. Step 3 Run: igmp version { 1 | 2 | 3 } The IGMP version is specified on the interface. ----End 4.3.5 (Optional) Configuring a Static IGMP Group Context After an interface is added to a multicast group statically, the S9700 considers that multicast group members exist on the network segment that the interface belongs to. Therefore, S9700 receives the multicast data sent to the multicast group. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface. Step 3 Run: igmp static-group group-address [ inc-step-mask { group-mask | group-mask-length } number group-number ] [ source source-address ] The interface is added to the multicast group or multicast source group statically. If a loopback interface is used, the S9700 forwards the received data only when a user demands the data. In this case, the bandwidth usage is reduced. If a VLANIF interface is adopted, the S9700 forwards the received data directly. If a loopback interface is used, the S9700 forwards the received data only when a user requests the data. This reduces the CPU usage. VLANIF interfaces, POS interfaces, and IP-Trunk interfaces forward multicast data immediately. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 73 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration By default, an interface is not statically added to any multicast group. ----End 4.3.6 (Optional) Configuring an IGMP Multicast Group Policy Context To enable hosts on the network to which the interface is connected to join the specified multicast groups and to receive messages from the groups, you need to set an ACL rule on the related interface to filter the received messages. In this case, the range of groups that the interface serves can be limited. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface. Step 3 Run: igmp group-policy { acl-number | acl-name acl-name } [ 1 | 2 | 3 ] The range of multicast groups that the interface can join is configured. By default, an interface can join any multicast group. ----End 4.3.7 Checking the Configuration Prerequisites The configuration of basic IGMP functions is complete. Procedure l Run the display igmp interface [ interface-type interface-number ] [ verbose ] command to check the configuration and running status of IGMP on an interface. l Run the display igmp group [ group-address | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * static command to check the information about the members of the static IGMP multicast group. l Run the display igmp group[ group-address | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * [ verbose ] command to check the information about the members that dynamically join the IGMP multicast group. ----End Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 74 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration Example Run the display igmp interface vlanif 3 command to check the configuration of IGMP on VLANIF 3. <Quidway> display igmp interface vlanif 3 Interface information Vlanif10 (100.0.0.3): IGMP is enabled Current IGMP version is 2 IGMP state: up IGMP group policy: none IGMP limit: Value of query interval for IGMP (negotiated): Value of query interval for IGMP (configured): 60 s Value of other querier timeout for IGMP: Value of maximum query response time for IGMP: 10 s Querier for IGMP: 100.0.0.3 (this router) Run the display igmp group static command to check the information about the static IGMP multicast group. <Quidway> display igmp group static Static join group information Total 2 entries, Total 2 active entries Group Address Source Address Interface 225.0.0.10 0.0.0.0 Loop1 232.1.1.20 10.0.0.1 Vlanif3 State UP UP Expires never never 4.4 Setting the Parameters of IGMP Features This section describes how to set the parameters of IGMP features. Context By default, IGMP can work normally. In the S9700, you can change the values of related parameters according to the specific network environment. You can perform the following configurations as required. NOTE l The configuration in the IGMP view is valid globally. The configuration in the interface view is valid only for the specific interface. l If this command is configured in the interface view and the IGMP view, the values set in the interface view are preferred. If this command is not configured in the interface view, the values configured in the IGMP view are valid. 4.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task Applicable Environment IGMPv2 and IGMPv3 have the Group-Specific and Source/Group-Specific Query messages. The groups are varied and an S9700 cannot join all groups. Therefore, the IGMP needs to use the Router-Alert option. Then the IGMP can send messages for the groups that the local device does not join to the upper protocol for processing. The IGMP querier periodically sends IGMP Query messages on the shared network connected to receivers. When receiving a Report message from a member, the querier updates information Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 75 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration about the membership. If non-queriers do not receive any General Query message within the Keepalive period of the IGMP querier, the querier is considered faulty, and a new round of the querier election is triggered automatically. In some cases, one host matches a port. Therefore, a querier matches only one receiver host. When a receiver host switches between multiple groups frequently, you can enable the prompt leave mechanism on the querier. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring IGMP message options and timers, complete the following tasks: l Configuring the unicast routing protocol to make the IP routes of nodes be reachable l 4.3 Configuring Basic IGMP Functions Data Preparation To configure IGMP message options and related timers, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Whether the Router-Alert option is contained in the packet 2 Interval for sending IGMP General Query messages 3 IGMP robustness variable 4 Maximum response duration of the IGMP Query messages 5 Keepalive period of the other IGMP queriers 6 Interval for sending IGMP Group-Specific Query messages 7 ACL that limits the application range of prompt leave 4.4.2 Configuring IGMP Message Options Context The Router-Alert option requires the S9700 to send the received IGMP messages that have not been added to IGMP groups to the upper layer protocol. By default, the S9700 sends IGMP messages containing the Router-Alert option, but does not check the Router-Alert option in the received messages. That is, the S9700 processes all the received IGMP messages, regardless whether the messages contain the Router-Alert option. If require-router-alert is configured, the S9700 checks this option. The Router-Alert option can be configured globally or on an interface. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 76 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration l The global configuration is valid on each interface. l The configuration on an interface is valid only for the specific interface. The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global configuration. If the Router-Alert option is not configured on the interface, the global configuration is used. l Configuring IGMP message options globally Procedure 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: igmp The IGMP view is displayed. 3. Run: require-router-alert The S9700 is configured to ignore the IGMP messages that do not contain the RouterAlert option. 4. Run: send-router-alert The S9700 is configured to add the Router-Alert option to the IGMP message header. NOTE After you run the send-router-alert command, information about the Router-Alert option will not be displayed when you view the current configuration. To view information about the Router-Alert option, run the undo send-router-alert command first. l Configuring IGMP message options for the interface 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IP-Trunk interface. 3. Run: igmp require-router-alert The S9700 is configured to ignore the IGMP messages that do not contain the RouterAlert option. 4. Run: igmp send-router-alert The S9700 is configured to add the Router-Alert option to the IGMP message header. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 77 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration NOTE After you run the igmp send-router-alert command, information about the Router-Alert option will not be displayed when you view the current configuration. To view information about the Router-Alert option, run the undo igmp send-router-alert command first. ----End 4.4.3 Configuring the IGMPv1 Querier Context The IGMP querier can be configured globally or on an interface. l The global configuration is valid on each interface. l The configuration on an interface is valid only for the specific interface. The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global configuration. If the IGMP querier is not configured on the interface, the global configuration is used. When the IGMP version is IGMPv1, the configurable parameters of the IGMP querier include the interval for sending IGMP General Query messages and IGMP robustness variable. Procedure l Configuring the global IGMP querier 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: igmp The IGMP view is displayed. 3. Run: timer query interval The interval for sending IGMP General Query messages is set. By default, the interval for sending IGMP General Query messages is 60 seconds. 4. Run: robust-count robust-value The IGMP robustness variable is set. When the S9700 starts, the S9700 sends General Query messages robust-value times. The interval between the messages is 1/4 of the interval for sending IGMP General Query messages. By default, the robustness variable is 2. l Configuring the IGMP querier on an interface 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 78 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IP-Trunk interface. 3. Run: igmp timer query interval The interval for sending IGMP General Query messages is set. By default, the interval for sending IGMP General Query messages is 60 seconds. 4. Run: igmp robust-count robust-value The IGMP robustness variable is set. When the S9700 starts, the S9700 sends General Query messages robust-value times. The interval between the messages is 1/4 of the interval for sending IGMP General Query messages. By default, the robustness variable is 2. ----End 4.4.4 Configuring the IGMPv2 or IGMPv3 Querier Context The IGMP querier can be configured globally or on an interface. l The global configuration is valid on each interface. l The configuration on an interface is valid only for the specified interface. The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global configuration. If the IGMP querier is not configured on the interface, the global configuration is used. When the version of IGMP is IGMPv2 or IGMPv3, the configurable parameters of the IGMP querier include the interval for sending IGMP General Query messages, interval for sending IGMP Group-Specific Query messages, maximum response time for IGMP Query messages, Keepalive period of other IGMP queriers, and IGMP robustness variable. NOTE In actual configuration, ensure that the interval for sending IGMP General Query messages is greater than the maximum response time for IGMP Query messages and is smaller than the Keepalive period of other IGMP queriers. Procedure l Configuring the IGMP querier globally 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: igmp The IGMP view is displayed. 3. Run: timer query interval The interval for sending IGMP General Query messages is set. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 79 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration By default, the interval for sending IGMP General Query messages is 60 seconds. 4. Run: robust-count robust-value The IGMP robustness variable is set. – When the system starts, the system sends General Query messages for a number of times specified by the value of the robustness variable. The interval for sending General Query messages is 1/4 of the interval for sending IGMP General Query messages. – When receiving a Leave message, the S9700 sends the IGMP Group-Specific Query messages for the time specified by the value of the robustness variable at the interval that you set. By default, the robustness variable is 2. 5. Run: max-response-time interval The maximum response time for an IGMP Query message is set. By default, the maximum response time for an IGMP Query message is 10 seconds. 6. Run: timer other-querier-present interval The Keepalive period of other IGMP queriers is set. By default, the Keepalive period of other IGMP queriers = Robustness variable x Interval for sending General Query messages + Maximum response time x 1/2. When the values of the parameters in the formula are the default values, the Keepalive period of other IGMP queriers is 125 seconds. 7. Run: lastmember-queryinterval interval The interval at which S9700 sends IGMP Group-Specific Query messages is set. By default, the interval for sending IGMP Group-Specific Query messages is 1 second. l Configuring the IGMP querier on an interface 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IP-Trunk interface. 3. Run: igmp timer query interval The interval for sending IGMP General Query messages is set. By default, the interval for sending IGMP General Query messages is 60 seconds. 4. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Run: Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 80 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration igmp robust-count robust-value The IGMP robustness variable is set. – When the system starts, the system sends General Query messages for a number of times specified by the value of the robustness variable. The interval for sending messages is 1/4 of the interval for sending IGMP General Query messages. – When receiving a Leave message, the S9700 sends IGMP Group-Specific Query messages for the time specified by the value of the robustness variable at the interval that you set. By default, the robustness variable is 2. 5. Run: igmp max-response-time interval The maximum response time for IGMP Query messages is set. By default, the maximum response time for an IGMP Query message is 10 seconds. 6. Run: igmp timer other-querier-present interval The Keepalive period of other IGMP queriers is set. By default, Keepalive period of other IGMP queriers = Robustness variable x Interval for sending General Query messages + Maximum response time x 1/2. When the values of the parameters to the right of the equal mark are the default values, the Keepalive period of other IGMP queriers is 125 seconds. 7. Run: igmp lastmember-queryinterval interval The interval at which the S9700 sends IGMP Group-Specific Query messages is set. By default, the interval for sending IGMP Group-Specific Query messages is 1 second. 8. Run: igmp on-demand The (S, G) entry never times out. The interface does not send IGMP Query messages. By default, the interface sends Query messages and participates in querier election. NOTE Both IGMPv2 and IGMPv3 support the igmp on-demand command. ----End 4.4.5 Configuring IGMP Prompt Leave Context After receiving a Leave message from a host, the querier reports the message to the upstream router instead of sending a Last Member Query message. This process is called IGMP prompt leave. In this manner, the delay in response is reduced and the bandwidth occupied by various messages is saved. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 81 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration NOTE l IGMP prompt leave is applicable to IGMPv2 and IGMPv3. l When the IGMP version is IGMPv1, the IGMP prompt leave does not take effect even if there is information about this function in current configuration. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. VLANIF Interface view, POS Interface view, IP-Trunk Interface view, Loopback interface view Step 3 Run: igmp prompt-leave [ group-policy basic-acl-number ] The S9700 leaves the group immediately without sending the Last Member Query message. By default, the S9700 sends the Last Member Query message after receiving a Leave message from a host. ----End 4.4.6 Checking the Configuration Prerequisites The configuration of basic IGMP functions and parameters is complete. Procedure l Run the display igmp group [ group-address | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * [ static | verbose ] command to check the information about members of an IGMP multicast group. l Run the display igmp interface [ interface-type interface-number ] [ verbose ] command to check the configuration and running status of IGMP on the interface. l Run the display igmp routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask | group-masklength } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask | source-mask-length } ] ]* [ static ] command to check the information about the IGMP routing table. Run the preceding command, and you can obtain the following result: – The membership information of the IGMP multicast group is correct. – The configuration and running status of IGMP on an S9700 interface are correct. – A matched multicast forwarding interface exists in the downstream list of the (*, G) or (S, G) entry. ----End Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 82 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration Example Run the display igmp group interface vlanif 3 static command, and you can view the IGMP configuration on VLANIF 3. <Quidway> display igmp group interface vlanif 3 static Static join group information Total 2 entries Specified interface state:UP Total 2 entries matched Group Address 232.1.1.1 225.0.0.10 Source Address 10.0.0.1 0.0.0.0 Expires never never Run the display igmp routing-table command, and you can view the IGMP routing table. NOTE The IGMP routing table is generated only after PIM is enabled. <Quidway> display igmp routing-table Total 1 entry 00001. (*, 225.0.0.10) List of 1 downstream interface Vlanif3 (100.0.0.3), Protocol: STATIC 4.5 Configuring SSM Mapping This section describes the applications of SSM mapping and the method of configuring SSM mapping. 4.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task Applicable Environment In the network segment where the SSM model is used to provide multicast services, some hosts must run IGMPv1 or IGMPv2 because of some limitations. To provide services for these hosts, you need to configure the SSM static mapping on S9700s. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring SSM mapping, complete the following tasks: l Configuring the unicast routing protocol to ensure that the IP routes between nodes are reachable l 4.3.3 Enabling the IGMP Function Data Preparation To configure SSM mapping, you need the following data. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 83 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration No. Data 1 Interface that needs to be enabled with SSM mapping 2 Addresses and masks of the multicast group and multicast source 4.5.2 Enabling SSM Mapping Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface. Step 3 Run: igmp enable The IGMP function is enabled. Step 4 Run: igmp version 3 The version number of IGMP is set to 3. To ensure that hosts running any IGMP version on the network segment can obtain SSM services, it is recommended to run IGMPv3 on the S9700 interface. Step 5 Run: igmp ssm-mapping enable SSM mapping is enabled. ----End 4.5.3 Configuring the SSM Mapping Policy Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 84 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration Step 2 Run: igmp The IGMP view is displayed. Step 3 Run: ssm-mapping group-address { mask | mask-length } source-address An SSM group is mapped to a source. The IP addresses of SSM groups range from 232.0.0.0 to 232.255.255.255. You can run the command repeatedly to map an SSM group to multiple sources. l group-address { mask | mask-length }: specifies the group address and mask. l source-address: specifies the address of the source mapping the SSM group. ----End 4.5.4 Checking the Configuration Prerequisites The configuration of SSM mapping is complete. Procedure l Run the display igmp group [ group-address | interface interface-type interfacenumber ]* ssm-mapping [ verbose ] command to check the address of a specific source or group. l Run the display igmp ssm-mapping { group [ group-address ] | interface [ interfacetype interface-number ] } command to check the information about SSM mapping of a specific source or group. ----End Example Run the display igmp ssm-mapping group [ group-address ] command, and you can view the information about SSM mapping of a specified group address. <Quidway> display igmp ssm-mapping group 232.0.0.1 IGMP SSM-Mapping conversion table of VPN-Instance: public net Total 2 entries 2 entries matched 00001. (10.0.0.1, 232.0.0.1) 00002. (10.0.0.2, 232.0.0.1) Total 2 entries matched Run the display igmp ssm-mapping interface interface-type interface-number command, and you can view information about SSM mapping on a specified interface. <Quidway> display igmp ssm-mapping interface vlanif 3 Info: IGMP SSM-Mapping is enabled Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 85 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration 4.6 Configuration IGMP Limit Function This section describes how to configure the IGMP limit function. 4.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task Applicable Environment To limit IPTV ICPs and the number of users accessing IP core networks, you can configure the IGMP limit function. The IGMP limit function is configured on the last-hop S9700 connected to users. You can perform the following configurations as required: l Configure the maximum number of global IGMP group memberships on a S9700. l Configure the maximum number of IGMP entries in a single instance. l Configure the maximum number of IGMP group memberships on an interface. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring the IGMP limit function, complete the following task: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol l 4.3 Configuring Basic IGMP Functions Data Preparation To configure the IGMP limit function, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Maximum number of global IGMP group memberships 2 Maximum number of IGMP group memberships in a single instance 3 Maximum number of IGMP group memberships on an interface 4.6.2 Configuring the Maximum Number of Global IGMP Group Memberships Context Do as follows on the S9700 connected to hosts. Procedure Step 1 Run: Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 86 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: igmp global limit number The maximum number of global IGMP entries of all instances is set. ----End 4.6.3 Setting the Maximum Number of Global IGMP Entries for an Instance Context Do as follows on the S9700 connected to user hosts. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: igmp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The IGMP view is displayed. Step 3 Run: limit number The maximum number of global IGMP entries of an instance is set. ----End 4.6.4 Configuring the Maximum Number of IGMP Group Memberships on an Interface Context Do as follows on the S9700 connected to hosts. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The IGMP interface view is displayed. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 87 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface. Step 3 Run: igmp limit number The maximum number of IGMP group memberships is set on the interface. ----End 4.6.5 Checking the Configuration Procedure l Run the display igmp interface [ interface-type interface-number ] [ verbose ] command to check the configuration and running of IGMP on an interface. ----End 4.7 Maintaining IGMP This section describes how to maintain IGMP. 4.7.1 Clearing the Information About an IGMP Group Context CAUTION The IGMP group that an interface dynamically joins is deleted after you run the reset igmp group command. Receivers may not receive multicast information normally. Therefore, confirm the action before run the command. You can run the following commands to clear the information about an IGMP group in the user view. Procedure l Run the reset igmp group { all | interface interface-type interface-number { all | groupaddress [ mask { group-mask | group-mask-length } ] [ source-address [ mask { sourcemask | source-mask-length } ] ] } } command to clear the IGMP group that the interface already dynamically joins. ----End 4.7.2 Monitoring the Running Status of IGMP Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 88 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration Context To check the running status of IGMP during routine maintenance, run the following display commands in any view. Procedure l Run the display igmp group [ group-address | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] [ static ] [ verbose ] command to check the information about the IGMP multicast group. l Run the display igmp group ssm-mapping [ verbose ] command to check the information about the multicast group that is already configured with SSM mapping. l Run the display igmp interface [ interface-type interface-number ] [ verbose ] command to check the configuration and running status of IGMP on the interface. l Run the display igmp routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask | group-masklength } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask | source-mask-length } ] ]* [ static ] [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] command to check the information about the IGMP routing table. l Run the display igmp ssm-mapping { group [ group-address ] | interface [ interfacetype interface-number ] } command to check the information about SSM mapping of a specific source or group. ----End 4.7.3 Debugging IGMP Context CAUTION Debugging affects the performance of the system. So, after debugging, run the undo debugging all command to disable it immediately. Procedure l Run the debugging igmp { all | event | leave | report | query | timer } command to enable the debugging of IGMP. l Run the debugging igmp ssm-mapping [ advanced-acl-number ] command to enable the debugging of SSM mapping. ----End 4.8 Configuration Examples This section provides several configuration examples of IGMP. 4.8.1 Example for Configuring Basic IGMP Functions Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 89 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration Networking Requirements On the network as shown in Figure 4-1, the unicast routing function is normal. You are required to implement multicast on the network to enable hosts to receive the Video On Demand (VOD) information. When the hosts connected to a certain interface need to receive a popular program for a long time, you can add the interface to a multicast group statically. As shown in the following figure, if HostA needs to receive the multicast data from the multicast group 225.1.1.1 for a long time, you need to add GE 1/0/0 on the SwitchA to the multicast group 225.1.1.1 statically. Figure 4-1 Networking diagram for configuring basic IGMP functions Ethernet HostA SwitchA GE1/0/0 GE2/0/0 N1 Receiver HostB SwitchB PIM network Leaf network GE1/0/0 GE2/0/0 HostC Receiver SwitchC GE2/0/0 N2 GE1/0/0 HostD Ethernet Switch Physical interface VLANIF interface IP address SwitchA GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 10 10.110.1.1/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 11 192.168.1.1/24 GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 20 10.110.2.1/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 21 192.168.2.1/24 GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 20 10.110.2.2/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 31 192.168.3.1/24 SwitchB SwitchC Configuration Roadmap The configuration roadmap is as follows: 1. Enable multicast on all Switches providing multicast services. 2. Enable PIM-SM on all the interfaces on Switch. 3. Enable IGMP on the interfaces on the host side. 4. Add VLANIF 10 on SwitchA to the multicast group 225.1.1.1 statically. Data Preparation To complete the configuration, you need the following data: Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 90 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration l Version of IGMP running between Switches and hosts l Static multicast group address: 225.1.1.1 NOTE This configuration example describes only the commands used to configure IGMP. Procedure Step 1 Configure the IP addresses of interfaces and the unicast routing protocol on each Switch. Configure the IP address and mask of each interface according to Figure 4-1. Configure OSPF to ensure the communication between SwitchA, SwitchB, and SwitchC on the network layer, and to ensure the dynamic update through the unicast routing protocol. For details on how to configure IP addresses of interfaces, see OSPF Configuration in the S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - IP Service. For details on how to configure OSPF, see IP Addresses Configuration in the S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - IP Routing. Step 2 Enable multicast on all Switches and PIM-SM on all interfaces. # Enable multicast on SwitchA and enable PIM-SM on all interfaces. The configurations of SwitchB and SwitchC are similar to the configuration of SwitchA, and are not provided here. [SwitchA] multicast routing-enable [SwitchA] interface vlanif 10 [SwitchA-Vlanif10] pim sm [SwitchA-Vlanif10] quit [SwitchA] interface vlanif 11 [SwitchA-Vlanif11] pim sm [SwitchA-Vlanif11] quit Step 3 Enable IGMP on the interfaces connected to hosts. # Enable IGMP on VLANIF 10 on SwitchA and configure the IGMP version as IGMPv2. The configurations of SwitchB and SwitchC are similar to the configuration of SwitchA, and are not provided here. NOTE By default, IGMPv2 is used and you do not need to set the IGMP version here. To use other IGMP versions, run the igmp version command to set the version. [SwitchA] interface vlanif 10 [SwitchA-Vlanif10] igmp enable [SwitchA-Vlanif10] igmp version 2 [SwitchA-Vlanif10] quit Step 4 Add VLANIF 10 on SwitchA to the multicast group 225.1.1.1 statically. In this manner, the hosts connected to VLANIF 10 can steadily receive the multicast data sent to the multicast group 225.1.1.1. [SwitchA] interface vlanif 10 [SwitchA-Vlanif10] igmp static-group 225.1.1.1 Step 5 Verify the configuration. # Run the display igmp interface command. You can check the configuration and running status of IGMP on each interface. For example, the information about IGMP on VLANIF 10 of SwitchA is as follows: <SwitchA> display igmp interface vlanif 10 Interface information of VPN-Instance: public net Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 91 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration Vlanif 10(10.110.1.1): IGMP is enabled Current IGMP version is 2 IGMP state: up IGMP group policy: none IGMP limit: Value of query interval for IGMP (negotiated): Value of query interval for IGMP (configured): 60 s Value of other querier timeout for IGMP: 0 s Value of maximum query response time for IGMP: 10 s Querier for IGMP: 10.110.1.1 (this router) # Run the display igmp routing-table command on SwitchA. You can check whether VLANIF 10 is added to the multicast group 225.1.1.1 statically. If the (*, 225.1.1.1) entry exists on SwitchA, the downstream interface is VLANIF 10, and the protocol type is STATIC, you can infer that VLANIF 10 is added to the multicast group 225.1.1.1 statically. <SwitchA> display igmp routing-table Routing table of VPN-Instance: public net Total 1 entry 00001. (*, 225.1.1.1) List of 1 downstream interface Vlanif10 (10.110.1.1), Protocol: STATIC ----End Configuration Files l Configuration file of SwitchA # sysname SwitchA # vlan batch 10 11 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif10 ip address 10.110.1.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm igmp enable igmp static-group 225.1.1.1 # interface Vlanif11 ip address 192.168.1.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface gigabitethernet 1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 10 port hybrid untagged vlan 10 # interface gigabitethernet 2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 11 port hybrid untagged vlan 11 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 10.110.1.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.1.0 0.0.0.255 # return l Configuration file of SwitchB # sysname SwitchB # vlan batch 20 21 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 92 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif20 ip address 10.110.2.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm igmp enable # interface Vlanif21 ip address 192.168.2.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface gigabitethernet 1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 20 port hybrid untagged vlan 20 # interface gigabitethernet 2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 21 port hybrid untagged vlan 21 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 10.110.2.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.2.0 0.0.0.255 # return l Configuration file of SwitchC # sysname SwitchC # vlan batch 20 31 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif20 ip address 10.110.2.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm igmp enable # interface Vlanif31 ip address 192.168.3.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface gigabitethernet 1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 20 port hybrid untagged vlan 20 # interface gigabitethernet 2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 31 port hybrid untagged vlan 31 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 10.110.2.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.3.0 0.0.0.255 # return 4.8.2 Example for Configuring SSM Mapping Networking Requirements On the multicast network as shown in Figure 4-2, PIM-SM is run and ASM and SSM models are used to provide multicast services. IGMPv3 is run on the interface on the Switch connected Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 93 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration to the Receiver. The IGMP version on the Receiver is IGMPv2 and cannot be upgraded to IGMPv3. The range of SSM group addresses on the current network is 232.1.1.0/24. S1, S2, and S3 send multicast data to the multicast group whose IP address is in this range. The Receiver receives the multicast data only from S1 and S3. Solution: Configure SSM mapping on SwitchD. Figure 4-2 Networking of the SSM mapping configuration S2 133.133.2.1/24 SwitchB GE3/0/0 GE1/0/0 S3 SwitchC 133.133.3.1/24 GE3/0/0 GE1/0/0 GE2/0/0 GE2/0/0 S1 133.133.1.1/24 GE1/0/0 PIM-SM GE2/0/0 SwitchA GE3/0/0 GE2/0/0 Receiver 133.133.4.1/24 GE1/0/0 GE3/0/0 SwitchD Switch Physical interfaces VLANIF interface IP address SwitchA GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 10 133.133.1.2/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 20 192.168.1.1/24 GE 3/0/0 VLANIF 30 192.168.4.2/24 GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 11 133.133.2.2/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 20 192.168.1.2/24 GE 3/0/0 VLANIF 31 192.168.2.1/24 GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 12 133.133.3.2/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 21 192.168.3.1/24 GE 3/0/0 VLANIF 31 192.168.2.2/24 GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 13 133.133.4.2/24 GE2/0/0 VLANIF 21 192.168.3.2/24 GE 3/0/0 VLANIF 30 192.168.4.1/24 SwitchB SwitchC SwitchD Configuration Roadmap The configuration roadmap is as follows: 1. Enable SSM mapping on the interfaces of the Switches connected to hosts. 2. Set the range of SSM group addresses on all the Switches in the PIM-SM domain. 3. Configure the static SSM mapping rules on the Switches where SSM mapping is enabled. Data Preparation To complete the configuration, you need the following data: Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 94 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration l Range of SSM multicast groups l IP addresses of Source 1 and Source 3 NOTE This configuration example describes only the commands used to configure SSM mapping. Procedure Step 1 Create VLANs and add interfaces to the VLANs. Step 2 Configure the IP address of each VLANIF and the unicast routing protocol according to Figure 4-2. Step 3 Enable IGMP and SSM mapping on the interfaces connected to hosts. [SwitchD] multicast routing-enable [SwitchD] interface vlanif 13 [SwitchD-Vlanif13] igmp enable [SwitchD-Vlanif13] igmp version 3 [SwitchD-Vlanif13] igmp ssm-mapping enable [SwitchD-Vlanif13] quit Step 4 Configure the range of SSM group addresses. # Set the range of SSM group addresses to 232.1.1.0/24 on all Switches. The configurations of SwitchB, SwitchC, and SwitchD are similar to configuration of SwitchA, and are not mentioned here. [SwitchA] acl number 2000 [SwitchA-acl-basic-2000] rule permit source 232.1.1.0 0.0.0.255 [SwitchA-acl-basic-2000] quit [SwitchA] pim [SwitchA-pim] ssm-policy 2000 Step 5 Configure static SSM mapping rules on the Switches connected to hosts. # Map the multicast group in the range of 232.1.1.0/24 to Source 1 and Source 3. [SwitchD] igmp [SwitchD-igmp] ssm-mapping 232.1.1.0 24 133.133.1.1 [SwitchD-igmp] ssm-mapping 232.1.1.0 24 133.133.3.1 # Check the information about SSM mapping of specific sources and group addresses on Switches. <SwitchD> display igmp ssm-mapping group IGMP SSM-Mapping conversion table of VPN-Instance: public net Total 2 entries 2 entries matched 00001. (133.133.1.1, 232.1.1.0) 00002. (133.133.3.1, 232.1.1.0) Total 2 entries matched Step 6 Verify the configuration. # The Receiver joins the group 232.1.1.1. # Run the display igmp group ssm-mapping command to view the information about the specific sources or group addresses on the Switches. Take the information about the specific source or group address on SwitchD for example: <SwitchD> display igmp group ssm-mapping IGMP SSM mapping interface group report information of VPN-Instance: public net Vlanif10 (133.133.4.2): Total 1 IGMP SSM-Mapping Group reported Group Address Last Reporter Uptime Expires Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 95 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 232.1.1.1 4 IGMP Configuration 133.133.4.1 00:01:44 00:00:26 <SwitchD> display igmp group ssm-mapping verbose Interface group report information of VPN-Instance: public net Vlanif10 (133.133.4.2): Total entry on this interface: 1 Total 1 IGMP SSM-Mapping Group reported Group: 232.1.1.1 Uptime: 00:01:52 Expires: 00:00:18 Last reporter: 133.133.4.1 Last-member-query-counter: 0 Last-member-query-timer-expiry: off Group mode: exclude Version1-host-present-timer-expiry: off Version2-host-present-timer-expiry: 00:00:17 # Run the display pim routing-table command to view the PIM-SM multicast routing table on a Switch. Take the information displayed on SwitchD for example: <SwitchD> display pim routing-table VPN-Instance: public net Total 2 (S, G) entries (133.133.1.1, 232.1.1.1) RP: 192.168.3.2 Protocol: pim-ssm, Flag: UpTime: 00:11:25 Upstream interface: Vlanif30 Upstream neighbor: 192.168.4.2 RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.4.2 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: Vlanif13 Protocol: pim-ssm, UpTime: 00:11:25, Expires:(133.133.3.1, 232.1.1.1) RP: 192.168.3.2 Protocol: pim-ssm, Flag: UpTime: 00:11:25 Upstream interface: Vlanif21 Upstream neighbor: 192.168.3.1 RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.3.1 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: Vlanif13 Protocol: pim-ssm, UpTime: 00:11:25, Expires:- ----End Configuration Files l Configuration file of SwitchA # sysname SwitchA # vlan batch 10 20 30 # multicast routing-enable # acl number 2000 rule 5 permit source 232.1.1.0 0.0.0.255 # interface Vlanif10 ip address 133.133.1.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface Vlanif20 ip address 192.168.1.1 255.255.255.0 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 96 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration pim sm # interface Vlanif30 ip address 192.168.4.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 10 port hybrid untagged vlan 10 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 20 port hybrid untagged vlan 20 # interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 30 port hybrid untagged vlan 30 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 133.133.1.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.1.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.4.0 0.0.0.255 # pim ssm-policy 2000 # return l Configuration file of SwitchB # sysname SwitchB # vlan batch 11 20 31 # multicast routing-enable # acl number 2000 rule 5 permit source 232.1.1.0 0.0.0.255 # interface Vlanif11 ip address 133.133.2.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface Vlanif20 ip address 192.168.1.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface Vlanif31 ip address 192.168.2.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 11 port hybrid untagged vlan 11 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 20 port hybrid untagged vlan 20 # interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 31 port hybrid untagged vlan 31 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 133.133.2.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.1.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.2.0 0.0.0.255 # Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 97 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration pim ssm-policy 2000 # return l Configuration file of SwitchC # sysname SwitchC # vlan batch 12 21 31 # multicast routing-enable # acl number 2000 rule 5 permit source 232.1.1.0 0.0.0.255 # interface Vlanif12 ip address 133.133.3.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface Vlanif21 ip address 192.168.3.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface Vlanif31 ip address 192.168.2.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 12 port hybrid untagged vlan 12 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 21 port hybrid untagged vlan 21 # interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 31 port hybrid untagged vlan 31 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 133.133.3.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.3.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.2.0 0.0.0.255 # pim ssm-policy 2000 # return l Configuration file of SwitchD # sysname SwitchD # vlan batch 13 21 30 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif13 ip address 133.133.4.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm igmp enable igmp version 3 igmp ssm-mapping enable # interface Vlaniaf21 ip address 192.168.3.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm # Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 98 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration interface Vlanif30 ip address 192.168.4.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 13 port hybrid untagged vlan 13 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 21 port hybrid untagged vlan 21 # interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 30 port hybrid untagged vlan 30 # pim ssm-policy 2000 # acl number 2000 rule 5 permit source 232.1.1.0 0.0.0.255 # igmp ssm-mapping 232.1.1.0 255.255.255.0 133.133.1.1 ssm-mapping 232.1.1.0 255.255.255.0 133.133.3.1 # return 4.8.3 Example for Configuring IGMP Limit Networking Requirements When many users are watching multiple video programs, they occupy high bandwidth. As a result, the device performance degrades and the multicast data received by users is unstable. The traditional multicast technologies control the multicast networks by limiting the number of multicast forwarding entries or the number of outgoing interfaces in a multicast forwarding entry. These technologies, however, cannot flexibly manage the real-time video services or available resources on the IPTV network. The IGMP limit function allows users to plan network resources properly and limit the number of multicast groups that users can join. As shown in Figure 4-3, the IGMP limit for the entire system, an instance, and an interface needs to be configured on SwitchA, SwitchB, and SwitchC connected to user hosts to limit the number of multicast groups that users can join. When the number of users in a multicast group reaches the upper limit, no IGMP entry can be created for the multicast group. This ensures that the multicast data received by the users in the multicast group is stable. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 99 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration Figure 4-3 Networking diagram of IGMP limit Ethernet HostA Receiver SwitchA GE2/0/0 192.168.1.1/24 GE2/0/0 192.168.2.1/24 PIM network N1 GE1/0/0 10.110.1.1/24 SwitchB GE1/0/0 10.110.2.1/24 HostB Leaf network HostC Receiver SwitchC GE1/0/0 10.110.2.2/24 N2 HostD GE2/0/0 192.168.3.1/24 Ethernet Switch Physical interface VLANIF interface IP address SwitchA GE1/0/0 VLANIF10 10.110.1.1/24 GE2/0/0 VLANIF11 192.168.1.1/24 GE1/0/0 VLANIF20 10.110.2.1/24 GE2/0/0 VLANIF21 192.168.2.1/24 GE1/0/0 VLANIF20 10.110.3.1/24 GE2/0/0 VLANIF31 192.168.3.1/24 SwitchB SwitchC Configuration Roadmap The configuration roadmap is as follows: 1. Enable multicast on all the switches providing multicast services. The multicast function must be enabled before you enable IGMP. 2. Enable PIM-SM on all the VLANIF interfaces of the switches. 3. Enable IGMP on the VLANIF interfaces connected to user hosts. 4. Add GE1/0/0 of SwitchA to the multicast group 225.1.1.1 statically to enable user hosts to receive stable multicast data. 5. Set the maximum number of IGMP group memberships on SwitchA. Data Preparation To complete the configuration, you need the following data: l Version of IGMP running between switches and user hosts l Static multicast group address, 225.1.1.1 l Maximum number of member relationships in an IGMP group Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 100 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration Procedure Step 1 Enable the multicast function and enable IGMP and PIM-SM on the user-side interfaces. # Enable the multicast function on SwitchA, enable IGMP and PIM-SM on VLANIF 10, and set the IGMP version to v2. The configurations of SwitchB and SwitchC are similar to the configuration of SwitchA, and are not provided here. [SwitchA] multicast routing-enable [SwitchA] interface gigabitethernet 1/0/0 [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid tagged vlan 10 [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] quit [SwitchA] interface vlanif 10 [SwitchA-Vlanif10] pim sm [SwitchA-Vlanif10] quit Step 2 Add GE1/0/0 of SwitchA to the multicast group 225.1.1.1 to enable the user hosts connected to GE1/0/0 to receive stable multicast data sent to the multicast group 225.1.1.1. [SwitchA] interface vlanif 10 [SwitchA-Vlanif10] igmp static-group 225.1.1.1 [SwitchA-Vlanif10] quit Step 3 Set the maximum number of member relationships in the IGMP group on the switch directly connected to the user hosts. # Set the maximum number of IGMP member relationships on SwitchA to 50. [SwitchA] igmp global limit 50 # Set the maximum number of IGMP member relationships in the public network instance to 40. [SwitchA] igmp [SwitchA-igmp] limit 40 [SwitchA-igmp] quit # Set the maximum number of IGMP member relationships on VLANIF 10 matching GE1/0/0 to 30. [SwitchA] interface vlanif 10 [SwitchA-Vlanif10] igmp limit 30 [SwitchA-Vlanif10] quit # The configurations of SwitchB and SwitchC are similar to the configuration of SwitchA, and are not provided here. Step 4 Verify the configuration. # Run the display igmp interface command to check the configuration and running status of IGMP on each interface of the switch. The IGMP information on VLANIF 10 of switchA is as follows: <SwitchA> display igmp interface vlanif 10 Interface information of VPN-Instance: public net vlanif10(10.110.1.1): IGMP is enabled Current IGMP version is 2 IGMP state: up IGMP group policy: none IGMP limit: 30 Value of query interval for IGMP (negotiated): Value of query interval for IGMP (configured): 60 s Value of other querier timeout for IGMP: 0 s Value of maximum query response time for IGMP: 10 s Querier for IGMP: 10.110.1.1 (this router) Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 101 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration You can find that a maximum of 30 IGMP member relationships can be created on VLANIF 10 of SwitchA. ----End Configuration Files l Configuration file of SwitchA # sysname SwitchA # vlan batch 10 11 # igmp global limit 50 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif10 pim sm igmp enable igmp limit 30 ip address 10.110.1.1 24 # interface Vlanif11 ip address 192.168.1.1 24 # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 10 port hybrid untagged vlan 10 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 11 port hybrid untagged vlan 11 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 10.110.1.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.1.0 0.0.0.255 # igmp limit 40 # return l Configuration file of SwitchB # sysname SwitchB # vlan batch 20 21 # igmp global limit 50 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif20 pim sm igmp enable igmp limit 30 ip address 10.110.2.1 24 # interface Vlanif21 ip address 192.168.2.1 24 # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 20 port hybrid untagged vlan 20 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 102 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 4 IGMP Configuration port hybrid pvid vlan 21 port hybrid untagged vlan 21 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 10.110.2.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.2.0 0.0.0.255 # igmp limit 40 # return l Configuration file of SwitchC # sysname SwitchC # vlan batch 20 31 # igmp global limit 50 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif20 pim sm igmp enable igmp limit 30 ip address 10.110.3.1 24 # interface Vlanif31 ip address 192.168.2.2 24 # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 20 port hybrid untagged vlan 20 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 31 port hybrid untagged vlan 31 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 10.110.3.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.3.0 0.0.0.255 # igmp limit 40 # return Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 103 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration About This Chapter The PIM protocol is used to implement multicast routing and data forwarding inside an AS. The PIM-DM protocol is a multicast routing protocol of dense node. It is applicable to a small-scale network with densely-distributed members. 5.1 PIM-DM Overview In the network where multicast group members are densely distributed and each network segment may have multicast group members, PIM-DM builds a unidirectional and loop-free SPT from the multicast source to the group member through periodical flooding and pruning. 5.2 PIM-DM Features Supported by the S9700 The system can work normally with default PIM-DM parameters. You are also allowed to adjust parameters related to neighbor discovery, prune, state refresh, graft, and assert according to specific scenarios. In addition, you can configure various filtering policies and the PIM silent function to enhance the PIM-DM security. 5.3 Configuring Basic PIM-DM Functions Ensure that unicast routes are reachable before enabling IPv4 multicast routing, and enable PIMDM on each interface of the multicast device. In this manner, the PIM-DM network can work normally. 5.4 Adjusting Control Parameters of a Multicast Source A multicast device can control the forwarding of multicast data based on multicast sources. This helps to control multicast data flows and limit information that can be obtained by downstream receivers to enhance security. 5.5 Adjusting Control Parameters for Maintaining Neighbor Relationships PIM devices exchange Hello messages to set up neighbor relationships and negotiate various control parameters for controlling the neighbor relationships. 5.6 Adjusting Control Parameters for Prune When the last member leaves a group, the multicast device sends a Prune message upstream, requesting the upstream device to execute the prune action. If other downstream devices on the same network segment need the multicast data for this group, they need to send Join messages to override the prune action. 5.7 Adjusting Control Parameters for State-Refresh In a PIM-DM network, the periodic flooding-pruning wastes lots of network resources. To prevent the pruned interface from forwarding messages because the prune timer times out, you Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 104 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration can enable the State-Refresh function. The multicast device then sends State-Refresh messages periodically to refresh the prune state of the interface and maintain the SPT. 5.8 Adjusting Control Parameters for Graft To make new members in a network to quickly receive multicast data, a multicast device actively sends a Graft message through an upstream interface, requesting the upstream device to forward multicast data to this network segment. 5.9 Adjusting Control Parameters for Assert If a multicast device can receive multicast data through an downstream interface, this indicates that other upstream devices exist in this network segment. The device then sends an Assert message through the downstream interface to take part in the election of the unique upstream device. 5.10 Configuring PIM Silent Function The interface directly connecting a multicast device to a user host needs to be enabled with PIM. In this case, some malicious hosts may simulate a large number of PIM Hello messages and send the messages to the interface for processing. As a result, the multicast device is suspended. To avoid the preceding case, you can set the interface to be in the PIM Silent state. 5.11 Maintaining PIM-DM (IPv4) Maintaining PIM-DM involves resetting PIM statistics, monitoring PIM running status and debugging PIM. 5.12 Configuration Example Configuration examples are provided to show how to construct a basic PIM-DM network. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 105 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration 5.1 PIM-DM Overview In the network where multicast group members are densely distributed and each network segment may have multicast group members, PIM-DM builds a unidirectional and loop-free SPT from the multicast source to the group member through periodical flooding and pruning. CAUTION This chapter is concerned only about the PIM-DM configuration in an IPv4 network. The Protocol Independent Multicast (PIM) is a multicast protocol that is independent of unicast routing protocol such as static route, RIP, OSPF, IS-IS, and BGP. Multicast routing is independent of unicast routing protocols, except that unicast routing protocols are used to generate related multicast routing entries. Based on the Reverse Path Forwarding (RPF), PIM transmits multicast data across a network. RPF constructs a multicast forwarding tree by using the existing unicast routing information. When a multicast packet reaches a switch, the switch performs the RPF check first. If the packet does not pass the RPF check, the switch directly discards the packet. NOTE For details about RPF, see IPv4 Multicast Routing Management. The Protocol Independent Multicast-Dense Mode (PIM-DM) is applicable to a small-scale network with densely-distributed members. The functions and location of PIM-DM in a multicast network are shown in Figure 5-1. Figure 5-1 Location of PIM-DM on the multicast network IGMP PIM-DM Source Multicast Server Receiver UserA Receiver UserB PIM-DM PIM-DM IGMP Receiver UserC Receiver UserD Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 106 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration The Protocol Independent Multicast-Sparse Mode (PIM-SM) is applicable to a large-scale network with sparsely-distributed members. For details about PIM-SM, see PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration. 5.2 PIM-DM Features Supported by the S9700 The system can work normally with default PIM-DM parameters. You are also allowed to adjust parameters related to neighbor discovery, prune, state refresh, graft, and assert according to specific scenarios. In addition, you can configure various filtering policies and the PIM silent function to enhance the PIM-DM security. Controlling the Forwarding of a Multicast Source You can configure the Keepalive period of a multicast source and the filtering rules based on multicast sources. Adjusting Control Parameters for Setting Up Neighbor Relationship You can set the following control parameters: l The interval for sending Hello messages l The period for keeping neighbors reachable l Whether the Hello messages without the Generation ID option are received l The maximum delay for triggering Hello messages l Neighbor filtering function: An interface sets up neighbor relationships with only the addresses matching the filtering rules and deletes the neighbors unmatched with the filtering rules Adjusting Control Parameters for Pruning You can adjust the following control parameters for pruning: l The interval for keeping the Prune state of the downstream interface l The delay from the time when the current switch receives a Prune message from a downstream switch to the time when the current switch performs the prune action in the LAN l The period for overriding the prune action Adjusting Control Parameters for State-Refresh You can enable or disable State-Refresh, set the interval for sending PIM State-Refresh messages, set the minimum interval for receiving the next State-Refresh message, and set the TTL value for forwarding State-Refresh messages on the switch directly connected to the source. Adjusting Control Parameters for Graft You can set the interval for retransmitting Graft messages. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 107 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration Adjusting Control Parameters for Assert You can set the period for a switch to retain the Assert state. The switch that fails in the election prevents the downstream interface from forwarding multicast data during this period. After the period expires, the downstream interface continues to forward multicast data. Attack Defense Using PIM Silent Some hosts may send a large number of malicious PIM Hello messages, which results in the suspension of the switch. The PIM Silent function can then be configured on the interfaces connected to hosts to protect the switch. PIM Multi-instance In multi-instance applications, multicast switchs need to maintain the PIM neighbor list and multicast routing table for different VPN instances and keep the information independent among multiple instances. When a switch receives a multicast data packet, the switch needs to distinguish the VPN instance to which the packet belongs and forward the packet based on the multicast routing table of the specific VPN instance, or create a PIM multicast routing entry of the VPN instance. 5.3 Configuring Basic PIM-DM Functions Ensure that unicast routes are reachable before enabling IPv4 multicast routing, and enable PIMDM on each interface of the multicast device. In this manner, the PIM-DM network can work normally. 5.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task Before configuring basic PIM-DM functions, configure a unicast IPv4 routing protocol. Applicable Environment PIM-DM is applicable to a small-scale network, and most network segments of the network have receivers. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring basic PIM-DM functions, complete the following configuration tasks: l Configuring an IPv4 unicast routing protocol Data Preparation To configure basic PIM-DM functions, you need the following data. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) No. Data 1 Type and number of an interface Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 108 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration 5.3.2 Enabling IPv4 Multicast Routing Prior to configuring all IPv4 multicast features, enable IPv4 multicast routing. Context CAUTION The configuration related to the VPN instance is applicable only to the PE switch. If the interface of the VPN instance connects to hosts, run the commands in Step 3 and Step 4. Do as follows on the switch: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 (Optional) Run: assign multicast-resource-mode optimize The multicast replication capability of LPUs is improved. If each multicast packet needs to be replicated into more than 8192 copies, run this command to improve the multicast replication capability before enabling IP multicast routing. Step 3 Run: multicast routing-enable IPv4 multicast routing is enabled in the public network instance. Step 4 (Optional) Run: ip vpn-instance vpn-instance-name The VPN instance view is displayed. Step 5 (Optional) Run: ipv4-family The IPv4 address family is enabled for the VPN instance and the VPN instance IPv4 address family view is displayed. Step 6 (Optional) Run: multicast routing-enable IPv4 multicast routing is enabled in the VPN instance IPv4 address family. ----End 5.3.3 Enabling PIM-DM An interface can set up PIM neighbor relationship with other devices after PIM-DM is enabled on it. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 109 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration Context NOTE PIM-SM and PIM-DM cannot be enabled on an interface at the same time. The PIM mode must be the same on all the interfaces of the same instance. When switches are distributed in PIM-DM domains, enable PIM-SM on all non-boundary interfaces. Do as follows on the switch: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface. Step 3 Run: pim dm PIM-DM is enabled. After PIM-DM is enabled on the interface and the PIM neighbor relationship is set up between switches, the protocol packets sent by the PIM neighbors can be processed. You can run the undo pim dm command to disable PIM-DM on the interface. ----End 5.3.4 Checking the Configuration After PIM-DM is configured successfully, you can check information about the PIM interface, PIM neighbor, and PIM routing table through commands.. Procedure l Run the command display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] to check PIM on interfaces of the public network instance, VPN instance, or all instances. l Run the command display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] neighbor [ neighbor-address | interface interface-type interface-number | verbose ] * to check PIM neighbors of the public network, VPN instance, or all instances. l Run the following commands to check the PIM routing table of the public network, VPN instance, or all instances. – display pim { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table [ groupaddress [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { sourcemask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interfacenumber | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 110 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration interface-number | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | groupmask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpninstance-name | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table brief [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } ] * ----End Example Run the display pim interface verbose command, and you can view the detailed information about PIM on the interface in the public network instance. <Quidway> display pim interface verbose VPN-Instance: public net Interface: Vlanif117, PIM version: 2 PIM mode: Dense PIM state: down PIM DR: PIM DR Priority (configured): 1 PIM neighbor count: PIM hello interval: 30 s PIM LAN delay (negotiated): PIM LAN delay (configured): 500 ms PIM hello override interval (negotiated): PIM hello override interval (configured): 2500 ms PIM Silent: disabled PIM neighbor tracking (negotiated): PIM neighbor tracking (configured): disabled PIM generation ID: PIM require-GenID: disabled PIM hello hold interval: 105 s PIM assert hold interval: 180 s PIM triggered hello delay: 5 s PIM J/P interval: 60 s PIM J/P hold interval: 210 s PIM state-refresh processing: enabled PIM state-refresh interval: 60 s PIM graft retry interval: 3 s PIM state-refresh capability on link: capable PIM BFD: disabled PIM dr-switch-delay timer : not configured Number of routers on link not using DR priority: Number of routers on link not using LAN delay: Number of routers on link not using neighbor tracking: ACL of PIM neighbor policy: ACL of PIM ASM join policy: ACL of PIM SSM join policy: ACL of PIM join policy: - Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 111 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration 5.4 Adjusting Control Parameters of a Multicast Source A multicast device can control the forwarding of multicast data based on multicast sources. This helps to control multicast data flows and limit information that can be obtained by downstream receivers to enhance security. 5.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After basic functions of PIM-DM are configured, you can configure the lifetime of a multicast source and source address-based filtering rules as required. Applicable Environment This configuration is applicable to all PIM-DM networks. A PIM switch checks the passing multicast data. By checking whether the data matches the filtering rule, the switch determines whether to forward the data. In this case, you can regard the switch as the filter of the multicast data. The filter helps to control the data flow and limit the information that downstream receivers can obtain. Network security is thus ensured. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring control parameters of a multicast source, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol l Configuring Basic PIM-DM Functions Data Preparation To configure control parameters of a multicast source, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Keepalive period of a multicast source 2 Filtering rules of multicast source addresses 5.4.2 Configuring the Lifetime of a Source A multicast device starts a timer for each (S, G) entry. If the multicast device does not receive any multicast packets from a multicast source within the set lifetime of the multicast source, it considers that the (S, G) entry becomes invalid and the multicast source stops sending multicast data to the multicast group. Context Do as follows on the PIM switch: NOTE If there is no special requirement, default values are recommended. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 112 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. Step 3 Run: source-lifetime interval The lifetime of a source is set. If a switch does not receive any (S, G) packet in the lifetime of the source, the switch considers that the source stops sending multicast data to G and the (S, G) entry becomes invalid. When State-Refresh is enabled, the lifetime of the multicast source is prolonged to about the value of interval. ----End 5.4.3 Configuring Filtering Rules Based on Source Addresses After ACL rules are configured, a multicast device can filter the received multicast packets based on source addresses or source/group addresses. Context Do as follows on the PIM switch: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. Step 3 Run: source-policy { acl-number | acl-name acl-name } The filter is configured. The effect of the filtering is more obvious if the filter is closer to the source. l If the basic ACL is configured, only the packets with the source addresses that pass the filtering are forwarded. l If the advanced ACL is configured, only the packets with the source addresses and group addresses that pass the filtering are forwarded. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 113 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration NOTE l If acl-number | acl-name acl-name is specified in the source-policy command and ACL rules are created, only the multicast packets whose source addresses match the ACL rules are permitted. l If acl-number | acl-name acl-name is specified in the source-policy command and no ACL rule is created, the multicast packets with any source addresses are not forwarded. l The source-policy command does not filter the static (S, G) entries and the PIM entries of the Join messages received from private networks. ----End 5.4.4 Checking the Configuration After the control parameters of a multicast source are adjusted, you can run commands to check entries in the PIM routing table. Procedure l Run the following commands to check the PIM routing table. – display pim { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table [ groupaddress [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { sourcemask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interfacenumber | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | groupmask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpninstance-name | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table brief [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } ] * ----End 5.5 Adjusting Control Parameters for Maintaining Neighbor Relationships PIM devices exchange Hello messages to set up neighbor relationships and negotiate various control parameters for controlling the neighbor relationships. 5.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After basic functions of PIM-DM are configured, you can adjust related parameters of Hello messages for controlling the neighbor relationships, and configure the neighbor filtering function to enhance security as required. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 114 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration Applicable Environment PIM switchs exchange Hello messages to set up neighbor relationships and negotiate various control parameters. The Switch under the control of default values can work normally. In the S9700, users can adjust related parameters according to the specific network environment. NOTE If there is no special requirement, default values are recommended. Pre-configuration Tasks Before adjusting control parameters for maintaining neighbor relationships, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol l Configuring Basic PIM-DM Functions Data Preparation To adjust control parameters for maintaining neighbor relationships, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Timeout period of the neighbor 2 Interval for sending Hello messages 3 Maximum delay for triggering Hello messages 4 Number or name of the ACL used to filter PIM neighbors 5.5.2 Configuring the Interval for Sending Hello Messages The interval for sending Hello messages can be set either globally or on an interface. The configuration in the interface view is prior to the configuration in the PIM view. When the interval is not configured in the interface view, the configuration in the PIM view takes effect. Context Do as follows on the PIM-DM switch: NOTE The configuration involves the following cases: l Global configuration: It is valid on each interface. l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 115 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration Procedure l Global Configuration 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. 3. Run: timer hello interval The interval for sending Hello messages is set. l Configuration on an Interface 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IP-Trunk interface. 3. Run: pim timer hello interval The interval for sending Hello messages is set. 4. Run: pim triggered-hello-delay interval The maximum delay for triggering Hello messages is set. After the maximum delay is set, the conflict caused by multiple PIM switchs sending Hello messages simultaneously is prevented. ----End 5.5.3 Configuring the Timeout Period of a Neighbor The timeout period of a neighbor can be set either globally or on an interface. If the multicast device does not receive any Hello message from a neighbor when the timeout period is expired, the device considers that the neighbor is unreachable. The timeout period of the neighbor must be longer than the interval for sending Hello messages. Context Do as follows on the PIM-DM switch: Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 116 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration NOTE The configuration involves the following two cases: l Global configuration: It is valid on each interface. l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used. Procedure l Global Configuration 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. 3. Run: hello-option holdtime interval The timeout period during which the neighbor is reachable is set. If no Hello message is received from a neighbor in the timeout period, the neighbor is considered unreachable. l Configuration on an Interface 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IP-Trunk interface. 3. Run: pim hello-option holdtime interval The timeout period during which the neighbor is reachable is set. If no Hello message is received from a neighbor in the timeout period, the neighbor is considered unreachable. ----End 5.5.4 Refusing to Receive the Hello Message Without the Generation ID Option When the Generation ID option in the Hello message received from an upstream neighbor changes, it indicates that the status of the upstream neighbor changes. Therefore, you can configure a PIM interface to deny the Hello messages without Generation ID options to obtain the upstream neighbor status in real time. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 117 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface. Step 3 Run: pim require-genid The Generation ID option is set in a Hello message. The Hello message without the Generation ID option is rejected. When the Generation ID option in the Hello message received from an upstream neighbor changes, it indicates that the pim state of upstream neighbor changes, for example restarts. If a switch does not want to receive data from an upstream neighbor, the switch sends a Prune message after receiving a data packet from the upstream neighbor. ----End 5.5.5 Configuring PIM Neighbor Filtering To prevent some unknown devices from being involved in PIM, filtering PIM neighbors is required. An interface sets up neighbor relationships with only the addresses matching the filtering rules and deletes the neighbors unmatched with the filtering rules. Context To prevent some switch from being involved in PIM, filtering PIM neighbors is required. Do as follows on the switch running PIM-DM: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface. Step 3 Run: pim neighbor-policy { basic-acl-number | acl-name acl-name } Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 118 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration PIM neighbor filtering is configured. An interface sets up neighbor relationships with only the addresses matching the filtering rules and deletes the neighbors unmatching the filtering rules. NOTE When configuring the neighbor filtering function on the interface, you must also configure the neighbor filtering function correspondingly on the switch that sets up the neighbor relationship with the interface. ----End 5.5.6 Checking the Configuration After the neighbor control parameters are adjusted, you can run commands to check information about the PIM interface and the PIM neighbor. Procedure l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check PIM on an interface. l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] neighbor [ neighbor-address | interface interface-type interface-number | verbose ] * command to check information about a PIM neighbor. ----End 5.6 Adjusting Control Parameters for Prune When the last member leaves a group, the multicast device sends a Prune message upstream, requesting the upstream device to execute the prune action. If other downstream devices on the same network segment need the multicast data for this group, they need to send Join messages to override the prune action. 5.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After basic PIM-DM functions are configured, you can set the period for an interface to keep the prune state, delay for transmitting Prune messages in a LAN, and interval for overriding the prune action as required. Applicable Environment When the last member leaves its group, the switch sends a Prune message through an upstream interface. After receiving the Prune message, the upstream switch performs the prune action and stops sending multicast packets to this network segment. If other downstream switchs exist in the network, the switchs need to send a Join message to override the prune action. Switchs can work normally under the control of the default parameter values. Users can adjust related parameters according to the specific network environment. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 119 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration NOTE The configuration involves the following two cases: l Global configuration: It is valid on each interface. l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used. Pre-configuration Tasks Before adjusting control parameters for prune, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol l Configuring Basic PIM-DM(IPv6) Functions Data Preparation To adjust control parameters for prune, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Timeout period of the Prune state 2 Delay for transmitting Prune messages 3 Interval for overriding the prune action 5.6.2 Configuring the Period for an Interface to Keep the Prune State The period for an interface to keep the prune state can be set either globally or on an interface. After the period expires, the pruned interface starts to forward messages again. If the multicast device receives a State-Refresh message before the period expires, it resets the timer, that is, it refreshes the prune state. Context Do as follows on the PIM-DM switch: Procedure l Global Configuration 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. 3. Run: holdtime join-prune interval The period during which the downstream interface is in the Prune state is set. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 120 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration After the period expires, the pruned interface starts to forward packets again. Before the period expires, the switch refreshes the Prune state when receiving a State-Refresh message. l Configuration on an Interface 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IP-Trunk interface. 3. Run: pim holdtime join-prune interval The period during which the downstream interface is in the Prune state is set. After the period is expired, the pruned interface starts to forward packets again. Before the period expires, the switch refreshes the Prune state when receiving a StateRefresh message. ----End 5.6.3 Configuring the Delay for Transmitting Prune Messages in a LAN The delay for transmitting Prune messages in a LAN can be set either globally or on an interface. When the values of lan-delay on all devices along the same link are different, the maximum value of these values is preferred. Context Do as follows on the PIM-DM switch: Procedure l Global Configuration 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. 3. Run: hello-option lan-delay interval The delay for transmitting messages in a LAN is set. l Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Configuration on an Interface Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 121 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 1. 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IP-Trunk interface. 3. Run: pim hello-option lan-delay interval The delay for transmitting messages in a LAN is set. ----End 5.6.4 Configuring the Interval for Overriding the Prune Action When a device sends a Prune message to the upstream in the same network segament, if other devices still needs to receive the multicast data, the device must send a Join message upstream within the override-interval. Context Do as follows on the PIM-DM switch: Procedure l Global Configuration 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. 3. Run: hello-option override-interval interval The interval for overriding the prune action is set. When a switch sends a Prune message to the upstream switch in the same network segament, if other switch still requests the multicast data, it needs to send a Join message to the upstream switch in the override-interval period. l Configuration on an Interface 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: interface interface-type interface-number Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 122 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration The interface view is displayed. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IP-Trunk interface. 3. Run: pim hello-option override-interval interval The interval for overriding the prune action is set. ----End 5.6.5 Checking the Configuration After the control parameters for prune are adjusted, you can check information about the PIM interface and the PIM routing table and statistics about PIM control messages through commands. Procedure l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check information about PIM on an interface. l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] control-message counters [ message-type { crp | probe | register | register-stop | assert | graft | graftack | hello | join-prune | state-refresh | bsr } | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * command to check the number of sent or received PIM control packets. l Run the following commands to check the PIM routing table. – display pim { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table [ groupaddress [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { sourcemask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interfacenumber | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | groupmask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpninstance-name | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table brief [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } ] * ----End 5.7 Adjusting Control Parameters for State-Refresh In a PIM-DM network, the periodic flooding-pruning wastes lots of network resources. To prevent the pruned interface from forwarding messages because the prune timer times out, you can enable the State-Refresh function. The multicast device then sends State-Refresh messages periodically to refresh the prune state of the interface and maintain the SPT. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 123 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration 5.7.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After basic functions of PIM-DM are configured, you can set the interval for sending StateRefresh messages, period for waiting to receive the next State-Refresh message, and TTL value carried in the State-Refresh message as required. Applicable Environment In a PIM-DM network, periodical flooding-prune wastes a lot of network resources. To prevent a pruned interface from forwarding packets, you can enable the State-Refresh function. Switch periodically send State-Refresh messages to refresh the prune state of interfaces and maintain the SPT. Switchs can work normally under the control of the default parameter values. Users can adjust related parameters according to the specific network environment. NOTE If there is no specific requirement, default values are recommended. Pre-configuration Tasks Before adjusting control parameters for State-Refresh, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol l Configuring Basic PIM-DM Functions Data Preparation To adjust control parameters for State-Refresh, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Interval for sending PIM State-Refresh messages 2 Period for waiting to receive the next State-Refresh message 3 TTL value for forwarding State-Refresh messages 5.7.2 Disabling State-Refresh After this function is disabled on the interface, the interface cannot forward any State-Refresh messages. Context Do as follows on all the switchs in the PIM-DM domain. NOTE By default, PIM-DM State-Refresh is enabled on the interface. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 124 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface. Step 3 Run: undo pim state-refresh-capable PIM-DM State-Refresh is disabled. The interface on which PIM-DM State-Refresh is disabled cannot forward any State-Refresh message. NOTE You can run the pim state-refresh-capable command to re-enable PIM-DM State-Refresh on the interface. ----End 5.7.3 Configuring the Interval for Sending State-Refresh Messages To prevent pruned interfaces from forwarding messages after the prune state timer times out, you need to set the interval for sending State-Refresh messages to be shorter than the period for keeping the Prune state. Context Do as follows on all the switchs in the PIM-DM domain: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. Step 3 Run: state-refresh-interval interval The interval for sending PIM State-Refresh messages is set. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 125 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration NOTE l This command is applicable to the first-hop switch connecting with the multicast source. l The interval for sending PIM State-Refresh messages should be shorter than the timeout period for keeping the Prune state. l You can run the holdtime join-prune command to set the timeout period for keeping the Prune state. ----End 5.7.4 Configuring the Period for Receiving the Next State-Refresh Message A multicast device may receive PIM State-Refresh messages from multiple routers in a short period and some PIM State-Refresh messages are repeated. Before the state-refresh timer times out, the device discards the received repeated State-Refresh messages. The device is allowed to receive the next State-Refresh message only after the timer times out. Context Do as follows on all the PIM-DM switchs in the PIM-DM domain: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. Step 3 Run: state-refresh-rate-limit interval The period for waiting to receive the next State-Refresh message is set. ----End 5.7.5 Configuring the TTL Value Carried in a State-Refresh Message After receiving the PIM State-Refresh message, a multicast device decrements the TTL value by 1 and then forwards the message downstream until the TTL value becomes 0. In a smallsized network, the PIM State-Refresh message is transmitted circularly on the network. You can adjust the TTL value according to the network scale. Context Do as follows on the PIM-DM switchs directly connected to the source in the PIM-DM domain: Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 126 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. Step 3 Run: state-refresh-ttl ttl-value The TTL value carried in the State-Refresh message is set. NOTE This command is valid only on the switch directly connected to the source. ----End 5.7.6 Checking the Configuration After the control parameters for state-refresh are adjusted, you can check information about the PIM interface and the PIM routing table and statistics about PIM control messages through commands. Procedure l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check PIM on an interface. l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] control-message counters [ message-type { crp | probe | register | register-stop | assert | graft | graftack | hello | join-prune | state-refresh | bsr } | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * command to check the number of sent or received PIM control messages. l Run the following commands to check the PIM routing table. – display pim { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table [ groupaddress [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { sourcemask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interfacenumber | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | groupmask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpninstance-name | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table brief [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 127 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } ] * ----End 5.8 Adjusting Control Parameters for Graft To make new members in a network to quickly receive multicast data, a multicast device actively sends a Graft message through an upstream interface, requesting the upstream device to forward multicast data to this network segment. 5.8.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After basic functions of PIM-DM are configured, you can set the interval for retransmitting Graft messages as required. Applicable Environment In a PIM-DM network, if State-Refresh is not enabled, a pruned interface can forward packets after the Prune state times out. If State-Refresh is enabled, the pruned interface may never forward packets. To enable new members in the network to receive multicast data quickly, a PIM-DM switch sends a Graft message through an upstream interface. After receiving the Graft message, the upstream switch responds immediately with a Graft-Ack message and enables the interface that receives the Graft message to forward packets. Switchs can work normally under the control of the default parameter values. Users can adjust the related parameters according to the specific network environment. NOTE If there is no specific requirement, default values are recommended. Pre-configuration Task Before configuring control parameters for graft, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol l Configuring Basic PIM-DM Functions Data Preparation To configure control parameters for graft, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Interval for retransmitting Graft messages 5.8.2 Configuring the Interval for Retransmitting Graft Messages In PIM-DM mode, when a member joins a pruned group, the multicast device sends a Graft message and waits for an ACK message from the upstream device. If the downstream device Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 128 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration does not receive any ACK message within a certain period, the device resends the Graft message until it receives an ACK message from the upstream device. Context Do as follows on the PIM-DM switch: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface. Step 3 Run: pim timer graft-retry interval The interval for retransmitting Graft messages is set. If the local switch does not receive any Graft-Ack message from the upstream switch in a specified period, it resends a Graft message. ----End 5.8.3 Checking the Configuration After the control parameters for graft are adjusted, you can check information about the unacknowledged PIM-DM graft, PIM interface, and PIM routing table and statistics about PIM control messages through commands. Procedure l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check PIM on an interface. l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] grafts command to check an unacknowledged PIM-DM graft. l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] control-message counters [ message-type { crp | probe | register | register-stop | assert | graft | graftack | hello | join-prune | state-refresh | bsr } | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * command to check the number of the sent or received PIM control messages. l Run the following commands to check the PIM routing table. – display pim { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table [ groupaddress [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { sourcemask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interfacenumber | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 129 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration interface-number | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | groupmask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpninstance-name | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table brief [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } ] * ----End 5.9 Adjusting Control Parameters for Assert If a multicast device can receive multicast data through an downstream interface, this indicates that other upstream devices exist in this network segment. The device then sends an Assert message through the downstream interface to take part in the election of the unique upstream device. 5.9.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After basic functions of PIM-DM are configured, you can set the holdtime of the Assert state as required. Applicable Environment When a PIM-DM switch receives multicast data through a downstream interface, it indicates that other upstream switchs exist in the network segment. The switch sends Assert messages through the interface to elect the unique upstream switch. Switchs can work normally under the control of the default parameter values. Users can adjust related parameters according to the specific network environment. NOTE If there is no specific requirement, default values are recommended. Pre-configuration Tasks Before adjusting control parameters for Assert, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol l Configuring Basic PIM-DM Functions Data Preparation To adjust control parameters for Assert, you need the following data. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 130 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration No. Data 1 Period for keeping the Assert state 5.9.2 Configuring the Period for Keeping the Assert State The device that fails in the election prevents its downstream interface from forwarding multicast data. After the holdtime of the Assert state expires, the downstream interface can forward multicast data. Context Do as follows on the PIM-DM switch: NOTE The configuration involves the following two cases: l Global configuration: It is valid on each interface. l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used. Procedure l Global Configuration 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. 3. Run: holdtime assert interval The period for holding the Assert state is set. The switch that fails in the election prevents its downstream interface from forwarding multicast data. After the Holdtime of the Assert state expires, the downstream interface can forward packets. l Configuration on an Interface 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 131 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 3. 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IP-Trunk interface. Run: pim holdtime assert interval The period for holding the Assert state is set. The switch that fails in the election prevents its downstream interface from forwarding multicast data. After the Holdtime period of the Assert state expires, the downstream interface can forward packets. ----End 5.9.3 Checking the Configuration After the control parameters for assert are adjusted, you can check information about the PIM interface and the PIM routing table and statistics about PIM control messages through commands. Procedure l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check PIM on an interface. l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] control-message counters [ message-type { crp | probe | register | register-stop | assert | graft | graftack | hello | join-prune | state-refresh | bsr } | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * command to check the number of sent or received PIM control messages. l Run the following commands to check the PIM routing table. – display pim { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table [ groupaddress [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { sourcemask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interfacenumber | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | groupmask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpninstance-name | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table brief [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } ] * ----End 5.10 Configuring PIM Silent Function The interface directly connecting a multicast device to a user host needs to be enabled with PIM. In this case, some malicious hosts may simulate a large number of PIM Hello messages and send Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 132 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration the messages to the interface for processing. As a result, the multicast device is suspended. To avoid the preceding case, you can set the interface to be in the PIM Silent state. 5.10.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After basic functions of PIM-DM and IGMP are configured, you can configure the PIM silent function on the interface connected with the user host. This interface should be enabled with PIM-DM and IGMP first. Applicable Environment On the access layer, the interface directly connected to hosts needs to be enabled with PIM. You can set up the PIM neighbor relationship on the interface to process various PIM packets. The configuration, however, has the security vulnerability. When a host maliciously generates PIM Hello messages and sends many packets to a switch, the switch may fail. To prevent the preceding case, you can set the status of the interface to PIM silent. When the interface is in the PIM silent state, the interface is prevented from receiving and forwarding any PIM packet. All PIM neighbor relationships and PIM state machines on the interface are deleted. At the same time, IGMP on the interface is not affected. To enable PIM silent, the network environment must meet the following conditions: l PIM silent is applicable only to the interface directly connected to the host network segment that is connected only to this switch. CAUTION If PIM silent is enabled on the interface connected to a switch, the PIM neighbor relationship cannot be established and a multicast fault may occur. If the host network segment is connected to multiple switchs and PIM silent is enabled on multiple interfaces of the switchs, these interfaces do not send Assert messages. Therefore, multiple interfaces that forward multicast data exist in the user network segment. A multicast fault thus occurs. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring PIM silent, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol to make the network reachable l Configuring PIM-DM l Configuring IGMP Data Preparation To configure PIM silent, you need the following data. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) No. Data 1 Type and number of the interface connected to hosts Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 133 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration 5.10.2 Configuring PIM Silent After the interface is configured with PIM silent, it is forbidden to receive or forward any PIM protocol packet. All PIM neighbors and PIM state machines on this interface are deleted. Then, this interface automatically becomes the DR. IGMP on the interface is not affected. Context Do as follows on the interface connected to the host network segment: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface. Step 3 Run: pim silent PIM silent is enabled. After PIM silent is enabled, the Hello message attack of malicious hosts is effectively prevented, and the switch is protected. ----End 5.10.3 Checking the Configuration After PIM silent is configured, you can run the command to check information about the PIM interface. Prerequisites All the configurations of PIM silent are complete. Procedure l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check PIM on an interface. ----End Example Run the display pim interface verbose command, and you can find that the configuration is complete. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 134 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration <Quidway> display pim interface Vlanif 10 verbose VPN-Instance: public net Interface: Vlanif10, PIM version: 2 PIM mode: Dense PIM state: down PIM DR: PIM DR Priority (configured): 1 PIM neighbor count: PIM hello interval: 30 s PIM LAN delay (negotiated): PIM LAN delay (configured): 500 ms PIM hello override interval (negotiated): PIM hello override interval (configured): 2500 ms PIM Silent: enabled PIM neighbor tracking (negotiated): PIM neighbor tracking (configured): disabled PIM generation ID: PIM require-GenID: disabled PIM hello hold interval: 105 s PIM assert hold interval: 180 s PIM triggered hello delay: 5 s PIM J/P interval: 60 s PIM J/P hold interval: 210 s PIM state-refresh processing: enabled PIM state-refresh interval: 60 s PIM graft retry interval: 3 s PIM state-refresh capability on link: capable PIM BFD: disabled PIM dr-switch-delay timer : not configured Number of routers on link not using DR priority: Number of routers on link not using LAN delay: Number of routers on link not using neighbor tracking: ACL of PIM neighbor policy: ACL of PIM ASM join policy: ACL of PIM SSM join policy: ACL of PIM join policy: - 5.11 Maintaining PIM-DM (IPv4) Maintaining PIM-DM involves resetting PIM statistics, monitoring PIM running status and debugging PIM. 5.11.1 Clearing Statistics of PIM Control Messages If you need to re-collect the statistics about PIM control messages, you can reset the existent statistics. Note that the statistics cannot be restored after you reset them. This operation does not affect normal running of PIM. Context CAUTION The statistics of the PIM control messages on the interface cannot be restored after you reset them. Confirm the action before you run the command. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 135 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration Procedure l Run the reset pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] control-message counters [ interface interface-type interface-number ] command in the user view to clear the statistics of the PIM control messages on an interface. ----End 5.11.2 Monitoring the Running Status of PIM During the routine maintenance, you can run the display commands in any view to know the running of PIM. Context In routine maintenance, you can run the following commands in any view to check the running status of PIM. Procedure l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] claimed-route [ source-address ] command in any view to check the unicast routes used by PIM. l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] control-message counters [ message-type { crp | probe | register | register-stop | assert | graft | graftack | hello | join-prune | state-refresh | bsr } | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * command in any view to check the number of sent or received PIM control messages. l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] grafts command in any view to check unacknowledged PIM-DM Graft messages. l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check information about PIM on an interface. l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] neighbor [ neighbor-address | interface interface-type interface-number | verbose ] * command to check information about a PIM neighbor. l Run the following commands to check the PIM routing table. – display pim { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table [ groupaddress [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { sourcemask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interfacenumber | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | groupmask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpninstance-name | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table brief [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 136 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } ] * ----End 5.11.3 Debugging PIM When a fault occurs during the running of PIM, run the debugging commands in the user view and check the contents of sent and received packets for fault location. Context CAUTION Debugging affects the performance of the system. So, after debugging, run the undo debugging all command to disable it immediately. When a PIM fault occurs, run the following debugging command in the user view to debug PIM and locate the fault. Procedure l Run the debugging pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] all command in the user view to enable all the debugging of PIM. l Run the debugging pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] event [ advanced-acl-number ] command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIM events. l Run the debugging pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routingtable [ advanced-acl-number ] command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIM routes. l Run the debugging pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] assert [ advanced-acl-number | [ receive | send ] ] * command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIM Assert. l Run the debugging pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] staterefresh [ advanced-acl-number | [ receive | send ] ] * command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIM State-Refresh. ----End 5.12 Configuration Example Configuration examples are provided to show how to construct a basic PIM-DM network. 5.12.1 Example for Configuring the PIM-DM Network Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 137 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration Networking Requirements On the experiment network shown in Figure 5-2, multicast is deployed. The unicast routes work normally. The Switches on the network need to be configured properly so that hosts can receive the VOD information in multicast mode. Figure 5-2 Networking diagram for configuring basic PIM-DM functions SwitchA Ethernet Ethernet GE1/0/0 Source Receiver HostA GE2/0/0 N1 PIM-DM GE3/0/0 GE4/0/0 GE1/0/0 SwitchD GE2/0/0 GE1/0/0 Leaf network GE2/0/0 SwitchB GE1/0/0 GE2/0/0 SwitchC N2 Receiver HostB Ethernet Switch Physical interface VLANIF interface IP address SwitchA GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 100 192.168.1.1/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 101 10.110.1.1/24 GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 200 192.168.2.1/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 102 10.110.2.1/24 GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 300 192.168.3.1/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 102 10.110.2.2/24 GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 200 192.168.2.2/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 300 192.168.3.2/24 GE 3/0/0 VLANIF 100 192.168.1.2/24 GE 4/0/0 VLANIF 103 10.110.5.1/24 SwitchB SwitchC SwitchD Configuration Roadmap In a small-scale experiment network, PIM-DM is adopted to configure multicast. Enable PIM silent on the VLANIF interfaces of SwitchA to protect SwitchA from Hello message attacks. The configuration roadmap is as follows: 1. Enable a unicast routing protocol on the Switch. 2. Enable multicast on the Switch. 3. Enable PIM-DM on each interface. 4. Enable PIM silent and configure IGMP on the VLANIF interfaces connected to hosts. Data Preparation To complete the configuration, you need the following data: Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 138 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration l Address of multicast group G: 225.1.1.1/24 l Address of multicast group S: 10.110.5.100/24 l Version of the IGMP protocol running between routers and hosts: IGMPv2 NOTE This configuration example describes only the commands used to configure PIM-DM. Procedure Step 1 Enable a unicast routing protocol on the Switch. The configuration procedure is not provided here. Step 2 Enable multicast on all Switches and enable PIM-DM on all interfaces. # Enable multicast on SwitchA and enable PIM-DM on each interface. The configurations of SwitchB, SwitchC, and SwitchD are similar to the configuration of SwitchA, and are not provided here. [SwitchA] multicast [SwitchA] interface [SwitchA-Vlanif100] [SwitchA-Vlanif100] [SwitchA] interface [SwitchA-Vlanif101] [SwitchA-Vlanif101] routing-enable vlanif 100 pim dm quit vlanif 101 pim dm quit Step 3 Configure the interfaces connected to hosts to be PIM silent and configure IGMP on the interface. # On SwitchA, configure the vlanif interfaces connected to hosts to be PIM silent, and configure IGMP on the interface. The configurations of SwitchB, SwitchC, and SwitchD are similar to configuration of SwitchA, and are not provided here. [SwitchA] interface [SwitchA-Vlanif101] [SwitchA-Vlanif101] [SwitchA-Vlanif101] vlanif 101 pim silent igmp enable quit Step 4 Verify the configuration. # Run the display pim interface command to view the configuration and operating of PIM on the router interface. The display of the PIM configuration on SwitchD is as follows: <SwitchD> display pim interface VPN-Instance: public net Interface State NbrCnt Vlanif103 up 0 Vlanif100 up 0 Vlanif200 up 0 Vlanif300 up 0 HelloInt 30 30 30 30 DR-Pri 1 1 1 1 DR-Address 10.110.5.1 (local) 192.168.1.2 (local) 192.168.2.2 (local) 192.168.3.2 (local) # Run the display pim neighbor command to check the PIM neighbor relationship between the Switches. The display of the PIM neighbor relationship on SwitchD is as follows: <SwitchD> display pim neighbor VPN-Instance: public net Total Number of Neighbors = 3 Neighbor Session 192.168.1.1 N 192.168.2.1 N 192.168.3.1 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Interface Uptime Expires Dr-Priority Vlanif100 00:02:22 00:01:27 1 Vlanif200 00:00:22 00:01:29 1 Vlanif300 00:00:23 00:01:31 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1 BFD- N 139 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration # Run the display pim routing-table command to view the PIM multicast routing table on the Switch. Assume that HostA needs to receive the information about multicast group G 225.1.1.1/24. When sending multicast packets to multicast group G, multicast source S 10.110.5.100/24 generates an SPT through flooding and the (S, G) entries exist on SwitchA and SwitchD that are in the SPT. When HostA joins multicast group G, an (*, G) entry is generated on SwitchA. The information displayed on SwitchB and SwitchC is similar to the information displayed on SwitchA. The displayed information is as follows: <SwitchA> display pim routing-table VPN-Instance: public net Total 1 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry (*, 225.1.1.1) Protocol: pim-dm, Flag: WC UpTime: 03:54:19 Upstream interface: NULL Upstream neighbor: NULL RPF prime neighbor: NULL Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: Vlanif101 Protocol: igmp, UpTime: 01:38:19, Expires: never (10.110.5.100, 225.1.1.1) Protocol: pim-dm, Flag: ACT UpTime: 00:00:44 Upstream interface: Vlanif100 Upstream neighbor: 192.168.1.2 RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.1.2 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: Vlanif101 Protocol: pim-dm, UpTime: 00:00:44, Expires: never <SwitchD> display pim routing-table VPN-Instance: public net Total 0 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry (10.110.5.100, 225.1.1.1) Protocol: pim-dm, Flag: LOC ACT UpTime: 01:35:25 Upstream interface: Vlanif103 Upstream neighbor: NULL RPF prime neighbor: NULL Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 2 1: Vlanif100 Protocol: pim-dm, UpTime: 00:03:27, Expires: never 2: Vlanif200 Protocol: pim-dm, UpTime: 00:03:27, Expires: never ----End Configuration Files l Configuration file of SwitchA # sysname SwitchA # multicast routing-enable # vlan batch 100 101 # interface Vlanif100 ip address 192.168.1.1 255.255.255.0 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 140 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration pim dm # interface Vlanif101 ip address 10.110.1.1 255.255.255.0 pim dm pim silent igmp enable # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 100 port hybrid untagged vlan 100 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 101 port hybrid untagged vlan 101 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 192.168.1.0 0.0.0.255 network 10.110.1.0 0.0.0.255 # return l Configuration file of SwitchB # sysname SwitchB # multicast routing-enable # vlan batch 200 102 # interface Vlanif102 ip address 10.110.2.1 255.255.255.0 pim dm igmp enable # interface Vlanif200 ip address 192.168.2.1 255.255.255.0 pim dm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 200 port hybrid untagged vlan 200 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 102 port hybrid untagged vlan 102 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 192.168.2.0 0.0.0.255 network 10.110.2.0 0.0.0.255 # return l Configuration file of SwitchC # sysname SwitchC # multicast routing-enable # vlan batch 102 300 # interface Vlanif102 ip address 10.110.2.2 255.255.255.0 pim dm igmp enable # interface Vlanif300 ip address 192.168.3.1 255.255.255.0 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 141 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5 PIM-DM (IPv4) Configuration pim dm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 300 port hybrid untagged vlan 300 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 102 port hybrid untagged vlan 102 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 192.168.3.0 0.0.0.255 network 10.110.2.0 0.0.0.255 # return l Configuration file of SwitchD # sysname SwitchD # multicast routing-enable # vlan batch 100 103 200 300 # interface Vlanif100 ip address 192.168.1.2 255.255.255.0 pim dm # interface Vlanif103 ip address 10.110.5.1 255.255.255.0 pim dm # interface Vlanif200 ip address 192.168.2.2 255.255.255.0 pim dm # interface Vlanif300 ip address 192.168.3.2 255.255.255.0 pim dm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 200 port hybrid untagged vlan 200 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 300 port hybrid untagged vlan 300 # interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 100 port hybrid untagged vlan 100 # interface GigabitEthernet4/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 103 port hybrid untagged vlan 103 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 192.168.2.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.3.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.1.0 0.0.0.255 network 10.110.5.0 0.0.0.255 # return Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 142 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration About This Chapter The PIM protocol is used to implement multicast routing and data forwarding inside an AS. The PIM-SM protocol is a multicast routing protocol of sparse node. It is applicable to a large-scale network with sparsely-distributed members. 6.1 PIM-SM Overview In a PIM-SM network, group members are sparsely distributed and almost all the network segments do not have group members resided. Therefore, an RP is a forwarding core of the PIMSM network. All PIM devices in the PIM-SM network must know the location of the RP and the RP collects information about both group members and multicast sources. 6.2 PIM-SM Features Supported by the S9700 The system can work normally with default PIM-SM parameters. You are also allowed to adjust parameters related to neighbor discovery, forwarding, DR, RP, join, register, and assert. In addition, you can configure various filtering policies and the PIM silent function to enhance the PIM-SM security. PIM-SM supports SSM, PIM BFD, PIM GR, and SPT switchover. 6.3 Configuring Basic PIM-SM Functions Ensure that unicast routes are reachable before configuring IPv4 multicast routing and enable PIM-SM on each interface of the multicast device. Configure static or dynamic RP so that the PIM-SM network can work normally. 6.4 Adjusting Control Parameters for a Multicast Source A multicast device can control the forwarding of multicast data based on multicast sources. This helps to control multicast data flows and limit information that can be obtained by downstream receivers to enhance security. 6.5 Adjusting Control Parameters of the C-RP and C-BSR If a dynamic RP is used, you can adjust parameters of C-RPs and C-BSR as required. If there is no special requirement, default values are recommended. 6.6 Configuring a BSR Administrative Domain A PIM-SM network can be divided into multiple BSR administrative domains and a global domain. This effectively reduces the load of a single BSR, and provides a special service for specific multicast groups. 6.7 Adjusting Control Parameters for Establishing the Neighbor Relationship Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 143 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration Multicast devices establish PIM neighbor relationships and negotiate various control parameters by exchanging Hello messages. You can adjust the parameters carried in Hello messages as required. If there is no special requirement, adopt default values. 6.8 Adjusting Control Parameters for Source Registering In a PIM-SM network, the DR directly connected to the multicast source encapsulates multicast data in a Register message and sends it to the RP in unicast mode. The RP then decapsulates the message, and forwards the multicast data to receivers along the RPT. The system supports the Register message filtering and suppression functions. 6.9 Adjusting Control Parameters for Forwarding A multicast device sends Join messages upstream to require to forward multicast data and Prune messages upstream for requiring to stop forwarding multicast data. You can adjust control parameters for multicast data forwarding as required. If there is no special requirement, adopt default values. 6.10 Adjusting Control Parameters for Assert If a multicast device can receive multicast data through the downstream interface, this indicates that other upstream devices exist in this network segment. The device then sends an Assert message through the downstream interface to take part in the election of the unique upstream device. 6.11 Configuring the SPT Switchover A high volume of multicast data traffic increases the load of an RP, and may result in a fault. To solve this problem, PIM-SM allows the RP or the DR at the group member side to trigger the SPT switchover when the rate of multicast packets is high. 6.12 Configuring PIM BFD After detecting a fault on the peer, BFD immediately notifies the PIM module to trigger a new DR election rather than waits until the neighbor relationship times out. This shortens the period during which multicast data transmission is discontinued and thus improves the reliability of multicast data transmission. 6.13 Configuring PIM GR In a PIM-SM network, PIM GR can be applied to a device with dual main control boards to ensure normal multicast data forwarding during master-slave switchover. 6.14 Configuring PIM Silent The interface directly connecting a multicast device to a user host needs to be enabled with PIM. In this case, some malicious hosts may simulate a large number of PIM Hello messages and send the messages to the interface for processing. As a result, the multicast device is suspended. To avoid the preceding case, you can set the interface to be in the PIM Silent state. 6.15 Maintaining PIM-SM (IPv4) Maintaining PIM-SM involves resetting PIM statistics, and monitoring PIM running status. 6.16 Configuration Examples Configuration examples are provided to show how to construct a basic PIM-SM network and configure basic functions of PIM-SM. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 144 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration 6.1 PIM-SM Overview In a PIM-SM network, group members are sparsely distributed and almost all the network segments do not have group members resided. Therefore, an RP is a forwarding core of the PIMSM network. All PIM devices in the PIM-SM network must know the location of the RP and the RP collects information about both group members and multicast sources. The Protocol Independent Multicast (PIM) indicates that any unicast routing protocol, such as static route, RIP, OSPF, IS-IS, or BGP, can provide the routing information for IP multicast. multicast routing is independent of unicast routing protocols, except that the unicast routing table is used to generated multicast routing entries. PIM forwards multicast packets by using the Reverse Path Forwarding (RPF) mechanism. The RPF mechanism is used to create the multicast forwarding tree through the existing unicast routing information. When a multicast packet arrives at a switch, the switch performs the RPF check on the packet. If the RPF check succeeds, a multicast routing entry is created for forwarding the multicast packet. If the RPF check fails, the packet is discarded. NOTE For details of RPF, refer to the chapter IPv4 Multicast Routing Management. The working process of the Protocol Independent Multicast-Sparse Mode (PIM-SM) consists of neighbor discovery, assert, DR election, RP discovery, join, prune, register, and SPT switchover. As shown in Figure 6-1, PIM-SM is used in a large-scale network with sparsely distributed group members. Figure 6-1 Application of PIM-SM a the multicast network Receiver IGMP Source PIM-SM PIM-SM Multicast Server PIM-SM UserA PIM-SM PIM-SM Receiver IGMP UserB PIM-SM Receiver PIM-SM IGMP UserC Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 145 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration NOTE l The Protocol Independent Multicast Dense Mode (PIM-DM) is applicable to a small-scale network with densely distributed members. l PIM-SM can be used to construct the Any-Source Multicast (ASM) and Source-Specific Multicast (SSM) models. 6.2 PIM-SM Features Supported by the S9700 The system can work normally with default PIM-SM parameters. You are also allowed to adjust parameters related to neighbor discovery, forwarding, DR, RP, join, register, and assert. In addition, you can configure various filtering policies and the PIM silent function to enhance the PIM-SM security. PIM-SM supports SSM, PIM BFD, PIM GR, and SPT switchover. Basic PIM-SM Functions PIM-SM supports the ASM and SSM models. You can set the range of ASM group addresses or the range of SSM group addresses. Static RP You can specify a static RP on all the switchs in a PIM-SM domain. When a dynamic RP exists in the domain, the dynamic RP is preferred by default, but you can configure the static RP to be preferred. Dynamic RP You can configure C-RPs and C-BSRs in a PIM-SM domain and set the unified rules used to dynamically generated the BSR and the RP. You can adjust the priority for C-RP election, adjust the lifetime of the advertisement message on the BSR received from the C-RP, adjust the interval for the C-RP to send advertisement messages, and specify an Access Control List (ACL) to limit the range of the multicast groups served by the C-RP. BSR You can specify the C-BSR in the BSR domain, adjust the hash length used by the RP for C-RP election, adjust the priority used for BSR election, and adjust the legal BSR address range. To limit the transmission of BSR messages, you can configure the BSR service boundary on an interface of the switch on the boundary of the BSR domain. Filtering Policy Based on Source Addresses You can configure filtering rules of the multicast source address to control multicast sources. You can configure the policy to filter Register messages, and suppress PIM-SM Register messages. BSR Administrative Domain You can configure the service boundary of the BSR administrative domain and the boundary of the administrative domain by using the related commands. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 146 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration Adjusting Parameters for Maintaining PIM-SM Neighbors You can adjust the following parameters about PIM-SM neighbors, including: l Interval for sending Hello messages l Time period for the neighbor to hold the reachable state l Whether to receive the Hello messages with Generation IDs l Maximum delay in triggering the Hello messages l Priority for DR election l DR switching delay l Neighbor filtering function: An interface sets up neighbor relationships with only the addresses matching the filtering rules. Configuring Control Parameters for Multicast Forwarding You can adjust control parameters for multicast forwarding, including: l Interval for sending Join messages l Time period for the downstream interface to keep the forwarding state l Time for overriding the prune action l Filtering Join information in the Join/Prune messages l Neighbor check function: checks whether the Join/Prune and Assert messages are sent to or received from a PIM neighbor. If not, these messages are not processed. Configuring Control Parameters for Assert You can configure the period for retaining the Assert state of the switch interface. Adjusting Control Parameters for SPT Switchover You can adjust conditions of the SPT switchover and the interval for checking the forwarding rate of multicast data. PIM BFD In the S9700, you can dynamically set up the BFD session to detect the status of the link between PIM neighbors. Once a fault occurs on the link, BFD reports the fault to PIM. PIM GR The S9700 supports the PIM GR function on the switch with double MPUs. PIM GR ensures normal multicast data forwarding during master-slave switchover of the switch. Configuring PIM Silent On the access layer, the switch interface directly connected to hosts needs to be enabled with PIM. You can establish a PIM neighbor on the switch interface to process various PIM packets. The configuration, however, has the security vulnerability. When a host maliciously generates PIM Hello packets and sends the packets in large quantity, the switch may break down. To prevent the preceding case, you can set the status of the switch interface to PIM silent. When the interface is in the PIM silent state, the interface is prohibited from receiving and forwarding Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 147 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration any PIM packet. Then all PIM neighbors and PIM state machines on the interface are deleted. The interface acts as the static DR and immediately takes effect. At the same time, IGMP on the interface are not affected. Multi-Instance PIM In multi-instance applications, a multicast switch needs to maintain the PIM neighbor list, multicast routing table, BSR information, and RP-Set information for different VPN instances and keep the information independent between the instances. The switch functions as multiple multicast switchs running PIM independently. When a switch receives a data packet, it needs to differentiate which VPN instance the packet belongs to and forward it based on the multicast routing table of that VPN instance, or create PIM-related multicast routing entries in that VPN instance. PIM for Anycast RP Through PIM for Anycast RP in a PIM-SM domain, IP routing will automatically select the topologically closest RP for each source and receiver. This releases burdens on a single RP, implements RP backup, and optimizes multicast forwarding paths. 6.3 Configuring Basic PIM-SM Functions Ensure that unicast routes are reachable before configuring IPv4 multicast routing and enable PIM-SM on each interface of the multicast device. Configure static or dynamic RP so that the PIM-SM network can work normally. 6.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task Before configuring basic PIM-SM functions, configure an IPv4 unicast routing protocol. Applicable Environment A PIM-SM network can adopt the ASM and SSM models to provide multicast services for user hosts. The integrated components (including the RP) of the ASM model must be configured in the network first. The SSM group address range is then adjusted as required. NOTE The SSM model is only supported in IGMPv3. If user hosts must run IGMPv1 or IGMPv2, configure IGMP SSM mapping on switch interfaces. Through IGMP, a switch knows the multicast group G that a user wants to join. l If G is in the SSM group address range and the source S is specified when the user joins G through IGMPv3, the SSM model is used to provide multicast services. l If G is in the SSM group address range and the switch is configured with the (S, G) SSM mapping rules, the SSM model is used to provide multicast services. l If G is not in the SSM group address range, the ASM model is used to provide multicast services. In the PIM-SM network, the ASM model supports the following methods to obtain an RP. You can select the method as required. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 148 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast l 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration Static RP: To obtain a static RP, manually configure RP on each switch in the PIM-SM domain. For the large-scale PIM network, configuring the static RP is complicated. To enhance the robustness and the operating management of the multicast network, the static RP is usually used as the backup of the BSR-RP. A multicast group may be in the service range of the dynamic RP and the static RP simultaneously. By default, The switch prefers the dynamic RP. If the static RP precedence is configured, the static RP is preferred. Different multicast groups correspond to different RPs. Compared with all groups corresponding to an RP, this can reduce the burden of an RP and enhance the robustness of the network. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring basic PIM-SM functions, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol Data Preparation To configure basic PIM-SM functions, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Static RP address 2 ACL rule indicating the service scope of static RP 3 C-RP priority 4 ACL rule indicating the service scope of C-RP 5 Interval for C-RP sending Advertisement message 6 Timeout of the period during which BSR waits to receive the Advertisement message from C-RP. 7 C-BSR Hash mask length 8 C-BSR priority 9 SSM group address range 6.3.2 Enabling IP Multicast Routing Prior to configuring all IPv4 multicast features, enable IPv4 multicast routing. Context CAUTION The configuration related to the VPN instance is applicable only to the PE switch. If the interface of the VPN instance connects to the host, run the commands in step 3 and step 4. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 149 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration Do as follows on the switch: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 (Optional) Run: assign multicast-resource-mode optimize The multicast replication capability of LPUs is improved. If each multicast packet needs to be replicated into more than 8192 copies, run this command to improve the multicast replication capability before enabling IP multicast routing. Step 3 Run: multicast routing-enable IP multicast routing is enabled in the public network instance. Step 4 (Optional) Run: ip vpn-instance vpn-instance-name The VPN instance view is displayed. Step 5 (Optional) Run: ipv4-family The IPv4 address family is enabled for the VPN instance and the VPN instance IPv4 address family view is displayed. Step 6 (Optional) Run: multicast routing-enable IP multicast routing is enabled is enabled in the VPN instance IPv4 address family. Before enable the multicast routing, the Route-distinguisher of the VPN instance must be configured first. ----End 6.3.3 Enabling Basic PIM-SM Functions An interface can set up PIM neighbor relationship with other devices after PIM-SM is enabled on it. Context NOTE PIM-SM and PIM-DM cannot be enabled on an interface at the same time. The PIM mode on all interfaces that belong to the same instance must be consistent. When the switch is distributed in the PIM-SM domain, enable PIM-SM on all non-boundary interfaces. Do as follows on the switch: Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 150 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface. Step 3 Run: pim sm PIM SM is enabled. After PIM SM is enabled on the interface and PIM neighbor relationships are set up between switches, the protocol packets from the PIM neighbors can be processed. ----End 6.3.4 (Optional) Configuring a Static RP When only one RP exists in the network, you can manually configure a static RP rather than a dynamic RP. This can save the bandwidth occupied by message exchange between the C-RP and the BSR. The configurations about the static RP should be the same on all the devices in a PIM-SM domain. Context CAUTION When the static RP and the dynamic RP are configured in the PIM-SM at the same time, faults may occur in the network. So, confirm the action before you run the command. If you want to use only the dynamic RP in the PIM-SM network, skip the configuration. Do as follows on all switchs in a PIM-SM domain. The switchs where static RP is not configured cannot participate in multicast forwarding in this PIM-SM domain. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 151 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration Step 3 Run: static-rp rp-address [ basic-acl-number | acl-name acl-name ] [ preferred ] The static RP is specified. You can run the command repeatedly to configure multiple static RPs for the switch. NOTE All switchs in the PIM-SM area must be configured with the same static-rp command. l rp-address: specifies the static RP address. l basic-acl-number | acl-name acl-name: specifies the ACL. The ACL defines the range of the multicast group served by the static RP. When the range of multicast groups that multiple static RPs serve overlaps, the static RP with the largest IP address functions as the RP. l preferred: indicates the preference of the static RP. If the C-RP is configured in the network at the same time, the switch prefers the RP statically specified after preferred is used. Otherwise, C-RP is preferred. ----End 6.3.5 (Optional) Configuring a Dynamic RP In a PIM-SM domain, you can select several PIM devices and configure C-RPs on the devices. Then, an RP is elected from these C-RPs. The C-BSRs should also be configured and a BSR is elected from these C-BSRs. The BSR is responsible for collecting and advertising the C-RP information on the network. The system supports the auto-RP listening function. Context CAUTION The configuration is applicable only to the dynamic RP. If you want to use the static RP in the network, skip the configuration. Do as follows on the switch that may become RP in the PIM-SM domain: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. Step 3 Run: c-rp interface-type interface-number [ group-policy { basic-acl-number | acl-name acl-name } | priority priority | holdtime hold-interval | advertisement-interval adv-interval ] * The C-RP is configured. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 152 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration l interface-type interface-number: specifies the interface where the C-RP resides. The interface must be configured with PIM-SM. l group-policy { basic-acl-number | acl-name acl-name }: specifies the multicast group permitted by ACL and served by the C-RP. By default, C-RP serves all multicast groups. l priority priority: specifies the priority for electing C-RP. The greater is the value, the lower is the priority. By default, it is 0. In the RP election, the C-RP with the highest priority wins. In case of the same priority, the hash function is used and the C-RP with the greatest hash value wins. In case of the same priority and the same hash value, the C-RP with the highest IP address wins. NOTE It is recommended to configure the loopback interfaces as RPs. If the address borrowing is configured, it is not recommended to configure C-RP on the interfaces that have the same addresses. If the priorities of the interfaces are different, the BSR considers that the CRP configuration is repeatedly modified. l holdtime hold-interval: specifies the interval during which the BSR waits for the Advertisement message from the C-RP. By default, the interval is 150 seconds. l advertisement-interval adv-interval: specifies the interval during which the C-RP sends the Advertisement message. By default, the interval is 60 seconds. Step 4 Run: c-bsr interface-type interface-number [ hash-length [ priority ] ] The C-BSR is configured. l interface-type interface-number: specifies the interface where the C-BSR resides. The interface must be configured with the PIM-SM. l hash-length: specifies the length of the hash. According to the G, C-RP address, and the value of hash-length, switchs calculate the C-RPs that have the same priority and require to serve G by operating hash functions, and compare the calculation results. The C-RP with the greatest calculated value functions as the RP that serves G. l priority: specifies the priority used by switchs to join the BSR election. The greater is the value, the higher is the priority. By default, it is 0. In the BSR election, the C-BSR with the highest priority wins. In the case of the same priority, the C-BSR with the largest IP address wins. Step 5 (Optional) Run: bsm semantic fragmentation The BSR message fragmentation is enabled. It is recommended to enable BSR message fragmentation on all devices on the network because BSR message fragmentation can solve the problem faced by IP fragmentation that all fragments become unavailable due to loss of fragment information. Step 6 (Optional) Run: auto-rp listening enable The Auto-RP listening is enabled. When the switch interworks with a switch supporting auto-RP, this command needs to be configured on the switch. ----End Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 153 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration 6.3.6 (Optional) Configuring the SSM Group Address Range The default SSM group address range is 232.0.0.0/8. You can manually configure the SSM group address range. Ensure that the SSM group address ranges configured on all devices in the network are identical. Context This configuration is optional. By default, the SSM group address range is 232.0.0.0/8. Do as follows on all switchs in the PIM-SM domain: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. Step 3 Run: ssm-policy { basic-acl-number | acl-name acl-name } The SSM group address range is configured. NOTE Ensure that the SSM group address range of all switchs in the network is consistent. ----End 6.3.7 Checking the Configuration After basic functions of PIM-SM are configured, you can check information about the BSR, RP, PIM interface, PIM neighbor, and PIM routing table through commands. Procedure l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] bsr-info command to check the BSR in a PIM-SM domain. l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check PIM on an interface. l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] neighbor [ neighbor-address | interface interface-type interface-number | verbose ] * command to check a PIM neighbor. l Run the following commands to check the PIM routing table. – display pim { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table [ groupaddress [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { sourcemask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interfacenumber | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 154 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration interface-number | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | groupmask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpninstance-name | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table brief [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } ] * l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] rp-info [ groupaddress ] command to check the RP in a PIM-SM domain. ----End 6.4 Adjusting Control Parameters for a Multicast Source A multicast device can control the forwarding of multicast data based on multicast sources. This helps to control multicast data flows and limit information that can be obtained by downstream receivers to enhance security. 6.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After basic functions of PIM-SM are configured, you can configure the lifetime of a multicast source and source address-based filtering rules as required. Applicable Environment All the configurations in this section are applicable to the ASM and SSM models. PIM switchs check the multicast data that passes by. By checking whether the data matches the filtering rule, the switchs determine whether to forward the data. That is, the switchs in the PIM domain function as filters. The filters help to control the data flow, and to limit the information that the downstream receiver can obtain. Switchs can work normally under the control of default values. The S9700 allows users to adjust the parameters as required. NOTE If there is no special requirement, default values are recommended. Pre-configuration Tasks Before adjusting control parameters for a multicast source, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a certain unicast routing protocol l Configuring Basic PIM-SM Functions Data Preparation To adjust control parameters for a multicast source, you need the following data. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 155 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration No. Data 1 Lifetime of a multicast source 2 Filtering rules based on multicast source addresses 6.4.2 Configuring the Lifetime of a Source A multicast device starts a timer for each (S, G) entry. If the multicast device does not receive any multicast packets from a multicast source within the set lifetime of the multicast source, it considers that the (S, G) entry becomes invalid and the multicast source stops sending multicast data to the multicast group. Context Do as follows on the switch: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. Step 3 Run: source-lifetime interval The lifetime of a source is configured. If the lifetime of the source expires, the (S, G) entry becomes invalid. ----End 6.4.3 Configuring Filtering Rules Based on Source Addresses After ACL rules are configured, a multicast device can filter the received multicast packets based on source addresses or source/group addresses. Context Do as follows on the switch: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 156 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration Step 2 Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. Step 3 Run: source-policy { acl-number | acl-name acl-name } A filter is configured. If the basic ACL is configured, only the packets with the source addresses that pass the filtering are forwarded. If the advanced ACL is configured, only the packets with the source addresses and group addresses that pass the filtering are forwarded. NOTE l If acl-number | acl-name acl-name is specified in the source-policy command, the multicast packets with the specified source address or source and group addresses are forwarded. l If acl-number | acl-name acl-name is specified in the source-policy command and no ACL rule is created, the multicast packets with any source addresses are not forwarded. l The source-policy command does not filter the static (S, G) entries and the PIM entries of the Join messages received from private networks. ----End 6.4.4 Checking the Configuration After the control parameters of a multicast source are adjusted, you can run commands to check entries in the PIM routing table. Procedure l Run the following commands to check the PIM routing table. – display pim { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table [ groupaddress [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { sourcemask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interfacenumber | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | groupmask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpninstance-name | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table brief [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } ] * ----End Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 157 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration 6.5 Adjusting Control Parameters of the C-RP and C-BSR If a dynamic RP is used, you can adjust parameters of C-RPs and C-BSR as required. If there is no special requirement, default values are recommended. 6.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task If dynamic RP is used, after basic functions of PIM-SM are configured, you can adjust parameters of the C-RP and C-BSR, configure a BSR boundary, and set valid address ranges for BSRs and C-RPs. Applicable Environment This section describes how to adjust control parameters of the C-RP and the C-BSR by using commands in the ASM model. NOTE The configuration is applicable only to a BSR-RP. If you want to use only a static RP in the network, skip the configuration. The switch can work properly by using default values of control parameters. The S9700 allows users to adjust parameters. NOTE Default values are recommended. Pre-configuration Tasks Before adjusting control parameters of the C-RP and C-BSR, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol l Configuring Basic PIM-SM Functions Data Preparation To adjust various control parameters of the C-RP and C-BSR, you need the following data. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) No. Data 1 C-RP priority 2 Interval for a C-RP to send Advertisement messages 3 Timeout of the period during which a BSR waits to receive Advertisement messages from a C-RP 4 Hash mask length of a C-BSR 5 Priority of a C-BSR 6 Interval for a C-BSR to send Bootstrap messages 7 Time of holding the Bootstrap message received from a BSR Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 158 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration No. Data 8 ACL defining the valid BSR address scope 6.5.2 Adjusting C-RP Parameters C-RPs periodically send Advertisement messages to a BSR. The Advertisement messages carry C-RP priorities. You can adjust the C-RP priority, the interval for sending Advertisement messages, and the holdtime of Advertisement messages on a device configured with the C-RP. Context Do as follows on the switch configured with the C-RP: NOTE You can re-set various parameters of a C-RP. This configuration is optional. If there is no specific requirement, default values of parameters are recommended. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. Step 3 Run: c-rp priority priority The C-RP priority is set. Step 4 Run: c-rp advertisement-interval interval The interval during which the C-RP sends Advertisement messages is set. Step 5 Run: c-rp holdtime interval The time for holding the Advertisement message from a C-RP is set. The value must be greater than the interval for a C-RP to send advertisement messages. The C-RP periodically sends advertisement messages to the BSR. After receiving the advertisement messages, the BSR obtains the Holdtime of the C-RP from the message. During the Holdtime, the C-RP is valid. When the Holdtime expires, the C-RP ages out. ----End 6.5.3 Adjusting C-BSR Parameters At first, each C-BSR considers itself as a BSR and sends Bootstrap messages to all devices in the network. You can adjust the hash mask length of the C-BSR carried in a Bootstrap message, Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 159 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration the C-BSR priority, the interval for sending Bootstrap messages, and the holdtime of Bootstrap messages on a device configured with the C-BSR. Context Do as follows on the switch configured with the C-BSR: NOTE You can re-set various parameters of a C-BSR. This configuration is optional. If there is no specific requirement, the default values of parameters are recommended. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. Step 3 Run: c-bsr hash-length hash-length The hash mask length of a C-BSR is set. Step 4 Run: c-bsr priority priority The priority of the C-BSR is set. Step 5 Run: c-bsr interval interval The interval for the BSR to send Bootstrap messages is set. Step 6 Run: c-bsr holdtime interval The time of holding the Bootstrap message received from a BSR is set. The BSR periodically sends a Bootstrap message to the network. After receiving the Bootstrap message, the switchs keep the message for a certain time. During the period, the BSR election stops temporarily. If the Holdtime timer times out, a new round of BSR election is triggered among C-BSRs. NOTE Ensure that the value of c-bsr holdtime is greater than the value of c-bsr interval. Otherwise, the winner of BSR election cannot be fixed. ----End 6.5.4 Configuring the BSR Boundary A BSR boundary can be configured on an interface. Bootstrap messages cannot pass the BSR boundary. Multiple BSR boundary interfaces divide the network into different PIM-SM domains. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 160 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration Context Do as follows on the switch that may become the BSR boundary: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface. Step 3 Run: pim bsr-boundary The BSR boundary is configured. Bootstrap messages cannot pass the BSR boundary. By default, all the PIM-SM switchs on the network can receive Bootstrap messages. ----End 6.5.5 (Optional) Configuring the BSR Address Range ACL-based policies can be set on all devices to filter C-BSR addresses. The devices then receive only the Bootstrap messages with the source addresses being in the valid C-BSR address range. Thus, BSR spoofing is avoided. Context Do as follows on all switches in the PIM-SM domain: NOTE By default, all BSR packets are received without the BSR source address check. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. Step 3 Run: bsr-policy { basic-acl-number | acl-name acl-name } The legal range of BSR addresses is set. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 161 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration After receiving a BSR message, the switch checks the source address of the message. If the source address is not within the range of legal addresses, the message is discarded. BSR spoofing is thus prevented. { basic-acl-number | acl-name acl-name } specifies the basic ACL. The ACL defines the filtering policy for the source address range of the BSR messages. ----End 6.5.6 (Optional) Configuring the Range of Valid C-RP Addresses ACL-based policies can be set on all C-BSRs to filter C-RP addresses and addresses of the groups that the C-RPs serve. The BSR adds C-RP information to the RP-set only when the addresses are in the set legal address range. Thus, C-RP spoofing is avoided. Context Do as follows on all the C-BSRs in the PIM-SM domain: NOTE This configuration is optional. By default, a switch does not check the C-RP address and the group address contained in a received Advertisement message and adds them to the RP-set. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. Step 3 Run: crp-policy { advanced-acl-number | acl-name acl-name } The range of the valid C-RP addresses and the range of the multicast group addresses that a switch serves are specified. When receiving an Advertisement message, the switch checks the C-RP address and the addresses of the groups that the C-RP serves in the message. The C-RP address and the addresses of the groups that the C-RP serves are added to the RP-Set only when they are in the valid address range. The C-RP spoofing can thus be prevented. { advanced-acl-number | acl-name acl-name }: specifies the advanced ACL. The ACL defines the filtering policy for the C-RP address range and the address range of the groups that a C-RP serves. ----End 6.5.7 Checking the Configuration After the control parameters of C-RPs and C-BSRs are adjusted, you can check information about the BSR and RP and check whether a BSR boundary is configured on the interface through commands. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 162 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration Procedure l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] bsr-info command to check the BSR in a PIM-SM domain. l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] rp-info [ groupaddress ] command to check the RP in a PIM-SM domain. ----End 6.6 Configuring a BSR Administrative Domain A PIM-SM network can be divided into multiple BSR administrative domains and a global domain. This effectively reduces the load of a single BSR, and provides a special service for specific multicast groups. 6.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After dynamic RP and basic PIM-SM functions are configured, you can configure BSR administrative domains as required. Each BSR administrative domain maintains a BSR and provides services for the multicast groups within a specific address range. Multicast groups that do not belong to any BSR administrative domain are served by the global domain. Applicable Environment This section describes how to configure a BSR administrative domain in the ASM model through commands. In the traditional mode, a PIM-SM network maintains only one BSR and all multicast groups in the network are in the administrative range of the BSR. To better manage the domains, the PIMSM network is divided into multiple BSR administrative domains. Each BSR administrative domain maintains only one BSR that serves specified multicast groups. BSR administrative domains are geographically isolated. Multicast packets of a BSR administrative domain cannot pass the border of the domain. The address of a multicast group served by a BSR administrative domain is valid only in the BSR administrative domain. The addresses of multicast groups served by different BSR administrative domains can be identical and these addresses are equal to private multicast group addresses. Multicast groups that do not belong to any BSR administrative domain are served by the global domain. Global domain maintains only one BSR that serves the remaining multicast groups. Dividing a PIM-SM network into multiple BSR administrative domains and a global domain effectively reduces the load of a single BSR, and provides a special service for specific multicast groups. The switch can work normally under the control of default values. The S9700 allows users to adjust the parameters. NOTE Default values are recommended. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring a BSR administrative domain, complete the following tasks: Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 163 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration l Configuring a unicast routing protocol l Configuring Basic PIM-SM Functions Data Preparation To configure a BSR administrative domain, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Priority and hash mask length for electing a BSR in a BSR domain 2 Priority and hash mask length of electing the global domain BSR 6.6.2 Enabling a BSR Administrative Domain Enable BSR administrative domains on all devices in a PIM-SM network. Context Do as follows on all switchs in the PIM-SM network: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. Step 3 Run: c-bsr admin-scope The division of BSR administrative domains is enabled in a PIM-SM network. ----End 6.6.3 Configuring the Boundary of a BSR Administrative Domain After an interface is configured as a BSR administrative domain boundary, all the multicast packets for the groups in this BSR administrative domain cannot pass this interface. Context Do as follows on all switchs at the boundary of a BSR administrative domain: NOTE The switchs outside the BSR administrative domain cannot forward the multicast packets of the BSR administrative domain. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 164 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface. Step 3 Run: multicast boundary group-address { mask | mask-length } The BSR administrative domain boundary is configured. Multicast packets that belong to the BSR administrative domain cannot traverse the boundary. ----End 6.6.4 Adjusting C-BSR Parameters You can adjust the C-BSR parameters of the BSR administrative domain and the global domain as required. Context Do as follows on all C-BSRs: NOTE The C-BSR configuration involves three cases: l Global configuration: For global configuration, see Adjusting Control Parameters of the C-RP and C-BSR. It is valid in the global domain and each BSR administrative domain. l Configuration in a BSR administrative domain: Because the configuration in a BSR administrative domain takes precedence over the global configuration, the global configuration is used when the configuration in a BSR administrative domain is not done. l Configuration in the global domain: Because the configuration in the global domain takes precedence over the global configuration, the global configuration is used when the configuration in the global domain is not done. Procedure l Configuration in a BSR Administrative Domain 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. 3. Run: c-bsr group group-address { mask | mask-length } [ hash-length hashlength | priority priority ] * Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 165 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration The C-BSR parameters are configured. – group-address { mask | mask-length }: specifies the range of the multicast groups served by a C-BSR. Group addresses in the 239.0.0.0/8 are valid group addresses. – hash-length hash-length: specifies the hash mask length of a C-BSR. – priority priority: specifies the priority of a C-BSR. l Configuration in the Global Domain 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. 3. Run: c-bsr global [ hash-length hash-length | priority priority ] * The C-BSR parameters are configured. – hash-length hash-length: specifies the hash mask length of a C-BSR. – priority priority: specifies the priority of a C-BSR. ----End 6.6.5 Checking the Configuration After a BSR administrative domain is configured, you can run commands to view configurations about the BSR and RP. Procedure l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] bsr-info command to check the BSR in a PIM-SM domain. l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] rp-info [ groupaddress ] command to check the RP in a PIM-SM domain. ----End 6.7 Adjusting Control Parameters for Establishing the Neighbor Relationship Multicast devices establish PIM neighbor relationships and negotiate various control parameters by exchanging Hello messages. You can adjust the parameters carried in Hello messages as required. If there is no special requirement, adopt default values. 6.7.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After basic functions of PIM-SM are configured, you can adjust related parameters of Hello messages for controlling neighbor relationships, and configure the downstream neighbor tracking function and the neighbor filtering function. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 166 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration Applicable Environment The configuration in this section is applicable to both the ASM model and the SSM model. The PIM switchs send Hello messages to each other to establish the neighbor relationship, negotiate the control parameters, and elect a DR. The switch can work normally by default. The S9700 allows the users to adjust the parameters as required. NOTE It is recommended to adopt the default value if there is no special requirement. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring control parameters for establishing the neighbor relationship, complete the following tasks: l Configuring unicast routing protocol l Configuring Basic PIM-SM Functions Data Preparation To adjust the control parameters for establishing the neighbor relationship, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Priority of the DR that is elected 2 Timeout period for waiting for Hello messages from a neighbor 3 Interval for sending Hello messages 4 Maximum delay for triggering Hello messages 5 DR switchover delay, that is, the period during which the original entries are still valid when the interface changes from a DR to a non-DR. 6 Number or name of the ACL used to filter PIM neighbors 6.7.2 Configuring Control Parameters for Establishing the Neighbor Relationship Control Parameters for Establishing the Neighbor Relationship can be configured either globally or on an interface. The configuration in the interface view is prior to the configuration in the PIM view. When the interval is not configured in the interface view, the configuration in the PIM view takes effect. Context Do as follows on the PIM-SM switch. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 167 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration NOTE The configuration involves the following cases: l Global configuration: It is valid on all the interfaces. l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used. Procedure l Global Configuration 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. 3. Run: timer hello interval The interval for sending Hello messages is set. 4. Run: hello-option holdtime interval The timeout period of holding the reachable state of a neighbor is set. If no Hello message is received after the interval expires, the neighbor is considered unreachable. l Configuration on an Interface 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IP-Trunk interface. 3. Run: pim timer hello interval The interval for sending Hello messages is set. 4. Run: pim triggered-hello-delay interval The maximum delay for triggering Hello messages is set. This can prevent the conflict of Hello messages sent by multiple PIM switchs at the same time. 5. Run: pim hello-option holdtime interval The timeout period of holding the reachable state of a neighbor is set. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 168 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration If no Hello message is received after the interval expires, the neighbor is considered unreachable. 6. Run: pim require-genid The Generation ID option is contained in a received Hello message. The Hello message without the Generation ID option is rejected. By default, the switch handles the Hello message without the Generation option. ----End 6.7.3 Configuring Control Parameters for Electing a DR The control parameters for electing a DR can be set either globally or on an interface. Context Do as follows on the PIM-SM switch: NOTE The configuration involves the following cases: l Global configuration: It is valid on all the interfaces. l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used. Procedure l Global Configuration 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. 3. Run: hello-option dr-priority priority The DR priority is set. On a shared network segment where all PIM switchs support the DR priority, the interface with the highest priority acts as the DR. In the case of the same priority, the interface with the largest IP address acts as the DR. If a minimum of one PIM switch does not support the DR priority, the interface with the largest IP address acts as the DR. l Configuration on an Interface 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: interface interface-type interface-number Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 169 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration The interface view is displayed. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IP-Trunk interface. 3. Run: pim hello-option dr-priority priority The DR priority is set. On a shared network segment where all PIM switchs support the DR priority, the interface with the highest priority acts as the DR. In the case of the same priority, the interface with the largest IP address acts as the DR. If a minimum of one PIM switch does not support the DR priority, the interface with the largest IP address acts as the DR. 4. Run: pim timer dr-switch-delay interval The DR switchover delay is configured and the delay is specified. When an interface changes from a DR to a non-DR, the original entries are valid till the delay expires. By default, once an interface changes from a DR to a non-DR, the original entries are deleted immediately. ----End 6.7.4 Enabling the Function of Tracking a Downstream Neighbor When the Generation ID option in the Hello message received from an upstream neighbor changes, it indicates that the status of the upstream neighbor changes. Therefore, you can configure a PIM interface to deny the Hello messages without Generation ID options to obtain the upstream neighbor status in real time. Context Do as follows on the PIM-SM switch: NOTE The configuration involves the following cases: l Global configuration: It is valid on all the interfaces. l Configuration on the interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used. Procedure l Global configuration 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 170 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 3. 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration Run: hello-option neighbor-tracking The function of tracking a downstream neighbor is enabled. After this function is enabled, information about the downstream neighbor who has sent a Join message and whose Join state does not times out is recorded. NOTE The function of tracking downstream neighbors cannot be implemented unless all the PIM switchs in the shared network segment are enabled with this function. l Configuration on an interface 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IP-Trunk interface. 3. Run: pim hello-option neighbor-tracking The function of tracking a downstream neighbor is enabled. After this function is enabled, information about the downstream neighbor who has sent a Join message and whose Join state does not times out is recorded. NOTE The function of tracking downstream neighbors cannot be implemented unless all PIM switchs in the shared network segment are enabled with this function. ----End 6.7.5 Configuring PIM Neighbor Filtering To prevent some unknown devices from being involved in PIM, filtering PIM neighbors is required. An interface sets up neighbor relationships with only the addresses matching the filtering rules and deletes the neighbors unmatched with the filtering rules. Context To prevent some switches from establishing unauthorized neighbor relationships through the PIM protocol, configure the local device to filter PIM neighbors. Do as follows on the switch enabled with PIM-SM: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 171 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface. Step 3 Run: pim neighbor-policy { basic-acl-number | acl-name acl-name } PIM neighbor filtering is configured. An interface sets up neighbor relationships with only the addresses matching the filtering rules and deletes the neighbors unmatching the filtering rules. NOTE When configuring the neighbor filtering function on the interface, you must also configure the neighbor filtering function correspondingly on the switch that sets up the neighbor relationship with the interface. ----End 6.7.6 Checking the Configuration After the neighbor control parameters are adjusted, you can run commands to check information about the PIM interface and the PIM neighbor. Procedure l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check PIM on an interface. l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] neighbor [ neighbor-address | interface interface-type interface-number | verbose ] * command to check a PIM neighbor. ----End 6.8 Adjusting Control Parameters for Source Registering In a PIM-SM network, the DR directly connected to the multicast source encapsulates multicast data in a Register message and sends it to the RP in unicast mode. The RP then decapsulates the message, and forwards the multicast data to receivers along the RPT. The system supports the Register message filtering and suppression functions. 6.8.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After basic functions of PIM-SM are configured, you can configure filtering policies and the checksum method for Register messages and configure PIM-SM Register suppression as required. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 172 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration Applicable Environment This section describes how to configure the control parameters of the source registering through commands. In a PIM-SM network, the DR directly connected to the source S encapsulates multicast data in a Register message and sends it to the RP in unicast mode. The RP then decapsulates the message, and forwards it along the RPT. After the SPT switchover on the RP is complete, the multicast data reaches the RP along the SPT tree in the multicast mode. The RP sends a Register-stop message to the DR at the source side. The DR stops sending Register messages and enters the suppressed state. During the register suppression, the DR periodically sends null-register packets to inform that the source is still in the active state. After the timeout of the register suppression, the DR starts to send Register message again. The switch can work normally under the control of default values. The S9700 allows the users to adjust the parameters as required. NOTE It is recommended to adopt default values if there is no special requirement. Pre-configuration Tasks Before adjusting control parameters for source registering, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol l Configuring Basic PIM-SM Functions Data Preparation To adjust control parameters for source registering, you need the following data. No. Data 1 ACL rules used by the RP to filter Register messages 2 Whether the checksum is calculated only according to the header of a Register message 3 Timeout for keeping the suppressed state of registering 4 Interval for sending null Register messages to the RP 6.8.2 Configuring PIM-SM Register Messages You can configure filtering policies for Register messages on all the devices that may become RPs. By default, the checksum is calculated based on the entire Register message. You can configure the device to calculate the checksum based on only the header of a Register message. Context Do as follows on all switchs that may become an RP: Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 173 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. Step 3 Run: register-policy { advanced-acl-number | acl-name acl-name } The policy for filtering Register messages is set. The RP applies the policy to filter received Register messages. Step 4 Run: register-header-checksum The checksum is calculated only according to the header of a Register message. By default, the checksum is calculated according to the entire message. ----End 6.8.3 Configuring PIM-SM Register Suppression You can set the timeout period for keeping the register suppression state and the interval for sending null Register messages on all the devices that may becomes DRs at the multicast source side. Context Do as follows on all the switchs that may become the DR at the multicast source side: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. Step 3 Run: register-suppression-timeout interval The timeout for keeping the suppressed state of registering is set. Step 4 Run: probe-interval interval The interval for sending null Register messages is set. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 174 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration NOTE The probe-interval value must be smaller than half of register-suppression-timeout value. ----End 6.8.4 Checking the Configuration After control parameters for source registering are adjusted, you can run the corresponding command to check information about the PIM interface. Procedure l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check PIM on an interface. ----End 6.9 Adjusting Control Parameters for Forwarding A multicast device sends Join messages upstream to require to forward multicast data and Prune messages upstream for requiring to stop forwarding multicast data. You can adjust control parameters for multicast data forwarding as required. If there is no special requirement, adopt default values. 6.9.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After basic functions of PIM-SM are configured, you can adjust related control parameters of forwarding relationship maintenance, and configure the Join information filtering and neighbor checking functions to enhance security as required. Applicable Environment The configurations in this section are applicable to the ASM model and the SSM model. When the first member of a group appears in the network segment, the switch sends a Join message through an upstream interface, requiring the upstream switch to forward packets to the network segment. When the last member of the group leaves, the switch sends a Prune message through an upstream interface, requiring the upstream switch to perform the Prune action and to stop forwarding packets to this network segment. If other downstream switchs in this network segment still want to receive data of this group, they must send a Join message to override the Prune action. In the ASM model, a switch periodically sends Join messages to the RP to prevent RPT branches from being deleted due to timeout. The switch can work normally under the control of default values. The S9700 allows users to adjust the parameters as required. NOTE It is recommended to adopt default values if there is no special requirement. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 175 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration Pre-configuration Tasks Before adjusting control parameters for forwarding, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a certain unicast routing protocol l Configuring Basic PIM-SM Functions Data Preparation To adjust control parameters for forwarding, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Interval for sending Join/Prune messages 2 Interval for holding the Join/Prune state 3 Delay for transmitting Prune messages 4 Period of overriding the Prune action 5 Number or name of the ACL used to filter join information in the Join/Prune messages 6 Whether neighbor check needs to be performed after Join/Prune message and Assert messages are sent or received 6.9.2 Configuring Control Parameters for Keeping the Forwarding State The control parameters of multicast data forwarding can be set either globally or on an interface. The parameters specify the interval for sending Join/Prune messages and the period for a downstream interface to keep the Join/Prune state. Context Do as follows on the PIM-SM switch: NOTE The configuration involves the following cases: l Global configuration: It is valid on all the interfaces. l Configuration on the interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used. Procedure l Global Configuration 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 176 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration The PIM view is displayed. 3. Run: timer join-prune interval The interval for sending Join/Prune messages is set. 4. Run: holdtime join-prune interval The interval for holding the Join/Prune state of a downstream interface is set. l Configuration on an Interface 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IP-Trunk interface. 3. Run: pim timer join-prune interval The interval for sending Join/Prune messages is set. 4. Run: pim holdtime join-prune interval The interval for holding the Join/Prune state of a downstream interface is set. 5. Run: pim require-genid The Generation ID option is contained in a received Hello message. The Hello message without the Generation ID option is rejected. By default, the switch handles the Hello message without the Generation option. The change of the Generation ID in the Hello message received from an upstream neighbor indicates that the upstream neighbor is lost or the status of the upstream neighbor has changed. The switch immediately sends the Join/Prune message to the upstream switch to refresh the status. ----End 6.9.3 Configuring Control Parameters for Prune The control parameters for prune can be set either globally or on an interface. The parameters specify the delay for transmitting messages in a LAN and the interval for overriding the Prune action. Context Do as follows on the PIM-SM switch: Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 177 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration NOTE The configuration involves the following cases: l Global Configuration: It is valid on all the interfaces. l Configuration on the interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used. Procedure l Global Configuration 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. 3. Run: hello-option lan-delay interval The delay for transmitting messages in a LAN is set. A Hello message carries lan-delay and override-interval . PPT indicates the delay from the time when a switch receives the Prune message from a downstream interface to the time when the switch performs the prune action to suppress the forwarding of the downstream interface. The PPT is obtained by the lan-delay plus override-interval. If the switch receives a Join message from a downstream switch within the PPT, the switch does not perform the prune action. 4. Run: hello-option override-interval interval The interval for overriding the Prune action is set. When a switch sends a Prune message to the upstream switch in the same network segament, if other switch still requests the multicast data, it needs to send a Join message to the upstream switch in the override-interval period. l Configuration on an Interface 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IP-Trunk interface. 3. Run: pim hello-option lan-delay interval The delay for transmitting messages in a LAN is set. 4. Run: pim hello-option override-interval interval Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 178 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration The interval for overriding the Prune action is set. ----End 6.9.4 Configuring Join Information Filtering A Join/Prune message received by an interface may contain both join information and prune information. You can configure the interface to filter join information based on ACL rules. The device then creates PIM entries for only the join information matching ACL rules. Context A Join/Prune message received by an interface may contain both join information and prune information. You can configure the switch to filter join information based on ACL rules. The switch then creates PIM entries for only the join information matching ACL rules, which can avoid access of illegal users. Do as follows on the switch enabled with PIM-SM: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface. Step 3 Run: pim join-policy { asm { basic-acl-number | acl-name acl-name } | ssm { advanced-aclnumber | acl-name acl-name } | advanced-acl-number | acl-name acl-name } Join information filtering is configured. ----End 6.9.5 (Optional) Configuring Parameters for Join/Prune Messages The parameters such as the maximum message size and number of (S, G) entries, and the message package function can be configured for PIM Join/Prune messages. Context Perform the following steps on the PIM-SM-enabled switch: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 179 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. Step 3 Run: join-prune max-packet-length packet-length The maximum size of each PIM-SM Join/Prune message to be sent is configured. The default size is 8100 bytes. Step 4 Run: join-prune periodic-messages queue-size queue-size The maximum number of entries carried in a PIM-SM Join/Prune message that is sent every second is configured. The default value is 1020. Step 5 Run: join-prune triggered-message-pack disable The function to package Join/Prune messages in real time is disabled. This function is enabled by default. ----End 6.9.6 Configuring Neighbor Check If PIM neighbor check is enabled, a device checks whether the Join/Prune and Assert messages are sent to or received from PIM neighbors. If not, the device drops the messages. Context By default, checking whether the Join/Prune message and Assert messages are sent to or received from a PIM neighbor is not enabled. If PIM neighbor checking is required, it is recommended to configure the neighbor checking function on the devices connected with user devices rather than on the internal devices of the network. Then, the switch checks whether the Join/Prune and Assert messages are sent to or received from a PIM neighbor. If not, the switch drops the messages. Do as follows on the switch enabled with PIM-SM: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 180 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration Step 3 Run: neighbor-check { receive | send } The neighbor check function is configured. You can specify both receive and send to enable the PIM neighbor check function for the received and sent Join/Prune and Assert messages. ----End 6.9.7 Checking the Configuration After control parameters for multicast data forwarding are adjusted, you can check information about the PIM interface and the PIM routing table and statistics about PIM control messages through commands. Procedure l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check PIM on an interface. l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] control-message counters [ message-type { crp | probe | register | register-stop | assert | graft | graftack | hello | join-prune | state-refresh | bsr } | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * command to check the number of sent or received PIM control messages. l Run the following commands to check the PIM routing table. – display pim { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table [ groupaddress [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { sourcemask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interfacenumber | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | groupmask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpninstance-name | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table brief [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } ] * ----End 6.10 Adjusting Control Parameters for Assert If a multicast device can receive multicast data through the downstream interface, this indicates that other upstream devices exist in this network segment. The device then sends an Assert message through the downstream interface to take part in the election of the unique upstream device. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 181 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration 6.10.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After basic functions of PIM-SM are configured, you can set the period for holding the Assert state as required. Applicable Environment The configurations in this section ares applicable to the ASM model and the SSM model. If a PIM-SM switch receives multicast data through a downstream interface, it indicates that other upstream switchs exist in this network segment. switchs send Assert messages to elect the unique upstream switch. The switch can work normally under the control of default values. The S9700 allows users to adjust the parameters as required. NOTE It is recommended to adopt default values if there is no special requirement. Pre-configuration Tasks Before adjusting control parameters for assert, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a certain unicast routing protocol l Configuring Basic PIM-SM Functions Data Preparation To adjust control parameters for assert, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Period for holding the Assert state 6.10.2 Configuring the Period for Keeping the Assert State The device that fails in the election prevents its downstream interface from forwarding multicast data during the Assert state. After the holdtime of the Assert state expires, the downstream interface can forward multicast data. Context Do as follows on all the switchs in the PIM-SM domain: NOTE The configuration involves the following cases: l Global configuration: It is valid on all the interfaces. l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 182 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration Procedure l Global Configuration 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. 3. Run: holdtime assert interval The period for holding the Assert state is set. The switch that fails in the election prevents the downstream interface from forwarding multicast packets within the interval. After the interval expires, the downstream interface starts to forward multicast packets. l Configuration on the Interface 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IP-Trunk interface. 3. Run: pim holdtime assert interval The period for holding the Assert state is configured. The switch that fails in the election prohibits the downstream interface from forwarding multicast packets within this interval. After the interval expires, the downstream interface starts to forward multicast packets. ----End 6.10.3 Checking the Configuration After the control parameters for assert are adjusted, you can check information about the PIM interface and the PIM routing table and statistics about PIM control messages through commands. Procedure l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check PIM on an interface. l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] control-message counters [ message-type { crp | probe | register | register-stop | assert | graft | graft- Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 183 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration ack | hello | join-prune | state-refresh | bsr } | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * command to check the number of sent or received PIM control messages. l Run the following commands to check the PIM routing table. – display pim { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table [ groupaddress [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { sourcemask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interfacenumber | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | groupmask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpninstance-name | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table brief [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } ] * ----End 6.11 Configuring the SPT Switchover A high volume of multicast data traffic increases the load of an RP, and may result in a fault. To solve this problem, PIM-SM allows the RP or the DR at the group member side to trigger the SPT switchover when the rate of multicast packets is high. 6.11.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After basic functions of PIM-SM are configured, you can adjust control parameters for SPT switchover as required. Applicable Environment This section describes how to configure the control parameters of the SPT switchover through commands. In a PIM-SM network, each multicast group corresponds to an RPT. At first, all multicast sources encapsulate data in Register messages, and send them to the RP in the unicast mode. The RP decapsulates the messages and forwards them along the RPT. Forwarding multicast data by using the RPT has the following defects: l The DR at the source side and the RP need to encapsulate and decapsulate packets. l Forwarding path may not be the shortest path from the source to receivers. l Large-volume data flow increases the load of the RP, and may cause a fault. The solution to the preceding defects is that: Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 184 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration l SPT switchover triggered by the RP: The RP sends a Join message to the source, and establishes a multicast route along the shortest path from the source to the RP. The subsequent packets are forwarded along the path. l SPT switchover triggered by the DR at the member side: The DR at the member side checks the forwarding rate of multicast data. If the DR finds that the rate exceeds the threshold, the DR tiggers the SPT switchover immediately. The DR sends a Join message to the source, and establishes a multicast route along the shortest path from the source to the DR. The subsequent packets are forwarded along the path. Switchs can work normally under the control of default values. The S9700 allows users to adjust the parameters as required. NOTE It is recommended to adopt default values if there is no special requirement. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring the SPT switchover, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol l Configuring Basic PIM-SM Functions Data Preparation To configure the SPT switchover, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Rate threshold that the DR at the member side switches packets from the RPT to the SPT 2 Group filtering policy and sequence policy for the switchover from the RPT to the SPT 3 Interval for checking the rate threshold of multicast data before the RPT-to-SPT switchover 6.11.2 (Optional) Configuring the Interval for Checking the Forwarding Rate of Multicast Data You can configure conditions for the SPT switchover and set the interval for checking the forwarding rate of multicast data on the DR at the group member side. Context Do as follows on all the switchs that may become a DR at the member side: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 185 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. Step 3 Run: spt-switch-threshold { traffic-rate | infinity } [ group-policy { basic-acl-number | acl-name acl-name } [ order order-value ] ] The SPT switchover condition is set. l traffic-rate: specifies the rate threshold of the SPT switchover. l infinity: indicates that the SPT switchover is not triggered forever. l group-policy { basic-acl-number | acl-name acl-name } [ order order-value]: specifies the range of the multicast groups that use the threshold. By default, the threshold is applicable to all multicast groups. Step 4 Run: timer spt-switch interval The interval for checking the forwarding rate of multicast data is set. ----End 6.11.3 Checking the Configuration After the control parameters for SPT switchover are adjusted, you can run commands to check entries in the PIM routing table. Procedure l Run the following commands to check the PIM routing table. – display pim { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table [ groupaddress [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { sourcemask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interfacenumber | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | groupmask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpninstance-name | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table brief [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } ] * ----End Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 186 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration 6.12 Configuring PIM BFD After detecting a fault on the peer, BFD immediately notifies the PIM module to trigger a new DR election rather than waits until the neighbor relationship times out. This shortens the period during which multicast data transmission is discontinued and thus improves the reliability of multicast data transmission. 6.12.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After basic functions of PIM-SM are configured, you can configure PIM BFD to improve PIM network reliability, and adjust BFD parameters as required. Networking Requirements Generally, if the current DR in a shared network segment is faulty, other PIM neighbors triggers a new round of DR election only after the neighbor relationship times out. The duration that data transmission is interrupted is not shorter than the timeout period of the neighbor relationship. Generally, it is of second level. BFD features fast detection of faults, and is up to the millisecond level. BFD can detect statuses of PIM neighbors in the shared network segment. When BFD detects that a peer is faulty, BFD immediately reports it to PIM. PIM then triggers a new round of DR election without waiting for the timeout of the neighbor relationship. This shortens the duration of interruption of data transmission and enhances the reliability of the network. PIM BFD is also applicable to the assert election in a shared network segment. It can fast respond to the fault of the interface that wins the assert election. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring PIM BFD, complete the following task: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol l Configuring Basic PIM-SM Functions l Enabling BFD in the system view Data Preparation To configure PIM BFD, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Minimum intervals for sending and receiving BFD detection messages, and local detection multiple 6.12.2 Enabling PIM BFD Enable PIM BFD on the devices that set up a PIM neighbor relationship. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 187 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration Context Do as follows on PIM switchs that set up the neighbor relationship: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface must be a VLANIF interface. Step 3 Run: pim bfd enable PIM BFD is enabled. By default, PIM BFD is disabled. ----End 6.12.3 (Optional) Adjusting BFD Parameters You can adjust PIM BFD parameters as required. PIM BFD parameters include the minimum interval for sending and receiving PIM BFD packets and the local detection multiplier. Context Do as follows on two PIM switchs that set up the neighbor relationship: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed The interface must be a VLANIF interface. Step 3 Run: pim bfd { min-tx-interval tx-value | min-rx-interval rx-value | detect-multiplier multiplier-value }* PIM BFD parameters are adjusted. PIM BFD parameters include the minimum interval for sending PIM BFD messages, the minimum interval for receiving PIM BFD messages, and the local detection multiple. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 188 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration If this command is not used, the default values of these parameters are used. When the BFD parameters configured for other protocols are the same as those configured for PIM, the configurations of the PIM BFD parameters are affected. ----End 6.12.4 Checking the Configuration After PIM BFD is configured, you can run the command to check information about PIM BFD sessions. Procedure l Run the following commands to check information about a PIM BFD session. – display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] bfd session statistics – display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] bfd session [ interface interface-type interface-number | neighbor neighbor-address ] * ----End 6.13 Configuring PIM GR In a PIM-SM network, PIM GR can be applied to a device with dual main control boards to ensure normal multicast data forwarding during master-slave switchover. 6.13.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After basic functions of PIM-SM are configured, you can configure PIM GR to improve PIM network reliability. Applicable Environment In some multicast applications, the switch may need to perform active/standby switchover. After active/standby switchover, the new active main control board deletes the forwarding entries on the interface board and re-learns the PIM routing table and multicast routing table. During this process, multicast traffic is interrupted. In the PIM-SM/SSM network, PIM Graceful Restart (GR) can be applied to the switch with dual main control boards to ensure normal multicast traffic forwarding during active/standby switchover. The active main control board of the switch backs up PIM routing entries and Join/Prune information to be sent upstream to the standby main control board. The interface board maintains forwarding entries. Therefore, after active/standby switchover, the switch can actively and fast send Join messages upstream to maintain the Join state of the upstream. In addition, the PIM protocol sends Hello message carrying new Generation ID to all switchs enabled with PIM-SM. When the downstream switch finds that the Generation ID of its neighbor changes, it sends a Join/Prune message to the neighbor for re-creating routing entires, thereby ensuring non-stop forwarding of multicast data on the forwarding plane. If a dynamic RP is used on the network, after receiving a Hello message with the Generation ID being changed, the DR or candidate DR unicasts a BSM message to the switch performing active/ standby switchover and the switch learns and restores RP information based on the received BSM message. If the switch has not leant any RP information from the BSM messages, it obtains Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 189 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration the RP information from the Join/Prune message received from the downstream router and recreates multicast routing table. NOTE PIM GR is applicable to PIM-SM/SSM networks. Pre-configuration Tasks Before enabling PIM GR, complete the following task: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol and enabling unicast GR l Configuring Basic PIM-SM Functions Data Preparation To enable PIM GR, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Unicast GR period 2 PIM GR period 6.13.2 Enabling PIM GR After PIM GR is enabled on a device, you can set the PIM GR period as required. Context Do as follows on the switch enabled with PIM-SM: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. Step 3 Run: graceful-restart PIM GR is enabled. Step 4 (Optional) Run: graceful-restart period period The PIM GR period is set. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 190 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration By default, the PIM GR period is 120 seconds. ----End 6.13.3 Checking the Configuration After PIM GR is configured, you can run the command to check whether the PIM routing table is the same as that before master-slave switchover. Procedure Step 1 Run the following commands to check PIM routing table. l display pim { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table [ groupaddress [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { sourcemask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interfacenumber | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] * [ outgoinginterface-number [ number ] ] l display pim routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] l display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table brief [ groupaddress [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { sourcemask-length | source-mask } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } ] * ----End 6.14 Configuring PIM Silent The interface directly connecting a multicast device to a user host needs to be enabled with PIM. In this case, some malicious hosts may simulate a large number of PIM Hello messages and send the messages to the interface for processing. As a result, the multicast device is suspended. To avoid the preceding case, you can set the interface to be in the PIM Silent state. 6.14.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After basic functions of PIM-SM and IGMP are configured, you can configure the PIM silent function on the interface connected with the user host. This interface should be enabled with PIM-SM and IGMP first. Applicable Environment On the access layer, the interface directly connected to hosts needs to be enabled with PIM. You can establish the PIM neighbor relationship on the interface to process various PIM packets. The configuration, however, has potential risks of security. When a host maliciously generates PIM Hello packets and sends the packets in large quantity, the switch may fail. To solve the problem, set the status of the interface to PIM silent. When the interface is in PIM silent state, the interface is prevented from receiving and forwarding any PIM packet. All PIM Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 191 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration neighbors and PIM state machines on the interface are deleted. The interface acts as the static DR and immediately takes effect. At the same time, IGMP on the interface are not affected. PIM silent is applicable only to the interface directly connected to the host network segment that is connected only to this switch. CAUTION If PIM silent is enabled on the interface connected to a switch, the PIM neighbor relationship cannot be set up and a multicast fault may occur. If the host network segment is connected to multiple switchs and PIM silent is enabled on multiple interfaces, the interfaces become static DRs. Therefore, multiple DRs exist in this network segment, and a fault occurs. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring PIM silent, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol to make the network layer reachable l Configuring PIM-SM l Configuring IGMP Data Preparation To configure PIM silent, you need the following data. No. Data 1 The type and number of the interface connected to hosts 6.14.2 Configuring PIM Silent After the interface is configured with PIM silent, it is forbidden to receive or forward any PIM protocol packet. All PIM neighbors and PIM state machines on this interface are deleted. Then, this interface automatically becomes the DR. IGMP on the interface is not affected. Context Do as follows on the interface connected to the host network segment: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 192 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration The interface view is displayed. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface. Step 3 Run: pim silent PIM silent is enabled. After PIM silent is enabled, the Hello packet attack of malicious hosts is effectively prevented and the switch is protected. ----End 6.14.3 Checking the Configuration After PIM silent is configured, you can run the command to check information about the PIM interface. Prerequisites All the configurations of PIM silent are complete. Procedure l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check PIM on an interface. ----End Example Run the display pim interface verbose command, and you can find that the configuration is complete. <SwitchA> display pim interface verbose VPN-Instance: public net Interface: Vlanif10, 2.2.2.2 PIM version: 2 PIM mode: Sparse PIM state: up PIM DR: 2.2.2.2 (local) PIM DR Priority (configured): 1 PIM neighbor count: 0 PIM hello interval: 30 s PIM LAN delay (negotiated): 500 ms PIM LAN delay (configured): 500 ms PIM hello override interval (negotiated): 2500 ms PIM hello override interval (configured): 2500 ms PIM Silent: enabled PIM neighbor tracking (negotiated): disabled PIM neighbor tracking (configured): disabled PIM generation ID: 0X2649E5DA PIM require-genid: disabled PIM hello hold interval: 105 s PIM assert hold interval: 180 s PIM triggered hello delay: 5 s PIM J/P interval: 60 s PIM J/P hold interval: 210 s PIM BSR domain border: disabled PIM BFD: disabled Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 193 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration PIM dr-switch-delay timer : not configured Number of routers on link not using DR priority: 0 Number of routers on link not using LAN delay: 0 Number of routers on link not using neighbor tracking: 1 ACL of PIM neighbor policy: ACL of PIM ASM join policy: ACL of PIM SSM join policy: ACL of PIM join policy: - 6.15 Maintaining PIM-SM (IPv4) Maintaining PIM-SM involves resetting PIM statistics, and monitoring PIM running status. 6.15.1 Clearing Statistics of PIM Control Messages If you need to re-collect the statistics about PIM control messages, you can reset the existent statistics. Note that the statistics cannot be restored after you reset them. This operation does not affect normal running of PIM. Context CAUTION The statistics of PIM control messages on an interface cannot be restored after you clear it. So, confirm the action before you use the command. Procedure l Run the reset pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] control-message counters [ interface interface-type interface-number ] command in the user view to clear the statistics of PIM control messages on an interface. ----End 6.15.2 Clearing the PIM Status of the Specified Downstream Interfaces of PIM Entries You can clear the PIM Join/Prune state and Assert state on the specified downstream interface of a PIM entry. IGMP status and static multicast groups on this interface are not affected. Context CAUTION Clearing PIM status of the downstream interfaces may trigger the sending of corresponding Join/ Prune messages, which affects multicast services. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 194 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration Using the following command can clear join information about illegal users, and clear the PIM status of the specified interface in a specified entry, such as PIM Join/Prune status and Assert status. The command cannot be used to clear the IGMP or static group join status on a specified interface. Procedure Step 1 After confirming that PIM status of the specified downstream interfaces of the specified PIM entry need to be cleared, run the reset pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] routing-table group group-address mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } source source-address interface interface-type interface-number command in the user view. ----End 6.15.3 Monitoring the Running Status of PIM-SM During the routine maintenance, you can run the display commands in any view to know the running of PIM. Context In routine maintenance, you can run the following commands in any view to check the running status of PIM-SM. Procedure l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] claimed-route [ source-address ] command in any view to check the unicast routes used by PIM. l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] bfd session [ interface interface-type interface-number | neighbor neighbor-address ] * command in any view to check information about a PIM BFD session. l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] bsr-info command in any view to check information about the BSR in a PIM-SM domain. l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] control-message counters [ message-type { crp | probe | register | register-stop | assert | graft | graftack | hello | join-prune | state-refresh | bsr } | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * command in any view to check the number of sent or received PIM control messages. l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command in any view to check PIM on an interface. l Run the command display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] neighbor [ neighbor-address | interface interface-type interface-number | verbose ] * to check PIM neighbors. l Run the following commands in any view to check the PIM routing table. – display pim { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table [ groupaddress [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { sourcemask-length | source-mask } ] | extranet { source-vpn-instance { all | public | vpninstance-name } | receive-vpn-instance { all | vpn-instance-name } } | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register | mcast-extranet } | outgoing- Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 195 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] * [ outgoing-interfacenumber [ number ] ] – display pim routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | groupmask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | extranet { source-vpn-instance { all | public | vpn-instance-name } | receive-vpn-instance { all | vpn-instance-name } } | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register | mcast-extranet } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | register | none } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | flags flag-value | fsm ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table brief [ group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | group-mask } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | extranet { source-vpn-instance { all | public | vpn-instance-name } | receive-vpn-instance { all | vpn-instancename } } | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register | mcastextranet } ] * l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] rp-info [ groupaddress ] command in any view to check information about the RP to which a multicast group corresponds. l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] invalid-packet [ interface interface-type interface-number | message-type { assert | graft | graft-afk | state-refresh | bsr | hello | join-prune } ] * command in any view to check the statistics about invalid PIM messages received by a device. ----End 6.15.4 Debugging PIM When a fault occurs during the running of PIM, run the debugging commands in the user view and check the contents of sent and received packets for fault location. Context CAUTION Debugging affects the performance of the system. So, after debugging, execute the undo debugging all command to disable it immediately. When a PIM fault occurs, run the following debugging command in the user view to debug PIM and locate the fault. Procedure l Run the debugging pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] all command in the user view to enable all the debugging of PIM. l Run the debugging pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] event [ advanced-acl-number ] command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIM events. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 196 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration l Run the debugging pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routingtable [ advanced-acl-number ] command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIM routes. l Run the debugging pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] assert [ advanced-acl-number | [ receive | send ] ] * command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIM Assert. l Run the debugging pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] rp [ receive | send ] command in the user view to the debugging of PIM RP. l Run the debugging pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] register [ advanced-acl-number ] command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIM Register. l Run the debugging pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] msdp [ advanced-acl-number ] command in the user view to enable the debugging of the information exchanged between PIM and MSDP. l Run the debugging pim bfd { all | create | delete | event } command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIM BFD. ----End 6.16 Configuration Examples Configuration examples are provided to show how to construct a basic PIM-SM network and configure basic functions of PIM-SM. 6.16.1 Example for Configuring the PIM-SM Network Networking Requirements As shown in Figure 6-2, multicast is deployed on the network of an Internet Service Provider (ISP). The Interior Gateway Protocol (IGP) is deployed on the network. The unicast routing routes work normally and are connected to the Internet. The routers on the network need to be configured properly so that hosts can receive the video on demand (VOD) in multicast mode. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 197 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration Figure 6-2 Networking diagram for configuring PIM-SM multicast network Ethernet SwitchA GE3/0/0 Ethernet N1 Receiver GE2/0/0 GE1/0/0 PIM-SM SwitchE GE2/0/0 GE3/0/0 Source GE3/0/0 GE1/0/0 GE2/0/0 GE4/0/0 SwitchD GE1/0/0 GE4/0/0 GE1/0/0 GE2/0/0 GE1/0/0 SwitchC HostA Leaf networks GE2/0/0 Receiver SwitchB HostB N2 Ethernet Switch Physical interface VLANIF interface IP address SwitchA GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 100 192.168.9.1/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 101 10.110.1.1/24 GE 3/0/0 VLANIF 200 192.168.1.1/24 GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 300 192.168.2.1/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 102 10.110.2.1/24 GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 102 10.110.2.2/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 400 192.168.3.1/24 GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 500 192.168.4.2/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 200 192.168.1.2/24 GE 3/0/0 VLANIF 103 10.110.5.1/24 GE 4/0/0 VLANIF 104 10.110.4.1/24 GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 400 192.168.3.2/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 300 192.168.2.2/24 GE 3/0/0 VLANIF 100 192.168.9.2/24 GE 4/0/0 VLANIF 500 192.168.4.1/24 SwitchB SwitchC SwitchD SwitchE Configuration Roadmap The ISP network connects to the Internet. The PIM-SM protocol is used to configure the multicast function, which facilitates service expansion. The ASM and SSM models provide multicast services. The configuration roadmap is as follows: 1. Configure the IP addresses of interfaces and the unicast routing protocol. PIM is an intradomain multicast routing protocol that depends on a unicast routing protocol. The multicast routing protocol can work normally after the unicast routing protocol works normally. 2. Enable multicast on all Switches providing multicast services. Before configuring other PIM-SM functions, you must enable the multicast function. 3. Enable PIM-SM on all the interfaces of Switches. After PIM-SM is enabled, you can configure other PIM-SM functions. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 198 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration NOTE If IGMP is also required on this interface, PIM-SM must be enabled before IGMP is enabled. The configuration order cannot be reversed; otherwise, the configuration of PIM fails. 4. Enable IGMP on the interfaces of Switches connected to hosts. A receiver can join and leave a multicast group freely by sending an IGMP message. The leaf Switches maintain the multicast membership through IGMP. 5. Enable the PIM silent function on interface that is directly connected to hosts. In this manner, malicious hosts are prevented from simulating PIM Hello messages and security of multicast routers is ensured. NOTE PIM silent is applicable only to the interfaces of a Switch directly connected to the host network segment that is connected only to this Switch. 6. Configure the RP. The RP is a root node of an RPT on the PIM-SM network. It is recommended that you configure the RP on a device that has more multicast flows, for example, SwitchE in Figure 6-2. NOTE l After creating an (*, G) entry according to the new multicast membership, the DR on the user side sends Join/Prune messages towards the RP and updates the shared tree on the path. l When a multicast data source starts to send data to groups, the DR unicasts the Register message to the RP. After receiving the Register message, the RP decapsulates it and then forwards it to other multicast members along the shared tree. At the same time, the RP sends a Register-Stop message to the DR on the multicast source side. After the Register-Stop is performed, the RPT can be switched to the SPT. 7. (Optional) Set the BSR boundary on the interfaces connected to the Internet. The Bootstrap message cannot pass through the BSR boundary; therefore, the BSR serves only this PIMSM domain. In this manner, multicast services can be controlled effectively. 8. (Optional) Configure range of SSM group addresses on each Switch. Ensure that Switches in the PIM-SM domain provide services only for multicast groups in the range of SSM group addresses. In this manner, multicast can be controlled effectively. NOTE This configuration example describes only the commands used to configure PIM-SM. Data Preparation To complete the configuration, you need the following data: l Address of multicast group G: 225.1.1.1/24 l Address of multicast group S: 10.110.5.100/24 l Version of the IGMP protocol running between routers and hosts: IGMPv3 l Range of SSM group addresses: 232.1.1.0/24 Procedure Step 1 Configure the IP address of each interface and the unicast routing protocol. # Configure IP addresses and masks of interfaces on the Switches according to Figure 6-2. Configure OSPF between Switches to ensure that the Switches can communicate at the network layer and update routes through the unicast routing protocol. For details on how to configure IP addresses of interfaces, see IP Addresses Configuration in the S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - IP Service. For details on how to Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 199 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration configure OSPF, see OSPF Configuration in the S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - IP Routing. Step 2 Enable multicast on all Switches and PIM-SM on all interfaces. # Enable multicast on all the Switches and enable PIM-SM on all interfaces. The configurations of SwitchB, SwitchC, and SwitchD are similar to the configuration of SwitchA, and are not provided here. [SwitchA] multicast [SwitchA] interface [SwitchA-Vlanif101] [SwitchA-Vlanif101] [SwitchA] interface [SwitchA-Vlanif100] [SwitchA-Vlanif100] [SwitchA] interface [SwitchA-Vlanif200] [SwitchA-Vlanif200] routing-enable vlanif 101 pim sm quit vlanif 100 pim sm quit vlanif 200 pim sm quit Step 3 Enable IGMP on the interfaces connected to hosts. # Enable IGMP on the interface connecting SwitchA to hosts, and set the IGMP version to v3. The configurations of SwitchB, SwitchC, and SwitchD are similar to configuration of SwitchA, and are not provided here. [SwitchA] interface vlanif 101 [SwitchA-Vlanif101] igmp enable [SwitchA-Vlanif101] igmp version 3 Step 4 Enable PIM silent on SwitchA. [SwitchA] interface vlanif 101 [SwitchA-Vlanif101] pim silent Step 5 Configure the RP. NOTE The RP can be configured in two modes: the static RP and the dynamic RP. The static RP can be configured together with the dynamic RP. You can also configure only the static RP or the dynamic RP. When the static RP and the dynamic RP are configured simultaneously, you can change the parameter values to specify which RP is preferred. This example shows how to configure the static RP and the dynamic RP and to specify the dynamic RP as the preferred RP and the static RP as the standby RP. # Configure the dynamic RP on one or more Switches in the PIM-SM domain. In this example, set the service range of the RP and specify the locations of the C-BSR and the C-RP on SwitchE. [SwitchE] acl number 2008 [SwitchE-acl-basic-2008] rule permit source 225.1.1.0 0.0.0.255 [SwitchE-acl-basic-2008] quit [SwitchE] pim [SwitchE-pim] c-bsr vlanif 100 [SwitchE-pim] c-rp vlanif 100 group-policy 2008 # Configure static RPs on all Switches. The configurations of SwitchB, SwitchC, SwitchD, and SwitchE are similar to configuration on SwitchA, and are not provided here. NOTE If you enter preferred to the right of static-rp X.X.X.X, the static RP is selected as the RP in the PIM-SM domain. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 200 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration [SwitchA] pim [SwitchA-pim] static-rp 192.168.2.2 Step 6 Configure the BSR boundary on the interface connecting SwitchD to the Internet. [SwitchD] interface vlanif 104 [SwitchD-Vlanif104] pim bsr-boundary [SwitchD-Vlanif104] quit Step 7 Configure the range of SSM group addresses. # Set the range of SSM group addresses to 232.1.1.0/24 on all Switches. The configurations of SwitchB, SwitchC, SwitchD, and SwitchE are the same as the configuration of SwitchA, and are not provided here. [SwitchA] acl number 2000 [SwitchA-acl-basic-2000] rule permit source 232.1.1.0 0.0.0.255 [SwitchA-acl-basic-2000] quit [SwitchA] pim [SwitchA-pim] ssm-policy 2000 Step 8 Verify the configuration. # Run the display pim interface command. You can view the configuration and running status of PIM on the interface. For example, the PIM information displayed on SwitchC is as follows: <SwitchC> display pim interface VPN-Instance: public net Interface State NbrCnt HelloInt Vlanif102 up 0 30 Vlanif400 up 1 30 DR-Pri 1 1 DR-Address 10.110.2.2 192.168.3.1 (local) (local) # Run the display pim bsr-info command to view information about BSR election on the Switches. For example, the BSR information on SwitchA and SwitchE (including the C-BSR information on SwitchE) is as follows: <SwitchA> display pim bsr-info VPN-Instance: public net Elected AdminScoped BSR Count: 0 Elected BSR Address: 192.168.9.2 Priority: 0 Hash mask length: 30 State: Accept Preferred Scope: Not scoped Uptime: 01:40:40 Expires: 00:01:42 C-RP Count: 1 <SwitchE> display pim bsr-info VPN-Instance: public net Elected AdminScoped BSR Count: 0 Elected BSR Address: 192.168.9.2 Priority: 0 Mask length: 30 State: Elected Scope: Not scoped Uptime: 00:00:18 Next BSR message scheduled at :00:01:42 C-RP Count: 1 Candidate AdminScoped BSR Count: 0 Candidate BSR Address is: 192.168.9.2 Priority: 0 Hash mask length: 30 State:Elected Scope: Not scoped Wait to be BSR: 0 # Run the display pim rp-info command to view the RP information on the Switches. For example, the RP information displayed on SwitchA is as follows: Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 201 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration <SwitchA> display pim rp-info VPN-Instance: public net PIM-SM BSR RP Number:1 Group/MaskLen: 225.1.1.0/24 RP: 192.168.9.2 Priority: 0 Uptime: 00:45:13 Expires: 00:02:17 PIM SM static RP Number:1 Static RP: 192.168.2.2 # Run the display pim routing-table command. You can view the PIM multicast routing table. Host A needs to receive the information from group 225.1.1.1/24, and HostB needs to receive the information sent by the source 10.110.5.100/24 to the group 232.1.1.1/24. The displayed information is as follows: [SwitchA] display pim routing-table VPN-Instance: public net Total 1 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry (*, 225.1.1.1) RP: 192.168.9.2 Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: WC UpTime: 00:13:46 Upstream interface: vlanif100, Upstream neighbor: 192.168.9.2 RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.9.2 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: vlanif101 Protocol: igmp, UpTime: 00:13:46, Expires:(10.110.5.100, 225.1.1.1) RP: 192.168.9.2 Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: SPT ACT UpTime: 00:00:42 Upstream interface: vlanif200 Upstream neighbor: 192.168.1.2 RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.1.2 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: vlanif101 Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 00:00:42, Expires:[SwitchB] display pim routing-table VPN-Instance: public net Total 1 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry (*, 232.1.1.1) RP: 192.168.9.2 Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: WC UpTime: 00:10:12 Upstream interface: vlanif100, Upstream neighbor: 192.168.9.2 RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.9.2 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: vlanif102 Protocol: igmp, UpTime: 00:10:12, Expires:(10.110.5.100, 232.1.1.1) RP: 192.168.9.2 Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: SPT ACT UpTime: 00:00:42 Upstream interface: vlanif300 Upstream neighbor: 192.168.1.2 RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.1.2 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: vlanif102 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 202 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 00:00:30, Expires:- [SwitchD] display pim routing-table VPN-Instance: public net Total 0 (*, G) entry; 2 (S, G) entry (10.110.5.100, 225.1.1.1) RP: 192.168.9.2 Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: SPT ACT UpTime: 00:00:42 Upstream interface: vlanif103 Upstream neighbor: 10.110.5.100 RPF prime neighbor: 10.110.5.100 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: vlanif200 Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 00:00:42, Expires:(10.110.5.100, 232.1.1.1) Protocol: pim-ssm, Flag: UpTime: 00:01:20 Upstream interface: vlanif103 Upstream neighbor: 10.110.5.100 RPF prime neighbor: 10.110.5.100 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: vlanif500 Protocol: pim-ssm, UpTime: 00:01:20, Expires:[SwitchE] display pim routing-table VPN-Instance: public net Total 1 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry (*, 225.1.1.1) RP: 192.168.9.2 (local) Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: WC UpTime: 00:13:16 Upstream interface: Register Upstream neighbor: 192.168.4.2 RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.4.2 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: vlanif100 Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 00:13:16, Expires: 00:03:22 (10.110.5.100, 232.1.1.1) Protocol: pim-ssm, Flag: UpTime: 00:01:22 Upstream interface: vlanif500 Upstream neighbor: 192.168.4.2 RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.4.2 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: vlanif400 Protocol: pim-ssm, UpTime: 00:01:22, Expires:[SwitchC] display pim routing-table VPN-Instance: public net Total 1 (S, G) entry (10.110.5.100, 232.1.1.1) Protocol: pim-ssm, Flag: UpTime: 00:01:25 Upstream interface: vlanif400 Upstream neighbor: 192.168.3.2 RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.3.2 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 203 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration 1: vlanif102 Protocol: igmp, UpTime: 00:01:25, Expires:- ----End Configuration Files l Configuration file of SwitchA # sysname SwitchA # vlan batch 100 101 200 # multicast routing-enable # acl number 2000 rule 5 permit source 232.1.1.0 0.0.0.255 # interface Vlanif100 ip address 192.168.9.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface Vlanif101 ip address 10.110.1.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm igmp enable igmp version 3 pim silent # interface vlanif 200 ip address 192.168.1.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 100 port hybrid untagged vlan 100 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 101 port hybrid untagged vlan 101 # interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 200 port hybrid untagged vlan 200 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 10.110.1.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.1.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.9.0 0.0.0.255 # pim static-rp 192.168.2.2 ssm-policy 2000 # return l Configuration file of SwitchB # sysname SwitchB # multicast routing-enable # vlan batch 102 300 # acl number 2000 rule 5 permit source 232.1.1.0 0.0.0.255 # Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 204 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration interface Vlanif102 ip address 10.110.2.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm igmp enable igmp version 3 # interface Vlanif300 ip address 192.168.2.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 300 port hybrid untagged vlan 300 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 102 port hybrid untagged vlan 102 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 10.110.2.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.2.0 0.0.0.255 # pim static-rp 192.168.2.2 ssm-policy 2000 # return l Configuration file of SwitchC # sysname SwitchC # vlan batch 102 400 # multicast routing-enable # acl number 2000 rule 5 permit source 232.1.1.0 0.0.0.255 # interface Vlanif102 ip address 10.110.2.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm igmp enable igmp version 3 # interface Vlanif400 ip address 192.168.3.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 102 port hybrid untagged vlan 102 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 400 port hybrid untagged vlan 400 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 10.110.2.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.3.0 0.0.0.255 # pim static-rp 192.168.2.2 ssm-policy 2000 # return l Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Configuration file of SwitchD Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 205 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration # sysname SwitchD # vlan batch 103 104 200 500 # multicast routing-enable # acl number 2000 rule 5 permit source 232.1.1.0 0.0.0.255 # interface Vlanif103 ip address 10.110.5.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface Vlanif104 ip address 10.110.4.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm pim bsr-boundary # interface Vlanif200 ip address 192.168.1.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface Vlanif500 ip address 192.168.4.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 500 port hybrid untagged vlan 500 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 200 port hybrid untagged vlan 200 # interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 103 port hybrid untagged vlan 103 # interface GigabitEthernet4/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 104 port hybrid untagged vlan 104 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 10.110.4.0 0.0.0.255 network 10.110.5.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.1.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.4.0 0.0.0.255 # pim static-rp 192.168.2.2 ssm-policy 2000 # return l Configuration file of SwitchE # sysname SwitchE # vlan batch 100 300 400 500 # multicast routing-enable # acl number 2000 rule 5 permit source 232.1.1.0 0.0.0.255 # acl number 2008 rule 5 permit source 225.1.1.0 0.0.0.255 # Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 206 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration interface Vlanif100 ip address 192.168.9.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface Vlanif300 ip address 192.168.2.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface Vlanif400 ip address 192.168.3.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface Vlanif500 ip address 192.168.4.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid tagged vlan 400 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 300 port hybrid untagged vlan 300 # interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 100 port hybrid untagged vlan 100 # interface GigabitEthernet4/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 500 port hybrid untagged vlan 500 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 192.168.3.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.2.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.9.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.4.0 0.0.0.255 # pim c-bsr vlanif 100 c-rp vlanif 100 group-policy 2008 static-rp 192.168.2.2 ssm-policy 2000 # return 6.16.2 Example for Configuring SPT Switchover in PIM-SM Domain Networking Requirements Receivers can receive the VOD information in multicast mode. The entire PIM network adopts a single BSR administrative domain. By default, after receiving the first multicast data packet, the RP and the DR on the receiver side perform the SPT switchover, finding the optimal path to receive the multicast information from the multicast source. If the receiver requires that the SPT switchover be performed after the traffic reaches the threshold, you need to configure the SPT switchover function. As shown in Figure 6-3, you need to configure the Switches properly. In this way, HostA on the leaf network then can receive multicast data from the RP (GE1/0/0 of SwitchA). When the transmission rate of multicast packets reaches 1024 kbit/s, the SPT switchover is performed. After the SPT switchover, the path through which HostA receive multicast packets is SourceSwitchB-SwitchC--HostA. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 207 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration Figure 6-3 Networking diagram for performing the SPT switchover in PIM-SM domain SwitchA GE2/0/0 Ethernet GE1/0/0 PIM-SM GE2/0/0 Source GE3/0/0 GE1/0/0 GE1/0/0 GE3/0/0 GE2/0/0 SwitchB SwitchC Leaf networks Receiver HostA Ethernet Switch Physical interface VLANIF interface IP address SwitchA GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 100 192.168.1.1/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 200 192.168.3.1/24 GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 300 192.168.2.1/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 200 192.168.3.2/24 GE 3/0/0 VLANIF 101 10.110.5.1/24 GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 100 192.168.1.2/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 102 10.110.2.1/24 GE 3/0/0 VLANIF 300 192.168.2.2/24 SwitchB SwitchC Configuration Roadmap The configuration roadmap is as follows: 1. Configure the IP addresses of interfaces and the unicast routing protocol. 2. Enable the multicast function on all Switches, enable PIM-SM on all interfaces, and enable IGMP on the interfaces connected to hosts. 3. Configure the same static RP on each Switch. 4. Perform the SPT switchover on SwitchC. Data Preparation To complete the configuration, you need the following data: l Address of multicast source S: 10.110.5.100/24 l Address of multicast group G: 225.1.1.1/24 l Version of IGMP running between SwitchC and the leaf network: 2 Procedure Step 1 Configure the IP addresses of interfaces and the unicast routing protocol on each Switch. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 208 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration # Based on Figure 6-3, configure the IP address and mask of each interface on Switches; connect the Switches through OSPF to ensure that SwitchA, SwitchB, and SwitchC can connect to each other at the network layer and can dynamically update routes through the unicast routing protocol. For details on how to configure IP addresses of interfaces, see IP Addresses Configuration in the S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - IP Service. For details on how configure OSPF, see OSPF Configuration in the S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - IP Routing. Step 2 Enable multicast on all Switches, PIM-SM on all interfaces, and IGMP on the interfaces connected to hosts. # Enable multicast on all Switches, PIM-SM on all interfaces, and IGMP on the interface through which SwitchC is connected to the leaf network. The configurations of SwitchA and SwitchB are similar to the configuration of SwitchC, and are not provided here. [SwitchC] multicast [SwitchC] interface [SwitchC-Vlanif102] [SwitchC-Vlanif102] [SwitchC-Vlanif102] [SwitchC-Vlanif102] [SwitchC] interface [SwitchC-Vlanif300] [SwitchC-Vlanif300] [SwitchC] interface [SwitchC-Vlanif100] [SwitchC-Vlanif100] routing-enable vlanif 102 pim sm igmp enable igmp version 2 quit vlanif 300 pim sm quit vlanif 100 pim sm quit Step 3 Configure the static RP. # Configure the static RP on SwitchA, SwitchB, and SwitchC. The configurations of SwitchB and SwitchC are similar to configuration of SwitchA, and are not provided here. [SwitchA] pim [SwitchA-pim] static-rp 192.168.1.1 Step 4 Configure the threshold of the SPT switchover. # Configure SwitchC to perform the SPT switchover when the transmission rate of multicast packets reaches 1024 kbit/s. [SwitchC] pim [SwitchC-pim] spt-switch-threshold 1024 [SwitchC-pim] quit Step 5 Verify the configuration. # The multicast source begins to send data to the multicast group, and HostA can receive the data from the source. When the rate is smaller than 1024 kbit/s, you can run the display pim routing-table command to view the PIM multicast routing table on SwitchC. You can find that the upstream neighbor is SwitchA. The displayed information is as follows: <SwitchC> display pim routing-table VPN-Instance: public net Total 1 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry (*, 225.1.1.1) RP: 192.168.1.1 Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: WC UpTime: 00:13:46 Upstream interface: vlanif100 Upstream neighbor: 192.168.1.1 RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.1.1 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 209 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: vlanif102 Protocol: igmp, UpTime: 00:13:46, Expires:(10.110.5.100, 225.1.1.1) RP: 192.168.1.1 Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: ACT UpTime: 00:00:42 Upstream interface: vlanif100 Upstream neighbor: 192.168.1.1 RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.1.1 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: vlanif102 Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 00:00:42, Expires:- # When the rate is higher than 1024 kbit/s, you can run the display pim routing-table command to view the PIM multicast routing table on SwitchC. You can find that the upstream neighbor is SwitchB. The displayed information is as follows: <SwitchC> display pim routing-table VPN-Instance: public net Total 1 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry (*, 225.1.1.1) RP: 192.168.1.1 Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: WC UpTime: 00:13:46 Upstream interface: vlanif300, Upstream neighbor: 192.168.2.1 RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.2.1 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: vlanif102, Protocol: igmp, UpTime: 00:13:46, Expires:(10.110.5.100, 225.1.1.1) RP: 192.168.1.1 Protocol: pim-sm, Flag:RPT SPT ACT UpTime: 00:00:42 Upstream interface: vlanif300 Upstream neighbor: 192.168.2.1 RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.2.1 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: vlanif102 Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 00:00:42, Expires:- ----End Configuration Files l Configuration file of SwitchA # sysname SwitchA # vlan batch 100 200 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif100 ip address 192.168.1.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface Vlanif200 ip address 192.168.3.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 210 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration port hybrid pvid vlan 100 port hybrid untagged vlan 100 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 200 port hybrid untagged vlan 200 # pim static-rp 192.168.1.1 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 192.168.1.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.3.0 0.0.0.255 # return l Configuration file of SwitchB # sysname SwitchB # vlan batch 101 200 300 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif101 ip address 10.110.5.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface Vlanif200 ip address 192.168.3.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface Vlanif300 ip address 192.168.2.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 300 port hybrid untagged vlan 300 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 200 port hybrid untagged vlan 200 # interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 101 port hybrid untagged vlan 101 # pim static-rp 192.168.1.1 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 10.110.5.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.2.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.3.0 0.0.0.255 # return l Configuration file of SwitchC # sysname SwitchC # multicast routing-enable # vlan batch 100 102 300 # interface Vlanif100 ip address 192.168.1.2 255.255.255.0 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 211 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration pim sm # interface Vlanif102 ip address 10.110.2.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm igmp enable # interface Vlanif300 ip address 192.168.2.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 100 port hybrid untagged vlan 100 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 102 port hybrid untagged vlan 102 # interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 300 port hybrid untagged vlan 300 # pim spt-switch-threshold 1024 static-rp 192.168.1.1 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 10.110.2.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.1.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.2.0 0.0.0.255 # return 6.16.3 Example for Configuring PIM BFD Networking Requirements On the multicast network shown in Figure 6-4, PIM-SM is run between Switches. Hosts receive the VOD information from the multicast source. SwitchA is the DR on the source side. SwitchB and SwitchC are connected to the segment where hosts reside. When the DR changes, other Switches on the network segment can detect the change of the DR quickly. You can set up the BFD session on the network segment where the host is located to respond to the changes of the DR quickly. In addition, you can configure the DR switchover delay. In this case, when a Switch is added to the network segment and may become a DR, the multicast routing table of the original DR is reserved until the routing entries of the new DR are created. Therefore, the packet loss due to the delay in creating multicast entries is prevented. NOTE After the delay of PIM DR switchover is set, the downstream receiver may receive two copies of the same data during the DR switchover and the assert mechanism will be triggered. If you do not want to trigger the assert mechanism, you do not need to set the DR switchover delay. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 212 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration Figure 6-4 Configuring the PIM BFD networking in the shared network segment SwitchA Source 10.1.7.1/24 PIM-SM GE1/0/0 SwitchC GE1/0/0 GE2/0/0 10.1.1.2/24 SwitchB GE2/0/0 10.1.1.1/24 VLAN100 User1 User2 Configuration Roadmap The configuration roadmap is as follows: 1. Configure PIM BFD on the interfaces that connect Switches to the network segment where the host is located. 2. Set the PIM DR switchover delay on the interfaces that connect Switches to the network segment where the host is located. Data Preparation To complete the configuration, you need the following data: l Parameters of PIM BFD sessions l PIM DR switchover delay NOTE This configuration example describes only the commands used to configure PIM-SM BFD. Procedure Step 1 Configure the IP address of each interface and the unicast routing protocol. # Configure IP addresses and masks of interfaces on the Switches according to Figure 6-4. Configure OSPF between Switches to ensure that the Switches can communicate at the network layer and update routes through the unicast routing protocol. For details on how to configure IP addresses of interfaces, see IP Addresses Configuration in the S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - IP Service. For details on how configure OSPF, see OSPF Configuration in the S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - IP Routing. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 213 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration Step 2 Enable BFD globally and configure PIM BFD in the interface view. # Enable BFD globally on SwitchB and SwitchC, enable PIM BFD on the interfaces that are connected to the network segment where the host resides, and set PIM BFD parameters. The configuration on SwitchC is similar to the configuration on SwitchB and is not provided here. [SwitchB] bfd [SwitchB-bfd] quit [SwitchB] interface vlanif 100 [SwitchB-Vlanif100] pim bfd enable [SwitchB-Vlanif100] pim bfd min-tx-interval 100 min-rx-interval 100 detectmultiplier 3 Step 3 Configure the PIM DR switchover delay. # Configure PIM DR switchover delay on SwitchB and SwitchC. The configuration on SwitchC is similar to the configuration on SwitchB and is not provided here. [SwitchB-Vlanif100] pim timer dr-switch-delay 20 [SwitchB-Vlanif100] quit [SwitchB] quit Step 4 Verify the configuration. # Run the display pim interface verbose command, and you can view detailed information about the interface that runs PIM. The information about the interface that runs PIM on SwitchB indicates that the DR on the network segment where the host is located is SwitchC. PIM BFD is enabled on the interface and the switchover delay is set. <SwitchB> display pim interface vlanif100 verbose VPN-Instance: public net Interface: Vlanif100, 10.1.1.1 PIM version: 2 PIM mode: Sparse PIM state: up PIM DR: 10.1.1.2 PIM DR Priority (configured): 1 PIM neighbor count: 1 PIM hello interval: 30 s PIM LAN delay (negotiated): 500 ms PIM LAN delay (configured): 500 ms PIM Hello override interval (negotiated): 2500 ms PIM Hello override interval (configured): 2500 ms PIM Silent: disabled PIM neighbor tracking (negotiated): disabled PIM neighbor tracking (configured): disabled PIM generation ID: 0XF5712241 PIM require-GenID: disabled PIM hello hold interval: 105 s PIM assert hold interval: 180 s PIM triggered hello delay: 5 s PIM J/P interval: 60 s PIM J/P hold interval: 210 s PIM BSR domain border: disabled PIM BFD: enable PIM BFD min-tx-interval: 100 ms PIM BFD min-rx-interval: 100 ms PIM BFD detect-multiplier: 3 PIM dr-switch-delay timer : 20 s Number of routers on link not using DR priority: 0 Number of routers on link not using LAN delay: 0 Number of routers on link not using neighbor tracking: 2 ACL of PIM neighbor policy: ACL of PIM ASM join policy: ACL of PIM SSM join policy: ACL of PIM join policy: - Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 214 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration # Run the display pim bfd session command to display information about the BFD session on each Switch. You can check whether the BFD session is set up on each Switch. <SwitchB> display pim bfd session VPN-Instance: public net Total 1 BFD session Created Vlanif100 (10.1.1.1): Total 1 BFD session Created Neighbor 10.1.1.2 ActTx(ms) 100 ActRx(ms) 100 ActMulti 3 Local/Remote 8192/8192 State Up # Run the display pim routing-table command to view the PLM routing table. SwitchC functions as the DR. The (S, G) and (*, G) entries exist. The displayed information is as follows: <SwitchC> display pim routing-table VPN-Instance: public net Total 1 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry (*, 225.1.1.1) RP: 10.1.5.2 Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: WC UpTime: 00:13:46 Upstream interface: vlanif200, Upstream neighbor: 10.1.2.2 RPF prime neighbor: 10.1.2.2 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: Vlanif100, Protocol: igmp, UpTime: 00:13:46, Expires:(10.1.7.1, 225.1.1.1) RP: 10.1.5.2 Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: SPT ACT UpTime: 00:00:42 Upstream interface: vlanif200 Upstream neighbor: 10.1.2.2 RPF prime neighbor: 10.1.2.2 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: Vlanif100 Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 00:00:42, Expires:- ----End Configuration Files l SwitchA needs to be configured with only basic PIM SM functions. The configuration file is not provided here. l The following is the configuration file of SwitchB. The configuration file of SwitchC is similar to the configuration file of SwitchB, and is not provided here. # sysname SwitchB # vlan batch 100 200 # multicast routing-enable # bfd # interface Vlanif100 ip address 10.1.1.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm igmp enable pim bfd enable pim bfd min-tx-interval 100 min-rx-interval 100 pim timer dr-switch-delay 20 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 215 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration # interface Vlanif200 ip address 10.1.2.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 200 port hybrid untagged vlan 200 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 100 port hybrid untagged vlan 100 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 10.1.1.0 0.0.0.255 network 10.1.2.0 0.0.0.255 # return 6.16.4 Example for Configuring PIM GR Networking Requirements In the multicast application, if the active/standby switchover occurs on a device, the new master MPU deletes the multicast forwarding entries of the LPUs and relearns the PIM routes and multicast forwarding entries. During this process, multicast traffic is interrupted. The PIM GR function on an IPTV network can protect the core devices and edge devices. When an active/standby switchover occurs, the PIM GR function ensures that the multicast data is forwarded normally. In this way, the fault tolerance capability of the devices on the IPTV network is improved. As shown in Figure 6-5, multicast services are deployed on the network. When SwitchC enabled with the PIM GR function forwards multicast data to the receiver, the master MPU backs up the PIM routes and Join/Prune messages to be sent to the upstream device to the slave MPU. When the active/standby switchover occurs on SwitchC, the LPUs maintain the existing forwarding entries to ensure uninterrupted forwarding of multicast data. The receiver can always receive multicast data from the source during the active/standby switchover. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 216 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration Figure 6-5 Networking diagram of PIM GR Ethernet Leaf networks SwitchA Source GE2/0/0 GE2/0/0 GE1/0/0 GE1/0/0 GE1/0/0 SwitchB Loopback0 1.1.1.1/32 GE2/0/0 SwitchC Receiver HostA PIM-SM Ethernet Device Physical interface VLANIF interface IP address SwitchA GE1/0/0 VLANIF 10 192.168.2.1/24 Loopback0 SwitchB SwitchC 1.1.1.1/32 GE2/0/0 VLANIF 20 10.110.1.1/24 GE1/0/0 VLANIF 10 192.168.2.2/24 GE2/0/0 VLANIF 40 192.168.4.1/24 GE1/0/0 VLANIF 40 192.168.4.2/24 GE2/0/0 VLANIF 60 10.110.2.1/24 Configuration Roadmap The configuration roadmap is as follows: 1. Configure the IP addresses and unicast routing protocols on the physical interfaces of the switch matching the VLANIF interfaces. 2. Enable the unicast GR function on each switch and set the GR period. 3. Enable the multicast function, enable PIM-SM on the interface of the switch, and enable IGMP on the interface connecting switch to the host. 4. Configure an RP. Configure same static RPs on the switches. 5. Enable the PIM GR function on SwitchC and set the GR period. Data Preparation To complete the configuration, you need the following data: l Multicast source address 10.110.1.100 l Multicast group address 225.1.1.1 l Unicast GR period l PIM GR period Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 217 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration Procedure Step 1 Configure the IP addresses and unicast routing protocols on the physical interfaces of the switch matching the VLANIF interfaces. # Configure the IP address and mask on each interface of the switches according to Figure 6-5. The switches are connected to each other through OSPF. SwitchA, SwitchB, and SwitchC can communicate with each other at the network layer. For details on how to configure IP addresses of interfaces, see IP Addresses Configuration in the S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - IP Service. For details on how to configure OSPF, see OSPF Configuration in the S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - IP Routing. Step 2 Enable the unicast GR function on each switch and set the unicast GR period. # Enable the unicast GR function on all the switches and set the unicast GR period to 200 seconds. The configurations of SwitchA and SwitchB are similar to the configuration of SwitchC, and are not provided here. [SwitchC] ospf 1 [SwitchC-ospf-1] [SwitchC-ospf-1] [SwitchC-ospf-1] [SwitchC-ospf-1] opaque-capability enable graceful-restart graceful-restart period 200 quit Step 3 Enable the multicast function, enable PIM SM on each interface of the switch, and enable IGMP on the interfaces connecting switch to the host. # Enable the multicast function on all switches, and enable PIM SM on each interface of the switch, and enable IGMP on the interface connecting switchC to the host. The configurations of SwitchA and SwitchB are similar to the configuration of SwitchC, and are not provided here. [SwitchC] multicast routing-enable [SwitchC] interface gigabitethernet [SwitchC-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port [SwitchC-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port [SwitchC-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] quit [SwitchC] interface vlanif 60 [SwitchC-Vlanif60] pim sm [SwitchC-Vlanif60] igmp enable [SwitchC-Vlanif60] quit [SwitchC] interface gigabitethernet [SwitchC-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port [SwitchC-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port [SwitchC-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] quit [SwitchC] interface vlanif 50 [SwitchC-Vlanif40] pim sm [SwitchC-Vlanif40] quit 2/0/0 hybrid pvid vlan 60 hybrid untagged vlan 60 1/0/0 hybrid pvid vlan 50 hybrid untagged vlan 50 Step 4 Configure the static RP. # Create a loopback interface on SwitchA and enable PIM SM on the interface. [SwitchA] interface [SwitchA-Loopback0] [SwitchA-Loopback0] [SwitchA-Loopback0] loopback 0 ip address 1.1.1.1 255.255.255.255 pim sm quit # Configure the static RP on all the switches. The configurations of SwitchB and SwitchC are similar to the configuration of SwitchA, and are not provided here. [SwitchA] pim [SwitchA-pim] static-rp 1.1.1.1 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 218 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration [SwitchA-pim] quit Step 5 Enable PIM GR and set the PIM GR period. # Enable the PIM GR function on SwitchC and set the PIM GR period to 300 seconds. [SwitchC] pim [SwitchC-pim] graceful-restart [SwitchC-pim] graceful-restart period 300 [SwitchC-pim] quit Step 6 Verify the configuration. # Multicast source 10.110.1.100 sends data to multicast group 225.1.1.1. Host A sends an IGMP Report message to join the multicast group and it can receive multicast data from the multicast source. Before SwitchC performs an active/standby switchover, run the display pim routingtable command on SwitchB and SwitchC to view the multicast routing tables. The command output is as follows: <SwitchB> display pim routing-table VPN-Instance: public net Total 1 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry (*, 225.1.1.1) RP: 1.1.1.1 Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: WC UpTime: 01:52:38 Upstream interface: Vlanif10 Upstream neighbor: 192.168.2.1 RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.2.1 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: Vlanif40 Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 01:52:38, Expires: 00:02:53 (10.110.1.100, 225.1.1.1) RP: 1.1.1.1 Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: SPT ACT UpTime: 01:52:38 Upstream interface: Vlanif10 upstream neighbor: 192.168.2.1 RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.2.1 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: Vlanif40 Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 01:52:38, Expires: 00:03:03 <SwitchC> display pim routing-table VPN-Instance: public net Total 1 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry (*, 225.1.1.1) RP: 1.1.1.1 Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: WC UpTime: 01:51:24 Upstream interface: Vlanif40 Upstream neighbor: 192.168.4.1 RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.4.1 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: Vlanif60 Protocol: igmp, UpTime: 01:51:24, Expires: (10.110.1.100, 225.1.1.1) RP: 1.1.1.1 Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: SPT ACT UpTime: 01:51:24 Upstream interface: Vlanif40 Upstream neighbor: 192.168.4.1 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 219 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.4.1 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: Vlanif60 Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 01:51:24, Expires: - # Run the active/standby switchover commands on SwitchC. [SwitchC] slave switchover # After SwitchC performs an active/standby switchover, during PIM GR, run the display pim routing-table command on SwitchB and SwitchC to view the routing tables. The command output is as follows: <SwitchB> display pim routing-table VPN-Instance: public net Total 1 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry (*, 225.1.1.1) RP: 1.1.1.1 Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: WC UpTime: 02:52:38 Upstream interface: Vlanif10 Upstream neighbor: 192.168.2.1 RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.2.1 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: Vlanif40 Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 02:52:38, Expires: 00:03:00 (10.110.1.100, 225.1.1.1) RP: 1.1.1.1 Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: SPT ACT UpTime: 02:52:38 Upstream interface: Vlanif10 Upstream neighbor: 192.168.2.1 RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.2.1 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: Vlanif40 Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 02:52:38, Expires: 00:03:12 <SwitchC> display pim routing-table VPN-Instance: public net Total 1 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry (*, 225.1.1.1) RP: 1.1.1.1 Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: WC UpTime: 02:51:24 Upstream interface: Vlanif40 Upstream neighbor: 192.168.4.1 RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.4.1 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: Vlanif60 Protocol: igmp, UpTime: 02:51:24, Expires: (10.110.1.100, 225.1.1.1) RP: 1.1.1.1 Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: SPT ACT UpTime: 02:51:24 Upstream interface: Vlanif40 Upstream neighbor: 192.168.4.1 RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.4.1 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: Vlanif60 Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 02:51:24, Expires: - Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 220 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration On a multicast network, the downstream switch periodically sends Join/Prune messages to the upstream device to update the timeout period of PIM routing entries on the upstream, thereby ensuring normal multicast data forwarding. If the GR function is not configured on SwitchC, the new master MPU deletes the multicast forwarding entries of the LPUs, receives the IGMP Report messages sent by hosts, and creates the PIM routing entries. During the active/standby switchover, multicast traffic is interrupted. The preceding information indicates that after SwitchC performs an active/standby switchover, the downstream interface on SwitchB remains unchanged. That is, after SwitchC performs the active/standby switchover, SwitchC sends the backup Join messages to the upstream device. In this way, the multicast forwarding entries are maintained during GR to ensure nonstop multicast data forwarding. During the restoration of multicast routing entries on SwitchC, users can still receive multicast data normally and services are not affected. ----End Configuration Files l Configuration file of SwitchA # sysname SwitchA # vlan batch 10 20 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif10 ip address 192.168.2.1 24 pim sm # interface Vlanif20 ip address 10.110.1.1 24 pim sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 10 port hybrid untagged vlan 10 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 20 port hybrid untagged vlan 20 # interface Loopback0 ip address 1.1.1.1 255.255.255.255 pim sm # ospf 1 opaque-capability enable graceful-restart period 200 area 0.0.0.0 network 192.168.2.0 0.0.0.255 network 10.110.1.0 0.0.0.255 network 1.1.1.1 0.0.0.0 # pim static-rp 1.1.1.1 # return l Configuration file of SwitchB # sysname SwitchB Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 221 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration # vlan batch 10 40 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif10 ip address 192.168.2.2 24 pim sm # interface Vlanif40 ip address 192.168.4.1 24 pim sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 10 port hybrid untagged vlan 10 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 40 port hybrid untagged vlan 40 # ospf 1 opaque-capability enable graceful-restart period 200 area 0.0.0.0 network 192.168.2.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.4.0 0.0.0.255 # pim static-rp 1.1.1.1 # return l Configuration file of SwitchC # sysname SwitchC # vlan batch 40 60 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif40 ip address 192.168.4.2 24 pim sm # interface Vlanif60 igmp enable ip address 10.110.2.1 24 pim sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 40 port hybrid untagged vlan 40 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 60 port hybrid untagged vlan 60 # ospf 1 opaque-capability enable graceful-restart period 200 area 0.0.0.0 network 10.110.2.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.4.0 0.0.0.255 # pim static-rp 1.1.1.1 graceful-restart graceful-restart period 300 # Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 222 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 6 PIM-SM (IPv4) Configuration return Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 223 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration 7 MSDP Configuration About This Chapter The MSDP protocol is used to implement multicast routing and data forwarding between PIMSM domains and anycast RP in a PIM-SM domain. 7.1 MSDP Overview MSDP functions to set up an MSDP peer relationship between RPs in different PIM-SM domains. MSDP peers exchange (S, G) information by sending SA messages. In this manner, MSDP peers share multicast source information and hosts can receive multicast data from the multicast sources in another PIM-SM domain. 7.2 MSDP Features Supported by the S9700 MSDP is used to implement PIM-SM inter-domain multicast and anycast RP in a PIM-SM domain. You can control connections between MSDP peers, adjust SA message parameters, and configure authentication for MSDP peers and filtering policies for SA messages to enhance MSDP security. The system supports multi-instance MSDP. 7.3 Configuring PIM-SM Inter-domain Multicast This section describes how to set up an MSDP peer relationship between PIM-SM domains in an AS and how to configure MSDP peers to implement PIM-SM inter-domain multicast. 7.4 Configuring an Anycast RP in a PIM-SM Domain Anycast RP indicates that when multiple RPs with the same address reside in the same PIM-SM domain and MSDP peer relationships are set up between these RPs, IP routing automatically selects the topologically closest RP for each source and receiver. In this manner, burdens on a single RP are released, RP backup is implemented, and the forwarding path is optimized. 7.5 Managing MSDP Peer Connections MSDP peers should set up TCP connections. You can then flexibly control the sessions set up between MSDP peers by closing or re-establishing TCP connections. You can also adjust the interval for retrying to set up a TCP connection between MSDP peers. 7.6 Configuring SA Cache An SA cache is used to save the (S, G) information carried in SA messages locally. When a device needs to receive multicast data, it directly obtains available (S, G) information from the SA cache. 7.7 Configuring the SA Request If the capacity of the SA cache enabled on the remote MSDP peer is too large, configuring "sending SA Request message" on the local device can shorten the time taken by a receiver to Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 224 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration obtain multicast source information. You can configure filtering rules for receiving SA Request messages on a specified remote MSDP peer. 7.8 Transmitting Burst Multicast Data Between Domains By default, an SA message carries only (S, G) information. Then, if burst multicast data need be transmitted between domains, you can configure multicast data encapsulation for an SA message on the source RP. In addition, you can set the TTL threshold to limit the transmission scope of multicast data encapsulated in an SA message. 7.9 Configuring the Filtering Rules for SA Messages By default, a device receives all SA messages that pass the RPF check, and forwards the SA messages to all MSDP peers. To control the transmission of SA messages among MSDP peers, you can configure rules to filter the constructing, receiving, and forwarding SA messages. 7.10 Configuring MSDP Authentication MSDP peer authentication contains MSDP MD5 authentication and Key-Chain authentication. You can choose either authentication mode. 7.11 Maintaining MSDP Maintaining MSDP involves clearing MSDP peer statistics and (S, G) information in the SA cache, and monitoring MSDP running status. 7.12 Configuration Examples Configuration examples are provided to show how to implement PIM-SM inter-domain multicast through MBGP, how to implement inter-AS multicast through static RPF peers, and how to configure anycast RP in a PIM-SM domain. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 225 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration 7.1 MSDP Overview MSDP functions to set up an MSDP peer relationship between RPs in different PIM-SM domains. MSDP peers exchange (S, G) information by sending SA messages. In this manner, MSDP peers share multicast source information and hosts can receive multicast data from the multicast sources in another PIM-SM domain. In the general PIM-SM mode, a multicast source registers only with the local rendezvous point (RP). The information on the inter-domain multicast sources is isolated. The RP knows only the source in its domain, establishes a multicast distribution tree (MDT) in its domain, and distributes the data sent by the source to the local users. A mechanism is required to enable the local RP to share the information on the multicast sources of other domains. With the mechanism, the local RP can send Join messages to the multicast sources of other domains and establish MDTs. Therefore, multicast packets can be transmitted across domains, and hosts in the local domain can receive data sent by multicast sources in other domains. The Multicast Source Discovery Protocol (MSDP) is an inter-area multicast solution based on multiple interconnected PIM-SM domains, and can solve the preceding problem. MSDP achieves this objective by setting up the MSDP peer relationship between RPs of different domains. MSDP peers share the information on multicast sources by sending Source Active (SA) messages. They transmit the (S, G) information from the RP that the source S registers with to other RPs connected to members of G. MSDP peers are connected through the TCP connection. MSDP peers perform the RPF check on received SA messages. NOTE MSDP is applicable only to PIM-SM domains, and useful only for the Any-Source Multicast (ASM) mode. 7.2 MSDP Features Supported by the S9700 MSDP is used to implement PIM-SM inter-domain multicast and anycast RP in a PIM-SM domain. You can control connections between MSDP peers, adjust SA message parameters, and configure authentication for MSDP peers and filtering policies for SA messages to enhance MSDP security. The system supports multi-instance MSDP. PIM-SM Inter-Domain Multicast When a multicast network is divided into multiple PIM-SM domains, MSDP is used to connect RPs in each domain to share the multicast source information. In this manner, hosts in a domain can receive multicast data sent by multicast sources in other domains. You can configure a loopback interface as a C-RP or a static RP or specify the address of a loopback interface as a logical RP address for SA messages. PIM-SM Intra-Domain Anycast RP After anycast RP is applied to a PIM-SM domain, the multicast source registers with the nearest RP and receivers send Join messages to the nearest RP. This reduces the burden of a single RP, implements RP backup, and optimizes the forwarding path. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 226 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration You can use a loopback interface as a interface of C-RP or static RP and specify the logical RP address for an SA message. Configuring Control Parameters for Maintaining MSDP Peer Connections In the S9700, you can set up and tear down an MSDP session, and configure the period for retrying to send TCP connection requests to the remote MSDP peers. Configuring SA Cache By default, SA-Cache is enabled on switchs. Therefore, switchs can locally store the (S, G) information carried in SA messages. When required to receive the multicast data, the switchs can obtain the (S, G) information from the SA-Cache. You can set the maximum number of cached (S, G) entries, which can effectively prevent the Denial of Service (DoS) attack. You can disable SA-Cache on a switch. After the SA-Cache on a switch is disabled, the switch does not locally store the (S, G) information carried in SA messages. When the switch needs to receive multicast data, it needs to wait for the SA message to be sent by its MSDP peer in the next period. This causes a delay for receivers to obtain multicast source information. Controlling SA Requests Certain switchs cannot be enabled with SA Cache or the capacity of SA Cache on these switchs is too small. When these switchs need to receive multicast data, they cannot immediately obtain the valid (S, G) information but need to wait for the SA message to be sent by their MSDP peers in the next period. If SA Cache is enabled on the remote MSDP peer and the capacity of the SA Cache is large, you can configure "sending SA request messages" on the local switch to reduce the period during which receivers obtain multicast source information. At the same time, you can also configure the filtering rules for receiving SA request messages on the remote MSDP peers. Transmitting Burst Multicast Data When the interval for a certain multicast source to send multicast data is longer than the timeout period of an (S, G) entry, the source DR can only encapsulate burst multicast data in Register messages and send them to the source RP. The source RP uses SA messages to transmit (S, G) information to the remote RP. The remote RP then sends an (S, G) Join message towards the multicast source to create an SPT. Because of the timeout of the (S, G) entry, the remote user cannot receive the multicast data sent by S. The S9700 supports the transmission of burst multicast data. You can enable the function of encapsulating a multicast data packet in an SA message on the source RP. The source RP can then encapsulate multicast data in an SA message and send the message out. After receiving the SA message, the remote RP decapsulates the message, and then forwards multicast data to hosts in the domain along the RPT. Setting the TTL threshold can limit the transmission scope of a multicast data packet contained in an SA message. After receiving an SA message containing a multicast data packet, an MSDP peer checks the TTL value in the IP header of the multicast packet. If the TTL value is equal to or smaller than the threshold, the MSDP peer does not forward the SA message to the specific Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 227 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration remote peers. If the TTL value is greater than the threshold, the MSDP peer reduces the TTL value in the IP header of the multicast packet by 1, and then encapsulates the multicast packet in an SA message and sends the message out. Rules for Creating, Receiving, and Forwarding SA Messages By default, MSDP switchs receive all SA messages that pass the RPF check and forward them to all MSDP peers. To control the transmission of SA messages between MSDP peers, you can configure filtering rules by using the following methods: l Setting rules for filtering SA messages based on multicast sources on the source RP The source RP filters active multicast sources that register with the local switch, and then determines whether to send (S, G) entries based on the rules. l Setting rules for filtering SA messages received from remote MSDP peers When an SA message sent by a remote MSDP peer reaches the local switch, the switch determines whether to receive the message based on the rules. l Setting rules for filtering SA messages forwarded to remote MSDP peers Before forwarding an SA message to a remote MSDP peer, the local switch determines whether to forward it based on the rules. Multi-Instance MSDP MSDP peer relationships can be set up between interfaces on multicast switchs that belong to the same instance (including the public instance and VPN instance). MSDP peers exchange SA message with each other. The inter-domain VPN multicast is thus implemented. Multicast switchs on which multi-instance is applied maintain a set of MSDP mechanisms for each instance. Multicast switchs also guarantee the information separation among different instances; therefore, only MSDP and PIM-SM that belong to the same instance can interact. By applying multi-instance, the S9700 implements inter-domain VPN multicast. NOTE For details of inter-domain VPN multicast, refer to the chapter Multicast VPN Configuration. MSDP Authentication Configuring MSDP MD5 or Key-Chain authentication can improve the security of TCP connections set up between MSDP peers. Note that the MSDP peers must be configured with the same authentication password; otherwise, the TCP connection cannot be set up between MSDP peers and MSDP messages cannot be transmitted. 7.3 Configuring PIM-SM Inter-domain Multicast This section describes how to set up an MSDP peer relationship between PIM-SM domains in an AS and how to configure MSDP peers to implement PIM-SM inter-domain multicast. 7.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task Before configuring PIM-SM inter-domain multicast, you need to configure intra-domain multicast. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 228 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration Applicable Environment When a large multicast network is divided into multiple PIM-SM domains, MSDP is used to connect RPs of various domains to share the source information. In this manner, hosts in a domain can receive multicast data sent by multicast sources in other domains. To ensure that all RPs in the network can share the source information, reduce the scale of an MSDP connected graph. It is recommended to configure MSDP peer relationships between all RPs, including static RPs and C-RPs, in the network. To ensure that SA messages transmitted between MSDP peers are not interrupted by RPF rules and to reduce redundant traffic, the following solutions are recommended: l Add MSDP peers in the same AS to one Mesh Group. l If MSDP peers are in different ASs, select either of the following solutions: – Establish an MBGP peer relationship and use the same interface address. – Configure each other as a static RPF peer. NOTE Both BGP and MBGP can be used to set up inter-AS EBGP peer relationships. MBGP is recommended because MBGP does not affect the unicast topology of a network. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring PIM-SM inter-domain multicast, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol to enable interworking at the network layer l Enabling IP multicast l Configuring a PIM-SM domain to implement intra-domain multicast Data Preparation To configure PIM-SM inter-domain multicast, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Address of a remote MSDP peer 2 Type and number of the local interface connected to MSDP peers 3 Description of an MSDP peer 4 Name of a mesh group 7.3.2 Configuring Intra-AS MSDP Peers When multiple PIM-SM domains exist in an AS or multiple RPs serving different multicast groups exist in a PIM-SM domain, you are recommended to configure MSDP peer relationships between all RPs (including static RPs and C-RPs) and add all MSDP peers to a mesh group. Context Do as follows on the RPs of all PIM-SM domains that belong to the same AS: Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 229 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system is displayed. Step 2 Run: msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] MSDP is enabled in the public network instance or VPN instances and the MSDP view is displayed. Step 3 Run: peer peer-address connect-interface interface-type interface-number An MSDP peer connection is configured The parameters of the command are explained as follows: l peer-address: specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer. l interface-type interface-number: specifies the local interface connected to the remote MSDP peer. NOTE The system does not advertise routes on MTIs to VPNs; therefore, it is not allowed to use MTIs to set up an MSDP peer connection. Step 4 (Optional) Run: peer peer-address description text The description of a remote MSDP peer is added. This configuration helps to differentiate remote MSDP peers and manage the connections with the remote MSDP peers. The parameters of the command are explained as follows: l peer-address specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer. l text: specifies the description text. The text is a string of 80 characters. Step 5 Run: peer peer-address mesh-group name A remote MSDP peer is configured to join a mesh group. That is, the remote MSDP peer is acknowledged as a member of the mesh group. The parameters of this command are explained as follows: l peer-address: specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer. l name: specifies the name of a mesh group. The members of the same mesh group use the same mesh group name. Note the following: l MSDP peer connections must be set up between all members of the same mesh group. l All members of the mesh group must acknowledge each other as a member of the group. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 230 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration l An MSDP peer can belong to only one mesh group. If an MSDP peer is configured to join different mesh groups for multiple times, only the latest configuration is valid. ----End 7.3.3 Configuring Inter-AS MSDP Peers on MBGP Peers You can configure an MSDP peer relationship between RPs in different ASs that have set up an MBGP peer relationship. In this manner, PIM-SM domains in different ASs can share multicast source information. Context Establish the MBGP peer relationship between two RPs of different ASs and do as follows on the MBGP peers: NOTE If the two RPs set up the BGP peer relationship, it is not necessary to set up the MBGP peer relationship between them. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] MSDP is enabled in the public network instance or VPN instance, and the MSDP view is displayed. Step 3 Run: peer peer-address connect-interface interface-type interface-number An MSDP peer connection is configured. The parameters of the command are explained as follows: l peer-address: specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer. The address is the same as that of the remote BGP or MBGP peer. l interface-type interface-number: specifies the local interface connected to the remote MSDP peer. The interface is the same as the local BGP or MBGP interface. Step 4 (Optional) Run: peer peer-address description text The description of the MSDP peer is added. The configuration helps to distinguish the remote MSDP peers and manage the connections with the remote MSDP peers. The parameters of the command are explained as follows: l peer-address: specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 231 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration l text: specifies the description text. The text is a string of 80 characters. ----End 7.3.4 Configuring Static RPF Peers You can configure a static RPF peer relationship between RPs in different ASs so that SA messages which sent by RPF peer don't need do RPF check. Context NOTE If Configuring Inter-AS MSDP Peers on MBGP Peers is complete, skip the configuration. Do as follows on two RPs of different ASs: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] MSDP is enabled in the public network instance or VPN instance, and the MSDP view is displayed. Step 3 Run: peer peer-address connect-interface interface-type interface-number An MSDP peer connection is configured. The parameters of the command are explained as follows: l peer-address: specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer. l interface-type interface-number: specifies the local interface connected to the remote MSDP peer. Step 4 (Optional) Run: peer peer-address description text The description of a remote MSDP peer is added. The configuration helps to distinguish remote MSDP peers and manage the connections with the remote MSDP peers. The parameters of the command are explained as follows: l peer-address: specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer. l text: specifies the description text. The text is a string of up to 80 characters. Step 5 Run: static-rpf-peer peer-address [ rp-policy ip-prefix-name ] A remote MSDP peer is statically specified as an RPF peer. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 232 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration peer-address specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer. ----End 7.3.5 Checking the Configuration After PIM-SM inter-domain multicast is configured, you can run related commands to check brief and detailed information about MSDP peers. Procedure l Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] brief command to check the brief information about the statuses of all remote peers that establish MSDP peer relationships with the local host. l Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] peer-status [ peer-address ] to check the detailed information about the statuses of the specified remote peers that establish the MSDP peer relationships with the local host. ----End Example Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] brief command. If the brief information about the remote MSDP peer status is displayed, it means that the configuration succeeds. For example: <Quidway> display msdp brief MSDP Peer Brief Information of VPN-Instance: public net Configured Up Listen Connect Shutdown 2 2 0 0 0 Peer's Address 192.168.2.1 192.168.4.2 State UP UP Up/Down time 01:07:08 00:06:39 AS 200 100 SA Count 8 13 Down 0 Reset Count 0 0 Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] peer-status [ peeraddress ] command. If the verborse information about the remote MSDP peer status is displayed, it means that the configuration succeeds. For example: <Quidway> display msdp peer-status 10.110.11.11 MSDP Peer Information of VPN-Instance: public net MSDP Peer 20.20.20.20, AS 100 Description: Information about connection status: State: Up Up/down time: 14:41:08 Resets: 0 Connection interface: LoopBack0 (20.20.20.30) Number of sent/received messages: 867/947 Number of discarded output messages: 0 Elapsed time since last connection or counters clear: 14:42:40 Information about (Source, Group)-based SA filtering policy: Import policy: none Export policy: none Information about SA-Requests: Policy to accept SA-Request messages: none Sending SA-Requests status: disable Minimum TTL to forward SA with encapsulated data: 0 SAs learned from this peer: 0, SA-cache maximum for the peer: none Input queue size: 0, Output queue size: 0 Counters for MSDP message: Count of RPF check failure: 0 Incoming/outgoing SA messages: 0/0 Incoming/outgoing SA requests: 0/0 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 233 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration Incoming/outgoing SA responses: 0/0 Incoming/outgoing data packets: 0/0 Peer authentication: configured Peer authentication type: KeyChain 7.4 Configuring an Anycast RP in a PIM-SM Domain Anycast RP indicates that when multiple RPs with the same address reside in the same PIM-SM domain and MSDP peer relationships are set up between these RPs, IP routing automatically selects the topologically closest RP for each source and receiver. In this manner, burdens on a single RP are released, RP backup is implemented, and the forwarding path is optimized. 7.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task You can configure anycast RP in the scenario where devices in a PIM-SM domain are reachable, PIM-SM is enabled on the interfaces configured with multicast routing, and no RP is configured in the network. Applicable Environment In a traditional PIM-SM domain, each multicast group can be mapped to only one RP. When the network is overloaded or the traffic is too concentrated, many network problems are caused. For example, the pressure of the RP is too heavy, switchs converge slowly after the RP fails, and the multicast forwarding path is not optimal. After anycast RPs are applied in a PIM-SM domain, the source registers with the nearest RP and hosts sends Join messages to the nearest RP. That is, the load of a single RP is abated, the RP backup is implemented, and the forwarding path is optimized. The recommended configuration solutions are as follows: l Configure loopback interfaces on multiple switchs in the PIM-SM domain respectively, assign the same IP address to the loopback interfaces, and advertise the IP address by using unicast routes. l Configure the loopback interfaces on the switchs as C-RPs or configure the address of the loopback interface as a static RP on all switchs in the PIM-SM domain. l Set up the MSDP peer relationship between the switchs. If the number of switchs is greater than three, it is recommended to set up the MSDP peer relationship between the switchs and configure them to join the same mesh group. l Specify the logical RP address to transmit SA messages between the MSDP peers. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring an anycast RP in a PIM-SM domain, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol to implement interconnection at the network layer l Enabling IP multicast l Configuring a PIM-SM domain without any RP Data Preparation To configure an anycast RP in a PIM-SM domain, you need the following data. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 234 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration No. Data 1 RP address 2 Interface and address of the local MSDP peer 3 Interface and address of the remote MSDP peer 4 Description of an MSDP peer 7.4.2 Configuring the Interface Address of an RP Before configuring anycast RP on the devices in a PIM-SM domain, configure a loopback interface on each device and assign the same IP address to the loopback interfaces. In addition, advertise the IP address of the RP through unicast routes to ensure that each device has a reachable route to the RP interface. Context Use a unicast routing protocol in the current network to advertise the address of the newly configured RP interface. Ensure that all switchs in the network have a route to the RP. In the PIM-SM domain, do as follows on multiple switchs on which the anycast RP is to be configured: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface loopback interface-number The loopback interface view is displayed. Multiple RPs can use the same IP address in a network. The RPs, therefore, are configured on the loopback interface. Step 3 Run: ip address ip-address { mask | mask-length } The address of the loopback interface is configured. The parameters of the command are explained as follows: l ip-address: specifies the address of an RP. The RPs configured on multiple devices uses the same IP address. l mask | mask-length: specifies the address mask of the loopback interface. Step 4 Run: pim sm PIM-SM is enabled for the RP interface. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 235 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration NOTE Before configuring a dynamic RP, you need to run this command. This command is not required when you configure a static RP. ----End 7.4.3 Configuring a C-RP A loopback interface is generally configured as a C-RP on the device to be configured with anycast RP. Context NOTE l If the PIM-SM network uses a static RP, the configuration is not necessary. l If the PIM-SM network uses a BSR-RP, the configuration is mandatory. Before configuring a C-RP, configure a BSR and BSP boundary. The BSR address cannot be the same as the C-RP address. Do as follows on multiple switchs where anycast RP is to be configured in the PIM-SM domain: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. Step 3 Run: c-rp loopback interface-number An interface is configured as a C-RP. ----End 7.4.4 Statically Configuring an RP To configure a static RP, you need to configure the addresses of the loopback interfaces as the RP addresses on all the devices in a PIM-SM domain. Context NOTE l When the PIM-SM network uses a BSR-RP, the configuration is not necessary. l When the PIM-SM network uses a static RP, the configuration is mandatory. Do as follows on all switchs in the PIM-SM domain: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 236 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The PIM view is displayed. Step 3 Run: static-rp rp-address The loopback interface address is configured as a static RP address. ----End 7.4.5 Configuring an MSDP Peer MSDP peer relationships need be set up between RPs. If there are more than three devices, MSDP peer relationships should be set up between any two devices and all MSDP peers should be added to one mesh group. Context Do as follows on multiple switchs on which an anycast RP is to be created: NOTE If the number of switchs configured with the RPs that have the same IP address exceeds two, ensure the interconnection between the switchs that set up MSDP peer relationship. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] MSDP is enabled in the public network instance or the VPN instance, and the MSDP view is displayed. Step 3 Run: peer peer-address connect-interface interface-type interface-number An MSDP peer connection is created. The parameters of the command are explained as follows: l peer-address: specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer. l interface-type interface-number: specifies the local interface. Step 4 (Optional) Run: peer peer-address description text The description of the MSDP peer is added. This configuration helps to differentiate remote MSDP peers and manage the connection with the remote MSDP peers. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 237 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration The parameters of the command are explained as follows: l peer-address: specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer. l text: specifies the description text. The text is a string of 80 characters. Step 5 (Optional) Run: peer peer-address mesh-group name A remote MSDP peer is configured to join a mesh group. That is, the remote MSDP peer is acknowledged as a member of the mesh group. If only two switchs are configured with the anycast-RP, this configuration is not necessary. The parameters of the command are explained as follows: l peer-address: specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer. l name: specifies the name of a mesh group. The members of the same mesh group use the same mesh group name. Note the following: l MSDP peer connections must be set up between all members of the mesh group. l All members of the mesh group must acknowledge each other as the member of the mesh group. l An MSDP peer belongs to only one mesh group. If an MSDP peer is configured to join different mesh groups for many times, only the last configuration is valid. ----End 7.4.6 Specifying the Logical RP Address for an SA Message After receiving an SA message, an MSDP peer performs the RPF check on the message. If the remote RP address carried in the SA message is the same as the local RP address, the MSDP peer discards the SA message. Therefore, you need to specify a logical RP address for SA messages on the device on which anycast RP is to be configured. Context After receiving an SA message, an MSDP peer performs the RPF check on the message. If the remote RP address carried in the SA message is the same as the local RP address, the SA message is discarded. Do as follows on the switchs on which the anycast RP is to be configured: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The MSDP view is displayed. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 238 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration Step 3 Run: originating-rp interface-type interface-number The logical RP interface is configured. The logical RP interface cannot be the same as the actual RP interface. It is recommended to configure the logical interface as the MSDP peer interface. After the originating-rp command is used, the logical RP address carried in the SA message sent by the switch replaces the RP address in the IP header of the SA message, and the SA message can pass the RPF check after reaching the remote switch. NOTE The system does not advertise routes on the MTIs to VPNs; therefore, the MTIs cannot be used as logical RPs. ----End 7.4.7 Checking the Configuration After anycast RP in a PIM-SM domain is configured, you can run related commands to check brief information about MSDP peers and RP information of PIM routing entries. Procedure l Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] brief command to check the brief information of the MSDP peer status. l Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table command to check the information about the RP corresponding to the PIM routing table. ----End Example Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] brief command. If the brief information about the remote MSDP peer status is displayed, it means that the configuration succeeds. For example: <Quidway> display msdp brief MSDP Peer Brief Information of VPN-Instance: public net Configured Up Listen Connect Shutdown 1 1 0 0 0 Peer's Address 2.2.2.2 State UP Up/Down time 00:10:17 AS ? SA Count 0 Down 0 Reset Count 0 Run the display pim [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table command. If the RP information corresponding to the routing table is displayed, it means that the configuration succeeds. For example: <Quidway> display pim routing-table VPN-Instance: public net Total 0 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry (10.11.1.2, 225.1.1.1) RP: 7.7.7.7 (local) Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: SPT ACT UpTime: 00:01:57 Upstream interface: Vlanif10 Upstream neighbor: 10.3.1.2 RPF prime neighbor: 10.3.1.2 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: Vlanif20 Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: - , Expires: Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. - 239 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration 7.5 Managing MSDP Peer Connections MSDP peers should set up TCP connections. You can then flexibly control the sessions set up between MSDP peers by closing or re-establishing TCP connections. You can also adjust the interval for retrying to set up a TCP connection between MSDP peers. 7.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After PIM-SM inter-domain multicast or anycast RP in a PIM-SM domain is configured, you can manage the connection between MSDP peers as required. Applicable Environment MSDP peers are connected by the TCP connection (the port number is 639). Users can close or reestablish a TCP connection, and flexibly control the sessions set up between MSDP peers. When a new MSDP peer is created, or when a closed MSDP peer connection is restarted, or when a faulty MSDP peer tries recovering, the TCP connection needs to be immediately set up between MSDP peers. Users can flexibly adjust the interval for retrying setting up an MSDP peer connection. Pre-configuration Tasks Before managing MSDP peer connections, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol to implement interconnection at the network layer l Enabling IP multicast l Configuring a PIM-SM domain to implement intra-domain multicast l Configuring PIM-SM Inter-domain Multicast or Configuring an Anycast RP in a PIM-SM Domain Data Preparation To manage MSDP peer connections, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Address of a remote MSDP peer 2 The period for retrying sending the TCP connection request to the remote MSDP peer of the local switch 7.5.2 Controlling the Sessions Between MSDP Peers After the connection between MSDP peers is closed, the MSDP peers no longer exchange SA messages and do not retry to set up a new connection. You can restart the connection between the MSDP peers as required. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 240 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration Context Do as follows on the switch on which the MSDP peer is created: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The MSDP view is displayed. Step 3 Run: shutdown peer-address A session with the remote MSDP peer is closed. The parameters of the command are explained as follows: l peer-address: specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer. l After the session with the remote MSDP peer is closed, the TCP connection is closed, the peers no longer transmit SA messages, and the peers do not re-try setting up the connection. The configuration, however, is saved. l You can run the undo shutdown peer-address command to open the session with the remote MSDP peer, and reestablish the TCP connection. ----End 7.5.3 Adjusting the interval for Retrying Setting up an MSDP Peer Connection When a new MSDP peer relationship is created, when a closed MSDP peer connection is restarted, or when a faulty MSDP peer tries recovering, a TCP connection needs to be immediately set up between the MSDP peers. You can flexibly adjust the interval for retrying to set up a TCP connection between MSDP peers. Context Do as follows on the switch on which the MSDP peer is created: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The MSDP view is displayed. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 241 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration Step 3 Run: timer retry interval The period for retrying sending the TCP connection request to the remote MSDP peer is set ----End 7.5.4 Checking the Configuration After a TCP connection is set up between MSDP peers, you can run related commands to check brief and detailed information about MSDP peers. Procedure l Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] brief command to check the brief information about the statuses of all remote peers that establish MSDP peer relationships with the local host. l Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] peer-status [ peer-address ] to check the detailed information about the statuses of the specified remote peers that establish the MSDP peer relationships with the local host. ----End Example <Quidway> display msdp brief MSDP Peer Brief Information of VPN-Instance: public net Configured Up Listen Connect Shutdown 2 2 0 0 0 Peer's Address 192.168.2.1 192.168.4.2 State UP UP Up/Down time 01:07:08 00:06:39 AS 200 100 SA Count 8 13 Down 0 Reset Count 0 0 7.6 Configuring SA Cache An SA cache is used to save the (S, G) information carried in SA messages locally. When a device needs to receive multicast data, it directly obtains available (S, G) information from the SA cache. 7.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After PIM-SM inter-domain multicast or anycast RP in a PIM-SM domain is configured, you can configure an SA cache as required. Applicable Environment By default, SA Cache is enabled on switchs on which MSDP peers are configured. The switchs can locally store the (S, G) information carried in SA messages. When the switchs need to receive (S, G) information, the switchs can obtain the (S, G) information from the SA Cache. Setting the maximum number of (S, G) entries can prevent the Denial of Service (DoS) attack. Users can disable the SA Cache of a switch. After the SA Cache of a switch is disabled, the switch does not locally store the (S, G) information carried in SA messages. When a switch wants to receive (S, G) data, it needs to waits for the SA message to be sent by its MSDP peer in the next period. This delays receivers from obtaining multicast data. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 242 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring SA Cache, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol to implement interconnection at the network layer l Enabling IP multicast l Configuring a PIM-SM domain to implement intra-domain multicast l Configuring PIM-SM Inter-domain Multicast or Configuring an Anycast RP in a PIM-SM Domain Data Preparation To configure SA Cache, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Maximum number of (S, G) entries in the SA Cache 7.6.2 Configuring the Maximum Number of (S, G) Entries in the Cache Setting the maximum number of (S, G) entries in an SA cache can prevent DoS attacks. Context Do as follows on the switch on which the MSDP peer is configured: NOTE If the configuration is not done, default values are used. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The MSDP view is displayed. Step 3 Run: peer peer-address sa-cache-maximum sa-limit The maximum number of (S, G) entries is set. The parameters of the command are explained as follows: l peer-address: specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 243 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration l sa-limit: specifies the maximum number of cached (S, G) entries. The value of configuration is valid when it is less than the specification of cache. Contrarily, specification of cache is valid. ----End 7.6.3 Disabling the SA Cache Function You are allowed to disable the SA cache function. Then, when a device wants to receive multicast data, it needs to wait for the SA message to be sent by its MSDP peer in the next period. This results in a delay in obtaining multicast data. Context Do as follows on the switch on which the MSDP peer is configured: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The MSDP view is displayed. Step 3 Run: undo cache-sa-enable The SA Cache function is disabled. NOTE To reenable SA Cache, run the cache-sa-enable command in the MSDP view. ----End 7.6.4 Checking the Configuration After the SA cache function is configured, you can run related commands to check the information about entries in the SA cache. Procedure l Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] sa-cache [ groupaddress | source-address | [ 2-byte-as-number | 4-byte-as-number ] ] * command to check (S, G) entries in the SA Cache of the public network instance, VPN instance or all instances. l Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] sa-count [ 2byte-as-number | 4-byte-as-number ] command to check the number of (S, G) entries in the SA Cache of the public network instance, VPN instance or all instances. ----End Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 244 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration Example Run the display msdp sa-cache command to check (S, G) entries in SA Cache. <Quidway> display msdp sa-cache MSDP Source-Active Cache Information of VPN-Instance: public net MSDP Total Source-Active Cache - 3 entries MSDP matched 3 entries (8.8.8.8, 225.0.0.200) Origin RP: 4.4.4.4 Pro: BGP, AS: 10 Uptime: 00:00:33, Expires: 00:05:27 (8.8.8.8, 225.0.0.201) Origin RP: 4.4.4.4 Pro: BGP, AS: 1.0 Uptime: 00:00:33, Expires: 00:05:27 (8.8.8.8, 225.0.0.202) Origin RP: 4.4.4.4 Pro: BGP, AS: 65535.65535 Uptime: 00:00:33, Expires: 00:05:27 Run the display msdp sa-count command to check the number of (S, G) entries in SA Cache. <Quidway> display msdp sa-count MSDP Source-Active Count Information of VPN-Instance: public net Number of cached Source-Active entries, counted by Peer Peer's Address Number of SA 10.10.10.10 5 Number of source and group, counted by AS AS Number of source Number of group ? 3 3 Total 5 Source-Active entries matched 7.7 Configuring the SA Request If the capacity of the SA cache enabled on the remote MSDP peer is too large, configuring "sending SA Request message" on the local device can shorten the time taken by a receiver to obtain multicast source information. You can configure filtering rules for receiving SA Request messages on a specified remote MSDP peer. 7.7.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After PIM-SM inter-domain multicast or anycast RP in a PIM-SM domain is configured, you can configure "SA Request message sending" as required. Applicable Environment The capacity of SA Cache on certain switchs is small. When these switchs need to receive multicast data, they cannot immediately obtain the valid (S, G) information and need to wait for the SA message sent by their MSDP peers in the next period. If SA Cache is enabled on the remote MSDP peer and the capacity of the SA Cache is large, configuring "sending SA Request message" on the local switch can shorten the period during which receivers obtain multicast source information. l When the local switch wants to receive (S, G) information, it sends an SA Request message to a specified remote MSDP peer. l Once receiving the SA Request message, the MSDP peer responds to the SA Request message with the required (S, G) information. If the "filtering rule of SA Request message" Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 245 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration is configured on the remote MSDP peer, it checks the SA Request messages received from a specified peers and determines whether to respond according to the checking results. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring an SA request, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol to implement interconnection at the network layer l Enabling IP multicast l Configuring a PIM-SM domain to implement intra-domain multicast l Configuring PIM-SM Inter-domain Multicast or Configuring an Anycast RP in a PIM-SM Domain Data Preparation To configure an SA request, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Address of a remote MSDP peer 2 Filtering list for receiving SA request messages 7.7.2 Configuring "Sending SA Request Messages" on the Local switch When a device receives a new Join message and no corresponding (S, G) entry exists locally or in the SA cache, the device immediately sends an SA Request message to the specified MSDP peer rather than waits for the SA message in the next period. Context Do as follows on the local switch: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The MSDP view is displayed. Step 3 Run: peer peer-address request-sa-enable Sending SA Request message is configured. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 246 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration peer-address specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer. When the local switch receives a new Join message from a group, it sends an SA Request message only to peer-address. ----End 7.7.3 (Optional) Configuring the Filtering Rules for Receiving SA Request Messages You can configure rules for filtering the SA Request messages received from the local device on a specified remote MSDP peer. If the SA Request message passes the filtering, the peer immediately responds. Context Do as follows on the remote MSDP peer specified by using the peer peer-address request-saenable command. If the configuration is not done, once an SA message reaches, the switch immediately responds to it with an SA message containing the required (S, G) information. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The MSDP view is displayed. Step 3 Run: peer peer-address sa-request-policy [ acl { basic-acl-number | acl-name } ] The filtering rules for receiving SA Request messages are set. l peer-address: specifies the address of an MSDP peer that sends the SA Request message. l acl: specifies the filtering policy. If the ACL is not specified, all SA messages sent by a peer are ignored. If the ACL is specified, only the SA messages that match the ACL are received and other SA messages are discarded. ----End 7.7.4 Check the Configuration After "SA Request message sending" is configured, you can run related commands to check detailed information about MSDP peers and SA cache information. Procedure l Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] peer-status [ peer-address ] command to check detailed information about the MSDP peer status. l Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] sa-cache [ groupaddress | source-address | [ 2-byte-as-number | 4-byte-as-number ] ] * command to check SA Cache of the public network instance, VPN instance, or all instances. ----End Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 247 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration Example Run the display msdp peer-status [ peer-address ] command, and you can view the SARequests field and check whether the configuration is valid. For example: <Quidway> display msdp peer-status MSDP Peer 172.40.41.1, AS ? Description: Information about connection status: State: Up Up/down time: 00:26:41 Resets: 0 Connection interface: Vlanif10 (172.40.41.2) Number of sent/received messages: 27/28 Number of discarded output messages: 0 Elapsed time since last connection or counters clear: 00:26:56 Information about (Source, Group)-based SA filtering policy: Import policy: none Export policy: none Information about SA-Requests: Policy to accept SA-Request messages: 2000 Sending SA-Requests status: enable Minimum TTL to forward SA with encapsulated data: 0 SAs learned from this peer: 0, SA Cache maximum for the peer: none Input queue size: 0, Output queue size: 0 Counters for MSDP message: Count of RPF check failure: 0 Incoming/outgoing SA messages: 16/0 Incoming/outgoing SA requests: 0/0 Incoming/outgoing SA responses: 0/0 Incoming/outgoing data packets: 0/0 Peer authentication: configured Peer authentication type: Key-Chain 7.8 Transmitting Burst Multicast Data Between Domains By default, an SA message carries only (S, G) information. Then, if burst multicast data need be transmitted between domains, you can configure multicast data encapsulation for an SA message on the source RP. In addition, you can set the TTL threshold to limit the transmission scope of multicast data encapsulated in an SA message. 7.8.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After PIM-SM inter-domain multicast or anycast RP in a PIM-SM domain is configured, you can configure the transmission of burst multicast data between domains as required. Applicable Environment The time during which certain multicast sources send multicast data is long, and is longer than the timeout of an (S, G) entry. In this case, the source DR encapsulates multicast data packets in Register messages one by one, and sends the messages to the source RP. The source RP then uses SA messages to forward (S, G) entries to the remote RP. The remote RP then sends a Join message to the source DR. An SPT is thus set up. Because of the timeout of the (S, G) entry, remote users cannot receive multicast data sent by S. After the function of encapsulating a multicast packet in an SA message is enabled on the source RP, the source RP encapsulates multicast data in SA messages and sends them out. After receiving an SA message, a remote RP decapsulates the message and forwards the multicast data to users in the domain along the RPT. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 248 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration Setting the TTL threshold can limit the transmission scope of a multicast packet contained in an SA message. After receiving an SA message containing a multicast packet, an MSDP peer checks the TTL value in the IP header of the multicast packet. If the TTL value is smaller than or equal to the threshold, the MSDP peer does not forward the SA message to a specific remote peers. If the TTL value is greater than the threshold, the MSDP peer reduces the TTL value in the IP header of the multicast packet by 1, and then encapsulates the multicast packet in an SA message and sends it out. Pre-configuration Tasks Before transmitting burst multicast data between domains, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol to implement interconnection at the network layer l Enabling IP multicast l Configuring a PIM-SM domain to implement intra-domain multicast l Configuring PIM-SM Inter-domain Multicast or Configuring an Anycast RP in a PIM-SM Domain Data Preparation To transmit burst multicast data between domains, you need the following data. No. Data 1 TTL threshold for forwarding an SA message containing a multicast data packet 2 Address of a remote MSDP peer 7.8.2 Encapsulating a Multicast Data Packet in an SA message By default, an SA message contains only (S, G) information, with no multicast data packets encapsulated. You can configure multicast data encapsulation for an SA message on the source RP configured with an MSDP peer. Context Do as follows on the source RP configured with an MSDP peer: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The MSDP view is displayed. Step 3 Run: encap-data-enable Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 249 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration A multicast data packet is encapsulated in an SA message. By default, the SA message contains only (S, G) information, and does not contain a multicast data packet. ----End 7.8.3 (Optional) Setting the TTL Threshold for Forwarding an SA Message Containing a Multicast Data Packet After receiving an SA massage encapsulated with a multicast data packet, an MSDP peer forwards the SA message to a specified remote MSDP peer only when the TTL value of the multicast packet is greater than the set threshold. Context Do as follows on the switch configured with an MSDP peer: NOTE If the configuration is not done, default values are used. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The MSDP view is displayed. Step 3 Run: peer peer-address minimum-ttl ttl The TTL threshold of a multicast data packet is set. After receiving an SA massage containing a multicast data packet, an MSDP peer forwards the SA message to a specified remote MSDP peers only when the TTL value of the multicast packet is greater than the threshold. The parameters of the command are explained as follows: l peer-address: specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer. l ttl: specifies the value of the TTL threshold. By default, the value is 0. ----End 7.8.4 Checking the Configuration After the transmission of burst multicast data is configured, you can run related commands to check detailed information about MSDP peers and SA cache information. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 250 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration Procedure l Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] sa-cache [ groupaddress | source-address | [ 2-byte-as-number | 4-byte-as-number ] ] * command to check SA Cache of the public network instance, VPN instance, or all instances. l Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] peer-status [ peer-address ] command to check detailed information about the MSDP peer status. ----End Example Run the display msdp peer-status [ peer-address ] command, and you can view the minimum TTL for forwarding an SA messages containing a data packet and check whether the configuration is valid. For example: <Quidway> display msdp peer-status MSDP Peer Information of VPN-Instance: public net MSDP Peer 172.40.41.1, AS ? Description: Information about connection status: State: Up Up/down time: 00:26:41 Resets: 0 Connection interface: Vlanif10 (172.40.41.2) Number of sent/received messages: 27/28 Number of discarded output messages: 0 Elapsed time since last connection or counters clear: 00:26:56 Information about (Source, Group)-based SA filtering policy: Import policy: none Export policy: none Information about SA-Requests: Policy to accept SA-Request messages: 2000 Sending SA-Requests status: enable Minimum TTL to forward SA with encapsulated data: 10 SAs learned from this peer: 0, SA Cache maximum for the peer: none Input queue size: 0, Output queue size: 0 Counters for MSDP message: Count of RPF check failure: 0 Incoming/outgoing SA messages: 16/0 Incoming/outgoing SA requests: 0/0 Incoming/outgoing SA responses: 0/0 Incoming/outgoing data packets: 0/0 Peer authentication: unconfigured Peer authentication type: none Run the display msdp sa-cache command to check the information about (S, G) entries in SA Cache. l If group-address is specified, the (S, G) entry to which a specified group corresponds is displayed. l If source-address is specified, the (S, G) entry to which a specified source corresponds is displayed. l If 2-byte-as-number or 4-byte-as-number is specified, the (S, G) entry whose Origin RP attribute belongs to a specified AS is displayed. <Quidway> display msdp sa-cache MSDP Source-Active Cache Information of VPN-Instance: public net MSDP Total Source-Active Cache - 3 entries MSDP matched 3 entries (8.8.8.8, 225.0.0.200) Origin RP: 4.4.4.4 Pro: BGP, AS: 10 Uptime: 00:00:33, Expires: 00:05:27 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 251 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration (8.8.8.8, 225.0.0.201) Origin RP: 4.4.4.4 Pro: BGP, AS: 1.0 Uptime: 00:00:33, Expires: 00:05:27 (8.8.8.8, 225.0.0.202) Origin RP: 4.4.4.4 Pro: BGP, AS: 65535.65535 Uptime: 00:00:33, Expires: 00:05:27 7.9 Configuring the Filtering Rules for SA Messages By default, a device receives all SA messages that pass the RPF check, and forwards the SA messages to all MSDP peers. To control the transmission of SA messages among MSDP peers, you can configure rules to filter the constructing, receiving, and forwarding SA messages. 7.9.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After PIM-SM inter-domain multicast or anycast RP in a PIM-SM domain is configured, you can configure filtering rules for SA messages. Applicable Environment By default, MSDP switchs receive all SA messages that pass the RPF check and forward them to all MSDP peers. To control of the transmission of SA messages among MSDP peers, users can configure various filtering rules by using the following methods: l Setting the rules for filtering the multicast source of an SA message on the source RP. The source RP filters active multicast sources that register with the local switch, and determines the (S, G) entries to be sent according to the rules. l Setting the rules for filtering an SA message received from a remote MSDP peer. When an SA message sent by a remote MSDP peer reaches a switch, the switch determines whether to receive the message based on the rules. l Setting the rules for filtering an SA message forwarded to a remote MSDP peer. Before forwarding the SA message to the remote MSDP peer, the switch determines whether to forward it based on the rules. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring the filtering rules for SA messages, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol to implement interconnection at the network layer l Enabling IP multicast l Configuring a PIM-SM domain to implement intra-domain multicast l Configuring PIM-SM Inter-domain Multicast or Configuring an Anycast RP in a PIM-SM Domain Data Preparation To configure the filtering rules for SA messages, you need the following data. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 252 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration No. Data 1 Filtering list for creating SA messages 2 Filtering list for receiving SA messages 3 Filtering list for forwarding SA messages 4 Address of a remote MSDP peer 7.9.2 Setting Rules for Creating an SA Message You can set rules for filtering the multicast source of an SA message on the source RP. The source RP then filters locally registered and active multicast sources, and determines which (S, G) information need be advertised based on the set rules. Context Do as follows on the source RP configured with an MSDP peer: NOTE If the configuration is not done, an SA message created by the source RP contains the information of all local active sources. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The MSDP view is displayed. Step 3 Run: import-source [ acl { acl-number | acl-name } ] The rules for filtering the multicast source of an SA message are set. The parameters of the command are explained as follows: l acl: specifies the filtering list based on multicast sources. The SA message created by an MSDP peer contains the local source information that match the filtering rules. The MSDP peer can thus control the local (S, G) information. l If the import-source command with acl is used, the SA message does not advertise any information about the local active source. ----End Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 253 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration 7.9.3 Setting Rules for Receiving an SA Message You can set the rules for filtering the received SA messages on a specified remote MSDP peer. When SA messages sent by a remote MSDP peer reach the local device, the local device determines whether to accept the messages based on the set rules. Context Do as follows on the switch configured with MSDP: NOTE If the configuration is not done, the switch receives all SA messages that pass the RPF check. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The MSDP view is displayed. Step 3 Run: peer peer-address sa-policy import [ acl { { advanced-acl-number | acl-name } ] The rules for filtering an SA message received from a remote MSDP peer are set. The parameters of the command are explained as follows: l peer-address: specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer. l acl: specifies the advanced filtering list. Only the (S, G) information that passes the filtering of the ACL is received. The (S, G) information is contained in an SA message sent by the peer specified by peer-address . l If the peer peer-address sa-policy import command without acl is used, the switch does not receive any (S, G) information from the peer specified by peer-address. ----End 7.9.4 Setting Rules for Forwarding an SA Message You can set the rules for filtering the SA messages to be forwarded to a remote MSDP peer on a local device. The local device then determines whether to forward the received SA messages based on the set rules. Context Do as follows on the switch enabled with MSDP: NOTE If the configuration is not done, the switch forwards all SA messages that pass the RPF check. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 254 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The MSDP view is displayed. Step 3 Run: peer peer-address sa-policy export [ acl advanced-acl-number ] The rules for filtering an SA message forwarded to a remote MSDP peer is set. The parameters of the command are explained as follows: l peer-address: specifies the address of a remote MSDP peer. l acl: specifies the advanced filtering list. Only the (S, G) information that matches the ACL rule is forwarded to the peer specified by peer-address. l If the peer peer-address sa-policy export command without acl is used, the switch does not forward any (S, G) information to the peer specified by peer-address. ----End 7.9.5 Checking the Configuration After filtering rules for SA messages are configured, you can run related commands to check detailed information about MSDP peers and SA cache information. Procedure l Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] sa-cache [ groupaddress | source-address | [ 2-byte-as-number | 4-byte-as-number ] ] * command to check SA Cache of the public network instance, VPN instance, or all instances. l Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] peer-status [ peer-address ] command to check detailed information about the MSDP peer status. ----End Example Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] peer-status [ peeraddress ] command, and you can view information about the (Source, Group)-based SA filtering policy field and check whether the configuration is valid. For example: <Quidway> display msdp peer-status MSDP Peer 172.40.41.1, AS ? Description: Information about connection status: State: Up Up/down time: 00:26:41 Resets: 0 Connection interface: Vlanif10 (172.40.41.2) Number of sent/received messages: 27/28 Number of discarded output messages: 0 Elapsed time since last connection or counters clear: 00:26:56 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 255 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration Information about (Source, Group)-based SA filtering policy: Import policy: 3000 Export policy: 3002 Information about SA-Requests: Policy to accept SA-Request messages: 2000 Sending SA-Requests status: enable Minimum TTL to forward SA with encapsulated data: 10 SAs learned from this peer: 0, SA Cache maximum for the peer: none Input queue size: 0, Output queue size: 0 Counters for MSDP message: Count of RPF check failure: 0 Incoming/outgoing SA messages: 16/0 Incoming/outgoing SA requests: 0/0 Incoming/outgoing SA responses: 0/0 Incoming/outgoing data packets: 0/0 Peer authentication: unconfigured Peer authentication type: none Run the display msdp sa-cache command to check the information about (S, G) entries in SA Cache. l If group-address is specified, the (S, G) entry to which a specified group corresponds is displayed. l If source-address is specified, the (S, G) entry to which a specified source corresponds is displayed. l If 2-byte-as-number or 4-byte-as-number is specified, the (S, G) entry whose Origin RP attribute belongs to a specified AS is displayed. <Quidway> display msdp sa-cache MSDP Source-Active Cache Information of VPN-Instance: public net MSDP Total Source-Active Cache - 3 entries MSDP matched 3 entries (8.8.8.8, 225.0.0.200) Origin RP: 4.4.4.4 Pro: BGP, AS: 10 Uptime: 00:00:33, Expires: 00:05:27 (8.8.8.8, 225.0.0.201) Origin RP: 4.4.4.4 Pro: BGP, AS: 1.0 Uptime: 00:00:33, Expires: 00:05:27 (8.8.8.8, 225.0.0.202) Origin RP: 4.4.4.4 Pro: BGP, AS: 65535.65535 Uptime: 00:00:33, Expires: 00:05:27 7.10 Configuring MSDP Authentication MSDP peer authentication contains MSDP MD5 authentication and Key-Chain authentication. You can choose either authentication mode. 7.10.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After Anycast RP is configured for PIM-SM intra-domain or inter-domain multicast, you can configure MSDP authentication as required to ensure the security of the TCP connection between MSDP peers. Applicable Environment Configuring MSDP authentication can enhance the security of the TCP connections between MSDP peers. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 256 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring MSDP authentication, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol to implement intra-domain IP interworking l Enabling IP multicast l Configuring PIM-SM domains to implement intra-domain multicast l Configuring PIM-SM Inter-domain Multicast or Configuring an Anycast RP in a PIM-SM Domain Data Preparation Before configuring MSDP authentication, prepare the following data: No. Data 1 IP address of the peer to be configured with MSDP authentication 2 Password for MSDP MD5 authentication 3 Key-Chain name for MSDP Key-Chain authentication 7.10.2 Configuring MSDP MD5 Authentication The MSDP peers must be configured with the same authentication password; otherwise, the TCP connection cannot be set up between MSDP peers and MSDP messages cannot be transmitted. The authentication password on peers can be in different forms, that is, the password on one end can be in the cipher text while the password on the peer can be in the plain text. Context By default, MSDP MD5 authentication is not configured. Do as follows on the switch configured with MSDP peers: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The MSDP view is displayed. Step 3 Run: peer peer-address password { cipher cipher-password | simple simple-password } MSDP MD5 authentication is configured. The MSDP MD5 authentication password is case sensitive and cannot contain any space. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 257 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration The MSDP peers must be configured with the same authentication password; otherwise, the TCP connection cannot be set up between MSDP peers and MSDP messages cannot be transmitted. The authentication password on peers can be in different forms, that is, the password on one end can be in the cipher text while the password on the peer can be in the plain text. NOTE MSDP MD5 authentication and MSDP Key-Chain authentication are mutually exclusive. Characters ^#^# and $@$@ are used to identify passwords with variable lengths. Characters ^#^# are the prefix and suffix of a new password, and characters $@$@ are the prefix and suffix of an old password. Neither of them can be both configured at the beginning and end of a plain text password. ----End 7.10.3 Configuring MSDP Key-Chain Authentication You must configure Key-Chain authentication on both MSDP peers. Encryption algorithms and passwords configured for Key-Chain authentication on both peers must be the same; otherwise, the TCP connection cannot be set up between MSDP peers and MSDP messages cannot be transmitted. Context By default, MSDP Key-Chain authentication is not configured. Do as follows on the switch configured with MSDP peers: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The MSDP view is displayed. Step 3 Run: peer peer-address keychain keychain-name MSDP Key-Chain authentication is configured. You must configure Key-Chain authentication on both MSDP peers. Encryption algorithms and passwords configured for Key-Chain authentication on both peers must be the same; otherwise, the TCP connection cannot be set up between MSDP peers and MSDP messages cannot be transmitted. Before configuring MSDP Key-Chain authentication, configure a Key-Chain in accordance with the configured keychain-name; otherwise, the TCP connection cannot be set up. NOTE MSDP MD5 authentication and MSDP Key-Chain authentication are mutually exclusive. ----End Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 258 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration 7.10.4 Checking the Configuration After MSDP authentication is configured, you can run related commands to check brief and detailed information about MSDP peers. Procedure l Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] brief command to check brief information about MSDP peers. l Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] peer-status [ peer-address ] command to check detailed information about MSDP peers. ----End Example Run the display msdp peer-status [ peer-address ] command, and you can find the Peer authentication and Peer authentication type fields in the command output. For example: <Quidway> display msdp peer-status MSDP Peer 172.40.41.1, AS ? Description: Information about connection status: State: Up Up/down time: 00:26:41 Resets: 0 Connection interface: Vlanif10 (172.40.41.2) Number of sent/received messages: 27/28 Number of discarded output messages: 0 Elapsed time since last connection or counters clear: 00:26:56 Information about (Source, Group)-based SA filtering policy: Import policy: 3000 Export policy: 3002 Information about SA-Requests: Policy to accept SA-Request messages: 2000 Sending SA-Requests status: enable Minimum TTL to forward SA with encapsulated data: 10 SAs learned from this peer: 0, SA-cache maximum for the peer: none Input queue size: 0, Output queue size: 0 Counters for MSDP message: Count of RPF check failure: 0 Incoming/outgoing SA messages: 16/0 Incoming/outgoing SA requests: 0/0 Incoming/outgoing SA responses: 0/0 Incoming/outgoing data packets: 0/0 Peer authentication: configured Peer authentication type: KeyChain 7.11 Maintaining MSDP Maintaining MSDP involves clearing MSDP peer statistics and (S, G) information in the SA cache, and monitoring MSDP running status. 7.11.1 Clearing Statistics of MSDP Peers When clear MSDP peer statistics, you can choose whether to reset the TCP connection between MSDP peers. Note that MSDP peer statistics cannot be restored after you clear them. Resetting the TCP connection will affect the running of MSDP. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 259 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration Context CAUTION The statistics of MSDP peers cannot be restored after you clear it. So, confirm the action before you use the command. Procedure l Run the reset msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] peer [ peeraddress ] command in the user view to clear the TCP connection with a specified MSDP peer and all statistics of the specified MSDP peer. l Run the reset msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] statistics [ peeraddress ] command in the user view to clear the statistics of an MSDP peer or multiple MSDP peers of the public network instance, VPN instance, or all instances, if MSDP peers are not reset. l Run the reset msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] control-message counters [ peer peer-address ] command in the user view to clear the statistics about the received, sent, and discarded MSDP messages. ----End 7.11.2 Clearing (S, G) Information in SA Cache When you want to reset contents in an SA cache, you can clear all (S, G) information from the SA cache. Note that the (S, G) information cannot be restored after you clear it. Context CAUTION The (S, G) information in SA Cache cannot be restored after you clear it. So, confirm the action before you use the command. Procedure l Run the reset msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] sa-cache [ groupaddress ] command in the user view to clear the entries in MSDP SA Cache. ----End 7.11.3 Monitoring the Running Status of MSDP During the routine maintenance, you can run the display commands in any view to know the running of MSDP. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 260 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration Context In routine maintenance, you can run the following commands in any view to check the running status of MSDP. Procedure l Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] brief [ state { connect | down | listen | shutdown | up } ] command in any view to check brief information about the MSDP peer status. l Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] peer-status [ peer-address ] command in any view to check detailed information about the status of an MSDP peer of the public network instance, VPN instance, or all instances. l Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] sa-cache [ groupaddress | source-address | { 2-byte-as-number | 4-byte-as-number } ] * command in any view to check the (S, G) information in SA Cache. l Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] sa-count [ 2byte-as-number | 4-byte-as-number ] command in any view to check the number of (S, G) entries in MSDP Cache. l Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] controlmessage counters [ peer peer-address | message-type { source-active | sa-request | saresponse | keepalive | notification | traceroute-request | traceroute-reply | datapackets | unknown-type } ] * command in any view to check statistics about the received, sent, and discarded MSDP messages. l Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] invalid-packet [ peer peer-address | message-type { keepalive | notification | sa-request | sa-response | source-active } ] * command in any view to check the statistics about invalid MSDP messages received by a device. l Run the display msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] rpf-peer original-rp original-rp-address command in any view to check information about all the RPF peers of a specific source's RP address, including RPF peer selection rules and RPF route types. ----End 7.11.4 Debugging MSDP When a fault occurs during the running of MSDP, run the debugging commands in the user view and check the contents of sent and received packets for fault location. Context CAUTION Debugging affects the performance of the system. So, after debugging, execute the undo debugging all command to disable it immediately. When an MSDP fault occurs, run the following debugging commands in the user view to debug MSDP and locate the fault. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 261 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration Procedure l Run the debugging msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] all command in the user view to enable all the debugging of MSDP. l Run the debugging msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] connect command in the user view to enable the debugging of the resetting of the MSDP peer connection. l Run the debugging msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] event command in the user view to enable the debugging of MSDP events. l Run the debugging msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] packet command in the user view to enable the debugging of MSDP packets. l Run the debugging msdp [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] sourceactive command in the user view to enable the debugging of MSDP active sources. ----End 7.12 Configuration Examples Configuration examples are provided to show how to implement PIM-SM inter-domain multicast through MBGP, how to implement inter-AS multicast through static RPF peers, and how to configure anycast RP in a PIM-SM domain. 7.12.1 Example for Configuring Basic MSDP Functions Networking Requirements As shown in Figure 7-1, two ASs exist on the network. Each AS contains one or more PIM-SM domains; each PIM-SM domain has 0 or 1 multicast source and receiver. The receivers in PIMSM2 need to receive the multicast data sent by S3 in the PIM-SM3 domain and multicast data sent by S1 in the PIM-SM1 domain. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 262 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration Figure 7-1 Networking diagram for configuring basic MSDP functions AS200 AS100 Loopback0 1.1.1.1/32 SwitchA GE2/0/0 GE2/0/0 GE1/0/0 PIM-SM1 Loopback0 2.2.2.2/32 GE1/0/0 GE1/0/0 SwitchB PIM-SM2 SwitchC GE1/0/0 GE2/0/0 GE2/0/0 SwitchD GE3/0/0 GE3/0/0 S1 Receiver SwitchF GE2/0/0 GE2/0/0 GE1/0/0 SwitchE PIM-SM3 Loopback0 3.3.3.3/32 S3 MSDP peer Switch Physical interface VLANIF interface/Logical interface IP address SwitchA GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 101 10.110.1.1/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 100 192.168.1.1/24 GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 200 192.168.2.1/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 100 192.168.1.2/24 Loopback0 1.1.1.1/32 GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 200 192.168.2.2/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 300 192.168.3.1/24 GE 3/0/0 VLANIF 400 192.168.4.1/24 SwitchB SwitchC SwitchD SwitchE SwitchF Loopback0 2.2.2.2/32 GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 102 10.110.2.1/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 300 192.168.3.2/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 500 192.168.5.1/24 GE 3/0/0 VLANIF 400 192.168.4.2/24 Loopback0 3.3.3.3/32 GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 103 10.110.3.1/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 500 192.168.5.2/24 Configuration Roadmap The configuration roadmap is as follows: 1. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Configure the IP addresses of the interfaces on each Switch and configure OSPF in the AS to ensure that the unicast routes within the AS are reachable. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 263 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration 2. Configure EBGP peers and import BGP and OSPF routes into each other's routing table to ensure that the unicast routes between ASs are reachable. 3. Enable multicast and PIM-SM on each interface, configure the boundary domain, and enable the IGMP function on the interfaces connected to hosts. 4. Configure the C-BSR and C-RP. Configure the RPs of PIM-SM1 and PIM-SM2 on the ASBR. 5. Establish MSDP peer relationship between RPs of each domain. The MSDP peers and the EBGP peers between ASs use the same interface addresses. According to the RPF rule, the Switches receive SA messages from the next hop toward the source RP. Data Preparation To complete the configuration, you need the following data: l Address of multicast group G: 225.1.1.1/24 l Number of the AS that SwitchA and SwitchB belong to, namely 100, and router ID of SwitchB, namely, 1.1.1.1 l Number of the AS that SwitchC and SwitchD belong to, namely 200, and Router ID of SwitchC, namely, 2.2.2.2 l Number of the AS that SwitchE and SwitchF belong to, namely 200 NOTE This configuration example describes only the commands related to MSDP configuration. Procedure Step 1 Configure the IP addresses of interfaces and the unicast routing protocol. # According to Figure 7-1, configure IP addresses and masks for the interfaces on each Switch. Configure the OSPF protocol between Switches. Ensure the communication on the network layer within an AS. Ensure the dynamic route update between Switches through unicast routing protocol. The configuration procedure is not provided here. Step 2 Configure EBGP peer relationship between ASs and import routes of BGP and OSPF into each other's routing table. # Configure EBGP on SwitchB and import OSPF routes. [SwitchB] bgp [SwitchB-bgp] [SwitchB-bgp] [SwitchB-bgp] [SwitchB-bgp] 100 router-id 1.1.1.1 peer 192.168.2.2 as-number 200 import-route ospf 1 quit # Configure EBGP on SwitchC and import OSPF routes. [SwitchC] bgp [SwitchC-bgp] [SwitchC-bgp] [SwitchC-bgp] [SwitchC-bgp] 200 router-id 2.2.2.2 peer 192.168.2.1 as-number 100 import-route ospf 1 quit # Import BGP routes to OSPF on SwitchB. The configuration on SwitchC is similar to the configuration on SwitchB, and is not provided here. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 264 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration [SwitchB] ospf 1 [SwitchB-ospf-1] import-route bgp [SwitchB-ospf-1] quit Step 3 Enable multicast, enable PIM-SM on all interfaces, configure the domain boundary, and enable IGMP on the interface connecting to the host. # Enable multicast on SwitchB and enable PIM-SM on each interface. The configurations of other Switches are similar to the configuration of SwitchB, and are not provided here. [SwitchB] multicast [SwitchB] interface [SwitchB-Vlanif100] [SwitchB-Vlanif100] [SwitchB] interface [SwitchB-Vlanif200] routing-enable vlanif 100 pim sm quit vlanif 200 pim sm # Configure the domain boundary on VLANIF 100 of SwitchB. [SwitchB-Vlanif100] pim bsr-boundary [SwitchB-Vlanif100] quit # Configure the domain boundary on VLANIF 200 and VLANIF 400 of SwitchC. Configure the service boundary of BSR on VLANIF 400 of SwitchE. The configuration on SwitchE is similar to the configuration on SwitchB, and is not provided here. # Enable IGMP on the interface connecting SwitchD to the leaf network. [SwitchD] interface vlanif 102 [SwitchD-Vlanif102] igmp enable Step 4 Configure the C-BSR and C-RP. # Create Loopback0, and then configure a C-BSR, and a C-RP on Loopback0 on SwitchB. The configurations of SwitchC and SwitchE are similar to the configuration of SwitchB, and are not provided here. [SwitchB] interface loopback 0 [SwitchB-LoopBack0] ip address 1.1.1.1 255.255.255.255 [SwitchB-LoopBack0] pim sm [SwitchB-LoopBack0] quit [SwitchB] pim [SwitchB-pim] c-bsr loopback 0 [SwitchB-pim] c-rp loopback 0 [SwitchB-pim] quit Step 5 Configure MSDP peer relations. # Configure the MSDP peer relationship on SwitchB. [SwitchB] msdp [SwitchB-msdp] peer 192.168.2.2 connect-interface vlanif200 [SwitchB-msdp] quit # Configure the MSDP peer relationship on SwitchC. [SwitchC] msdp [SwitchC-msdp] peer 192.168.2.1 connect-interface vlanif200 [SwitchC-msdp] peer 192.168.4.2 connect-interface vlanif400 [SwitchC-msdp] quit # Configure the MSDP peer relationship on SwitchE. [SwitchE] msdp [SwitchE-msdp] peer 192.168.4.1 connect-interface vlanif400 [SwitchE-msdp] quit Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 265 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration Step 6 Verify the configuration. # Run the display bgp peer command to view the BGP peer relationship between Switches. For example, the following information shows the BGP peer relationship on SwitchB and SwitchC: <SwitchB> display bgp peer BGP local router ID : 1.1.1.1 Local AS number : 100 Total number of peers : 1 Peer PrefRcv 192.168.2.2 V AS 4 200 Peers in established state : 1 MsgRcvd MsgSent 24 21 OutQ 0 Up/Down State 00:13:09 Established 6 <SwitchC> display bgp peer BGP local router ID : 2.2.2.2 Local AS number : 200 Total number of peers : 1 Peer PrefRcv 192.168.2.1 Peers in established state : 1 V AS MsgRcvd MsgSent OutQ Up/Down State 4 100 18 16 0 00:12:04 Established 1 # Run the display bgp routing-table command to view the BGP routing table on a Switch. For example, the BGP routing table displayed on SwitchC is as follows: <SwitchC> display bgp routing-table BGP Local router ID is 2.2.2.2 Status codes: * - valid, > - best, d - damped, h - history, i - internal, s - suppressed, S - Stale Origin : i - IGP, e - EGP, ? - incomplete Total Number of Routes: 5 Network NextHop *> 1.1.1.1/32 192.168.2.1 *>i 2.2.2.2/32 0.0.0.0 *> 192.168.2.0 0.0.0.0 *> 192.168.2.1/32 0.0.0.0 *> 192.168.2.2/32 0.0.0.0 MED 0 0 0 0 0 LocPrf PrefVal 0 0 0 0 0 Path/Ogn 100? ? ? ? ? # Run the display msdp brief command to view the status of the MSDP peer relationship between Switches. The information about establishing MSDP peer relationship among SwitchB, SwitchC and SwitchE is as follows: <SwitchB> display msdp brief MSDP Peer Brief Information of VPN-Instance: public net Configured Up Listen Connect Shutdown 1 1 0 0 0 Peer's Address 192.168.2.2 State UP Up/Down time 00:12:27 AS 200 SA Count 13 Down 0 Reset Count 0 <SwitchC> display msdp brief MSDP Peer Brief Information of VPN-Instance: public net Configured Up Listen Connect Shutdown 2 2 0 0 0 Peer's Address 192.168.2.1 192.168.4.2 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) State UP UP Up/Down time 01:07:08 00:06:39 AS 100 200 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. SA Count 8 13 Down 0 Reset Count 0 0 266 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration <SwitchE> display msdp brief MSDP Peer Brief Information of VPN-Instance: public net Configured Up Listen Connect Shutdown 1 1 0 0 0 Peer's Address State Up/Down time AS SA Count 192.168.4.1 UP 00:15:32 200 8 Down 0 Reset Count 0 # Run the display msdp peer-status command to view the details about MSDP peer relations between Switches. The details displayed on SwitchB are as follows: <SwitchB> display msdp peer-status MSDP Peer Information of VPN-Instance: public net MSDP Peer 192.168.2.2, AS 200 Description: Information about connection status: State: Up Up/down time: 00:15:47 Resets: 0 Connection interface: vlanif200 (192.168.2.1) Number of sent/received messages: 16/16 Number of discarded output messages: 0 Elapsed time since last connection or counters clear: 00:17:51 Information about (Source, Group)-based SA filtering policy: Import policy: none Export policy: none Information about SA-Requests: Policy to accept SA-Request messages: none Sending SA-Requests status: disable Minimum TTL to forward SA with encapsulated data: 0 SAs learned from this peer: 0, SA-cache maximum for the peer: none Input queue size: 0, Output queue size: 0 Counters for MSDP message: Count of RPF check failure: 0 Incoming/outgoing SA messages: 0/0 Incoming/outgoing SA requests: 0/0 Incoming/outgoing SA responses: 0/0 Incoming/outgoing data packets: 0/0 Peer authentication: unconfigured Peer authentication type: none # Run the display pim routing-table command to view the PIM routing table on a Switch. When multicast sources S1 (10.110.1.2/24) in PIM-SM1 and S3 (10.110.3.2/24) in PIM-SM3 send multicast data to multicast group G (225.1.1.1/24), Receiver (10.110.2.2/24) in PIM-SM2 can receive the multicast data. The PIM routing tables displayed on SwitchB and SwitchC are as follows: <SwitchB> display pim routing-table VPN-Instance: public net Total 0 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry (10.110.1.2, 225.1.1.1) RP: 1.1.1.1(local) Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: SPT EXT ACT UpTime: 00:00:42 Upstream interface: vlanif100 Upstream neighbor: 192.168.1.1 RPF pirme neighbor: 192.168.1.1 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: vlanif200 Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 00:00:42, Expires:<SwitchC> display pim routing-table VPN-Instance: public net Total 1 (*, G) entry; 2 (S, G) entries Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 267 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration (*, 225.1.1.1) RP: 2.2.2.2(local) Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: WC RPT UpTime: 00:13:46 Upstream interface: NULL, Upstream neighbor: NULL RPF prime neighbor: NULL Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: vlanif300, Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 00:13:46, Expires:(10.110.1.2, 225.1.1.1) RP: 2.2.2.2 Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: SPT MSDP ACT UpTime: 00:00:42 Upstream interface: vlanif200 Upstream neighbor: 192.168.2.1 RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.2.1 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: vlanif300 Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 00:00:42, Expires:(10.110.3.2, 225.1.1.1) RP: 2.2.2.2 Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: SPT MSDP ACT UpTime: 00:00:42 Upstream interface: vlanif400 Upstream neighbor: 192.168.4.2 RPF prime neighbor: 192.168.4.2 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: vlanif300 Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 00:00:42, Expires:- ----End Configuration Files l Configuration file of SwitchA # sysname SwitchA # vlan batch 100 101 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif100 ip address 192.168.1.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface Vlanif101 ip address 10.110.1.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 101 port hybrid untagged vlan 101 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 100 port hybrid untagged vlan 100 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 192.168.1.0 0.0.0.255 network 10.110.1.0 0.0.0.255 # return Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 268 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast l 7 MSDP Configuration Configuration file of SwitchB # sysname SwitchB # vlan batch 100 200 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif100 ip address 192.168.1.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface Vlanif200 ip address 192.168.2.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm pim bsr-boundary # interface LoopBack0 ip address 1.1.1.1 255.255.255.255 pim sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 200 port hybrid untagged vlan 200 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 100 port hybrid untagged vlan 100 # bgp 100 router-id 1.1.1.1 peer 192.168.2.2 as-number 200 import-route ospf 1 # ospf 1 import-route bgp area 0.0.0.0 network 192.168.1.0 0.0.0.255 network 1.1.1.1 0.0.0.0 # pim c-bsr LoopBack0 c-rp LoopBack0 # msdp peer 192.168.2.2 connect-interface vlanif200 # return l Configuration file of SwitchC # sysname SwitchC # vlan batch 200 300 400 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif200 ip address 192.168.2.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm pim bsr-boundary # interface Vlanif300 ip address 192.168.3.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface Vlanif400 ip address 192.168.4.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 269 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration pim bsr-boundary # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 200 port hybrid untagged vlan 200 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 300 port hybrid untagged vlan 300 # interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 400 port hybrid untagged vlan 400 # interface LoopBack0 ip address 2.2.2.2 255.255.255.255 pim sm # bgp 200 router-id 2.2.2.2 peer 192.168.2.1 as-number 100 import-route ospf 1 # ospf 1 import-route bgp area 0.0.0.0 network 192.168.3.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.4.0 0.0.0.255 network 2.2.2.2 0.0.0.0 # pim c-bsr LoopBack0 c-rp LoopBack0 # msdp peer 192.168.2.1 connect-interface vlanif200 peer 192.168.4.2 connect-interface vlanif400 # return l Configuration file of SwitchD # sysname SwitchD # vlan batch 102 300 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif102 ip address 10.110.2.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm igmp enable # interface Vlanif300 ip address 192.168.3.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 102 port hybrid untagged vlan 102 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 300 port hybrid untagged vlan 200 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 192.168.3.0 0.0.0.255 network 10.110.2.0 0.0.0.255 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 270 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration # return l Configuration file of SwitchE # sysname SwitchE # vlan batch 400 500 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif400 ip address 192.168.4.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm pim bsr-boundary # interface Vlanif500 ip address 192.168.5.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 500 port hybrid untagged vlan 500 # interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 400 port hybrid untagged vlan 400 # interface LoopBack0 ip address 3.3.3.3 255.255.255.255 pim sm # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 192.168.4.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.5.0 0.0.0.255 network 3.3.3.3 0.0.0.0 # pim c-bsr LoopBack0 c-rp LoopBack0 # msdp peer 192.168.4.1 connect-interface vlanif400 # return l Configuration file of SwitchF # sysname SwitchF # vlan batch 103 500 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif103 ip address 10.110.3.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface Vlanif500 ip address 192.168.5.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 103 port hybrid untagged vlan 103 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 500 port hybrid untagged vlan 500 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 271 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 192.168.5.0 0.0.0.255 network 10.110.3.0 0.0.0.255 # return 7.12.2 Example for Configuring Inter-AS Multicast by Using Static RPF Peers Networking Requirements As shown in Figure 7-2, two ASs exist on the network. Each AS contains one or more PIM-SM domains; each PIM-SM domain has 0 or 1 multicast source and receiver. MSDP peers need to be set up between PIM-SM domains to share the information of the multicast source. Figure 7-2 Networking diagram for configuring inter-AS multicast by using static RPF peers AS100 AS200 SwitchE Loopback0 1.1.1.1/32 GE2/0/0 SwitchC GE2/0/0 GE1/0/0 GE1/0/0 SwitchB GE2/0/0 PIM-SM1 S1 GE2/0/0 GE3/0/0 GE1/0/0 SwitchA Loopback0 2.2.2.2/32 GE1/0/0 GE1/0/0 GE3/0/0 SwitchD PIM-SM2 Receiver 3.3.3.3/32 Loopback0 GE1/0/0 SwitchF Receiver SwitchG GE3/0/0 GE2/0/0 GE2/0/0 GE1/0/0 PIM-SM3 S2 BGP peers Switch Interface VLANIF interface IP address SwitchA GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 500 192.168.5.2/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 400 192.168.4.2/24 GE 3/0/0 VLANIF 101 10.110.1.1/24 GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 100 192.168.1.2/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 200 192.168.2.2/24 GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 100 192.168.1.1/24 SwitchB SwitchC Loopback0 GE 2/0/0 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) 1.1.1.1/32 VLANIF 400 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 192.168.4.1/24 272 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration Loopback0 2.2.2.2/32 SwitchD GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 300 192.168.3.2/24 SwitchE GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 300 192.168.3.1/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 200 192.168.2.1/24 GE 3/0/0 VLANIF 102 10.110.2.1/24 GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 500 192.168.5.1/24 SwitchF Loopback0 SwitchG 3.3.3.3/32 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 600 192.168.6.1/24 GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 103 10.110.3.1/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 600 192.168.6.2/24 GE 3/0/0 VLANIF 104 10.110.4.1/24 Configuration Roadmap Set up an MSDP peer on the RP in each PIM-SM domain. Establish the static RPF peer relationship between MSDP peers. In this way, the source information can be transmitted across domains without changing unicast topology. 1. Configure IP addresses for the interfaces on each Switch, configure OSPF in the AS, configure EBGP between ASs, and import BGP and OSPF routes into each other's routing table. 2. Enable multicast on all Switches and PIM-SM on all interfaces and enable IGMP on the interfaces at the user side. Configure Loopback0, C-BSR, and C-RP. The Loopback 0 interfaces on SwitchC, SwitchD, and SwitchF function as the C-BSR and the C-RP of each PIM-SM domain. 3. Establish MSDP peer relationship between RPs of each domain. Establish the MSDP peer relationship between SwitchC and SwitchD and establish the MSDP peer relationship between SwitchC and SwitchF. 4. Specify a static RPF peer for the MSDP peer. The static RPF peers of SwitchC are SwitchD and SwitchF. SwitchD and SwitchF have only one static RPF peer, namely, SwitchC. According to RPF rules, Switches receive SA messages from static RPF peers. Data Preparation To complete the configuration, you need the following data: l Number of the AS that SwitchA, SwitchB, and SwitchC belong to: 100 l Router IDs of SwitchA, SwitchB, and SwitchC: 1.1.1.3, 1.1.1.2 and 1.1.1.1 l Number of the AS that SwitchD and SwitchE belong to: 200 l Router IDs of SwitchD and SwitchE: 2.2.2.2 and 2.2.2.1 l Number of the AS that SwitchF and SwitchG belong to: 200 l Router ID of SwitchF: 3.3.3.3 l SwitchC uses the list-df policy to filter the SA messages from SwitchD and SwitchF. l SwitchD and SwitchF use the list-c policy to filter the SA messages from SwitchC. NOTE This configuration example describes only the commands used to configure static RPF peers. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 273 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration Procedure Step 1 Configure the IP addresses of interfaces and the unicast routing protocol # According to Figure 7-2, configure IP addresses and masks for the interfaces of each Switch. Configure OSPF in the AS. Configure EBGP between SwitchA and SwitchF, and between SwitchB and SwitchE. Import BGP and OSPF routes into each other's routing table. Ensure that the Switches can communicate with each other at the network layer. Ensure the dynamic route update between routers through the unicast routing protocol. The configuration procedure is not provided here. Step 2 Enable multicast on all Switches and PIM-SM on all interfaces, and enable the IGMP function on the interfaces connected to the hosts. In addition, configure the service boundary of BSR on the interfaces of Switches on the AS boundary. # Enable multicast all the Switches and enable PIM-SM on each interface. The configurations of other Switches are similar to configuration of SwitchC, and are not provided here. [SwitchC] multicast [SwitchC] interface [SwitchC-Vlanif100] [SwitchC-Vlanif100] [SwitchC] interface [SwitchC-Vlanif400] [SwitchC-Vlanif400] routing-enable vlanif 100 pim sm quit vlanif 400 pim sm quit # Configure the service boundary of BSR on VLANIF 500 of SwitchA, VLANIF 200 of SwitchB, VLANIF 200 of SwitchE, and VLANIF 500 of SwitchF. The configurations of SwitchB, SwitchE, and SwitchF are similar to configuration of SwitchA, and are not provided here. [SwitchA] interface vlanif 500 [SwitchA-Vlanif500] pim bsr-boundary [SwitchA-Vlanif500] quit Step 3 Configure Loopback0, C-BSR, and C-RP. # Configure loopback0, C-BSR, and C-RP on SwitchC, SwitchD, and SwitchF. The configurations of SwitchD and SwitchF are similar to the configuration of SwitchC, and are not provided here. [SwitchC] interface loopback 0 [SwitchC-LoopBack0] ip address 1.1.1.1 255.255.255.255 [SwitchC-LoopBack0] pim sm [SwitchC-LoopBack0] quit [SwitchC] pim [SwitchC-pim] c-bsr loopback 0 [SwitchC-pim] c-rp loopback 0 [SwitchC-pim] quit Step 4 Configure static RPF peers. # Configure SwitchD and SwitchF as the static RPF peers of SwitchC. [SwitchC] ip ip-prefix list-df permit 192.168.0.0 16 greater-equal 16 less-equal 32 [SwitchC] msdp [SwitchC-msdp] peer 192.168.3.2 connect-interface vlanif100 [SwitchC-msdp] peer 192.168.5.1 connect-interface vlanif400 [SwitchC-msdp] static-rpf-peer 192.168.3.2 rp-policy list-df [SwitchC-msdp] static-rpf-peer 192.168.5.1 rp-policy list-df [SwitchC-msdp] quit # Configure SwitchC as the static RPF peer of SwitchD and SwitchF. The configuration of SwitchF is similar to the configuration of SwitchD, and is not provided here. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 274 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration [SwitchD] ip ip-prefix list-c permit 192.168.0.0 16 greater-equal 16 less-equal 32 [SwitchD] msdp [SwitchD-msdp] peer 192.168.1.1 connect-interface vlanif300 [SwitchD-msdp] static-rpf-peer 192.168.1.1 rp-policy list-c Step 5 Verify the configuration. # Run the display bgp peer command to view the status of the BGP peer relationship between Switches. No output information is displayed on SwitchC, which indicates that no BGP peer relationship is set up between SwitchC and SwitchD, and between SwitchC and SwitchF. # Run the display msdp brief command to view the status of the MSDP peer relationship between Switches. When multicast source S1 in the PIM-SM1 domain sends multicast packets, the receivers in the PIM-SM2 and PIM-SM3 domains can receive the packets. For example, the displayed information of MSDP peers on SwitchC, SwitchD and SwitchF is as follows: <SwitchC> display msdp brief MSDP Peer Brief Information of VPN-Instance: public net Configured Up Listen Connect Shutdown 2 2 0 0 0 Peer's Address 192.168.3.2 192.168.5.1 State UP UP Up/Down time 01:07:08 00:16:39 AS ? ? SA Count 8 13 <SwitchD> display msdp brief MSDP Peer Brief Information of VPN-Instance: public net Configured Up Listen Connect Shutdown 1 1 0 0 0 Peer's Address 192.168.1.1 State UP Up/Down time 01:07:09 AS ? SA Count 8 <SwitchF> display msdp brief MSDP Peer Brief Information of VPN-Instance: public net Configured Up Listen Connect Shutdown 1 1 0 0 0 Peer's Address 192.168.4.1 State UP Up/Down time 00:16:40 AS ? SA Count 13 Down 0 Reset Count 0 0 Down 0 Reset Count 0 Down 0 Reset Count 0 ----End Configuration Files l Configuration file of SwitchA The configuration files of SwitchD and SwitchF are similar to the configuration file of SwitchA, and are not provided here. # sysname SwitchA # vlan batch 101 400 500 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif101 ip address 10.110.1.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface Vlanif400 ip address 192.168.4.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface Vlanif500 ip address 192.168.5.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm pim bsr-boundary Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 275 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 500 port hybrid untagged vlan 500 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 400 port hybrid untagged vlan 400 # interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 101 port hybrid untagged vlan 101 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 192.168.4.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.5.0 0.0.0.255 network 10.110.1.0 0.0.0.255 # return l Configuration file of SwitchC # sysname SwitchC # vlan batch 100 400 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif100 ip address 192.168.1.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface Vlanif 400 ip address 192.168.4.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 100 port hybrid untagged vlan 100 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 400 port hybrid untagged vlan 400 # interface LoopBack0 ip address 1.1.1.1 255.255.255.255 pim sm # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 192.168.1.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.4.0 0.0.0.255 network 1.1.1.1 0.0.0.0 # pim c-bsr LoopBack0 c-rp LoopBack0 # ip ip-prefix list-df permit 192.168.0.0 16 greater-equal 16 less-equal 32 # msdp peer 192.168.3.2 connect-interface vlanif100 peer 192.168.5.1 connect-interface vlanif400 static-rpf-peer 192.168.3.2 rp-policy list-df static-rpf-peer 192.168.5.1 rp-policy list-df # return l Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Configuration file of SwitchD Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 276 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration # sysname SwitchD # vlan batch 300 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif300 ip address 192.168.3.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 300 port hybrid untagged vlan 300 # interface LoopBack0 ip address 2.2.2.2 255.255.255.255 pim sm # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 192.168.3.0 0.0.0.255 network 2.2.2.2 0.0.0.0 # pim c-bsr LoopBack0 c-rp LoopBack0 # ip ip-prefix list-c permit 192.168.0.0 16 greater-equal 16 less-equal 32 # msdp peer 192.168.1.1 connect-interface vlanif300 static-rpf-peer 192.168.1.1 rp-policy list-c # return l Configuration file of SwitchF # sysname SwitchF # vlan batch 500 600 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif500 ip address 192.168.5.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm pim bsr-boundary # interface Vlanif600 ip address 192.168.6.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 500 port hybrid untagged vlan 500 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 600 port hybrid untagged vlan 600 # interface LoopBack0 ip address 3.3.3.3 255.255.255.255 pim sm # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 192.168.5.0 0.0.0.255 network 192.168.6.0 0.0.0.255 network 3.3.3.3 0.0.0.0 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 277 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration # pim c-bsr LoopBack0 c-rp LoopBack0 # ip ip-prefix list-c permit 192.168.0.0 16 greater-equal 16 less-equal 32 # msdp peer 192.168.4.1 connect-interface vlanif500 static-rpf-peer 192.168.4.1 rp-policy list-c # return l Configuration file of SwitchG # sysname SwitchG # vlan batch 103 104 600 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif103 ip address 10.110.3.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface Vlanif104 ip address 10.110.4.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm igmp enable # interface Vlanif600 ip address 192.168.6.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 103 port hybrid untagged vlan 103 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 600 port hybrid untagged vlan 600 # interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 104 port hybrid untagged vlan 104 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 192.168.6.0 0.0.0.255 network 10.110.3.0 0.0.0.255 network 10.110.4.0 0.0.0.255 # return 7.12.3 Example for Configuring Anycast RP Networking Requirements As shown in Figure 7-3, a PIM-SM domain contains multiple multicast sources and receivers. The MSDP peer relationship needs to be set up in the PIM-SM domain to implement RP load balancing. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 278 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration Figure 7-3 Networking diagram for configuring anycast RP PIM-SM S1 Source GE1/0/0 SwitchB Receiver user2 GE2/0/0 Loopback10 GE3/0/0 GE1/0/0 GE2/0/0 SwitchD Loopback1 GE1/0/0 SwitchA Source S2 Loopback0 GE2/0/0 Loopback0 GE2/0/0 Loopback1 SwitchC GE1/0/0 GE1/0/0 GE3/0/0 Loopback10 GE2/0/0 SwitchE Receiver user1 MSDP peers Switch Interface VLANIF interface IP address SwitchA GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 105 10.110.5.1/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 101 10.110.1.2/24 GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 106 10.110.6.1/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 102 10.110.2.2/24 GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 100 192.168.1.1/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 101 10.110.1.1/24 GE 3/0/0 VLANIF 104 10.110.4.1/24 SwitchB SwitchC Loopback0 1.1.1.1/32 Loopback1 3.3.3.3/32 Loopback10 SwitchD 10.1.1.1/32 GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 300 192.168.3.1/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 102 10.110.2.1/24 GE 3/0/0 VLANIF 103 10.110.3.1/24 Loopback0 2.2.2.2/32 Loopback1 4.4.4.4/32 Loopback10 SwitchE 10.1.1.1/32 GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 300 192.168.3.2/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 100 192.168.1.2/24 Configuration Roadmap Configure anycast RPs. Then the receiver sends a Join message to the nearest RP and the multicast source sends a Register message to the nearest RP. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 279 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration 1. Configure IP addresses for the interfaces of each Switch and configure OSPF in the PIMSM domain. 2. Enable multicast on all Switches and PIM-SM on all interfaces and enable the IGMP function on the interfaces connected the hosts. 3. Configure Loopback10 interfaces on SwitchC and SwitchD. Configure C-RPs on Loopback10 interfaces, and configure the C-BSR on Loopback1. 4. Configure MSDP peers on Loopback0 interfaces of SwitchC and SwitchD. According to RPF rules, the Switches receive SA messages from the source RP. Data Preparation To complete the configuration, you need the following data: l Address of multicast group G: 225.1.1.1/24 l Router ID of SwitchC: 1.1.1.1 l Router ID of SwitchD: 2.2.2.2 NOTE This configuration example describes only the commands used to configure anycast RP. Procedure Step 1 Configure the IP addresses of interfaces and the unicast routing protocol # According to Figure 7-3, configure IP addresses and masks for the interfaces in the PIM-SM domain. Configure the OSPF protocol between Switches. The configuration procedure is not provided here. Step 2 Enable multicast and configure PIM-SM. # Enable multicast on all Switches, and PIM-SM on all interfaces. Enable the IGMP function on the interfaces at the host side. The configurations of other Switches are similar to configuration of SwitchC, and are not provided here. [SwitchC] multicast [SwitchC] interface [SwitchC-Vlanif104] [SwitchC-Vlanif104] [SwitchC-Vlanif104] [SwitchC] interface [SwitchC-Vlanif102] [SwitchC-Vlanif102] [SwitchC] interface [SwitchC-Vlanif100] [SwitchC-Vlanif100] routing-enable vlanif 104 pim sm igmp enable quit vlanif 101 pim sm quit vlanif 100 pim sm quit Step 3 Configure Loopback1, Loopback10, C-BSR, and C-RP. # Configure the same address for Loopback1 and Loopback10 on both SwitchC and SwitchD. Configure C-BSR on Loopback1 and C-RP on Loopback 10. The configuration of SwitchD is similar to configuration of SwitchC, and is not provided here. [SwitchC] interface loopback 1 [SwitchC-LoopBack1] ip address 3.3.3.3 255.255.255.255 [SwitchC-LoopBack1] pim sm [SwitchC-LoopBack1] quit [SwitchC] interface loopback 10 [SwitchC-LoopBack10] ip address 10.1.1.1 255.255.255.255 [SwitchC-LoopBack10] pim sm Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 280 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration [SwitchC-LoopBack10] quit [SwitchC] pim [SwitchC-pim] c-bsr loopback 1 [SwitchC-pim] c-rp loopback 10 [SwitchC-pim] quit Step 4 Configure Loopback0 interfaces and MSDP peers. # Configure the MSDP peer on Loopback0 of SwitchC. [SwitchC] interface loopback 0 [SwitchC-LoopBack0] ip address 1.1.1.1 255.255.255.255 [SwitchC-LoopBack0] pim sm [SwitchC-LoopBack0] quit [SwitchC] msdp [SwitchC-msdp] originating-rp loopback0 [SwitchC-msdp] peer 2.2.2.2 connect-interface loopback0 [SwitchC-msdp] quit # Configure the MSDP peer on Loopback0 of SwitchD. [SwitchD] interface loopback 0 [SwitchD-LoopBack0] ip address 2.2.2.2 255.255.255.255 [SwitchD-LoopBack0] pim sm [SwitchD-LoopBack0] quit [SwitchD] msdp [SwitchD-msdp] originating-rp loopback0 [SwitchD-msdp] peer 1.1.1.1 connect-interface loopback0 [SwitchD-msdp] quit Step 5 Verify the configuration. # Run the display msdp brief command to view the status of the MSDP peer relationship between Switches. Information about MSDP peers on SwitchC and SwitchD is as follows: <SwitchC> display msdp brief MSDP Peer Brief Information of VPN-Instance: public net Configured Up Listen Connect Shutdown 1 1 0 0 0 Peer's Address 2.2.2.2 State Up Up/Down time 00:10:17 AS ? Down 0 SA Count 0 Reset Count 0 <SwitchD> display msdp brief MSDP Peer Brief Information of VPN-Instance: public net Configured Up Listen Connect Shutdown 1 1 0 0 0 Peer's Address State Up/Down time AS SA Count 1.1.1.1 Up 00:10:18 ? 0 Down 0 Reset Count 0 # Run the display pim routing-table command to view the PIM routing table on a Switch. In the PIM-SM domain, multicast source S1 (10.110.5.100/24) sends multicast packets to multicast group G (225.1.1.1). User 1 that joins G receives the multicast packets. Comparing information about the PIM routing tables on SwitchC and SwitchD, you can find that SwitchC is the valid RP. That is, S1 registers to SwitchC, and User 1 sends a Join message to SwitchC. <SwitchC> display pim routing-table VPN-Instance: public net Total 1 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry (*, 225.1.1.1) RP: 10.1.1.1 (local) Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: WC UpTime: 00:28:49 Upstream interface: Register Upstream neighbor: NULL RPF prime neighbor: NULL Downstream interface(s) information: Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 281 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration Total number of downstreams: 1 1: vlanif104 Protocol: static, UpTime: 00:28:49, Expires: (10.110.5.1, 225.1.1.1) RP: 10.1.1.1 (local) Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: SPT 2MSDP ACT UpTime: 00:02:26 Upstream interface: vlanif101 Upstream neighbor: 10.110.1.2 RPF prime neighbor: 10.110.1.2 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: vlanif104 Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 00:02:26, Expires: <SwitchD> display pim routing-table No output information is displayed. # User 1 leaves group G, and multicast source S1 stops sending multicast packets to G. You can run the reset multicast routing-table all and reset multicast forwarding-table all commands to clear the multicast routing entries and multicast forwarding entries on SwitchC. <SwitchC> reset multicast routing-table all <SwitchC> reset multicast forwarding-table all # User 2 joins group G, and multicast source S2 (10.110.6.100/24) sends multicast packets to G. Comparing information about the PIM routing tables on SwitchC and SwitchD, you can find that SwitchD is the valid RP. That is, S2 registers to SwitchD, and User 2 sends a Join message to SwitchD. <SwitchC> display pim routing-table No output information is displayed. <SwitchD> display pim routing-table VPN-Instance: public net Total 1 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry (*, 225.1.1.1) RP: 10.1.1.1 (local) Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: WC RPT UpTime: 00:07:23 Upstream interface: NULL, Upstream neighbor: NULL RPF prime neighbor: NULL Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: vlanif103, Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 00:07:23, Expires:(10.110.6.100, 225.1.1.1) RP: 10.1.1.1 (local) Protocol: pim-sm, Flag: SPT 2MSDP ACT UpTime: 00:10:20 Upstream interface: vlanif102 Upstream neighbor: 10.110.2.2 RPF prime neighbor: 10.110.2.2 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: vlanif103 Protocol: pim-sm, UpTime: 00:10:22, Expires: - ----End Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 282 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration Configuration Files l Configuration file of SwitchA The configuration files of SwitchB and SwitchE are similar to the configuration file of SwitchA, and are not provided here. # sysname SwitchA # vlan batch 101 105 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif101 ip address 10.110.1.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface Vlanif105 ip address 10.110.5.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 105 port hybrid untagged vlan 105 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 101 port hybrid untagged vlan 101 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 10.110.1.0 0.0.0.255 network 10.110.5.0 0.0.0.255 # return l Configuration file of SwitchC The configuration file of SwitchD IS similar to the configuration file of SwitchC, and is not provided here. # sysname SwitchC # vlan batch 100 101 104 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif100 ip address 192.168.1.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface Vlanif101 ip address 10.110.1.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface Vlanif104 ip address 10.110.4.1 255.255.255.0 igmp enable pim sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 100 port hybrid untagged vlan 100 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 101 port hybrid untagged vlan 101 # interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 104 port hybrid untagged vlan 104 # Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 283 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 7 MSDP Configuration interface LoopBack0 ip address 1.1.1.1 255.255.255.255 pim sm # interface LoopBack1 ip address 3.3.3.3 255.255.255.255 pim sm # interface LoopBack10 ip address 10.1.1.1 255.255.255.255 pim sm # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 10.110.1.0 0.0.0.255 network 10.110.4.0 0.0.0.255 network 1.1.1.1 0.0.0.0 network 3.3.3.3 0.0.0.0 network 10.1.1.1 0.0.0.0 network 192.168.1.0 0.0.0.255 # pim c-bsr LoopBack1 c-rp LoopBack10 # msdp originating-rp LoopBack0 peer 2.2.2.2 connect-interface LoopBack0 # return Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 284 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration About This Chapter With wide applications of the VPN technology, the requirements for operating multicast services over the VPN are increasingly stringent. Multicast VPN is mainly used in the MPLS/BGP VPN for multicast data transmission. 8.1 Overview of IPv4 Multicast VPN This section takes the networking where the public network PE supports multi-instance IPv4 multicast VPN as an example to describe concepts of the IPv4 multicast VPN and networking requirements for implementing the IPv4 multicast VPN. 8.2 IPv4 Multicast VPN Supported by the S9700 The system supports multiple IPv4 multicast VPN features, including MD VPNs, share-MDT and switch-MDT switchover, and inter-AS MD VPNs. 8.3 Configuring Basic MD VPN Functions By configuring the IPv4 multicast VPN through the MD solution, you can enable the transmission of private multicast data over a public network. In this manner, multicast data in the private network can traverse the public network and finally reach the receiver. 8.4 Configuring Switch-MDT Switchover When multicast data packets are forwarded through the share-MDT in the public network, the packets are forwarded to all PEs in the same VPN instance. Therefore, the high rate of multicast data packets in the VPN will increase the burden on the PE. To solve this problem, you can configure share-MDT and switch-MDT switchover to implement on-demand multicast, thereby, saving bandwidth resource on the network. 8.5 Maintaining IPv4 Multicast VPN Maintaining the IPv4 multicast VPN involves monitoring the running status of the IPv4 multicast VPN and controlling the output of logs. 8.6 Configuration Examples Examples for configuring the IPv4 multicast VPN. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 285 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration 8.1 Overview of IPv4 Multicast VPN This section takes the networking where the public network PE supports multi-instance IPv4 multicast VPN as an example to describe concepts of the IPv4 multicast VPN and networking requirements for implementing the IPv4 multicast VPN. NOTE EH1D2G24SSA0, EH1D2G24SCSA, EH1D2X12SSA0, EH1D2G48SBC0, EH1D2G48TBC0 boards do not support multicast VPN. TheS9700 implements multicast data transmission based on MPLS/BGP VPN. As shown in Figure 8-1, when multicast VPN is deployed in the network, the network carries three separate multicast services at the same time, that is, VPN A instance, VPN B instance, and the public network instance. A multicast switch PE at the edge of the public network supports multi-instance. The PE acts as multiple multicast switchs that run separately. Each instance corresponds to a plane. The three planes are isolated. Figure 8-1 Multicast VPN based on multi-instance PE2 site4 site6 MD B site5 PE1 VPN instance B P PE2 PE1 PIM PE3 Public instance MD A site1 PE1 VPN instance A site2 PE2 site3 PE3 The following takes VPN A instance as an example to explain multicast VPN. l S1 belongs to VPN A. S1 sends multicast data to G, a multicast group. l Among all possible data receivers, only members of VPN A (Site 1, Site 2, and Site 3) can receive multicast data from S1. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 286 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast l 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration Multicast data is transmitted among sites in the public network and each site in multicast mode. To implement multicast VPN, the following network conditions need to be met: l Each site supports multicast based on VPN instances. l Public network supports multicast based on the public network instance. l PE device supports multi-instance multicast: – Connecting sites through a VPN instance, and supporting multicast based on the VPN instance – Connecting the public network through the public instance, and supporting multicast based on the public network instance – Supporting information communication and data switching between the public network instance and the VPN instance 8.2 IPv4 Multicast VPN Supported by the S9700 The system supports multiple IPv4 multicast VPN features, including MD VPNs, share-MDT and switch-MDT switchover, and inter-AS MD VPNs. MD VPN The S9700 applies Multicast Domain (MD) to implement multicast VPN, which is called MD VPN. In an MD, VPN data is transmitted through the Multicast Tunnel (MT). The greatest advantage of the MD solution is that only PEs are required to support multi-instance. MD neither needs to upgrade CEs and Ps, nor modify the previous Protocol Independent Multicast (PIM) configuration on CEs and Ps. That is, the MD solution is transparent to CEs and Ps. Users can bind Share-Group to Multicast Tunnel Interfaces (MTIs), and set MTI parameters. Share-Multicast Distribution Tree For a VPN instance, data transmission in the public network is transparent. The VPN data is seamlessly connected at MTIs on PEs: The VPN instance only knows that after it sends the VPN data through an MTI on local PE, and the remote PE can receive the data through an MTI. Actually, the data experiences the complex public network transmission process, that is, multicast distribution tree (MDT) transmission. The MDT that takes the address of Share-group as the group address is called Share-MDT. VPNs use Share-Group to uniquely identify a Share-MDT. Multicast can be enabled in a PIM-SM network or a PIM-DM network. In the two different modes, the process of setting up a Share-MDT is different. Switch-MDT Switchover When multicast data is forwarded through a Share-MDT in the public network, the multicast data is forwarded to all PEs that support the same VPN instance, regardless of whether there is a receiver in the site connected to PEs. When the rate of VPN multicast data is higher, it may lead to data flooding, which wastes the network bandwidth and adds load to PEs. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 287 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration The S9700 optimizes the MD. Special Switch-MDTs is set up between PEs connected to VPN receivers and PEs connected to the VPN multicast source for VPN multicast data of a high rate flowing to the public network. The multicast data flow is then switched from the Share-MDT to the Switch-MDT. Multicast data can thus be transmitted on demand. Users can configure the switching conditions of a Switch-MDT. MD VPN across Multi-AS When a VPN covers multiple ASs, it is necessary to connect VPN nodes among different ASs. The following lists methods used by MD VPN to realize inter-AS multicast: l VPN instance-to-VPN Instance connection method l Multi-hop EBGP connection method NOTE For detailed implementation process, refer to the chapter "Multicast VPN" in the S9700 Core Routing Switch Feature Description - IP Multicast. 8.3 Configuring Basic MD VPN Functions By configuring the IPv4 multicast VPN through the MD solution, you can enable the transmission of private multicast data over a public network. In this manner, multicast data in the private network can traverse the public network and finally reach the receiver. 8.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task Before configuring basic MD VPN functions, familiarize yourself with the applicable environment, pre-configuration tasks, and required data. This can help you complete the configuration task quickly and accurately. Applicable Environment To implement multicast transmission in a VPN network, ensure that the VPN network works normally. To enable a PE to receive information from multiple VPNs, the PE needs to simultaneously support the public network instance and the VPN instance. The public network is responsible for communicating with Ps, and each VPN instance is responsible for communicating with each CE. Configure multicast VPN by using the MD solution. Set up Share-MDT to forward multicast packets. When the multicast forwarding rate exceeds the threshold, Share-MDT is switched to Switch-MDT. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring basic MD VPN functions, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol l Configuring MPLS/BGP VPN l Configuring public network multicast Data Preparation To configure basic MD VPN functions, you need the following data. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 288 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration No. Data 1 VPN instance name and Route Distinguisher 2 Share-Group address 3 Address and MTU of MTI 8.3.2 Enabling IP Multicast Routing Before configuring basic MD VPN functions, enable IP multicast routing. Context Do as follows on the PE switch: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: multicast routing-enable IP multicast routing is enabled in the public network instance. Step 3 Run: ip vpn-instance vpn-instance-name The VPN instance view is displayed. Step 4 Run: ipv4-family The IPv4 address family is enabled for the VPN instance and the VPN instance IPv4 address family view is displayed. Step 5 Run: route-distinguisher route-distinguisher An RD is configured for the VPN instance IPv4 address family. Step 6 Run: multicast routing-enable IP multicast routing is enabled for the VPN instance IPv4 address family. ----End 8.3.3 Configuring the Eth-Trunk as a Multicast Loopback Interface Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 289 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration Context On a multicast VPN, all multicast data is processed by the GRE board. Therefore, an Eth-Trunk must be configured, and a physical port on the GRE board must be added to the Eth-Trunk so that multicast data can be forwarded to the GRE board for processing. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface eth-trunk trunk-id The Eth-Trunk interface view is displayed. Step 3 Run: service type multicast-tunnel The Eth-Trunk is configured as a multicast loopback interface. This command does not take effect if the Eth-Trunk contains member interfaces or other services are configured on the Eth-Trunk. In addition, this command can run on only one Eth-Trunk of a device. Step 4 Run: trunkport interface-type interface-number A physical port is added to the Eth-Trunk. The member interfaces in the Eth-Trunk must support the multicast tunnel service. An Eth-Trunk set up between boards cannot be configured as a multicast loopback interface. ----End 8.3.4 Configuring Share-Group and Binding an MTI When configuring the IPv4 multicast VPN, you need to configure a share-group address and the MTI to be bound to the VPN instance. On one PE, different VPN instances cannot have the same share-group address. Context Do as follows on the PE switch: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: ip vpn-instance vpn-instance-name Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 290 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration The VPN instance view is displayed. Step 3 Run: ipv4-family The IPv4 address family is enabled for the VPN instance and the VPN instance IPv4 address family view is displayed. Step 4 Run: multicast-domain share-group group-address binding mtunnel number A share group is configured. The system automatically creates an MTI, and then binds the share group to the MTI and binds the MTI to the VPN instance IPv4 address family. NOTE After an MTI is created using the command in this step, the system automatically configures PIM on the MTI. You do not need to configure PIM on this MTI. PIM-SM is enabled on an MTI by default. If a physical interface configured with a PIM mode exists in the same VPN with an MTI, the PIM mode of the MTI will be the same as that of the physical interface. ----End 8.3.5 Configuring an MTI An MTI can send and receive multicast data only after being enabled with the multicast function. Context Do as follows on the PE switch: NOTE An MTI can be configured in either of the following modes: l Automatic mode l Manual mode If both of the modes are configured, the manual configuration takes precedence over the automatic configuration. Procedure l Automatic configuration 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: ip vpn-instance vpn-instance-name The VPN instance view is displayed. 3. Run: ipv4-family An IPv4 address family is enabled for the VPN instance and the VPN instance IPv4 address family view is displayed. 4. Run: multicast-domain source-interface interface-type interface-number Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 291 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration An interface from which an MTI references an IP address is specified. l Manual configuration 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: interface mtunnel number The MTI interface view is displayed. 3. Run: ip address ip-address { mask | mask-length } The address of the MTI is configured. NOTE The MTI address must be the same as the IP address that is used to set up the IBGP peer relationship on the PE in the public network. Otherwise, the VPN multicast packets received on the MTI cannot pass the RPF check. ----End 8.3.6 Checking the Configuration After basic MD VPN functions are configured, you can check information about the share-group and MTI of a specified VPN instance to ensure normal running of the VPN. Procedure l Run the display multicast-domain vpn-instance vpn-instance-name share-group [ local | remote ] command to check Share-Group information of a specified VPN instance in an MD. l Run the display pim vpn-instance vpn-instance-name interface mtunnel interfacenumber [ verbose ] command to check information about an MTI. ----End 8.4 Configuring Switch-MDT Switchover When multicast data packets are forwarded through the share-MDT in the public network, the packets are forwarded to all PEs in the same VPN instance. Therefore, the high rate of multicast data packets in the VPN will increase the burden on the PE. To solve this problem, you can configure share-MDT and switch-MDT switchover to implement on-demand multicast, thereby, saving bandwidth resource on the network. 8.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task Before configuring share-MDT and switch-MDT switchover, familiarize yourself with the applicable environment, pre-configuration tasks, and required data. This can help you complete the configuration task quickly and accurately. Applicable Environment When multicast data packets are forwarded through the share-MDT in the public network, the packets are forwarded to all PEs that support the same VPN instance, regardless of whether there Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 292 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration is a receiver in the site to which a PE is connected. When the rate for forwarding VPN multicast data packets is high, the packets may be flooded in the public network. This wastes network bandwidth and increases the load of PEs. In the S9700, you can determine whether to perform Switch-MDT switchover. If Switch-MDT switchover is not configured, MDs use Share-MDT to transmit VPN multicast data forever. l When the rate of the VPN multicast data entering the public network exceeds the threshold, the VPN multicast data can be switched from Share-MDT to a specified Switch-MDT. Ondemand multicast is thus implemented. l After the VPN multicast data is switched to the switch-MDT, the switchover conditions may not be met. In this case, the VPN multicast data can be reversely switched from SwitchMDT to Share-MDT. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring Switch-MDT switchover, complete the task of Configuring Basic MD VPN Functions. Data Preparation To configure Switch-MDT switchover, you need the following data. No. Data 1 VPN instance name 2 The address range and mask of the switch-group-pool of Switch-MDT 3 Switching threshold 4 Delay for switching from Share-MDT to Switch-MDT 5 Delay for switching from Switch-MDT to Share-MDT 8.4.2 (Optional) Setting Switching Parameters of Switch-MDT To reduce the burden on the PE and save bandwidth resources, you can establish a switch-MDT for multicast data packets flowing from the VPN to the public network and switch the multicast data packets from the share-MDT to the switch-MDT. Context Do as follows on the PE switch: NOTE This configuration is optional. If this configuration is not done, Switch-MDT switchover cannot be performed and Share-MDT is always used to transmit VPN multicast data. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 293 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: ip vpn-instance vpn-instance-name The VPN instance view is displayed. Step 3 Run: ipv4-family The IPv4 address family is enabled for the VPN instance and the VPN instance IPv4 address family view is displayed. Step 4 Run: multicast-domain switch-group-pool switch-group-pool { network-mask | network-masklength } [ threshold threshold-value | acl { advanced-acl-number | acl-name } ] * The switch-group-pools of Switch-MDT and switch conditions are configured. The parameters of the command are explained as follows: l switch-group-pool: specifies a switch-group-pool. It's suggested that the same VPN instance enabled with the IPv4 address family on different PEs are configured with the same switchgroup-pool. On a PE, the Switch-Group address ranges to which different VPNs enabled with the IPv4 address family correspond cannot overlap. l threshold-value: Specifies the threshed. By default, it is 0 kbit/s. l { advanced-acl-number | acl-name }: specifies the advanced ACL filtering rules. By default, packets are not filtered. Step 5 (Optional) Run: multicast-domain switch-delay switch-delay The delay for switching to Switch-MDT is configured. By default, the delay is 5 seconds. Step 6 (Optional) Run: multicast-domain holddown-time interval The duration for keeping the rate of VPN multicast data lower than the threshold before reversely switching from Switch-MDT to Share-MDT is set. By default, the delay for switching from Switch-MDT to Share-MDT is 60 seconds. ----End 8.4.3 Checking the Configuration After share-MDT and switch-MDT switchover is configured, you can check information about the switch-group sent and received by a specified VPN instance in the MD to ensure normal running of the VPN. Procedure l Run the following commands to check Switch-Group information received by a specified VPN instance in the MD. – display multicast-domain vpn-instance vpn-instance-name switch-group receive brief Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 294 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration – display multicast-domain vpn-instance vpn-instance-name switch-group receive [ active | group group-address | sender source-address | vpn-source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | vpn-group-address [ mask { group-masklength | group-mask } ] ] * l Run the display multicast-domain vpn-instance vpn-instance-name switch-group send [ group group-address | reuse interval | vpn-source-address [ mask { source-masklength | source-mask } ] | vpn-group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | groupmask } ] ] * command to check Switch-Group information sent by a specified VPN instance in the MD. ----End 8.5 Maintaining IPv4 Multicast VPN Maintaining the IPv4 multicast VPN involves monitoring the running status of the IPv4 multicast VPN and controlling the output of logs. 8.5.1 Monitoring the Running Status of IPv4 Multicast VPN During the routine maintenance of the IPv4 multicast VPN, you can run the display commands in any view to know the running of the IPv4 multicast VPN. Context In routine maintenance, you can run the following commands in any view to check the running status of IPv4 Multicast VPN. Procedure l Run the display multicast-domain vpn-instance vpn-instance-name share-group [ local | remote ] command in any view to check information about Share-Group of a specified VPN instance in an MD. l Run the following commands in any view to check information about Switch-Group received by a specified VPN instance in an MD. – display multicast-domain vpn-instance vpn-instance-name switch-group receive brief – display multicast-domain vpn-instance vpn-instance-name switch-group receive [ active | group group-address | sender source-address | vpn-source-address [ mask { source-mask-length | source-mask } ] | vpn-group-address [ mask { group-masklength | group-mask } ] ] * l Run the display multicast-domain vpn-instance vpn-instance-name switch-group send [ group group-address | reuse interval | vpn-source-address [ mask { source-masklength | source-mask } ] | vpn-group-address [ mask { group-mask-length | groupmask } ] ] * command in any view to check information about the Switch-Group sent to a specified VPN instance in an MD. l Run the display multicast-domain { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } control-message counters command in any view to check the statistics about sent and received MDT switch messages in a specified VPN instance or all VPN instances. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 295 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast l 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration Run the display multicast-domain { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } invalid-packet command in any view to check the statistics about invalid MDT switch messages received by a device. ----End 8.5.2 Debugging IPv4 Multicast VPN When a fault occurs during the running of the IPv4 multicast VPN, run the debugging commands in the user view and locate the fault based on the debugging information. Debugging affects the performance of the system. So, after debugging, disable it immediately. Context CAUTION Debugging affects the performance of the system. After debugging, run the undo debugging all command to disable it immediately. Procedure l Run the debugging md [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] { all | event [ advanced-acl-number ] | packet } command in the user view to enable multicast debugging in an MD. ----End 8.5.3 Controlling the Output of Logs To know the running status of the system or locate a fault through logs, you can enable the output of logs about the reused switch-group addresses. Context In the VPN instance on the source PE, if the number of VPN multicast data flows that need to be switched is more than the number of group addresses in the switch-group-pool of SwitchMDT, the group addresses in the switch-group-pool can be used repeatedly. By default, the logs of the reused Switch-Group addresses are not recorded. To know the running status of the system or locate a fault through logs, do as follows on the PE: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: ip vpn-instance vpn-instance-name Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 296 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration The VPN instance view is displayed. Step 3 Run: ipv4-family The IPv4 address family is enabled for the VPN instance and the VPN instance IPv4 address family view is displayed. Step 4 Run: multicast-domain log switch-group-reuse The logs of the reused Switch-Group addresses are recorded. ----End 8.6 Configuration Examples Examples for configuring the IPv4 multicast VPN. 8.6.1 Example for Configuring a Single-AS MD VPN Networking Requirements As shown in Figure 8-2, MD is used on the single-AS MPLS/BGP VPN to deploy multicast services. Figure 8-2 Networking diagram of a single-AS MD VPN PC2 VPN RED Source2 GE1 CE-Rb GE3 GE2 GE1 VPN BLUE Loopback1 GE1 VPN RED GE3 GE1 Loopback1 Public GE1 GE2 GE1 CE-Ra GE3 GE2 GE2 P CE-Rc PE-C GE3 GE1 GE2 Loopback2 GE3 GE1Loopback1 GE2 VPN BLUE CE-Bc PE-A PC1 Loopback1 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) VPN RED GE2 GE2 PE-B Source1 Loopback1 GE3 GE2 CE-Bb PC3 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. GE1 PC4 297 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration NOTE GE1 indicates GigabitEthernet 1/0/0; GE2 indicates GigabitEthernet 2/0/0; GE3 indicates GigabitEthernet 3/0/0.Table 8-1 lists the IP address of each interface in the figure. Table 8-1 Configurations of the interfaces on switches Device Interface IP Address Remarks P GE1: 192.168.6.2/24 - VLANIF 10 GE2: 192.168.7.2/24 - VLANIF 20 GE3: 192.168.8.2/24 - VLANIF 30 PE-A Loopback 1: 2.2.2.2/32 Loopback 1 acts as the C-RP for the public network. GE1: 192.168.6.1/24 VLANIF 40 GE1 belongs to the public network instance. GE2: 10.110.1.1/24 GE2 belongs to the VPN-RED instance. VLANIF 50 GE3: 10.110.2.1/24 GE3 belongs to the VPN-RED instance. VLANIF 60 Loopback 1: 1.1.1.1/32 Loopback 1 belongs to the public network instance. IBGP peer relationships are set up between the Loopback 1 interfaces on PEA, PE-B, and PE-C. PE-B GE1: 192.168.7.1/24 VLANIF 70 GE1 belongs to the public network instance. GE2: 10.110.3.1/24 GE2 belongs to the VPN-BLUE instance. VLANIF 80 GE3: 10.110.4.1/24 GE3 belongs to the VPN-RED instance. VLANIF 90 Loopback 1: 1.1.1.2/32 Loopback 1 belongs to the public network instance. IBGP peer relationships are set up between the Loopback 1 interfaces on PEA, PE-B, and PE-C. PE-C GE1: 192.168.8.1/24 VLANIF 100 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) GE1 belongs to the public network instance. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 298 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast Device 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration Interface IP Address Remarks GE2: 10.110.5.1/24 GE2 belongs to the VPN-RED instance. VLANIF 110 GE3: 10.110.6.1/24 GE3 belongs to the VPN-BLUE instance. VLANIF 120 Loopback 1: 1.1.1.3/32 Loopback 1 belongs to the public network instance. IBGP peer relationships are set up between the Loopback 1 interfaces on PEA, PE-B, and PE-C. CE-Ra Loopback 2: 33.33.33.33/32 Loopback 2 belongs to the VPN-BLUE instance and acts as the C-RP of the private network. GE1: 10.110.7.1/24 - VLANIF 130 GE2: 10.110.2.2/24 - VLANIF 140 CE-Bb GE1: 10.110.8.1/24 - VLANIF 150 GE2: 10.110.3.2/24 - VLANIF 160 CE-Rb GE1: 10.110.9.1/24 - VLANIF 170 GE2: 10.110.4.2/24 - VLANIF 180 GE3: 10.110.12.1/24 - VLANIF 190 CE-Rc Loopback 1: 22.22.22.22/32 Loopback 1 belongs to the VPN-RED instance and acts as the C-RP of the private network. GE1: 10.110.10.1/24 - VLANIF 200 GE2: 10.110.5.2/24 - VLANIF 210 GE3: 10.110.12.2/24 - VLANIF 220 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 299 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration Device Interface IP Address Remarks CE-Bc GE1: 10.110.11.1/24 - VLANIF 230 GE2: 10.110.6.2/24 - VLANIF 240 Source1 10.110.7.2/24 Multicast source of VPN-RED Source 2 10.110.8.2/24 Multicast source of VPN-BLUE PC1 10.110.1.2/24 Multicast receiver of VPN-RED PC2 10.110.9.2/24 Multicast receiver of VPN-RED PC3 10.110.10.2/24 Multicast receiver of VPN-RED PC4 10.110.11.2/24 Multicast receiver of VPN-BLUE Table 8-2 Networking requirements of the single-AS MD VPN Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Item Requirements Multicast source and receivers The multicast source of VPN-RED is Source 1; the receivers of VPNRED are PC1, PC2, and PC3. The multicast source of VPN-BLUE is Source 2 and the receiver of VPN-BLUE is PC4. The Share-Group address of VPN-RED is 239.1.1.1; the addresses in the Switch-Group address pool range from 225.2.2.1 to 225.2.2.16. The Share-Group address of VPN-BLUE is 239.2.2.2; the addresses in the Switch-Group address pool range from 225.4.4.1 to 225.4.4.16. VPN instances to which the interfaces on the PEs belong GE2 and GE3 on PE-A belong to the VPN-RED instance; GE1 and Loopback 1 on PE-A belong to the public network instance; GE2 on PE-B belongs to the VPN-BLUE instance; GE3 on PE-B belongs to the VPN-RED instance; GE1 and Loopback 1 on PE-B belong to the public network instance; GE2 on PE-C belongs to the VPN-RED instance; GE3 and Loopback 2 on PE-C belong to the VPN-BLUE instance; GE1 and Loopback 1 on PE-C belong to the public network instance. Routing protocols and MPLS OSPF is configured on the public network; RIP is configured between PEs and switches (CEs). BGP peer connections are set up between the Loopback 1 interfaces on PE-A, PE-B, and PE-C. All private network routes are transmitted along these BGP peer connections. MPLS forwarding starts on the public network. Multicast function Multicast is enabled on the P. Multicast is enabled on the public network instances of PE-A, PE-B, and PE-C. Multicast is enabled on the VPN-RED instances of PE-A, PE-B, and PE-C. Multicast is enabled on the VPN-BLUE instances of PE-B and PE-C. Multicast is enabled on CE-Ra, CE-Rb, CE-Rc, CE-Bb, and CE-Bc. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 300 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration Item Requirements IGMP IGMP is enabled on GE2 on PE-A, GE1 interfaces of CE-Rb, CE-Rc, CE-Bb, and CE-Bc. PIM PIM-SM is enabled on all the private network interfaces of VPN-RED and VPN-BLUE. PIM-SM is enabled on all the interfaces of Ps and CEs, and on all the public network interfaces of PEs. Loopback 1 of the P acts as a C-BSR and C-RP for all the groups. Loopback 1 of the CE-Rb acts as the C-BSR and C-RP for the private network VPN-RED for all the groups. Loopback 2 of PE-C acts as the C-BSR and C-RP for the private network VPN-BLUE for all the groups. Configuration Roadmap The configuration roadmap is as follows: 1. Configure MPLS/BGP VPN; ensure that the VPN works normally and unicast routes are reachable. 2. On the PE, configure Eth-Trunk 10 as the multicast loopback interface. 3. Enable the multicast function and the PIM function on the entire network. Configure the public network-based multicast between PEs and Ps and configure the VPN instance-based multicast between PEs and CEs. 4. Configure the identical Share-Group address, MTI, and address pool range of Switch-MDT for the same VPN instance on each PE. 5. Configure the MTI address of each PE as the IBGP peer interface address on the public network, and enable PIM on the MTI. Data Preparation See Table 8-2 in "Networking Requirements." Procedure Step 1 # Configure PE-A. # Configure the ID of PE-A, enable IP multicast routing on the public network, configure the ID of the MPLS LSR, and then enable LDP. [PE-A] router id 1.1.1.1 [PE-A] multicast routing-enable [PE-A] mpls lsr-id 1.1.1.1 [PE-A] mpls [PE-A-mpls] quit [PE-A] mpls ldp [PE-A-mpls-ldp] quit # Configure Eth-Trunk 10 as the multicast loopback interface. [PE-A] interface eth-trunk 10 [PE-A-Eth-Trunk10] service type multicast-tunnel [PE-A-Eth-Trunk10] trunkport GigabitEthernet 3/0/5 [PE-A-Eth-Trunk10] quit # Create a VPN-RED instance and enter the VPN instance view. Configure the VPN IPv4 prefix and create ingress and egress routes of the instance. Enable IP multicast routing and configure Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 301 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration the Share-Group. Specify the MTI to be bound to the VPN instance and address pool range of Switch-MDT. [PE-A] ip vpn-instance RED [PE-A-vpn-instance-RED] route-distinguisher 100:1 [PE-A-vpn-instance-RED] vpn-target 100:1 export-extcommunity [PE-A-vpn-instance-RED] vpn-target 100:1 import-extcommunity [PE-A-vpn-instance-RED] multicast routing-enable [PE-A-vpn-instance-RED] multicast-domain share-group 239.1.1.1 binding mtunnel 0 [PE-A-vpn-instance-RED] multicast-domain switch-group-pool 225.2.2.1 28 [PE-A-vpn-instance-RED] quit # Enable LDP on GigabitEthernet 1/0/0 and start PIM-SM. [PE-A] interface gigabitethernet 1/0/0 [PE-A-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 40 [PE-A-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 40 [PE-A-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] quit [PE-A] interface vlanif 40 [PE-A-Vlanif40] ip address 192.168.6.1 24 [PE-A-Vlanif40] pim sm [PE-A-Vlanif40] mpls [PE-A-Vlanif40] mpls ldp # Bind GigabitEthernet 2/0/0 to the VPN-RED instance, and start IGMP and PIM-SM. [PE-A] interface gigabitethernet 2/0/0 [PE-A-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 50 [PE-A-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 50 [PE-A-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] quit [PE-A] interface vlanif 50 [PE-A-Vlanif50] ip binding vpn-instance RED [PE-A-Vlanif50] ip address 10.110.1.1 24 [PE-A-Vlanif50] pim sm [PE-A-Vlanif50] igmp enable # Bind GigabitEthernet 3/0/0 to the VPN-RED instance, and start PIM-SM. [PE-A] interface gigabitethernet 3/0/0 [PE-A-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 60 [PE-A-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 60 [PE-A-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] quit [PE-A] interface vlanif 60 [PE-A-Vlanif60] ip binding vpn-instance RED [PE-A-Vlanif60] ip address 10.110.2.1 24 [PE-A-Vlanif60] pim sm # Assign an IP address to Loopback 1 and start PIM-SM. [PE-A] interface [PE-A-LoopBack1] [PE-A-LoopBack1] [PE-A-LoopBack1] loopback 1 ip address 1.1.1.1 32 pim sm quit # Configure an IP address for MTI 0, which must be the same as the IP address of Loopback 1. The system automatically binds MTI 0 to the VPN-RED instance. Start PIM-SM on the interface. [PE-A] interface MTunnel 0 [PE-A-MTunnel0] ip address 1.1.1.1 32 [PE-A-MTunnel0] pim sm [PE-A-MTunnel0] quit # Configure unicast routing information of BGP, OSPF, and RIP. [PE-A] bgp [PE-A-bgp] [PE-A-bgp] [PE-A-bgp] [PE-A-bgp] Issue 01 (2012-03-15) 100 group VPN-G internal peer VPN-G connect-interface LoopBack1 peer 1.1.1.2 group VPN-G peer 1.1.1.3 group VPN-G Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 302 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration [PE-A-bgp] ipv4-family vpn-instance RED [PE-A-bgp-RED] import-route rip 2 [PE-A-bgp-RED] import-route direct [PE-A-bgp-RED] quit [PE-A-bgp] ipv4-family vpnv4 [PE-A-bgp-af-vpnv4] peer VPN-G enable [PE-A-bgp-af-vpnv4] peer 1.1.1.2 group VPN-G [PE-A-bgp-af-vpnv4] peer 1.1.1.3 group VPN-G [PE-A-bgp-af-vpnv4] quit [PE-A-bgp] quit [PE-A] ospf 1 [PE-A-ospf-1] area 0.0.0.0 [PE-A-ospf-1-area-0.0.0.0] network 1.1.1.1 0.0.0.0 [PE-A-ospf-1-area-0.0.0.0] network 192.168.0.0 0.0.255.255 [PE-A-ospf-1-area-0.0.0.0] quit [PE-A-ospf-1] quit [PE-A] rip 2 vpn-instance RED [PE-A-rip-2] network 10.0.0.0 [PE-A-rip-2] import-route bgp cost 3 Step 2 # Configure PE-B. # Configure the ID of PE-B, enable IP multicast routing of the public network, configure the ID of the MPLS LSR, and then enable LDP. [PE-B] router id 1.1.1.2 [PE-B] multicast routing-enable [PE-B] mpls lsr-id 1.1.1.2 [PE-B] mpls [PE-B-mpls] quit [PE-B] mpls ldp [PE-B-mpls-ldp] quit # Configure Eth-Trunk 10 as the multicast loopback interface. [PE-B] interface eth-trunk 10 [PE-B-Eth-Trunk10] service type multicast-tunnel [PE-B-Eth-Trunk10] trunkport GigabitEthernet 3/0/5 [PE-B-Eth-Trunk10] quit # Create a VPN-BLUE instance and enter the VPN instance view. Configure the VPN IPv4 prefix and create ingress and egress routes of the instance. Start an IP multicast route and configure the Share-Group. Specify the MTI to be bound to the VPN instance and switchaddress-pool range of Switch-MDT. [PE-B] ip vpn-instance BLUE [PE-B-vpn-instance-BLUE] route-distinguisher 200:1 [PE-B-vpn-instance-BLUE] vpn-target 200:1 export-extcommunity [PE-B-vpn-instance-BLUE] vpn-target 200:1 import-extcommunity [PE-B-vpn-instance-BLUE] multicast routing-enable [PE-B-vpn-instance-BLUE] multicast-domain share-group 239.2.2.2 binding mtunnel 1 [PE-B-vpn-instance-BLUE] multicast-domain switch-group-pool 225.4.4.1 28 # Create a VPN-RED instance and enter the VPN instance view. Configure the VPN IPv4 prefix and create ingress and egress routes of the instance. Start an IP multicast route and configure the Share-Group. Specify the MTI to be bound to the VPN instance and switch-address-pool range of Switch-MDT. [PE-B] ip vpn-instance RED [PE-B-vpn-instance-RED] route-distinguisher 100:1 [PE-B-vpn-instance-RED] vpn-target 100:1 export-extcommunity [PE-B-vpn-instance-RED] vpn-target 100:1 import-extcommunity [PE-B-vpn-instance-RED] multicast routing-enable [PE-B-vpn-instance-RED] multicast-domain share-group 239.1.1.1 binding mtunnel 0 [PE-B-vpn-instance-RED] multicast-domain switch-group-pool 225.2.2.1 28 # Enable LDP on GigabitEthernet 1/0/0 and start PIM-SM. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 303 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration [PE-B] interface gigabitethernet 1/0/0 [PE-B-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 70 [PE-B-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 70 [PE-B-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] quit [PE-B] interface vlanif 70 [PE-B-Vlanif70] ip address 192.168.7.1 24 [PE-B-Vlanif70] pim sm [PE-B-Vlanif70] mpls [PE-B-Vlanif70] mpls ldp # Bind GigabitEthernet 2/0/0 to the VPN-BLUE instance, and start PIM-SM. [PE-B] interface gigabitethernet 2/0/0 [PE-B-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 80 [PE-B-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 80 [PE-B-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] quit [PE-B] interface vlanif 80 [PE-B-Vlanif80] ip binding vpn-instance BLUE [PE-B-Vlanif80] ip address 10.110.3.1 24 [PE-B-Vlanif80] pim sm # Bind GigabitEthernet 3/0/0 to the VPN-RED instance, and start PIM-SM. [PE-B] interface gigabitethernet 3/0/0 [PE-B-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 90 [PE-B-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 90 [PE-B-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] quit [PE-B] interface vlanif 90 [PE-B-Vlanif90] ip binding vpn-instance RED [PE-B-Vlanif90] ip address 10.110.4.1 24 [PE-B-Vlanif90] pim sm # Assign an IP address to Loopback 1 and start PIM-SM. [PE-B] interface [PE-B-LoopBack1] [PE-B-LoopBack1] [PE-B-LoopBack1] loopback 1 ip address 1.1.1.2 32 pim sm quit # Configure an IP address for MTI 0, which needs to be the same as the IP address of Loopback 1. Start PIM-SM on the interface. [PE-B] interface MTunnel 0 [PE-B-MTunnel0] ip address 1.1.1.2 32 [PE-B-MTunnel0] pim sm # Configure an IP address for MTI 1, which needs to be the same as the IP address of Loopback 1. Start PIM-SM on the interface. [PE-B] interface MTunnel 1 [PE-B-MTunnel1] ip address 1.1.1.2 32 [PE-B-MTunnel1] pim sm # Configure unicast routing information of BGP, OSPF, and RIP. [PE-B] bgp 100 [PE-B-bgp] group VPN-G internal [PE-B-bgp] peer VPN-G connect-interface LoopBack1 [PE-B-bgp] peer 1.1.1.1 group VPN-G [PE-B-bgp] peer 1.1.1.3 group VPN-G [PE-B-bgp] ipv4-family vpn-instance RED [PE-B-bgp-RED] import-route rip 2 [PE-B-bgp-RED] import-route direct [PE-B-bgp-RED] quit [PE-B-bgp] ipv4-family vpn-instance BLUE [PE-B-bgp-BLUE] import-route rip 3 [PE-B-bgp-BLUE] import-route direct [PE-B-bgp-BLUE] quit [PE-B-bgp] ipv4-family vpnv4 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 304 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration [PE-B-bgp-af-vpnv4] peer VPN-G enable [PE-B-bgp-af-vpnv4] peer 1.1.1.1 group VPN-G [PE-B-bgp-af-vpnv4] peer 1.1.1.3 group VPN-G [PE-B-bgp-af-vpnv4] quit [PE-B-bgp] quit [PE-B] ospf 1 [PE-B-ospf-1] area 0.0.0.0 [PE-B-ospf-1-area-0.0.0.0] network 1.1.1.2 0.0.0.0 [PE-B-ospf-1-area-0.0.0.0] network 192.168.0.0 0.0.255.255 [PE-B-ospf-1-area-0.0.0.0] quit [PE-B-ospf-1] quit [PE-B] rip 2 vpn-instance RED [PE-B-rip-2] network 10.0.0.0 [PE-B-rip-2] import-route bgp cost 3 [PE-B-rip-2] quit [PE-B] rip 3 vpn-instance BLUE [PE-B-rip-3] network 10.0.0.0 [PE-B-rip-3] import-route bgp cost 3 Step 3 # Configure PE-C. # Configure the ID of PE-C, enable IP multicast routing of the public network, configure the ID of the MPLS LSR, and then enable LDP. [PE-C] router id 1.1.1.3 [PE-C] multicast routing-enable [PE-C] mpls lsr-id 1.1.1.3 [PE-C] mpls [PE-C-mpls] quit [PE-C] mpls ldp [PE-C-mpls-ldp] quit # Configure Eth-Trunk 10 as the multicast loopback interface. [PE-C] interface eth-trunk 10 [PE-C-Eth-Trunk10] service type multicast-tunnel [PE-C-Eth-Trunk10] trunkport GigabitEthernet 3/0/5 [PE-C-Eth-Trunk10] quit # Create a VPN-RED instance and enter the VPN instance view. Configure the VPN IPv4 prefix and create ingress and egress routes of the instance. Start an IP multicast route and configure the Share-Group. Specify the MTI to be bound to the VPN instance and switch-address-pool range of Switch-MDT. [PE-C] ip vpn-instance RED [PE-C-vpn-instance-RED] route-distinguisher 100:1 [PE-C-vpn-instance-RED] vpn-target 100:1 export-extcommunity [PE-C-vpn-instance-RED] vpn-target 100:1 import-extcommunity [PE-C-vpn-instance-RED] multicast routing-enable [PE-C-vpn-instance-RED] multicast-domain share-group 239.1.1.1 binding mtunnel 0 [PE-C-vpn-instance-RED] multicast-domain switch-group-pool 225.2.2.1 28 # Create a VPN-BLUE instance and enter the VPN instance view. Configure the VPN IPv4 prefix and create ingress and egress routes of the instance. Start an IP multicast route and configure the Share-Group. Specify the MTI to be bound to the VPN instance and switchaddress-pool range of Switch-MDT. [PE-C] ip vpn-instance BLUE [PE-C-vpn-instance-BLUE] route-distinguisher 200:1 [PE-C-vpn-instance-BLUE] vpn-target 200:1 export-extcommunity [PE-C-vpn-instance-BLUE] vpn-target 200:1 import-extcommunity [PE-C-vpn-instance-BLUE] multicast routing-enable [PE-C-vpn-instance-BLUE] multicast-domain share-group 239.2.2.2 binding mtunnel 1 [PE-C-vpn-instance-BLUE] multicast-domain switch-group-pool 225.4.4.1 28 # Enable LDP on GigabitEthernet 1/0/0 and start PIM-SM. [PE-C] interface gigabitethernet 1/0/0 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 305 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration [PE-C-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] [PE-C-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] [PE-C-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] [PE-C] interface vlanif 100 [PE-C-Vlanif100] ip address [PE-C-Vlanif100] pim sm [PE-C-Vlanif100] mpls [PE-C-Vlanif100] mpls ldp port hybrid pvid vlan 100 port hybrid untagged vlan 100 quit 192.168.8.1 24 # Bind GigabitEthernet 2/0/0 to the VPN-RED instance, and start PIM-SM. [PE-C] interface gigabitethernet 2/0/0 [PE-C-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 110 [PE-C-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 110 [PE-C-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] quit [PE-C] interface vlanif 110 [PE-C-Vlanif110] ip binding vpn-instance RED [PE-C-Vlanif110] ip address 10.110.5.1 24 [PE-C-Vlanif110] pim sm # Bind GigabitEthernet 3/0/0 to the VPN-BLUE instance, and start PIM-SM. [PE-C] interface gigabitethernet 3/0/0 [PE-C-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 120 [PE-C-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 120 [PE-C-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] quit [PE-C] interface vlanif 120 [PE-C-Vlanif120] ip binding vpn-instance BLUE [PE-C-Vlanif120] ip address 10.110.6.1 24 [PE-C-Vlanif120] pim sm # Assign an IP address to Loopback 1 and start PIM-SM. [PE-C] interface [PE-C-LoopBack1] [PE-C-LoopBack1] [PE-C-LoopBack1] loopback 1 ip address 1.1.1.3 32 pim sm quit # Configure an IP address for MTI 0, which needs to be the same as the IP address of Loopback 1. Start PIM-SM on the interface. [PE-C] interface MTunnel 0 [PE-C-MTunnel0] ip address 1.1.1.3 32 [PE-C-MTunnel0] pim sm # Configure an IP address for MTI 1, which needs to be the same as the IP address of Loopback 1. Start PIM-SM on the interface. [PE-C] interface MTunnel 1 [PE-C-MTunnel1] ip address 1.1.1.3 32 [PE-C-MTunnel1] pim sm # Bind Loopback 2 to the VPN-BLUE instance, and start PIM-SM. [PE-C] interface [PE-C-LoopBack2] [PE-C-LoopBack2] [PE-C-LoopBack2] [PE-C-LoopBack2] loopback 2 ip binding vpn-instance BLUE ip address 33.33.33.33 32 pim sm quit # Configure Loopback 2 as the C-BSR and C-RP for VPN-BLUE of the private network. [PE-C] pim vpn-instance BLUE [PE-C-pim-BLUE] c-bsr Loopback2 [PE-C-pim-BLUE] c-rp Loopback2 [PE-C-pim-BLUE] quit # Configure unicast routing information of BGP, OSPF, and RIP. [PE-C] bgp 100 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 306 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration [PE-C-bgp] group VPN-G internal [PE-C-bgp] peer VPN-G connect-interface LoopBack1 [PE-C-bgp] peer 1.1.1.1 group VPN-G [PE-C-bgp] peer 1.1.1.2 group VPN-G [PE-C-bgp] ipv4-family vpn-instance RED [PE-C-bgp-RED] import-route rip 2 [PE-C-bgp-RED] import-route direct [PE-C-bgp-RED] quit [PE-C-bgp] ipv4-family vpn-instance BLUE [PE-C-bgp-BLUE] import-route rip 3 [PE-C-bgp-BLUE] import-route direct [PE-C-bgp-BLUE] quit [PE-C-bgp] ipv4-family vpnv4 [PE-C-bgp-af-vpnv4] peer VPN-G enable [PE-C-bgp-af-vpnv4] peer 1.1.1.1 group VPN-G [PE-C-bgp-af-vpnv4] peer 1.1.1.2 group VPN-G [PE-C-bgp-af-vpnv4] quit [PE-C-bgp] quit [PE-C] ospf 1 [PE-C-ospf-1] area 0.0.0.0 [PE-C-ospf-1-area-0.0.0.0] network 1.1.1.3 0.0.0.0 [PE-C-ospf-1-area-0.0.0.0] network 192.168.0.0 0.0.255.255 [PE-C-ospf-1-area-0.0.0.0] quit [PE-C-ospf-1] quit [PE-C] rip 2 vpn-instance RED [PE-C-rip-2] network 10.0.0.0 [PE-C-rip-2] import-route bgp cost 3 [PE-C-rip-2] quit [PE-C] rip 3 vpn-instance BLUE [PE-C-rip-3] network 10.0.0.0 [PE-C-rip-3] import-route bgp cost 3 Step 4 Configure the P. # Enable IP multicast routing of the public network, configure the ID of the MPLS LSR, and then enable LDP. [P] multicast routing-enable [P] mpls lsr-id 2.2.2.2 [P] mpls [P-mpls] quit [P] mpls ldp [P-mpls-ldp] quit # Enable LDP on GigabitEthernet 1/0/0 and start PIM-SM. [P] interface gigabitethernet 1/0/0 [P-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 10 [P-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 10 [P-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] quit [P] interface vlanif 10 [P-Vlanif10] ip address 192.168.6.2 24 [P-Vlanif10] pim sm [P-Vlanif10] mpls [P-Vlanif10] mpls ldp # Enable LDP on GigabitEthernet 2/0/0 and start PIM-SM. [P] interface gigabitethernet 2/0/0 [P-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 20 [P-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 20 [P-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] quit [P] interface vlanif 20 [P-Vlanif20] ip address 192.168.7.2 24 [P-Vlanif20] pim sm [P-Vlanif20] mpls [P-Vlanif20] mpls ldp # Enable LDP on GigabitEthernet 3/0/0 and start PIM-SM. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 307 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration [P] interface gigabitethernet 3/0/0 [P-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 30 [P-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 30 [P-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] quit [P] interface vlanif 30 [P-Vlanif30] ip address 192.168.8.2 24 [P-Vlanif30] pim sm [P-Vlanif30] mpls [P-Vlanif30] mpls ldp # Assign an IP address to Loopback 1 and start PIM-SM. [P] interface [P-LoopBack1] [P-LoopBack1] [P-LoopBack1] loopback 1 ip address 2.2.2.2 32 pim sm quit # Configure Loopback 1 as the C-BSR and C-RP for the public network. [P] pim [P-pim] c-bsr Loopback1 [P-pim] c-rp Loopback1 # Configure OSPF unicast routing information. [P] ospf 1 [P-ospf-1] area 0.0.0.0 [P-ospf-1-area-0.0.0.0] network 2.2.2.2 0.0.0.0 [P-ospf-1-area-0.0.0.0] network 192.168.0.0 0.0.255.255 [P-ospf-1-area-0.0.0.0] quit Step 5 Configure CE-Ra. # Enable IP multicast routing. [CE-Ra] multicast routing-enable # Enable PIM-SM on GigabitEthernet 1/0/0. [CE-Ra] interface gigabitethernet 1/0/0 [CE-Ra-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 130 [CE-Ra-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 130 [CE-Ra-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] quit [CE-Ra] interface vlanif 130 [CE-Ra-Vlanif130] ip address 10.110.7.1 24 [CE-Ra-Vlanif130] pim sm # Enable PIM-SM on GigabitEthernet 2/0/0. [CE-Ra] interface gigabitethernet 2/0/0 [CE-Ra-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 140 [CE-Ra-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 140 [CE-Ra-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] quit [CE-Ra] interface vlanif 140 [CE-Ra-Vlanif140] ip address 10.110.2.2 24 [CE-Ra-Vlanif140] pim sm # Configure RIP unicast routing information. [CE-Ra] rip 2 [CE-Ra-rip-2] network 10.0.0.0 [CE-Ra-rip-2] import-route direct Step 6 Configure CE-Bb. # Enable IP multicast routing. [CE-Bb] multicast routing-enable # Enable PIM-SM on GigabitEthernet 1/0/0. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 308 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration [CE-Bb] interface gigabitethernet 1/0/0 [CE-Bb-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 150 [CE-Bb-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 150 [CE-Bb-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] quit [CE-Bb] interface vlanif 150 [CE-Bb-Vlanif150] ip address 10.110.8.1 24 [CE-Bb-Vlanif150] pim sm # Enable PIM-SM on GigabitEthernet 2/0/0. [CE-Bb] interface gigabitethernet 2/0/0 [CE-Bb-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 160 [CE-Bb-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 160 [CE-Bb-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] quit [CE-Bb] interface vlanif 160 [CE-Bb-Vlanif160] ip address 10.110.3.2 24 [CE-Bb-Vlanif160] pim sm # Configure RIP unicast routing information. [CE-Bb] rip 3 [CE-Bb-rip-3] network 10.0.0.0 [CE-Bb-rip-3] import-route direct Step 7 Configure CE-Rb. # Enable IP multicast routing. [CE-Rb] multicast routing-enable # Enable PIM-SM and IGMP on GigabitEthernet 1/0/0. [CE-Rb] interface gigabitethernet 1/0/0 [CE-Rb-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 170 [CE-Rb-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 170 [CE-Rb-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] quit [CE-Rb] interface vlanif 170 [CE-Rb-Vlanif170] ip address 10.110.9.1 24 [CE-Rb-Vlanif170] pim sm [CE-Rb-Vlanif170] igmp enable # Enable PIM-SM on GigabitEthernet 2/0/0. [CE-Rb] interface gigabitethernet 2/0/0 [CE-Rb-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 180 [CE-Rb-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 180 [CE-Rb-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] quit [CE-Rb] interface vlanif 180 [CE-Rb-Vlanif180] ip address 10.110.4.2 24 [CE-Rb-Vlanif180] pim sm # Enable PIM-SM on GigabitEthernet 3/0/0. [CE-Rb] interface gigabitethernet 3/0/0 [CE-Rb-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 190 [CE-Rb-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 190 [CE-Rb-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] quit [CE-Rb] interface vlanif 190 [CE-Rb-Vlanif190] ip address 10.110.12.1 24 [CE-Rb-Vlanif190] pim sm # Assign an IP address to Loopback 1 and start PIM-SM. [CE-Rb] interface [CE-Rb-LoopBack1] [CE-Rb-LoopBack1] [CE-Rb-LoopBack1] loopback 1 ip address 22.22.22.22 32 pim sm quit # Configure Loopback 1 as the BSR and RP for the private network VPN-RED. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 309 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration [CE-Rb] pim [CE-Rb-pim] c-bsr Loopback1 [CE-Rb-pim] c-rp Loopback1 [CE-Rb-pim] quit # Configure RIP unicast routing information. [CE-Rb] rip 2 [CE-Rb-rip-2] network 10.0.0.0 [CE-Rb-rip-2] network 22.0.0.0 [CE-Rb-rip-2] import-route direct Step 8 Configure CE-Rc. # Enable IP multicast routing. [CE-Rc] multicast routing-enable # Enable PIM-SM and IGMP on GigabitEthernet 1/0/0. [CE-Rc] interface gigabitethernet 1/0/0 [CE-Rc-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 200 [CE-Rc-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 200 [CE-Rc-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] quit [CE-Rc] interface vlanif 200 [CE-Rc-Vlanif200] ip address 10.110.10.1 24 [CE-Rc-Vlanif200] pim sm [CE-Rc-Vlanif200] igmp enable # Enable PIM-SM on GigabitEthernet 2/0/0. [CE-Rc] interface gigabitethernet 2/0/0 [CE-Rc-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 210 [CE-Rc-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 210 [CE-Rc-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] quit [CE-Rc] interface vlanif 210 [CE-Rc-Vlanif210] ip address 10.110.5.2 24 [CE-Rc-Vlanif210] pim sm # Enable PIM-SM on GigabitEthernet 3/0/0. [CE-Rc] interface gigabitethernet 3/0/0 [CE-Rc-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 220 [CE-Rc-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 220 [CE-Rc-GigabitEthernet3/0/0] quit [CE-Rc] interface vlanif 220 [CE-Rc-Vlanif220] ip address 10.110.12.2 24 [CE-Rc-Vlanif220] pim sm # Configure RIP unicast routing information. [CE-Rc] rip 2 [CE-Rc-rip-2] network 10.0.0.0 [CE-Rc-rip-2] import-route direct Step 9 Configure CE-Bc. # Enable IP multicast routing. [CE-Bc] multicast routing-enable # Enable PIM-SM and IGMP on GigabitEthernet 1/0/0. [CE-Bc] interface gigabitethernet 1/0/0 [CE-Bc-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 230 [CE-Bc-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 230 [CE-Bc-GigabitEthernet1/0/0] quit [CE-Bc] interface vlanif 230 [CE-Bc-Vlanif230] ip address 10.110.11.1 24 [CE-Bc-Vlanif230] pim sm Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 310 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration [CE-Bc-Vlanif230] igmp enable # Enable PIM-SM on GigabitEthernet 2/0/0. [CE-Bc] interface gigabitethernet 2/0/0 [CE-Bc-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid pvid vlan 240 [CE-Bc-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] port hybrid untagged vlan 240 [CE-Bc-GigabitEthernet2/0/0] quit [CE-Bc] interface vlanif 240 [CE-Bc-Vlanif240] ip address 10.110.6.2 24 [CE-Bc-Vlanif240] pim sm # Configure RIP unicast routing information. [CE-Bc] rip 3 [CE-Bc-rip-3] network 10.0.0.0 [CE-Bc-rip-3] import-route direct Step 10 Verify the configuration. After the preceding configurations, PC1, PC2, and PC3 can receive multicast information from Source 1; PC4 can receive multicast information from Source 2. ----End Configuration Files l Configuration file of PE-A # sysname PE-A # vlan batch 40 50 60 # router id 1.1.1.1 # multicast routing-enable # mpls lsr-id 1.1.1.1 mpls # mpls ldp # ip vpn-instance RED route-distinguisher 100:1 vpn-target 100:1 export-extcommunity vpn-target 100:1 import-extcommunity # multicast routing-enable multicast-domain share-group 239.1.1.1 binding MTunnel 0 multicast-domain switch-group-pool 225.2.2.0 255.255.255.240 # interface Vlanif40 ip address 192.168.6.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm mpls mpls ldp # interface Vlanif50 ip address 10.110.1.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm igmp enable ip binding vpn-instance RED # interface Vlanif60 ip binding vpn-instance RED ip address 10.110.2.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 311 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration interface Eth-Trunk10 service type multicast-tunnel # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 40 port hybrid untagged vlan 40 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 50 port hybrid untagged vlan 50 # interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 60 port hybrid untagged vlan 60 # interface GigabitEthernet3/0/5 eth-trunk 10 # interface LoopBack1 ip address 1.1.1.1 255.255.255.255 pim sm # interface MTunnel0 ip binding vpn-instance RED ip address 1.1.1.1 255.255.255.255 pim sm # bgp 100 group VPN-G internal peer VPN-G connect-interface LoopBack1 peer 1.1.1.2 as-number 100 peer 1.1.1.2 group VPN-G peer 1.1.1.3 as-number 100 peer 1.1.1.3 group VPN-G # ipv4-family unicast undo synchronization peer VPN-G enable peer 1.1.1.2 enable peer 1.1.1.2 group VPN-G peer 1.1.1.3 enable peer 1.1.1.3 group VPN-G # ipv4-family vpnv4 policy vpn-target peer VPN-G enable peer 1.1.1.2 enable peer 1.1.1.2 group VPN-G peer 1.1.1.3 enable peer 1.1.1.3 group VPN-G # ipv4-family vpn-instance RED import-route rip 2 import-route direct # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 1.1.1.1 0.0.0.0 network 192.168.0.0 0.0.255.255 # rip 2 vpn-instance RED network 10.0.0.0 import-route bgp cost 3 # return l Configuration file of PE-B # sysname PE-B # Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 312 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration vlan batch 70 80 90 # router id 1.1.1.2 # multicast routing-enable # mpls lsr-id 1.1.1.2 mpls # mpls ldp # ip vpn-instance BLUE route-distinguisher 200:1 vpn-target 200:1 export-extcommunity vpn-target 200:1 import-extcommunity multicast routing-enable multicast-domain share-group 239.2.2.2 binding MTunnel 1 multicast-domain switch-group-pool 225.4.4.0 255.255.255.240 # ip vpn-instance RED route-distinguisher 100:1 vpn-target 100:1 export-extcommunity vpn-target 100:1 import-extcommunity multicast routing-enable multicast-domain share-group 239.1.1.1 binding MTunnel 0 multicast-domain switch-group-pool 225.2.2.0 255.255.255.240 # interface Vlanif70 ip address 192.168.7.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm mpls mpls ldp # interface Vlanif80 ip binding vpn-instance BLUE ip address 10.110.3.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface Eth-Trunk10 service type multicast-tunnel # interface Vlanif90 ip binding vpn-instance RED ip address 10.110.4.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 70 port hybrid untagged vlan 70 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 80 port hybrid untagged vlan 80 # interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 90 port hybrid untagged vlan 90 # interface GigabitEthernet3/0/5 eth-trunk 10 # interface LoopBack1 ip address 1.1.1.2 255.255.255.255 pim sm # interface MTunnel0 ip binding vpn-instance RED ip address 1.1.1.2 255.255.255.255 pim sm Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 313 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration # interface MTunnel1 ip binding vpn-instance BLUE ip address 1.1.1.2 255.255.255.255 pim sm # bgp 100 group VPN-G internal peer VPN-G connect-interface LoopBack1 peer 1.1.1.1 as-number 100 peer 1.1.1.1 group VPN-G peer 1.1.1.3 as-number 100 peer 1.1.1.3 group VPN-G # ipv4-family unicast undo synchronization peer VPN-G enable peer 1.1.1.1 enable peer 1.1.1.1 group VPN-G peer 1.1.1.3 enable peer 1.1.1.3 group VPN-G # ipv4-family vpnv4 policy vpn-target peer VPN-G enable peer 1.1.1.1 enable peer 1.1.1.1 group VPN-G peer 1.1.1.3 enable peer 1.1.1.3 group VPN-G # ipv4-family vpn-instance RED import-route rip 2 import-route direct # ipv4-family vpn-instance BLUE import-route rip 3 import-route direct # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 1.1.1.2 0.0.0.0 network 192.168.0.0 0.0.255.255 # rip 2 vpn-instance RED network 10.0.0.0 import-route bgp cost 3 # rip 3 vpn-instance BLUE network 10.0.0.0 import-route bgp cost 3 # return l Configuration file of PE-C # sysname PE-C # vlan batch 100 110 120 # router id 1.1.1.3 # multicast routing-enable # mpls lsr-id 1.1.1.3 mpls # mpls ldp # ip vpn-instance RED route-distinguisher 100:1 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 314 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration vpn-target 100:1 export-extcommunity vpn-target 100:1 import-extcommunity multicast routing-enable multicast-domain share-group 239.1.1.1 binding MTunnel 0 multicast-domain switch-group-pool 225.2.2.0 255.255.255.240 # ip vpn-instance BLUE route-distinguisher 200:1 vpn-target 200:1 export-extcommunity vpn-target 200:1 import-extcommunity multicast routing-enable multicast-domain share-group 239.2.2.2 binding MTunnel 1 multicast-domain switch-group-pool 225.4.4.0 255.255.255.240 # interface Vlanif100 ip address 192.168.7.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm mpls mpls ldp # interface Vlanif110 ip binding vpn-instance RED ip address 10.110.5.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface Vlanif120 ip binding vpn-instance BLUE ip address 10.110.6.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface Eth-Trunk10 service type multicast-tunnel # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 100 port hybrid untagged vlan 100 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 110 port hybrid untagged vlan 110 # interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 120 port hybrid untagged vlan 120 # interface GigabitEthernet3/0/5 eth-trunk 10 # interface LoopBack1 ip address 1.1.1.3 255.255.255.255 pim sm # interface LoopBack2 ip binding vpn-instance BLUE ip address 33.33.33.33 255.255.255.255 pim sm # pim vpn-instance BLUE c-bsr LoopBack2 c-rp LoopBack2 # interface MTunnel0 ip binding vpn-instance RED ip address 1.1.1.3 255.255.255.255 pim sm # interface MTunnel1 ip binding vpn-instance BLUE ip address 1.1.1.3 255.255.255.255 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 315 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration pim sm # bgp 100 group VPN-G internal peer VPN-G connect-interface LoopBack1 peer 1.1.1.1 as-number 100 peer 1.1.1.1 group VPN-G peer 1.1.1.2 as-number 100 peer 1.1.1.2 group VPN-G # ipv4-family unicast undo synchronization peer VPN-G enable peer 1.1.1.1 enable peer 1.1.1.1 group VPN-G peer 1.1.1.2 enable peer 1.1.1.2 group VPN-G # ipv4-family vpnv4 policy vpn-target peer VPN-G enable peer 1.1.1.1 enable peer 1.1.1.1 group VPN-G peer 1.1.1.2 enable peer 1.1.1.2 group VPN-G # ipv4-family vpn-instance RED import-route rip 2 import-route direct # ipv4-family vpn-instance BLUE import-route rip 3 import-route direct # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 1.1.1.3 0.0.0.0 network 192.168.0.0 0.0.255.255 # rip 2 vpn-instance RED network 10.0.0.0 import-route bgp cost 3 # rip 3 vpn-instance BLUE network 10.0.0.0 import-route bgp cost 3 # return l Configuration file of P # sysname P # vlan batch 10 20 30 # multicast routing-enable # mpls lsr-id 2.2.2.2 mpls # mpls ldp # interface Vlanif10 ip address 192.168.6.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm mpls mpls ldp # interface Vlanif20 ip address 192.168.7.2 255.255.255.0 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 316 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration pim sm mpls mpls ldp # interface Vlanif30 ip address 192.168.8.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm mpls mpls ldp # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 10 port hybrid untagged vlan 10 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 20 port hybrid untagged vlan 20 # interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 30 port hybrid untagged vlan 30 # interface LoopBack1 ip address 2.2.2.2 255.255.255.255 pim sm # pim c-bsr Loopback1 c-rp Loopback1 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 2.2.2.2 0.0.0.0 network 192.168.0.0 0.0.255.255 # return l Configuration file of CE-Ra # sysname CE-Ra # vlan batch 130 140 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif130 ip address 10.110.7.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface Vlanif140 ip address 10.110.2.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 130 port hybrid untagged vlan 130 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 140 port hybrid untagged vlan 140 # rip 2 network 10.0.0.0 import-route direct # return l Configuration file of CE-Bb # sysname CE-Bb Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 317 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration # vlan batch 150 160 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif150 ip address 10.110.8.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface Vlanif160 ip address 10.110.3.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 150 port hybrid untagged vlan 150 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 160 port hybrid untagged vlan 160 # rip 3 network 10.0.0.0 import-route direct # return l Configuration file of CE-Rb # sysname CE-Rb # vlan batch 170 180 190 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif170 ip address 10.110.9.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm igmp enable # interface Vlanif180 ip address 10.110.4.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface Vlanif190 ip address 10.110.12.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 170 port hybrid untagged vlan 170 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 180 port hybrid untagged vlan 180 # interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 190 port hybrid untagged vlan 190 # interface loopback 1 ip address 22.22.22.22 32 pim sm # pim c-bsr Loopback1 c-rp Loopback1 # rip 2 network 10.0.0.0 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 318 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration network 22.0.0.0 import-route direct # return l Configuration file of CE-Rc # sysname CE-Rc # vlan batch 200 210 220 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif200 ip address 10.110.10.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm igmp enable # interface Vlanif210 ip address 10.110.5.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface Vlanif220 ip address 10.110.12.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm # # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 200 port hybrid untagged vlan 200 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 210 port hybrid untagged vlan 210 # interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 220 port hybrid untagged vlan 220 # rip 2 network 10.0.0.0 import-route direct # return l Configuration file of CE-Bc # sysname CE-Bc # vlan batch 230 240 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif230 ip address 10.110.11.1 255.255.255.0 pim sm igmp enable # interface Vlanif240 ip address 10.110.6.2 255.255.255.0 pim sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 230 port hybrid untagged vlan 230 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 240 port hybrid untagged vlan 240 # Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 319 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 8 IPv4 Multicast VPN Configuration rip 3 network 10.0.0.0 import-route direct # return Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 320 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management IPv4 Multicast Routing Management About This Chapter The system synchronously maintains multiple multicast routing protocols, and controls multicast routing and forwarding through the information exchanged between the control plane and the forwarding plane. 9.1 Overview of IPv4 Multicast Routing Management Multicast routing and forwarding maintains a protocol routing table, multicast routing table, and multicast forwarding table. A multicast routing protocol creates multicast routing entries through RPF. 9.2 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management Features Supported by the S9700 The IPv4 multicast routing management features supported by the system are: static multicast route, GRE tunnel, multicast routing policy, controlling the multicast forwarding range, controlling the capacity of a multicast forwarding table, testing multicast routes, and multicast splitting. 9.3 Configuring a Static Multicast Route Static multicast routes have the functions of changing RPF routes and connecting RPF routes. 9.4 Configuring the Multicast Routing Policy Configuring a multicast routing policy involves optimizing storage resources for multicast forwarding entries,configuring the multicast Hash algorithm, configuring the longest match of the multicast route, configuring multicast load splitting, and setting a multicast load splitting weight. 9.5 Configuring the Multicast Forwarding Scope Multicast information of each multicast group in a network should be transmitted within a certain range. Therefore, configuring a multicast forwarding boundary are necessary for restricting the multicast data forwarding scope. 9.6 Configuring Control Parameters of the Multicast Forwarding Table During network planning, you can restrict the capacity of the forwarding table on a multicast device, such as the maximum number of entries in the multicast forwarding table and the maximum number of downstream interfaces of multicast forwarding entries. In this manner, traffic load on the multicast device is released and the fault risk resulted from excessive entries can be avoided. 9.7 Maintaining the Multicast Policy Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 321 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management Maintaining IPv4 multicast routing management involves testing multicast routing, checking the RPF path and multicast path, clearing multicast forwarding and routing entries, and monitoring multicast routing and forwarding. 9.8 Configuration Examples Examples for configuring static multicast routes and multicast load splitting are provided. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 322 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management 9.1 Overview of IPv4 Multicast Routing Management Multicast routing and forwarding maintains a protocol routing table, multicast routing table, and multicast forwarding table. A multicast routing protocol creates multicast routing entries through RPF. In the S9700, multicast routing and forwarding consist of the following three aspects: l Each multicast routing protocol has its routing table, such as PIM routing table. l The multicast routing information of each multicast routing protocol forms a general multicast routing table. The multicast routing table resides in the multicast route management module. It is composed of (S, G) entries. (S, G) indicates that S sends multicast data to G. If the multicast route management module supports multiple multicast protocols, the routing table contains multicast routes that are generated by the protocols. The routing entries are copied to the forwarding table. l The multicast forwarding table controls the forwarding of multicast data packets. The multicast forwarding table guides the forwarding of multicast data packets. It remains consistent with the multicast routing table. To ensure that multicast data is transmitted along the correct path, multicast routing protocols use the Reverse Path Forwarding (RPF) to create multicast routing entries. The system performs RPF check based on the following types of routes: l Unicast routes The unicast routing table collects the shortest paths to each destination. l MBGP routes The MBGP routing table provides multicast routing information. l MIGP routes The MIGP routing table provides the routing information calculated based on physical interfaces of the TE tunnel to guide the forwarding of multicast packets. l Static multicast routes The static multicast routing table provides RPF routing information that is specified through static configuration. 9.2 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management Features Supported by the S9700 The IPv4 multicast routing management features supported by the system are: static multicast route, GRE tunnel, multicast routing policy, controlling the multicast forwarding range, controlling the capacity of a multicast forwarding table, testing multicast routes, and multicast splitting. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 323 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management Static Multicast Route The static multicast route is an important factor of RPF check. By configuring the static multicast route, users can specify the RPF interface and RPF neighbor for a specific source of packets on the current switch. The static multicast route cannot be used to forward data. It only affects RPF check, and is also called static RPF route. The static multicast route is valid only on the configured multicast switchs, and cannot be advertised or imported to other switchs. Multicast Routing Policy If multiple unicast routes with the same cost exist when a multicast switch selects an upstream interface, users can use one of following methods to configure the switch to select the RPF route: l By default, the switch chooses the route with the largest next-hop address. l According to the longest match, the switch selects the route longest matching the address of the source of the packet. l Load splitting is configured among equal-cost routes. Performing load splitting of multicast traffic according to different policies can optimize network traffic transmission in the scenario where multiple multicast data flows exist. There are five multicast load splitting policies: stable-preferred, balance-preferred, source address-based, group address-based, and source and group addresses-based. The five load splitting policies are mutually exclusive. In stable-preferred mode and balance-preferred mode, you can configure load splitting weights on the interfaces to achieve unbalanced multicast load splitting. Controlling the Multicast Forwarding Range In a network, the multicast information to which each multicast group corresponds is transmitted in a certain range. Users can define the multicast forwarding range by using the following method: l Configuring a multicast forwarding boundary on an interface to form a closed multicast forwarding area. Controlling the Capacity of a Multicast Forwarding Table When planning a specific network according to network services, the Internet Service Provider (ISP) can perform the following configurations: l Limiting the number of entries in the multicast forwarding table Each switch maintains a forwarding entry for each received multicast packet. Too many multicast forwarding entries, however, use up the memory of a switch. Users can define the maximum number of entries in the multicast forwarding table of a switch. Limiting the number of entries according to the actual networking and service performance can avoid switch faults caused by excessive entries. l Limiting the number of downstream nodes of each forwarding entry Switch replicate a multicast packet for each downstream node, and then send it out. Each downstream node forms a branch of an MDT. The number of downstream nodes determines the maximum scale of the MDT and the multicast service range. Users can define the Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 324 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management number of downstream nodes of a single forwarding entry. Limiting the number of downstream nodes according to the actual networking and service performance can reduce the processing pressure of a switch and control the multicast service range. Testing Multicast Routing When a fault occurs on a multicast network, you can run the ping multicast and mtrace commands to test the connectivity of the network. NOTE The mtrace command can be used to trace multicast path on a specified multicast VPN network to maintain multicast VPN services and locate faults on the network. The ping multicast command is used to check whether a group is reachable and to implement the following functions: l Pinging a reserved group address This is used to check whether a member of a group exists in the directly connected network segment, and is not exclusive for multicast networks. You can ping devices that use multicast addresses. l Pinging a common group address This function is applied as follows: – To generate multicast traffic and trigger the creation of multicast routing entries: Based on multicast routing information, you can check whether a protocol runs normally, determine whether the network can carry multicast services, or test the forwarding performance. – To check the members of related groups in the network: Based on the ICMP-EchoReply messages received from destination hosts, the switch on which the command is used checks the members of the groups in the network, and calculates response time and the TTL from the switch to members. You can run the command repeatedly in a certain interval to calculate the network delay and route flapping. The mtrace command can be used to trace the following paths and output the hop information: l RPF path from a source to a querier l Multicast path from a source to a querier l RPF path from a source to a destination host l Multicast path from a source to a destination host NOTE You can ping multicast addresses by using the Network Quality Analysis (NQA) test instances or related commands. For detailed configurations of NQA test instances, refer to the chapter " NQA Configuration " in S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Network Management. 9.3 Configuring a Static Multicast Route Static multicast routes have the functions of changing RPF routes and connecting RPF routes. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 325 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management 9.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task Before configuring static multicast routes, familiarize yourself with the applicable environment, pre-configuration tasks, and required data. This can help you complete the configuration task quickly and accurately. Applicable Environment Static multicast route has the following functions: l Changing RPF route If the topology of multicast is the same as that of unicast, the transmission path of multicast data is the same as that of unicast data. Users can change the RPF route by configuring a static multicast route. Thus a transmission path of the multicast data, which is different from the transmission path of unicast data, is established. l Connecting RPF route In the network segment where unicast routes are blocked, when multicast static routes are not configured, packets cannot be forwarded because there is no RPF route. You can configure multicast static routes. Therefore, the system can generate RPF routes, complete RPF check, create routing entries, and guide the forwarding of packets. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring a static multicast route, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol l Configuring basic multicast functions Data Preparation To configure a static multicast route, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Multicast source address, mask or mask length 2 Unicast routing protocol 3 Filtering policy and its preference 9.3.2 Configuring a Static Multicast Route Function When configuring a static multicast route, you can specify an RPF interface and an RPF neighbor on the current multicast device. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 326 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management Context CAUTION When configuring a static multicast route, configure the outgoing interface through the command if the next hop is in the point-to-point format. If the next hop is not in the point-to-point format, you must use the next hop. Do as follows on the multicast switch: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: ip rpf-route-static [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] source-address { mask | masklength } [ isis process-id | ospf process-id | rip process-id | bgp | static ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] { gateway-address | interface-type interfacenumber } [ preference preference ] [ order order-number ] A static multicast route is configured. The parameters of the command are explained as follows: l source-address { mask |mask-length }: specifies a source address and mask. l isis process-id, ospf process-id, rip process-id, bgp, static: specifies that the matching route must be present in the specified unicast routing protocol. protocol specifies a unicast routing protocol. process-id specifies the ID of a process. l route-policy policy-name: specifies the matching rule of the static multicast route. l interface-type interface-number: specifies the type and the number of the outgoing interface. The outgoing interface acts as the RPF interface. l preference preference: specifies the preference of the route. The greater the preference value is, the lower the preference is. l order order-num: specifies the configuration order of routes on the same network segment. ----End 9.3.3 Checking the Configuration After static multicast routes are configured, you can check the static multicast routing table and RPF routing information to ensure the normal running of the multicast network. Procedure l Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Run the display multicast routing-table [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] static [ config ] [ source-address { mask | mask-length } ] command to check the static multicast routing table. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 327 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast l 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management Run the display multicast [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] rpf-info source-address [ group-address ] [ rpt | spt ] command to check RPF routing information of a specified multicast source. ----End 9.4 Configuring the Multicast Routing Policy Configuring a multicast routing policy involves optimizing storage resources for multicast forwarding entries,configuring the multicast Hash algorithm, configuring the longest match of the multicast route, configuring multicast load splitting, and setting a multicast load splitting weight. 9.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task Before configuring multicast routing policies, familiarize yourself with the applicable environment, pre-configuration tasks, and required data. This can help you complete the configuration task quickly and accurately. Applicable Environment If multiple equal-cost unicast routes exist when a multicast switch select an upstream interface, you can configure the switch to choose the RPF switch by using one of the following methods: l By default, the switch chooses the route with the largest next-hop address. l According to the longest match rules, you can configure the switch to select the route with the destination address that longest matches the address of the source of the packet. l You can configure load splitting among these routes. Performing load splitting of multicast traffic according to different policies can optimize network traffic when multiple multicast data flows exist. To optimize storage for multicast entries, set the storage mode of the interface board to multicast optimization mode. When many multicast hash collisions occur, the switch may fail to learn some multicast addresses. When this situation occurs, you can change the multicast hash algorithm to reduce hash collisions. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring the multicast routing policy, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol l Configuring basic multicast functions Data Preparation To configure the multicast routing policy, you need the following data. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) No. Data 1 Multicast load splitting policy Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 328 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management No. Data 2 Multicast load splitting weight on the interface 3 (Optional) Slot ID of the LPU requires the multicast optimization mode configured for storing Layer 3 forwarding entries. 9.4.2 Configuring Longest Match of Multicast Route If the longest match principle is configured for route selection, a multicast device prefers the route with the longest matched mask. If the mask lengths of multiple routes are the same, the device selects a route as the multicast data forwarding path in the order of the static multicast route, inter-domain unicast route, and intra-domain unicast route. Context CAUTION Configurations related to VPN instances are applicable only to the PE switch. When configuring the longest match of multicast routes for a VPN instance on a PE, perform the configuration in the VPN instance. In other cases, the longest match is configured in the public network instance. By default, routes are selected in the order of routing entries. Do as follows on the multicast switch: Procedure l Public network instance 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: multicast longest-match Routes are selected according to the longest match. l VPN instance 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: ip vpn-instance vpn-instance-name The VPN instance view is displayed. 3. Run: ipv4-family Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 329 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management The IPv4 address family is enabled for the VPN instance and the VPN instance IPv4 address family view is displayed. 4. Run: multicast longest-match Devices are selected according to the longest match. ----End 9.4.3 Configuring Multicast Load Splitting Performing load splitting of multicast traffic according to different policies can optimize network traffic transmission in the scenario where multiple multicast data flows exist. You can choose to configure a balance-preferred or stable-preferred load splitting policy. Context CAUTION Configurations related to VPN instances are applicable only to the PE switch. When configuring load splitting among multicast routes for a VPN instance on a PE, perform the configuration in the VPN instance. In other cases, load balancing among multicast routes is configured in the public network instance. The multicast load splitting function extends multicast routing rules, which does not fully depend on the RPF check. If multiple equal-cost optimal routes exist over the network, they all can be used for multicast data forwarding and multicast traffic is load split among multiple equal-cost routes. By default, load splitting is not performed. Do as follows on the multicast switch: Procedure l Public network instance 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: multicast load-splitting { balance-preferred | stable-preferred | source | group | source-group } Multicast load balancing is configured. The parameters of the command are explained as follows: – balance-preferred: indicates balance-preferred load splitting. This policy is applicable to the scenario where hosts frequently join or leave the groups, which requires automatic load adjustment. If balance-preferred is specified, the switch automatically adjusts and balances the entries on the equal-cost routes when equal-cost routes are added or deleted, Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 330 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management IPv4 multicast routing entries are deleted, or IPv4 load splitting weights on the interfaces are changed. – stable-preferred: indicates stable-preferred load splitting. This policy is applicable to the stable multicast networking. If stable-preferred is specified, the switch automatically adjusts and balances the entries when equal-cost routes are added or deleted; however, when IPv4 multicast routing entries are deleted or load splitting weights on the interfaces are changed, the switch does not automatically adjust the entries on the equal-cost routes. – group: indicates group address-based load splitting. This policy is applicable to the scenario of one source to multiple groups. – source: indicates source address-based load splitting. This policy is applicable to the scenario of one group to multiple sources. – source-group: indicates source and group addresses-based load splitting. This policy is applicable to the scenario of multiple sources to multiple groups. NOTE It is recommended to adopt a fixed IPv4 multicast load splitting policy based on the actual networking. It is recommended to use the balance-preferred or stable-preferred policy. balance-preferred or stable-preferred cannot be configured on the interface enabled with PIM-DM. You can configure a multicast load balancing timer or a multicast load splitting weight only in a stable-preferred load splitting or balance-preferred load splitting scenario. 3. (Optional) Run: multicast load-splitting-timer interval A load balancing timer is set. l VPN instance 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: ip vpn-instance vpn-instance-name The VPN instance view is displayed. 3. Run: ipv4-family The IPv4 address family is enabled for the VPN instance and the VPN instance IPv4 address family view is displayed. 4. Run: multicast load-splitting { balance-preferred | stable-preferred | source | group | source-group } Multicast load splitting is configured. NOTE You can configure a multicast load balancing timer or a multicast load splitting weight only in a stable-preferred load splitting or balance-preferred load splitting scenario. 5. (Optional) Run: multicast load-splitting-timer interval Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 331 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management A load balancing timer is set for the VPN IPv4 address family. ----End 9.4.4 Configuring a Multicast Load Splitting Weight When a load splitting policy is configured, because the forwarding capabilities of equal-cost routes are different from the actual load bearing situation on the equal-cost routes, balanced load splitting cannot meet network requirements in some scenarios. In such a case, you can configure a load splitting weight on an interface to achieve unbalanced multicast load splitting. Context When stable-preferred or balance-preferred load splitting is configured, because the forwarding capabilities of equal-cost routes are different from the actual load bearing situation on the equalcost routes, balanced load splitting cannot meet network requirements in some scenarios. In such a case, you can configure a load splitting weight on an interface to achieve unbalanced multicast load splitting. Do as follows on the switch enabled with multicast: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface. By default, the multicast load splitting weight of an interface is 1. The greater the multicast load splitting weight of an interface, the more multicast routing entries with this interface being the upstream interface. When the multicast load splitting weight on an interface is 0, it indicates that the routes with this interface being the upstream interface do not take part in load splitting. Step 3 Run: multicast load-splitting weight weight-value The multicast load splitting weight is set on the interface. ----End 9.4.5 (Optional) Optimizing Storage for Multicast Forwarding Entries Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 332 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management Context In most cases, the system allocates hardware resources preferentially to the routing table by default. The ND cache table and multicast forwarding table share hardware resources. If a large number of ND prefix entries and multicast forwarding entries are sharing hardware resources, configure optimization mode as the storage mode for Layer 3 multicast forwarding entries. The system allocates hardware resources preferentially to the multicast forwarding table. The ND cache table and routing table share hardware resources. CAUTION When you configure this mode or restore the default mode, the system will prompt you to restart the device or a specified LPU. If the system receives no response, the configuration times out, and the system view is displayed. The system does not restart. The restart can lead to the network crash for a short period. In most cases, you are advised not to perform this configuration. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: set multicast forwarding-table optimization-mode [ slot slot-id ] The optimization mode is configured for storing the multicast forwarding entries. ----End 9.4.6 (Optional) Configuring the Multicast Hash Algorithm Context To improve multicast forwarding performance, the switch uses a hash algorithm to learn multicast addresses. When many multicast hash collisions occur, the switch may fail to learn some multicast addresses. When this occurs, you can change the multicast hash algorithm to reduce hash collisions. CAUTION MAC addresses are distributed on a network randomly, so the system cannot determine the best hash algorithm. The default hash algorithm is the best algorithm in most cases, so changing the hash algorithm is not recommended. After changing the hash algorithm, restart the switch for the configuration to take effect. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 333 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: set multicast-hash-mode{ crc-32-upper| crc-32-lower| lsb| crc-16-upper| crc-16lower } The multicast hash algorithm is specified. ----End 9.4.7 Checking the Configuration After multicast routing policies are configured, you can check the configuration of the multicast optimization mode, the multicast routing table and RPF routing information to ensure normal running of the multicast network. Procedure l Run the following commands to check the multicast routing table. – display multicast { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask | group-mask-length } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask | source-mask-length } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | register | none } ] * [ outgoing-interfacenumber [ number ] ] – display multicast routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask | group-masklength } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask | source-mask-length } ] | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpninstance-name | register | none } ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] l Run the following command to check the source-specific RPF route. display multicast [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] rpf-info sourceaddress [ group-address ] l Run the following command to check the multicast optimization mode display multicast forwarding-table optimization-mode configuration [ slot slot-id ] ----End 9.5 Configuring the Multicast Forwarding Scope Multicast information of each multicast group in a network should be transmitted within a certain range. Therefore, configuring a multicast forwarding boundary are necessary for restricting the multicast data forwarding scope. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 334 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management 9.5.1 Establish the Configuration Task Before configuring the multicast data forwarding scope, familiarize yourself with the applicable environment, pre-configuration tasks, and required data. This can help you complete the configuration task quickly and accurately. Applicable Environment Multicast information to which each multicast group corresponds is forwarded in a certain scope in network. Uers can define the multicast forwarding scope by using the following methods: l Configuring the multicast forwarding boundary to form a close multicast forwarding area. The interface configured with a forwarding boundary of a multicast group cannot send or receive packets of the multicast group. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring the multicast forwarding scope, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol l Configuring basic multicast functions Data Preparation To configure the multicast forwarding scope, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Group address, mask, and mask length of the multicast forwarding boundary 9.5.2 Configuring the Multicast Forwarding Boundary When an interface of a multicast device is configured with a forwarding boundary for a specified group, the forwarding scope of multicast packets is restricted. Context By default, no multicast forwarding boundary is configured on the interface. Do as follows on the multicast switch: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 335 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management The interface can be a VLANIF interface, an Loopback interface, a POS interface, or an IPTrunk interface. Step 3 Run: multicast boundary group-address { mask | mask-length } The multicast forwarding boundary is configured. ----End 9.5.3 Checking the Configuration After the multicast forwarding scope is configured, you can check information about the multicast routing table and multicast boundary of an interfaceto ensure normal running of the multicast network. Procedure l Run the following commands to check the multicast routing table. – display multicast { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask | group-mask-length } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask | source-mask-length } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | register | none } ] * [ outgoing-interfacenumber [ number ] ] – display multicast routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask | group-masklength } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask | source-mask-length } ] | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpninstance-name | register | none } ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] l Run the display multicast [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] boundary [ group-address [ mask | mask-length ] ] [ interface interface-type interface-number ] command to check information about the multicast boundary of an interface. ----End 9.6 Configuring Control Parameters of the Multicast Forwarding Table During network planning, you can restrict the capacity of the forwarding table on a multicast device, such as the maximum number of entries in the multicast forwarding table and the maximum number of downstream interfaces of multicast forwarding entries. In this manner, traffic load on the multicast device is released and the fault risk resulted from excessive entries can be avoided. 9.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task Before configuring control parameters for the multicast forwarding table, familiarize yourself with the applicable environment, pre-configuration tasks, and required data. This can help you complete the configuration task quickly and accurately. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 336 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management Applicable Environment To plan a network according to the services, the ISP needs to perform the following configuration policies: l Limiting the number of entries in the multicast forwarding table Each switch maintains a routing entry for each received multicast packet. Too many entries, however, may exhaust the memory of the switch. In this case, you can define the maximum number of multicast routing entries. Limiting the number of the entries can avoid faults in the switch. l Limiting the number of downstream nodes of a single entry Switchs copy a multicast packet for each downstream node, and the downstream node sends the copy out. Each downstream node forms a branch of the multicast distribution tree. The number of the downstream nodes determines the maximum scale of the multicast distribution tree and the multicast service scope. Users can define the number of the downstream nodes of a single forwarding entry. Limiting the number of downstream nodes according to the actual networking and the services can reduce the pressure of switchs and control the multicast service scope. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring control parameters of the multicast forwarding table, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol l Configuring basic multicast functions Data Preparation To configure control parameters of the multicast forwarding table, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Maximum number of entries in the multicast forwarding table 42 Maximum number of downstream nodes of each entry in the multicast forwarding table 9.6.2 Setting the Maximum Number of Entries in Multicast Forwarding Table You can adjust the number of entries according to the actual networking and service performance to avoid the fault risk resulted from excessive entries. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 337 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management Context CAUTION Configurations related to VPN instances are applicable only to the PE switch. When configuring the maximum number of entries in the forwarding table for a VPN instance on a PE, perform the configuration in the VPN instance. In other cases, the maximum number of entries in the forwarding table is configured in the public network instance. Too many multicast forwarding entries may use up the memory of a multicast device. You can set the maximum number of entries in a multicast forwarding table of a multicast device. By default, the maximum number supported by the system is used. Do as follows on the multicast switch: Procedure l Public network instance 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: multicast forwarding-table route-limit limit The maximum number of entries in the multicast forwarding table is configured. l VPN instance 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: ip vpn-instance vpn-instance-name The VPN instance view is displayed. 3. Run: ipv4-family The IPv4 address family is enabled for the VPN instance and the VPN instance IPv4 address family view is displayed. 4. Run: multicast forwarding-table route-limit limit The maximum number of entries in the multicast forwarding table is configured. ----End 9.6.3 Setting the Maximum Number of Downstream Nodes of Multicast Forwarding Entry A multicast device replicates a copy of multicast packets for each downstream interface. Then, you can set the number of downstream interfaces of a single forwarding entry and adjust the Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 338 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management number of downstream interfaces according to the actual networking and service performance to release the burden on the multicast device. Context CAUTION This configuration becomes valid only after the reset multicast forwarding-table command is used. Multicast services are interrupted after you run the reset multicast forwarding-table command. So, confirm the action before you use the command. Configurations related to the VPN instance are applicable only to the PE switch. When configuring the maximum number of downstream nodes for a forwarding entry in a VPN instance on a PE, perform the configuration in the VPN instance. In other cases, the maximum number of entries in the forwarding table is configured in the public network instance. Do as follows on the multicast switch: Procedure l Public network instance 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: multicast forwarding-table downstream-limit limit The maximum number of downstream nodes of a forwarding entry in the multicast forwarding table is configured. The maximum number is valid when it is smaller than the default value. l VPN instance 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: ip vpn-instance vpn-instance-name The VPN instance view is displayed. 3. Run: ipv4-family The IPv4 address family is enabled for the VPN instance and the VPN instance IPv4 address family view is displayed. 4. Run: multicast forwarding-table downstream-limit limit The maximum number of downstream nodes of a forwarding entry in the multicast forwarding table is configured. ----End Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 339 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management 9.6.4 Checking the Configuration After control parameters for the multicast forwarding table are configured, you can check information about the multicast routing table to ensure normal running of the multicast network. Procedure l Run the display multicast [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] forwardingtable [ group-address [ mask { group-mask | group-mask-length } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask | source-mask-length } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interfacetype interface-number | register | none } | statistics [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] ] * command to check the multicast forwarding table. ----End 9.7 Maintaining the Multicast Policy Maintaining IPv4 multicast routing management involves testing multicast routing, checking the RPF path and multicast path, clearing multicast forwarding and routing entries, and monitoring multicast routing and forwarding. 9.7.1 Testing Multicast Routing When a fault occurs during multicast data transmission, you can run the ping command to check the RPF path and multicast path. Context When data transmission is abnormal, you can ping related multicast addresses to check the RPF path and multicast path. Procedure l Run the ping multicast [ -i interface-type interface-number | -c count | -h ttl-value | -m time | -p pattern | -q | -s packet(s)ize | -t timeout | -tos tos-value | -v ] * host command in any view to ping a reserved group address. l Run the ping multicast [ -c count | -h ttl-value | -m time | -p pattern | -q | -s packet(s)ize | -t timeout | -tos tos-value | -v ] * host command in any view to ping a common group address. ----End 9.7.2 Check RPF Paths and Multicast Paths When a fault occurs during multicast data transmission, you can run the mtrace command to check the RPF path and multicast path. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 340 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management Context NOTE When checking the RPF path or multicast path from a source to a destination host, run the mtrace querypolicy [ acl-number ] command on the switch connected to hosts to configure the filtering policy for queriers. The ACL defines the address scope of reliable queriers. Based on the ACL, the last-hop switch refuses the IGMP-Tracert-Query messages sent by illegal queriers. Note the following when using this command: l This command is valid only for the last-hop switch, and the querier is not the last-hop switch. l This command is used to filter only the IGMP-Tracert-Query message encapsulated in a unicast IP packet. l This command is not applicable to the trace that is initiated by the local querier. When a fault occurs during data transmission, you can run the following commands in any view to check RPF paths and multicast paths. Procedure l Run the mtrace [ -ur resp-dest | -l [ stat-times ] [ -st stat-int ] | -m max-ttl | -q nqueries | ts ttl | -tr ttl | -v | -w timeout | -vpn-instance vpn-name ] * source source-address command in any view to check the RPF path from a source to a querier. l Run the mtrace -g group [ { -mr | -ur resp-dest } | -l [ stat-times ] [ -st stat-int ] | -m maxttl | -q nqueries | -ts ttl | -tr ttl | -v | -w timeout | -vpn-instance vpn-name ] * source sourceaddress command in any view to check the multicast path from a source to a querier. l Run the mtrace { -gw last-hop-router | -d } -r receiver [ -ur resp-dest | -a source-ipaddress | -l [ stat-times ] [ -st stat-int ] | -m max-ttl | -q nqueries | -ts ttl | -tr ttl | -v | -w timeout | -vpn-instance vpn-name ] * source source-address command in any view to check the RPF path from a source to a destination host. l Run the mtrace { -gw last-hop-router | -b | -d } -r receiver -g group [ { -mr | -ur respdest } | -a source-ip-address | -l [ stat-times ] [ -st stat-int ] | -m max-ttl | -q nqueries | -ts ttl | -tr ttl | -v | -w timeout | -vpn-instance vpn-name ] * source source-address command in any view to check the multicast path from a source to a destination host. ----End 9.7.3 Clearing Multicast Routing and Forwarding Entries After you confirm to clear multicast forwarding and routing entries, use the reset command in the user view. Context CAUTION The reset command clears the entries in the multicast forwarding table or the multicast routing table. It may result in abnormal multicast information forwarding. After the routing entries in the multicast routing table are cleared, the corresponding forwarding entries corresponding to the public network instance or VPN instance are also cleared. So, confirm the action before you use the command. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 341 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management Procedure l Run the following commands to clear the forwarding entries in the multicast forwarding table. – reset multicast [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] forwarding-table all – reset multicast [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] forwarding-table { group-address [ mask { group-mask | group-mask-length } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask | source-mask-length } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } } * l Run the following commands to clear the routing entries in the multicast routing table. – reset multicast [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table all – reset multicast [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] routing-table { group-address [ mask { group-mask | group-mask-length } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask | source-mask-length } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } } * ----End 9.7.4 Monitoring the Status of Multicast Routing and Forwarding During the routine maintenance of IPv4 multicast routing management, you can run the display commands in any view to know the running of the multicast forwarding table and routing table. Context In routine maintenance, you can run the following commands in any view to check the status of multicast routing and forwarding. Procedure l Run the display multicast [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] boundary [ group-address [ mask | mask-length ] ] [ interface interface-type interface-number ] command in any view to check the multicast boundary configured on an interface. l Run thedisplay multicast [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] forwardingtable [ group-address [ mask { group-mask | group-mask-length } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask | source-mask-length } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interfacetype interface-number | register | none } | statistics ] * command in any view to check the multicast forwarding table. l Run the following commands in any view to check the multicast routing table. – display multicast { vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance } routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask | group-mask-length } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask | source-mask-length } ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | register | none } ] * [ outgoing-interfacenumber [ number ] ] – display multicast routing-table [ group-address [ mask { group-mask | group-masklength } ] | source-address [ mask { source-mask | source-mask-length } ] | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | outgoing-interface Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 342 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management { include | exclude | match } { interface-type interface-number | vpn-instance vpninstance-name | register | none } ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] l Run the display multicast routing-table [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] static [ config ] [ source-address { mask-length | mask } ] command in any view to check the static multicast routing table. l Run the display multicast [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] rpf-info source-address [ group-address ] [ rpt | spt ] command in any view to check the RPF routing information. ----End 9.7.5 Debugging Multicast Routing and Forwarding When a fault occurs during IPv4 multicast routing management, run the debugging commands in the user view and locate the fault based on the debugging information. Debugging affects the performance of the system. So, after debugging, disable it immediately. Context CAUTION Debugging affects the performance of the system. After debugging, run the undo debugging all command to disable it immediately. When a fault occurs when multicast is enabled, run the following debugging commands in the user view to debug multicast routes and to locate the fault. Procedure l Run the following commands in the user view to enable the debugging of multicast forwarding. – debugging mfib [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] all – debugging mfib [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] { no-cache | module | packet | register | route | sync | upcall | wrong-iif } [ advanced-aclnumber ] l Run the debugging mrm [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name | all-instance ] { all | event | packet [ advanced-acl-number ] | route [ advanced-acl-number ] } command in the user view to enable the debugging of multicast routing management. ----End 9.8 Configuration Examples Examples for configuring static multicast routes and multicast load splitting are provided. 9.8.1 Example for Changing Static Multicast Routes to RPF Routes Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 343 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management Networking Requirements As shown in Figure 9-1, PIM-DM runs on the network and all the Switches support multicast. The receiver can receive information from the multicast source. Switch A, Switch B, and Switch C run OSPF. You need to configure a static multicast route to make the multicast path from the source to the receiver different from the unicast path from the source to the receiver. Figure 9-1 Networking diagram for changing static multicast routes to RPF routes SwitchC GE3/0/0 GE3/0/0 GE2/0/0 PIM-DM GE2/0/0 SwitchB SwitchA GE2/0/0 GE1/0/0 GE1/0/0 8.1.1.2/24 GE3/0/0 7.1.1.2/24 Receiver Source Multicast static route Switch Physical interface VLANIF interface IP address Switch A GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 10 9.1.1.1/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 20 8.1.1.1/24 GE 3/0/0 VLANIF 30 12.1.1.1/24 GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 10 9.1.1.2/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 40 13.1.1.1/24 GE 3/0/0 VLANIF 50 7.1.1.1/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 40 13.1.1.2/24 GE 3/0/0 VLANIF 30 12.1.1.2/24 Switch B Switch C Configuration Roadmap The configuration roadmap is as follows: 1. Configure the IP addresses of interfaces and the unicast routing protocol on each Switch. 2. Enable the multicast function on all Switches, PIM-SM on all interfaces, and IGMP on the interfaces at the host side. 3. Configure static multicast RPF routes on Switch B, and configure Switch C as the RPF neighbor. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 344 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management Data Preparation To complete the configuration, you need the following data: l IP address of the source l Outgoing interface of the route from Switch B to Switch C: VLANIF 40 NOTE This configuration example describes only the commands used to configure static multicast routes. Procedure Step 1 Configure the IP addresses of interfaces and the unicast routing protocol on each Switch. # Configure the IP addresses and masks on the interfaces on each Switch according to Figure 9-1. IP addresses must be configured on the VLANIF interfaces. OSPF runs between Switch A, Switch B and Switch C, and the Switches can update routes among them through the unicast routing protocol. The configuration procedure is not provided here. Step 2 Enable multicast on all Switches and PIM-DM on all interfaces. # Enable multicast on all Switches, and PIM-SM on all interfaces. Enable the IGMP function on the interfaces at the host side. The configurations of other Switches are similar to configuration of Switch B, and are not provided here. [SwitchB] multicast routing-enable [SwitchB] interface vlanif 10 [SwitchB-Vlanif10] pim dm [SwitchB-Vlanif10] quit [SwitchB] interface vlanif 40 [SwitchB-Vlanif40] pim dm [SwitchB-Vlanif40] quit [SwitchB] interface vlanif 50 [SwitchB-Vlanif50] pim dm [SwitchB-Vlanif50] igmp enable [SwitchB-Vlanif50] quit # Run the display multicast rpf-info command on Switch B to view the RPF information of the source. The RPF routes are unicast routes, and the RPF neighbor is Switch A. The following information is displayed: [SwitchB] display multicast rpf-info 8.1.1.2 VPN-Instance: public net RPF information about source 8.1.1.2: RPF interface: vlanif10, RPF neighbor: 9.1.1.1 Referenced route/mask: 8.1.1.0/24 Referenced route type: unicast Route selection rule: preference-preferred Load splitting rule: disable Step 3 Configure the static multicast route. # Configure a static multicast RPF route on Switch B, and configure Switch C as the RPF neighbor. [SwitchB] ip rpf-route-static 8.1.1.0 255.255.255.0 13.1.1.2 Step 4 Verify the configuration. # Run the display multicast rpf-info command on Switch B to view the RPF information of the source. The RPF information is as follows. The RPF routes and the RPF neighbor are updated according to the static multicast route. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 345 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management [SwitchB] display multicast rpf-info 8.1.1.2 VPN-Instance: public net RPF information about source 8.1.1.2: RPF interface: vlanif40, RPF neighbor: 13.1.1.2 Referenced route/mask: 8.1.1.0/24 Referenced route type: mstatic Route selection rule: preference-preferred Load splitting rule: disable ----End Configuration Files l Configuration file of Switch A # sysname SwitchA # vlan batch 10 20 30 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif10 ip address 9.1.1.1 255.255.255.0 pim dm # interface Vlanif20 ip address 8.1.1.1 255.255.255.0 pim dm # interface Vlanif30 ip address 12.1.1.1 255.255.255.0 pim dm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 10 port hybrid untagged vlan 10 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 20 port hybrid untagged vlan 20 # interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 30 port hybrid untagged vlan 30 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 8.1.1.0 0.0.0.255 network 9.1.1.0 0.0.0.255 network 12.1.1.0 0.0.0.255 # return l Configuration file of Switch B # sysname SwitchB # vlan batch 10 40 50 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif10 ip address 9.1.1.2 255.255.255.0 pim dm # interface Vlanif40 ip address 13.1.1.1 255.255.255.0 pim dm Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 346 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management # interface Vlanif50 ip address 7.1.1.1 255.255.255.0 pim dm igmp enable # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 10 port hybrid untagged vlan 10 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 40 port hybrid untagged vlan 40 # interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 50 port hybrid untagged vlan 50 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 7.1.1.0 0.0.0.255 network 9.1.1.0 0.0.0.255 network 13.1.1.0 0.0.0.255 # ip rpf-route-static 8.1.1.0 255.255.255.0 13.1.1.2 # return l Configuration file of Switch C # sysname SwitchC # vlan batch 30 40 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif30 ip address 12.1.1.2 255.255.255.0 pim dm # interface Vlanif40 ip address 13.1.1.2 255.255.255.0 pim dm # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 40 port hybrid untagged vlan 40 # interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 30 port hybrid untagged vlan 30 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 12.1.1.0 0.0.0.255 network 13.1.1.0 0.0.0.255 # return 9.8.2 Example for Connecting RPF Routes Through Static Multicast Routes Networking Requirements As shown in Figure 9-2, PIM-DM runs on the network and all Switch support multicast. The receiver can receive information from the multicast source Source1. Switch B and Switch C run Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 347 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management OSPF. No unicast route is available between Switch A and Switch B. You need to use a multicast static route to enable the receiver to receive information sent by Source2. Figure 9-2 Networking diagram for connecting the RPF route through static multicast routes PIM-DM OSPF Source1 10.1.3.2/24 GE2/0/0 GE3/0/0 GE3/0/0 SwitchA SwitchB GE1/0/0 GE1/0/0 GE1/0/0 SwitchC GE2/0/0 Source2 10.1.5.2/24 Receiver Multicast static route Switch Physical interface VLANIF interface IP address Switch A GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 11 10.1.5.1/24 GE 3/0/0 VLANIF 40 10.1.4.2/24 GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 20 10.1.2.2/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 13 10.1.3.1/24 GE 3/0/0 VLANIF 40 10.1.4.1/24 GE 1/0/0 VLANIF 20 10.1.2.1/24 GE 2/0/0 VLANIF 12 10.1.1.1/24 Switch B Switch C Configuration Roadmap The configuration roadmap is as follows: 1. Configure the IP addresses of interfaces and the unicast routing protocol on each Switch. 2. Enable the multicast function on all routers, PIM-SM on all interfaces, and IGMP on the interfaces connected to hosts. 3. Configure static multicast RPF routes on Switch B and Switch C. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 348 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management Data Preparation To complete the configuration, you need the following data: l IP address of Source2 l RPF interface, VLANIF 40, through which Switch B connects to Source 2 and the RPF neighbor, namely, Switch A l RPF interface, VLANIF 20, through which Switch C connects to Source 2 and the RPF neighbor, namely, Switch C NOTE This configuration example describes only the commands used to configure static multicast routes. Procedure Step 1 Configure the IP addresses of interfaces and the unicast routing protocol on each Switch. # Configure the IP addresses and masks on the interfaces on each Switch according to Figure 9-2. Switch B and Switch C belong to the same OSPF area, and they can update routes between them through the unicast routing protocol. The configuration procedure is not provided here. Step 2 Enable multicast on all Switches and PIM-DM on all interfaces. # Enable multicast on all Switches, and PIM-DM on all interfaces. Enable the IGMP function on the interfaces connected to hosts. [SwitchA] multicast routing-enable [SwitchA] interface vlanif11 [SwitchA-Vlanif11] pim dm [SwitchA-Vlanif11] quit [SwitchA] interface vlanif 40 [SwitchA-Vlanif40] pim dm [SwitchA-Vlanif40] quit [SwitchB] multicast routing-enable [SwitchB] interface vlanif 20 [SwitchB-Vlanif20] pim dm [SwitchB-Vlanif20] quit [SwitchB] interface vlanif 13 [SwitchB-Vlanif13] pim dm [SwitchB-Vlanif13] quit [SwitchB] interface vlanif 40 [SwitchB-Vlanif40] pim dm [SwitchB-Vlanif40] quit [SwitchC] multicast routing-enable [SwitchC] interface vlanif 20 [SwitchC-Vlanif20] pim dm [SwitchC-Vlanif20] quit [SwitchC] interface vlanif 12 [SwitchC-Vlanif12] pim dm [SwitchC-Vlanif12] igmp enable [SwitchC-Vlanif12] quit # Source 1 (10.1.3.2/24) and Source 2 (10.1.5.2/24) send multicast data to the multicast group G (225.1.1.1). The receiver joins multicast group G. Therefore, the receiver can receive the multicast data sent by Source1, but cannot receive the multicast data sent by Source2. # Run the display multicast rpf-info 10.1.5.2 command on Switch B and Switch C. If no information is displayed, it indicates that Switch B and Switch C have no RPF route to Source2. Step 3 Configure the static multicast route. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 349 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management # Configure a static multicast RPF route on Switch B, and configure Switch A as the RPF neighbor. [SwitchB] ip rpf-route-static 10.1.5.0 255.255.255.0 10.1.4.2 # Configure a static multicast RPF route on Switch C, and configure Switch B as the RPF neighbor. [SwitchC] ip rpf-route-static 10.1.5.0 255.255.255.0 10.1.2.2 Step 4 Verify the configuration. # Run the display multicast rpf-info 10.1.5.2 command on Switch B and Switch C to view the RPF information of Source2. The RPF information is as follows: [SwitchB] display multicast rpf-info 10.1.5.2 VPN-Instance: public net RPF information about source: 10.1.5.2 RPF interface: vlanif40, RPF neighbor: 10.1.4.2 Referenced route/mask: 10.1.5.0/24 Referenced route type: mstatic Route selecting rule: preference-preferred Load splitting rule: disable [SwitchC] display multicast rpf-info 10.1.5.2 VPN-Instance: public net RPF information about source 10.1.5.2: RPF interface: vlanif20, RPF neighbor: 10.1.2.2 Referenced route/mask: 10.1.5.0/24 Referenced route type: mstatic Route selection rule: preference-preferred Load splitting rule: disable # Run the display pim routing-table command on Switch C to view the routing table. Switch C has the multicast entries of Source2. The receiver can receive the multicast data from Source2. [SwitchC] display pim routing-table VPN-Instance: public net Total 1 (*, G) entry; 2 (S, G) entry (*, 225.1.1.1) Protocol: pim-dm, Flag: WC UpTime: 03:54:19 Upstream interface: NULL Upstream neighbor: NULL RPF prime neighbor: NULL Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: vlanif12 Protocol: pim-dm, UpTime: 01:38:19, Expires: never (10.1.3.2, 225.1.1.1) Protocol: pim-dm, Flag: ACT UpTime: 00:00:44 Upstream interface: vlanif20 Upstream neighbor: 10.1.2.2 RPF prime neighbor: 10.1.2.2 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: vlanif12 Protocol: pim-dm, UpTime: 00:00:44, Expires: never (10.1.5.2, 225.1.1.1) Protocol: pim-dm, Flag: ACT UpTime: 00:00:44 Upstream interface: vlanif20 Upstream neighbor: 10.1.2.2 RPF prime neighbor: 10.1.2.2 Downstream interface(s) information: Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 350 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management Total number of downstreams: 1 1: vlanif12 Protocol: pim-dm, UpTime: 00:00:44, Expires: never ----End Configuration Files l Configuration file of Switch A # sysname SwitchA # multicast routing-enable # vlan batch 11 40 # interface Vlanif11 ip address 10.1.5.1 255.255.255.0 pim dm # interface Vlanif40 ip address 10.1.4.2 255.255.255.0 pim dm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 11 port hybrid untagged vlan 11 # interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 40 port hybrid untagged vlan 40 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 10.1.5.0 0.0.0.255 network 10.1.4.0 0.0.0.255 # return l Configuration file of Switch B # sysname SwitchB # vlan batch 13 20 40 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif13 ip address 10.1.3.1 255.255.255.0 pim dm # interface Vlanif20 ip address 10.1.2.2 255.255.255.0 pim dm # interface Vlanif40 ip address 10.1.4.1 255.255.255.0 pim dm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 20 port hybrid untagged vlan 20 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 13 port hybrid untagged vlan 13 # interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 351 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management port hybrid pvid vlan 40 port hybrid untagged vlan 40 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 10.1.2.0 0.0.0.255 network 10.1.3.0 0.0.0.255 # ip rpf-route-static 10.1.5.0 24 10.1.4.2 # return l Configuration file of Switch C # sysname SwitchC # vlan batch 12 20 # multicast routing-enable # interface Vlanif12 ip address 10.1.1.1 255.255.255.0 igmp enable pim dm # interface Vlanif20 ip address 10.1.2.1 255.255.255.0 pim dm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 20 port hybrid untagged vlan 20 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 12 port hybrid untagged vlan 12 # ospf 1 area 0.0.0.0 network 10.1.1.0 0.0.0.255 network 10.1.2.0 0.0.0.255 # ip rpf-route-static 10.1.5.0 24 10.1.2.2 # return 9.8.3 Example for Configuring Multicast Load Splitting Networking Requirements RPF check is the basis of route selection and unicast routes are used to forward multicast traffic. According to RPF check, a unique route is selected to forward multicast data. If multicast traffic is heavy, network congestion may occur and multicast services are affected. Multicast load splitting is an extension of the multicast route selection rule and is independent of RPF check. If there are multiple optimal equal-cost routes on a network, they may be used to forward multicast data. Multicast traffic can be load balanced amount multiple equal-cost routes. Currently, multicast load splitting can be performed based on the source address, group address, and source group address, without meeting requirements of load splitting in all the scenarios. If multicast routing entries and network configurations are stable, RPF interfaces and RPF neighbors in the entries remain unchanged. If a few multicast routing entries are used, traffic among equal-cost routes may be distributed unevenly. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 352 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management The stable-preferred multicast load splitting policy offsets the disadvantages of the preceding load splitting policies. As shown in Figure 9-3, three equal-cost routes are available from Switch E connected to HostA to the multicast source. The stable-preferred multicast load splitting policy is configured on Switch E so that entries are evenly distributed to the three equal-cost routes. Load splitting among equal-cost routes is implemented. If forwarding capabilities or traffic congestion degrees of the three equal-cost routes of Switch E are different, multicast entries cannot be load balanced. You need to configure uneven load splitting on Switch E, set different load splitting routes for upstream interfaces, and change the number of multicast entries on the equal-cost routes. In this manner, multicast entries on the equal-cost routes can be controlled flexibly. Figure 9-3 Networking diagram for configuring multicast load splitting PIM-SM Source GE1/0/0 SwitchA GE /0 0/1 GE1/0 SwitchB 2/0/0 GE1/0 / 2 /1 GE GE1/0/2 GE2/0/2 GE2 GE2/0/0 /0/3 GE1/0/0 /0/3 GE1 SwitchC Loopback0 GE1 /0/0 GE2/0/0 SwitchE /0/0 GE2 HostA SwitchD Device Interface IP Address Device Interface IP Address Switch A GE1/0/0 10.110.1.2/24 Switch C GE1/0/0 192.168.2.2/24 VLANIF10 GE2/0/1 VLANIF30 192.168.1.1/24 GE2/0/0 VLANIF20 GE2/0/2 VLANIF80 192.168.2.1/24 Switch D VLANIF30 GE2/0/3 GE1/0/0 192.168.3.2/24 VLANIF40 192.168.3.1/24 GE2/0/0 VLANIF40 LoopBack0 192.168.5.1/24 192.168.6.1/24 VLANIF100 1.1.1.1/32 Switch E GE1/0/1 192.168.4.2/24 VLANIF60 SwitchB GE1/0/0 192.168.1.2/24 VLANIF20 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. GE1/0/2 192.168.5.2/24 VLANIF80 353 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management GE2/0/0 192.168.4.1/24 VLANIF60 GE1/0/3 192.168.6.2/24 VLANIF100 GE2/0/0 10.110.2.2/24 VLANIF140 Configuration Roadmap The configuration roadmap is as follows: l Assign IP addresses to interfaces on switches. l Configure IS-IS to implement interworking among all the switches and ensure that route costs are the same. l Enable multicast on all the switches, enable PIM-SM on all the interfaces, and set the loopback interface on Switch A as an RP. l Configure stable-preferred multicast load splitting on Switch E to ensure the stability of multicast services. l HostA needs to receive data from some multicast groups for a long period. Add the hostside interfaces of Switch E to multicast groups in batches. l HostA needs to receive data from a new multicast group. According to networking requirements, set different multicast load splitting weights for upstream interfaces on Switch E to ensure that multicast traffic is distributed unevenly. Data Preparation To complete the configuration, you need the following data: l IP address of the multicast source l IP addresses of interfaces on the switches l Addresses of the multicast groups to which the host-side interfaces of Switch E are added in batches l Multicast load splitting weights of upstream interfaces on Switch E Procedure Step 1 Assign IP addresses to interfaces on the switches according to Figure 9-3. The configuration details are not provided here. Step 2 Configure IS-IS to implement interworking among switches and ensure that route costs are the same. The configuration details are not provided here. Step 3 Enable multicast on all the switches and enable PIM-SM on each interface. # Configure Switch A. The configurations on Switch B, Switch C, Switch D, and Switch E are similar to the configuration on Switch A, and are not provided here. [SwitchA] multicast routing-enable [SwitchA] interface Vlanif10 [SwitchA-Vlanif10] pim sm [SwitchA-Vlanif20] quit Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 354 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management [SwitchA] interface Vlanif20 [SwitchA-Vlanif20] pim sm [SwitchA-Vlanif20] quit [SwitchA] interface Vlanif30 [SwitchA-Vlanif30] pim sm [SwitchA-Vlanif30] quit [SwitchA] interface Vlanif40 [SwitchA-Vlanif40] pim sm [SwitchA-Vlanif40] quit [SwitchA] interface loopback 0 [SwitchA-LoopBack0] pim sm [SwitchA-LoopBack0] quit Step 4 Configure an RP on Switch A. # Configure Loopback0 on Switch A as an RP. [SwitchA] pim [SwitchA-pim] c-bsr loopback 0 [SwitchA-pim] c-rp loopback 0 [SwitchA-pim] quit Step 5 Configure stable-preferred multicast load splitting on Switch E. [SwitchE] multicast load-splitting stable-preferred Step 6 Add the host-side interfaces of Switch E to multicast groups in batches. # Add VLANIF140 to multicast groups from 225.1.1.1 to 225.1.1.3. [SwitchE] interface Vlanif140 [SwitchE-Vlanif140] igmp static-group 225.1.1.1 inc-step-mask 32 number 3 [SwitchE-Vlanif140] quit Step 7 Verify the configuration of stable-preferred multicast load splitting. # The multicast source (10.110.1.1/24) sends multicast data to multicast groups 225.1.1.1 to 225.1.1.3. HostA can receive the multicast data from the multicast source. On Switch E, check brief information about the PIM routing table. <SwitchE> display pim routing-table brief VPN-Instance: public net Total 3 (*, G) entry; 3 (S, G) entries 00001.(*, 225.1.1.1) Upstream interface:Vlanif100 Number of downstream:1 00002.(10.110.1.1, 225.1.1.1) Upstream interface:Vlanif100 Number of downstream:1 00003.(*, 225.1.1.2) Upstream interface:Vlanif80 Number of downstream:1 00004.(10.110.1.1, 225.1.1.2) Upstream interface:Vlanif80 Number of downstream:1 00005.(*, 225.1.1.3) Upstream interface:Vlanif60 Number of downstream:1 00006.(10.110.1.1, 225.1.1.3) Upstream interface:Vlanif60 Number of downstream:1 (*, G) and (S, G) entries are evenly distributed to the three equal-cost routes, with the upstream interfaces being VLANIF100, VLANIF80, and VLANIF60. NOTE The load splitting algorithm processes (*, G) and (S, G) entries separately with the same processing rule. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 355 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management Step 8 Set different multicast load splitting weights for upstream interfaces of Switch E to ensure that multicast traffic is distributed unevenly. # Set the multicast load splitting weight on VLANIF60 to 2. [SwitchE] interface Vlanif60 [SwitchE-Vlanif60] multicast load-splitting weight 2 [SwitchE-Vlanif60] quit # Set the multicast load splitting weight on VLANIF100 to 0. [SwitchE] interface Vlanif100 [SwitchE-Vlanif100] multicast load-splitting weight 0 [SwitchE-Vlanif100] quit Step 9 Add the host-side interfaces of SwitchE to multicast groups in batches. # Add VLANIF140 to multicast groups from 225.1.1.4 to 225.1.1.9. [SwitchE] interface Vlanif140 [SwitchE-Vlanif140] igmp static-group 225.1.1.4 inc-step-mask 32 number 6 [SwitchE-Vlanif140] quit Step 10 Verify the configuration of uneven multicast load splitting. # The multicast source (10.110.1.1/24) sends multicast data to multicast groups 225.1.1.1 to 225.1.1.9. HostA can receive the multicast data from the multicast source. On Switch E, check brief information about the PIM routing table. <SwitchE> display pim routing-table brief VPN-Instance: public net Total 9 (*, G) entry; 9 (S, G) entries 00001.(*, 225.1.1.1) Upstream interface:Vlanif100 Number of downstream:1 00002.(10.110.1.1, 225.1.1.1) Upstream interface:Vlanif100 Number of downstream:1 00003.(*, 225.1.1.2) Upstream interface:Vlanif80 Number of downstream:1 00004.(10.110.1.1, 225.1.1.2) Upstream interface:Vlanif80 Number of downstream:1 00005.(*, 225.1.1.3) Upstream interface:Vlanif60 Number of downstream:1 00006.(10.110.1.1, 225.1.1.3) Upstream interface:Vlanif60 Number of downstream:1 00007.(*, 225.1.1.4) Upstream interface:Vlanif60 Number of downstream:1 00008.(10.110.1.1, 225.1.1.4) Upstream interface:Vlanif60 00009.(*, 225.1.1.5) Upstream interface:Vlanif60 Number of downstream:1 00010.(10.110.1.1, 225.1.1.5) Upstream interface:Vlanif60 00011.(*, 225.1.1.6) Upstream interface:Vlanif60 Number of downstream:1 00012.(10.110.1.1, 225.1.1.6) Upstream interface:Vlanif60 Number of downstream:1 00011.(*, 225.1.1.6) Upstream interface:Vlanif60 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 356 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management Number of downstream:1 00012.(10.110.1.1, 225.1.1.6) Upstream interface:Vlanif60 Number of downstream:1 00013.(*, 225.1.1.7) Upstream interface:Vlanif80 Number of downstream:1 00014.(10.110.1.1, 225.1.1.7) Upstream interface:Vlanif60 Number of downstream:1 00015.(*, 225.1.1.8) Upstream interface:Vlanif60 Number of downstream:1 00016.(10.110.1.1, 225.1.1.8) Upstream interface:Vlanif80 Number of downstream:1 00017.(*, 225.1.1.9) Upstream interface:Vlanif60 Number of downstream:1 00018.(10.110.1.1, 225.1.1.9) Upstream interface:Vlanif60 Number of downstream:1 The upstream interfaces of existing (*, G) and (S, G) entries remain unchanged. The multicast load splitting weight of VLANIF60 is greater than that of VLANIF80; The default multicast load splitting weight is 1. therefore, the newly generated entries with the upstream interface being VLANIF60 are more than those with the upstream interface being VLANIF80. The multicast load splitting weight of VLANIF100 is 0, indicating that VLANIF100 does not load balance new entries. ----End Configuration Files l Configuration file of Switch A. # sysname SwitchA # multicast routing-enable # isis 1 network-entity 10.0000.0000.0001.00 # interface Vlanif10 ip address 10.110.1.2 255.255.255.0 isis enable 1 pim sm interface Vlanif20 ip address 192.168.1.1 255.255.255.0 isis enable 1 pim sm interface Vlanif30 ip address 192.168.2.1 255.255.255.0 isis enable 1 pim sm interface Vlanif40 ip address 192.168.3.1 255.255.255.0 isis enable 1 pim sm interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port link-type hybrid port hybrid tagged vlan 10 # Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 357 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management interface GigabitEthernet2/0/1 port link-type hybrid port hybrid tagged vlan 20 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/2 port link-type hybrid port hybrid tagged vlan 30 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/3 port link-type hybrid port hybrid tagged vlan 40 # interface LoopBack0 ip address 1.1.1.1 255.255.255.255 isis enable 1 pim sm # pim c-bsr LoopBack0 c-rp LoopBack0 # return l Configuration file of Switch B. # sysname SwitchB # multicast routing-enable # isis 1 network-entity 10.0000.0000.0002.00 # interface Vlanif20 ip address 192.168.1.2 255.255.255.0 isis enable 1 pim sm interface Vlanif60 ip address 192.168.4.1 255.255.255.0 isis enable 1 pim sm interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port link-type hybrid port hybrid tagged vlan 20 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port link-type hybrid port hybrid tagged vlan 60 # return l Configuration file of Switch C. # sysname SwitchC # multicast routing-enable # isis 1 network-entity 10.0000.0000.0003.00 # interface Vlanif30 ip address 192.168.2.2 255.255.255.0 isis enable 1 pim sm interface Vlanif80 ip address 192.168.5.1 255.255.255.0 isis enable 1 pim sm Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 358 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port link-type hybrid port hybrid tagged vlan 30 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port link-type hybrid port hybrid tagged vlan 80 # return l Configuration file of Switch D. # sysname SwitchD # multicast routing-enable # isis 1 network-entity 10.0000.0000.0004.00 # interface Vlanif40 ip address 192.168.3.2 255.255.255.0 isis enable 1 pim sm interface Vlanif100 ip address 192.168.6.1 255.255.255.0 isis enable 1 pim sm interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port link-type hybrid port hybrid tagged vlan 40 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port link-type hybrid port hybrid tagged vlan 100 # return l Configuration file of Switch E. # sysname SwitchE # multicast routing-enable multicast load-splitting stable-preferred # isis 1 network-entity 10.0000.0000.0005.00 # interface Vlanif60 ip address 192.168.4.2 255.255.255.0 isis enable 1 pim sm multicast load-splitting weight 2 interface Vlanif80 ip address 192.168.5.2 255.255.255.0 isis enable 1 pim sm interface Vlanif100 ip address 192.168.6.2 255.255.255.0 isis enable 1 pim sm multicast load-splitting weight 0 interface Vlanif140 ip address 10.110.2.2 255.255.255.0 isis enable 1 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 359 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 9 IPv4 Multicast Routing Management pim sm igmp static-group 225.1.1.1 inc-step-mask 0.0.0.1 number 3 igmp static-group 225.1.1.4 inc-step-mask 0.0.0.1 number 6 interface GigabitEthernet1/0/1 port link-type hybrid port hybrid tagged vlan 60 # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/2 port link-type hybrid port hybrid tagged vlan 80 # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/3 port link-type hybrid port hybrid tagged vlan 100 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port link-type hybrid port hybrid tagged vlan 140 # return Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 360 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 10 MLD Configuration 10 MLD Configuration About This Chapter On an IPv6 network, by configuring MLD on an interface of a multicast device connected with the user network segment, you can manage group members on the local network. 10.1 MLD Overview MLD is short for Multicast Listener Discovery. It has two versions: MLDv1 and MLDv2. MLDv1 supports the ASM model and MLDv2 can directly support the SSM model. 10.2 MLD Features Supported by the S9700 The MLD features supported by the system include: basic MLD functions, static MLD groups, configuring the range of groups that an interface can join, controlling the Router-Alert option in an MLD packet, configuring parameters of an MLD Query message, SSM mapping, and limiting the number of MLD group memberships. 10.3 Configuring Basic MLD Functions By configuring basic MLD functions on an interface of a multicast device connected with the user network segment, you can enable a user host to access the multicast network and receive multicast data packets. 10.4 Configuring Options of an MLD Packet You can enable a multicast device to filter MLD Report messages and receive only the MLD messages with Router-Alert options by configuring options of MLD messages. 10.5 Configuring MLD Query Control An MLD querier periodically sends MLD Query messages on a shared network segment to refresh information about IGMP group members. MLD parameters configured on all the interfaces of the multicast devices on the same network segment with the user host should be consistent; otherwise, a fault occurs on the network. 10.6 Configuring SSM Mapping In the network segment where multicast services are provided in the SSM mode, the interface of the multicast device runs MLDv2 while certain hosts can run only MLDv1 due to various limitations. To ensure that the multicast device running a later MLD version is compatible with the hosts running an earlier MLD version and provides SSM services for these hosts, you need to configure static SSM mapping on the multicast device. 10.7 Configuration MLD Limit Function If you want to restrict the servable IPTV ICPs and the number of access users on an IP core network, the MLD limit function is required. Configuring the MLD limit function involves Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 361 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 10 MLD Configuration setting the maximum number of global MLD group memberships, maximum number of global MLD group memberships in a single instance, and maximum number of MLD group memberships on an interface. 10.8 Maintaining MLD Maintaining MLD involves resetting MLD group information, and monitoring MLD running status. 10.9 Configuration Example Examples for configuring basic MLD functions and the MLD limit function in the multicast network are provided. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 362 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 10 MLD Configuration 10.1 MLD Overview MLD is short for Multicast Listener Discovery. It has two versions: MLDv1 and MLDv2. MLDv1 supports the ASM model and MLDv2 can directly support the SSM model. The Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD) is a sub-protocol of the Internet Control Message Protocol version 6 (ICMPv6). MLD is used to set up and maintain the membership of groups between hosts and their directly connected multicast switchs. The functions and principles of MLD are the same as those of the Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP).MLD has the following versions: l MLDv1 MLDv1 is defined in RFC 2710, and is derived from IGMPv2. MLDv1 supports the AnySource Multicast (ASM) model. With the help of SSM mapping, MLDv1 can support the Source-Specific Multicast (SSM) model. l MLDv2 MLDv2 is defined in RFC 3810, and is derived from IGMPv3. MLDv2 supports the ASM and SSM models. 10.2 MLD Features Supported by the S9700 The MLD features supported by the system include: basic MLD functions, static MLD groups, configuring the range of groups that an interface can join, controlling the Router-Alert option in an MLD packet, configuring parameters of an MLD Query message, SSM mapping, and limiting the number of MLD group memberships. Basic MLD Function You can enable MLD and configure the MLD version. Static MLD Group You can configure an interface to statically join a multicast group. After the interface statically joins a group, the system considers that the network segment where the interface resides has a member of the group. Configuring the Range of Groups that an Interface Can Join You can set the range of groups that an interface can join as required. Controlling the Router-Alert Option in an MLD Packet You can determine whether to set the Router-Alert option in the MLD packets to be sent, and whether to require that the received MLD packets contain the Router-Alert option. Configuring Parameters of an MLD Query Message You can set the interval for sending general query messages, MLD robustness variable, the maximum response time of MLD Query messages, Keepalive period of other MLD queriers, the interval for sending MLD group-specific query messages, and MLD fast leave. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 363 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 10 MLD Configuration SSM Mapping For MLDv1 hosts, you can configure SSM mapping to build a multicast network of the SSM model. Limiting the Number of MLD Group Memberships l Limiting the total number of MLD group memberships on a switch: The total number of MLD group memberships created by a switch cannot exceed the limit value. When the total number of MLD group memberships created by a switch exceeds the limit value, no MLD entry can be created. l Limiting the total number of MLD group memberships in a single instance: The total number of MLD group memberships related to an instance cannot exceed the limit value. When the total number of MLD group memberships related to an instance reaches the limit value, no MLD entry can be created. l Limiting the total number of MLD group memberships on an interface: The total number of MLD group memberships created on an interface cannot exceed the limit value. When the total number of MLD group memberships created on an interface reaches the limit value, no MLD entry can be created. 10.3 Configuring Basic MLD Functions By configuring basic MLD functions on an interface of a multicast device connected with the user network segment, you can enable a user host to access the multicast network and receive multicast data packets. 10.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task Before configuring basic MLD functions, familiarize yourself with the applicable environment, pre-configuration tasks, and required data. This can help you complete the configuration task quickly and accurately. Applicable Environment MLD is applicable to the switch and the hosts directly connected to the switch. The switch and hosts need to run MLD. This section only describes how to configure MLD on a switch. You must enable IPv6 multicast routing before configuring MLD. IPv6 multicast routing is the prerequisite for configuring IPv6 multicast functions. If the IPv6 multicast routing is disabled, all IPv6 multicast configurations are deleted. Enable MLD on the interface connected to hosts. For different MLD versions, MLD packets are different; therefore, you need to configure matching MLD versions for switchs and hosts. Other MLD configurations can be done only after the preceding operations are complete. To enable hosts in the network segment to which the interface is connected to join the specified groups and receive packets to the groups, you can set a group policy on the related interface to limit the range of groups that the interface serves. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring basic MLD functions, configure a unicast routing protocol to interconnect the entire multicast domain. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 364 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 10 MLD Configuration Data Preparation To configure basic MLD functions, you need the following data. No. Data 1 MLD version 2 Group address and source address 3 ACL6 rules for filtering multicast groups 10.3.2 Enabling IPv6 Multicast Routing Before configuring basic MLD functions, enable IPv6 multicast routing. Context Do as follows on the switch connected to hosts: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: multicast ipv6 routing-enable IPv6 multicast routing is enabled in the public network instance. ----End 10.3.3 Enabling MLD After MLD is enabled on an interface of a multicast device connected with the user network segment, user hosts can dynamically join multicast groups. Context Do as follows on the switch connected to hosts: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 365 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 10 MLD Configuration interface-type interface-number specifies the interface connected to hosts. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, or an Loopback interface. Step 3 Run: mld enable MLD is enabled on the interface. By default, MLD is not enabled on the interface. NOTE If PIM-SM (IPv6) or PIM-DM (IPv6) is also required on this interface, PIM-SM (IPv6) or PIM-DM (IPv6) must be enabled before MLD is enabled. ----End 10.3.4 (Optional) Configuring the MLD Version You need to configure the version of MLD enabled on the interface of a multicast device connected with the user network segment. Note that the versions of MLD enabled on the multicast devices on the same network segment should be the same; otherwise, a network abnormality occurs. Context CAUTION Ensure that all MLD switch interfaces in the same network segment are configured with the same MLD version. Otherwise, faults may occur. This configuration is optional. By default, MLDv2 is adopted. Do as follows on the switch connected to hosts: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be a VLANIF interface, or an Loopback interface. Step 3 Run: mld version { 1 | 2 } The MLD version of the interface level is configured. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 366 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 10 MLD Configuration By default, MLDv2 is adopted. ----End 10.3.5 (Optional) Configuring an Interface to Statically Join a Group After a static MLD group is configured on the interface that connects a multicast device to the user network segment, the multicast device considers that the interface has multicast group members and keeps on forwarding matched multicast packets to the network segment where this interface resides. Context Do as follows on the switch connected to hosts: NOTE This configuration is optional. By default, the interface does not statically join any group. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. Step 3 Run: mld static-group ipv6-group-address [ inc-step-mask ipv6-group-mask-length number group-number ] [ source ipv6-source-address ] The interface is configured to statically join a single multicast group or multiple multicast groups in batches. After the interface statically joins the multicast groups, the switch considers that the members of the multicast groups exist on the network segment where the interface resides. ----End 10.3.6 (Optional) Configuring the Range of Groups an Interface Can Join You can configure the range of groups on the interface of a multicast device connected with the user network segment so that user hosts can join only a specified range of multicast groups. Context Do as follows on the switch connected to hosts: NOTE This configuration is optional. By default, the interface can join any group. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 367 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 10 MLD Configuration Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. Step 3 Run: mld group-policy { acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name } [ 1 | 2 ] The range of groups that the interface can join is configured. ----End 10.3.7 Checking the Configuration After configuring basic MLD functions, check the configuration and running information about MLD on the interface and memberships of MLD multicast groups to ensure that MLD runs normally. Procedure l Run the display mld interface [ interface-type interface-number ] [ verbose ] command to check the MLD configuration and running information on an interface. l Run the display mld group [ ipv6-group-address | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * [ static ] [ verbose ] command to check information on members of an MLD multicast group. ----End 10.4 Configuring Options of an MLD Packet You can enable a multicast device to filter MLD Report messages and receive only the MLD messages with Router-Alert options by configuring options of MLD messages. 10.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task Before configuring options of an MLD message, familiarize yourself with the applicable environment, pre-configuration tasks, and required data. This can help you complete the configuration task quickly and accurately. Applicable Environment MLD has the group-specific and source/group-specific query messages. The groups are varied. Switchs cannot join all groups. The Router-Alert option is used to send the MLD packets of which the multicast group is not specified by the upper-layer protocol of the IP layer to the upperlayer protocol for processing. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 368 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 10 MLD Configuration Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring options of an MLD packet, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol to interconnect the entire multicast domain l Configuring Basic MLD Functions Data Preparation To configure options of an MLD packet, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Whether the Router-Alert option is set in the packet 10.4.2 Configuring the Router-Alert Option of an MLD Packet To make the multicast device connected with the user network segment or other MLD interfaces on the same network segment receive only the MLD messages with Router-Alert options, you can configure a Router-Alert option for MLD messages on the multicast device connected with the user network segment. Context Do as follows on the switch connected to hosts: This configuration is optional. By default, MLD packets sent by switchs carry the Router-Alert option, but the switchs do not check the Router-Alert option. That is, the switchs process all the received MLD packets, including those without the Router-Alert option. NOTE The configuration involves the following cases: l Global configuration: It is valid on all interfaces. l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used. Procedure l Global Configuration 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: mld The MLD view is displayed. 3. Run: require-router-alert The Router-Alert option is required in the received MLD packet. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 369 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 10 MLD Configuration If the received the MLD packet does not carry the Router-Alert option, the packet is discarded. 4. Run: send-router-alert The Router-Alert option is set in the header of the MLD packet to be sent. l Configuration on an Interface 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. 3. Run: mld require-router-alert The Router-Alert option is required in the received MLD packet. If the received the MLD packet does not carry the Router-Alert option, the packet is discarded. 4. Run: mld send-router-alert The Router-Alert option is set in the header of the MLD packet to be sent. ----End 10.4.3 Checking the Configuration After options of MLD messages are configured, you can check MLD configurations and running information on the interface to ensure normal running of MLD. Procedure l Run the display mld interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check the MLD configuration and running information on an interface. ----End 10.5 Configuring MLD Query Control An MLD querier periodically sends MLD Query messages on a shared network segment to refresh information about IGMP group members. MLD parameters configured on all the interfaces of the multicast devices on the same network segment with the user host should be consistent; otherwise, a fault occurs on the network. 10.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task Before configuring MLD query control, familiarize yourself with the applicable environment, pre-configuration tasks, and required data. This can help you complete the configuration task quickly and accurately. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 370 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 10 MLD Configuration Applicable Environment CAUTION A great many of MLD interfaces exist in the network and these MLD interfaces are mutually restricted. Ensure that all MLD parameters of all MLD switch interfaces on the same network segment are identical. Otherwise, the network may be faulty. The MLD querier periodically sends MLD Query messages on the share network connected to receivers. When receiving a Report message from a member, the switchs on the shared network refresh information about the member relationship. If non-queriers do not receive any query message within the Keepalive period of the MLD querier, the querier is considered faulty, and a new round of the querier election is triggered automatically. In the application of ADSL dial-up access, one host corresponds to a port. A querier, therefore, corresponds to only one receiver host. When a receiver host switches among multiple groups such as TV channels, you can enable the fast leave mechanism on the querier. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring MLD query control, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol to interconnect the entire multicast domain l Configuring Basic MLD Functions Data Preparation To configure MLD query control, you need the following data. No. Data 1 The interval for sending MLD general Query messages 2 Robustness variable 3 The maximum response time of the MLD Query message 4 Keepalive period of the other MLD queriers 5 The interval for sending MLD group-specific Query messages and group/sourcespecific Query messages 6 ACL6 that limits the application range of prompt leave 10.5.2 (Optional) Configuring MLD Query and Response Configuring an MLD querier involves setting the interval for sending general query messages, MLD robustness variable, maximum response time of the MLD Query message, Keepalive Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 371 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 10 MLD Configuration period of other MLD queriers, and interval for sending last listener query messages, and enabling the MLD fast leave function. Context CAUTION In the actual configuration, ensure that the interval for sending general Query messages is greater than the maximum response time and is smaller than the Keepalive time of the other MLD queriers. Do as follows on the switch connected to hosts: NOTE The configuration involves the following cases: l Global configuration: It is valid on all interfaces. l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used. Procedure l Global Configuration 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: mld The MLD view is displayed. 3. Run: timer query interval The interval for sending Query messages is set. By default, the interval for sending Query messages is 125 seconds. 4. Run: robust-count robust-value The MLD robustness variable is set. By default, the MLD robustness variable is 2. – When a switch starts, the switch sends general query messages for the number of robust-value times. The sending interval is 1/4 of the interval for sending MLD general query messages. – When a switch receives a Leave message, the switch sends MLD last listener query messages for the number of robust-value times. The greater the robustness variable is, the longer the timeout period of the group is. 5. Run: max-response-time interval Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 372 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 10 MLD Configuration The maximum response time of the MLD Query message is set. By default, the maximum MLD response time is 10 seconds. 6. Run: timer other-querier-present interval The interval for the Keepalive period of the other MLD queriers is set. By default, the formula used to calculate the Keepalive period of the other queriers is: the Keepalive period of the other MLD queriers = robustness variable x the interval for sending MLD general query messages + 1/2 x the MLD maximum response time. When default values of robustness variable, the interval for sending MLD general query messages, and maximum response time are used, the Keepalive period of the other MLD queriers is 255 seconds. 7. Run: lastlistener-queryinterval interval The interval for sending last listener query messages is set. The shorter the interval, the more sensitive the querier. By default, the interval is 1 second. l Configuration on an Interface 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. 3. Run: mld timer query interval The interval for sending MLD general query messages is set. 4. Run: mld max-response-time interval The maximum response time of the MLD Query message is set. 5. Run: mld timer other-querier-present interval The Keepalive period of the other MLD queriers is set. 6. Run: mld robust-count robust-value The MLD robustness variable is set. 7. Run: mld lastlistener-queryinterval interval The interval for sending MLD last listener query messages is set. 8. Run: mld prompt-leave [ group-policy { basic-acl6-number | advanced-acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name } ] MLD fast leave is configured. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 373 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 10 MLD Configuration When an interface receives a Leave message for a certain group, the interface immediately deletes the downstream interface of the entry to which the group corresponds, without sending the last listener query message. By default, when a switch receives a Leave message for a group, the switch sends last listener query messages. ----End 10.5.3 Checking the Configuration After MLD query control is configured, you can check MLD configurations and running information on the interface to ensure normal running of MLD. Procedure l Run the display mld interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check the MLD configuration and running information on an interface. ----End 10.6 Configuring SSM Mapping In the network segment where multicast services are provided in the SSM mode, the interface of the multicast device runs MLDv2 while certain hosts can run only MLDv1 due to various limitations. To ensure that the multicast device running a later MLD version is compatible with the hosts running an earlier MLD version and provides SSM services for these hosts, you need to configure static SSM mapping on the multicast device. 10.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task Before configuring SSM mapping, familiarize yourself with the applicable environment, preconfiguration tasks, and required data. This can help you complete the configuration task quickly and accurately. Applicable Environment In the SSM host network segment, the switch can know the specific source when a host joins a group. The SSM solutions are as follows: l Hosts and switchs run MLDv2. When a host joins a group, the host specifies the source from which the host wants to receive data. l If some hosts in the network segment can run only MLDv1, the hosts cannot specify the sources from which they want to receive data when joining related groups. In this case, you need to configure SSM mapping and static mapping rules on the switch. As a result, the (*, G) information carried in the Report message is mapped to the (G, INCLUDE, (S1, S2, ...)) information. SSM mapping can be configured in the following situations: l Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Interfaces in the same VPN sharing one SSM mapping: Configure a mapping in a VPN, and all SSM mapping-enabled interfaces will share the mapping. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 374 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast l 10 MLD Configuration Each interface using an SSM mapping policy: Configure an SSM mapping policy globally and specify the required SSM mapping policy on the interface. Different SSM mapping policies can be configured on different interfaces. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring SSM mapping, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol to interconnect the entire multicast domain l Enabling IPv6 Multicast Routing Data Preparation To configure SSM mapping, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Interface that needs to be enabled with SSM mapping 2 Name of the IPv6 SSM mapping policy 3 Group address/mask and source address/mask 10.6.2 Enabling SSM Mapping Prior to configuring SSM mapping, enable SSM mapping on the interface that connects the multicast device to the user network segment. Context SSM mapping must have been enabled before static SSM mapping policies are configured. The configured SSM source/group address mapping entries take effect only after SSM mapping is enabled on interfaces. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. Step 3 Run: mld enable MLD is enabled. Step 4 Run: mld version 2 The MLD version is set to 2. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 375 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 10 MLD Configuration By default, the MLD version is 1. To ensure that the hosts that run any MLD version on the network segment can obtain the SSM services, it is recommended to configure MLDv2 on the switch interface. Step 5 Run: mld ssm-mapping enable [ policy policy-name ] SSM mapping and an SSM mapping policy are enabled. If policy policy-name is specified, SSM mapping is enabled, and the SSM mapping policy is specified. If policy policy-name is not specified, only SSM mapping is enabled. ----End 10.6.3 Configuring a Static SSM Mapping Policy You can configure SSM mapping on the interface that connects the multicast device to the user network segment to enable the user hosts that support only MLDv1 but not MLDv2 to join a specific source/group. In this manner, the multicast device running a later MLD version is compatible with the hosts running an earlier MLD version and can provide the SSM service for these hosts. Context After a static SSM mapping policy is configured, SSM mapping-enabled interfaces use the SSM source/group address mapping based on the policy, and the multicast device running a later IGMP version is compatible with the hosts running an earlier IGMP version and can provide the SSM service for these hosts. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: mld The MLD view is displayed. Step 3 Run: ssm-mapping ipv6-group-address ipv6-group-mask-length ipv6-source-address The mapping from the source to the group is set. You can run the command repeatedly to configure the mapping from a group to multiple sources. l ipv6-group-address ipv6-group-mask-length: specifies the group address and mask. The group address must be in the SSM group address range. l ipv6-source-address: specifies the address of the source that sets up the mapping relationship with the group. ----End Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 376 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 10 MLD Configuration 10.6.4 Checking the Configuration After SSM mapping is configured, you can check MLD configurations and running information, SSM mapping information of a source-specific group, information about the interface enabled with SSM mapping, and SSM mapping rules of a specified group to ensure that SSM mapping runs normally. Procedure l Run the display mld interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check the MLD configuration and running information on an interface. l Run the display mld group [ ipv6-group-address | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * ssm-mapping [ verbose ] to check information about a source/group-specific address. l Run the display mld ssm-mapping interface [ interface-type interface-number [ group ipv6-group-address ] ] command to check information about an interface enabled with SSM mapping. l Run the display mld ssm-mapping group [ ipv6-group-address ] command to check SSM mapping rules of a specified group address. ----End 10.7 Configuration MLD Limit Function If you want to restrict the servable IPTV ICPs and the number of access users on an IP core network, the MLD limit function is required. Configuring the MLD limit function involves setting the maximum number of global MLD group memberships, maximum number of global MLD group memberships in a single instance, and maximum number of MLD group memberships on an interface. 10.7.1 Establishing the Configuration Task Before configuring the MLD limit function, familiarize yourself with the applicable environment, pre-configuration tasks, and required data. This can help you complete the configuration task quickly and accurately. Applicable Environment To limit IPTV ICPs and the number of users accessing IP core networks, you can configure the MLD limit function. The MLD limit function is configured on the last-hop switch connected to users. You can perform the following configurations as required: l Configure the maximum number of global MLD group memberships on a switch. l Configure the maximum number of MLD entries in a single instance. l Configure the maximum number of MLD group memberships on an interface. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 377 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 10 MLD Configuration NOTE If the MLD limit function is required to be configured globally, for a single instance, and for an interface on the same switch, it is recommended that the limits on the number of global MLD group memberships, the number of MLD group memberships in the single instance, and the number of MLD group memberships on the interface should be in descending order. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring the MLD limit function, complete the following task: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol l Configuring Basic MLD Functions Data Preparation To configure the MLD limit function, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Maximum number of global MLD group memberships 2 Maximum number of MLD group memberships in a single instance 3 Maximum number of MLD group memberships on an interface 10.7.2 Configuring the Maximum Number of Global MLD Group Memberships Configure the maximum number of MLD entries that can be created on the multicast device connected with the user network segment. When the number of MLD entries reaches the limit, the system does not create any new MLD entry. If the host wants to join a new multicast group, you need to delete certain useless entries, modify the limit, or configure the host to statically join a multicast group or source/group. Context Do as follows on the switch connected to hosts: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: mld global limit number The maximum number of global MLD entries of all instances is set. ----End Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 378 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 10 MLD Configuration 10.7.3 Configuring the Maximum Number of Global MLD Entries in a Single Instance Configure the maximum number of MLD entries that can be created in a single instance on the multicast device connected with the user network segment. When the number of MLD entries reaches the limit, the system does not create any new MLD entry. If the host wants to join a new multicast group, you need to delete certain useless entries, modify the limit, or configure the host to statically join a multicast group or source/group. Context Do as follows on the switch connected to hosts: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: mld The MLD view is displayed. Step 3 Run: limit number The maximum number of global MLD entries in a single instance is set. ----End 10.7.4 Configuring the Maximum Number of MLD Group Memberships on an Interface Configure the maximum number of MLD entries that can be created on the interface of the multicast device connected with the user network segment. When the number of MLD entries reaches the limit, the system does not create any new MLD entry. If the host wants to join a new multicast group, you need to delete certain useless entries, modify the limit, or configure the host to statically join a multicast group or source/group. Context Do as follows on the switch connected to hosts: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 379 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 10 MLD Configuration The MLD interface view is displayed. Step 3 Run: mld limit number [ except { acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name } ] The maximum number of MLD group memberships is set on the interface. NOTE If except is not specified in the command, the router is limited by the maximum number of MLD entries when creating the entries for all the groups or source/groups. Before specifying except, you need to configure the corresponding ACl. Then, the interface filters the received MLD Join messages according to the ACL. The number of entries that are filtered according to the ACL is not limited by the maximum number of MLD entries. ----End 10.7.5 Checking the Configuration After configuring MLD limit, check the configuration and running information about MLD on the interface and memberships of MLD multicast groups to ensure that MLD runs normally. Procedure l Run the display mld interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check the configuration and running of MLD on an interface. l Run the following commands to check information about the members of an MLD multicast group. – display mld group [ ipv6-group-address | interface interface-type interface-number ] * [ verbose ] – display mld group [ ipv6-group-address | interface interface-type interface-number ] * ssm-mapping [ verbose ] # Run the display mld interface command to view the configuration and running status of MLD on the switch interface. The display information is as follows: <SwitchA> display mld interface vlanif 10 Interface information Vlanif10(FE80::200:5EFF:FE66:5100): MLD is enabled Current MLD version is 1 MLD state: up MLD group policy: none MLD limit: 30 Value of query interval for MLD (negotiated): 125 s Value of query interval for MLD (configured): 125 s Value of other querier timeout for MLD: 0 s Value of maximum query response time for MLD: 10 s Querier for MLD: FE80::200:5EFF:FE66:5100 (this switch) From the display, you can see the maximum number of MLD group members on VLANIF 10 of Switch A. ----End 10.8 Maintaining MLD Maintaining MLD involves resetting MLD group information, and monitoring MLD running status. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 380 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 10 MLD Configuration 10.8.1 Clearing Information about MLD Groups After you confirm to clear the statistics on MLD groups, use the reset commands in the user view. The receiver cannot receive multicast information normally if the MLD group that the interface dynamically joins is deleted. Therefore, confirm the action before you use the reset commands. Context CAUTION The MLD groups that an interface dynamically joins are deleted after you run the reset mld group or the reset mld group ssm-mapping command. Receivers may not receive multicast information normally. So, confirm the action before you use the command. Procedure l Run the reset mld explicit-tracking { all | interface interface-type interface-number [ host ipv6-host-address [ group ipv6-group-address [ source ipv6-source-address ] ] ] } command in the user view to clear the hosts that join a multicast group through MLD on an interface. l Run the following commands in the user view to clear the MLD groups that the interface dynamically joins (not including the MLDv1 group in the SSM range). – reset mld group all – reset mld group interface interface-type interface-number { all | ipv6-groupaddress [ ipv6-group-mask-length ] [ ipv6-source-address [ ipv6-source-masklength ] ] } l Run the following commands in the user view to clear MLDv1 groups in the SSM range. – reset mld group ssm-mapping all – reset mld group ssm-mapping interface interface-type interface-number { all | ipv6group-address [ ipv6-group-mask-length ] } l Run the reset mld control-message counters [ interface interface-type interfacenumber ] [ message-type { query | report } ] command in the user view to delete statistics of MLD messages. ----End 10.8.2 Monitoring the Running Status of MLD During MLD routine maintenance, you can run the display commands in any view to know the running of MLD. Context In routine maintenance, you can run the following commands in any view to check the running status of MLD. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 381 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 10 MLD Configuration Procedure l Run the display mld explicit-tracking [ interface interface-type interface-number [ hostaddress ipv6-host-address | group ipv6-group-address source ipv6-source-address ] ] command in any view to check information about the MLD hosts on an interface. l Run the display mld group [ ipv6-group-address | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * [ static ] [ verbose ] command in any view to check information about groups on each interface. l Run the display mld group [ ipv6-group-address | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * ssm-mapping [ verbose ] command in any view to check information about a group configured with SSM mapping. l Run the display mld interface [ interface-type interface-number ] [ verbose ] command in any view to check the MLD configuration and running information on an interface. l Run the display mld routing-table [ ipv6-source-address [ ipv6-source-mask-length ] | ipv6-group-address [ ipv6-group-mask-length ] ] * [ static ] [ outgoing-interfacenumber [ number ] ] command in any view to check the MLD routing table. l Run the display mld ssm-mapping interface [ interface-type interface-number [ group ipv6-group-address ] ] command in any view to check information about an interface enabled with SSM mapping. l Run the display mld ssm-mapping group [ ipv6-group-address ] command in any view to check SSM mapping rules of a specified group address. l Run the display mld control-message counters [ interface interface-type interfacenumber ] [ message-type { query | report } ] command in any view to check the statistics of MLD messages received by interfaces. l Run the display mld invalid-packet [ interface interface-type interface-number | message-type { done | query | report } ] * command in any view to check the statistics about invalid MLD messages received by a device. ----End 10.8.3 Debugging MLD When an MLD running fault occurs, run the debugging commands in the user view and locate the fault based on the debugging information. Debugging affects the performance of the system. So, after debugging, disable it immediately. Context CAUTION Debugging affects the performance of the system. After debugging, you need to run the undo debugging all command to disable the debugging immediately. Procedure l Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Run the debugging mld { all | done [ interface-based-acl6-number | basic-acl6number ] * | event [ advanced-acl6-number ] | query [ interface-based-acl6-number | basicHuawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 382 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 10 MLD Configuration acl6-number ] * [ receive | send ] | report [ interface-based-acl6-number | advanced-acl6number ] * | timer } command in the user view to enable the debugging of MLD. l Run the debugging mld ssm-mapping [ advanced-acl6-number ] command in the user view to enable the debugging of SSM mapping. ----End 10.9 Configuration Example Examples for configuring basic MLD functions and the MLD limit function in the multicast network are provided. 10.9.1 Example for Configuring Basic MLD Functions Networking Requirements On the IPv6 network shown in Figure 10-1, unicast routes are normal. It is required to implement multicast on the network to enable hosts to receive the Video on Demand (VoD) information. Figure 10-1 Networking diagram for configuring basic MLD functions Ethernet HostA Receiver SwitchA GE2/0/0 GE2/0/0 PIM network N1 GE1/0/0 3000::12/64 SwitchB HostB Leaf network GE1/0/0 3001::10/64 SwitchC GE2/0/0 HostC Receiver N2 GE1/0/0 3001::12/64 HostD Ethernet Switch Physical interface VLANIF interface IP address SwitchA GE1/0/0 VLANIF100 3000::12/64 GE2/0/0 VLANIF101 2002::1/64 GE1/0/0 VLANIF200 3001::10/64 GE2/0/0 VLANIF201 2003::1/64 GE1/0/0 VLANIF300 3001::12/64 GE2/0/0 VLANIF301 2004::1/64 SwitchB SwitchC Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 383 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 10 MLD Configuration Configuration Roadmap The configuration roadmap is as follows: 1. Enable IPv6 Multicast on the S9700s. 2. Enable IPv6 PIM-SM on all the interfaces on S9700. 3. Enable MLD on the interface at the host side. Data Preparation To complete the configuration, you need the following data: l MLD version running between the S9700s and the user hosts Procedure Step 1 Create VLANs and VLAN interfaces on the S9700s and assign IPv6 addresses to the VLAN interfaces. The configuration procedure is not provided here. Step 2 Enable multicast on the S9700s and enable MLD and IPv6 PIM-DM on the interfaces connected to user hosts. # Enable multicast on SwitchA, enable MLD and IPv6 PIM-DM on VLANIF 100, and set the MLD version to 2. <SwitchA> system-view [SwitchA] multicast ipv6 routing-enable [SwitchA] interface vlanif 100 [SwitchA-Vlanif100] pim ipv6 sm [SwitchA-Vlanif100] mld enable [SwitchA-Vlanif100] mld version 2 [SwitchA-Vlanif100] quit The configurations of SwitchB and SwitchC are similar to the configuration of SwitchA, and are not provided here. Step 3 Verify the configuration. # Run the display mld interface command, and you can check the configuration and running status of MLD on each interface. MLD information on VLANIF 200 of SwitchB is as follows: <SwitchB> display mld interface vlanif 200 verbose Interface information Vlanif200(FE80::200:5EFF:FE66:5100): MLD is enabled Current MLD version is 2 MLD state: up MLD group policy: none MLD limit: Value of query interval for MLD (negotiated): 125 s Value of query interval for MLD (configured): 125 s Value of other querier timeout for MLD: 0 s Value of maximum query response time for MLD: 10 s Value of last listener query time: 2 s Value of last listener query interval: 1 s Value of startup query interval: 31 s Value of startup query count: 2 General query timer expiry (hours:minutes:seconds): 00:00:28 Querier for MLD: FE80::200:5EFF:FE66:5100 (this router) MLD activity: 0 joins, 0 dones Robustness (negotiated): 2 Robustness (configured): 2 Require-router-alert: disabled Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 384 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 10 MLD Configuration Send-router-alert: enabled Prompt-leave: disabled SSM-Mapping: disabled Startup-query-timer-expiry: on Other-querier-present-timer-expiry: off From the display, you can see that SwitchB is a querier. This is because the IPv6 address of VLANIF 200 on S9700B is the smallest on the network segment. ----End Configuration Files l Configuration file of SwitchA # sysname SwitchA # vlan batch 100 101 # ipv6 # multicast ipv6 routing-enable # interface Vlanif101 ipv6 enable ipv6 address 2002::1/64 pim ipv6 sm # interface Vlanif100 ipv6 enable ipv6 address 3000::12/64 pim ipv6 sm mld enable mld version 2 # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 100 port hybrid untagged vlan 100 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 101 port hybrid untagged vlan 101 # return l Configuration file of SwitchB # sysname SwitchB # vlan batch 200 201 # ipv6 # multicast ipv6 routing-enable # interface Vlanif201 ipv6 enable ipv6 address 2003::1/64 pim ipv6 sm # interface Vlanif200 ipv6 enable ipv6 address 3001::10/64 pim ipv6 sm mld enable mld version 2 # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 385 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 10 MLD Configuration port hybrid pvid vlan 200 port hybrid untagged vlan 200 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 201 port hybrid untagged vlan 201 # return l Configuration file of SwitchC # sysname SwitchC # vlan batch 300 301 # ipv6 # multicast ipv6 routing-enable # interface Vlanif301 ipv6 enable ipv6 address 2004::1/64 pim ipv6 sm # interface Vlanif300 ipv6 enable ipv6 address 3001::12/64 pim ipv6 sm mld enable mld version 2 # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 300 port hybrid untagged vlan 300 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 301 port hybrid untagged vlan 301 # return 10.9.2 Example for Configuring MLD Limit Networking Requirements When a large number of users watch multiple programs simultaneously, great bandwidth of devices is consumed, which degrades the performance of the devices and lowers the stability of receiving multicast data. The existing multicast technologies control multicast networks by limiting the number of multicast forwarding entries or the number of outgoing interfaces of an entry, which cannot meet the requirements of operators for real-time video services on IPTV networks and flexible management of network resources. Configuring MLD limit can enable operators to properly plan network resources and flexibly control the number of multicast groups that hosts can join. In the network shown in Figure 10-2, multicast services are deployed. The global MLD limit, instance-based MLD limit, and interface-based MLD limit are configured on Switch A, Switch B, and Switch C connected to hosts to limit the number of multicast groups that the hosts can join. When the number of multicast groups that hosts can join reaches the limit, the devices are not allowed to create new MLD entries. This ensures that the users that join related multicast groups more clearly and stably watch related programs. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 386 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 10 MLD Configuration Figure 10-2 Networking diagram of configuring MLD Limit Ethernet HostA SwitchA Receiver N1 GE2/0/0 GE1/0/0 HostB SwitchB Leaf network GE2/0/0 PIM network GE1/0/0 HostC Receiver SwitchC N2 GE2/0/0 GE1/0/0 HostD Ethernet Switch Physical interface VLANIF interface IP address SwitchA GE1/0/0 VLANIF100 3000::12/64 GE2/0/0 VLANIF101 2001::1/64 GE1/0/0 VLANIF200 3001::10/64 GE2/0/0 VLANIF201 2002::1/64 GE1/0/0 VLANIF300 3001::12/64 GE2/0/0 VLANIF301 2003::1/64 SwitchB SwitchC Configuration Roadmap The configuration roadmap is as follows: 1. Enable IPv6 multicast. 2. Enable PIM-IPv6-SM on all switch interfaces. 3. Enable MLD on the interface at the host side. 4. Limit the number of MLD group memberships on Switch A, Switch B, and Switch C. Data Preparation To complete the configuration, you need the following data: l the version number of MLD of switches and user hosts. l The maximum number of MLD group memberships. Procedure Step 1 Assign IPv6 addresses to interfaces on the switches according to Figure 10-2. The configuration details are not provided here. Step 2 Enable multicast on switches and MLD and PIM-IPv6-SM on the interface at the host side. # Enable multicast on Switch A, enable MLD and PIM-IPv6-SM on VLANIF 100. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 387 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 10 MLD Configuration <SwitchA> system-view [SwitchA] multicast ipv6 routing-enable [SwitchA] interface vlanif 100 [SwitchA-Vlanif100] pim ipv6 sm [SwitchA-Vlanif100] mld enable [SwitchA-Vlanif100] quit [SwitchA] interface vlanif 101 [SwitchA-Vlanif101] pim ipv6 sm [SwitchA-Vlanif101] quit # The configurations of Switch B and Switch C are the same as the configuration of Switch A, and are not mentioned here. Step 3 Limit the number of MLD group memberships on the last-hop switch connected to users. # Configure the maximum number of MLD group memberships to 50 on Switch A. [SwitchA] mld global limit 50 # Configure the maximum number of MLD group memberships to 40 in the public network instance. [SwitchA] mld [SwitchA-mld] limit 40 [SwitchA-mld] quit # Configure the maximum number of MLD group relationships to 30 on VLANIF 100. [SwitchA] interface vlanif 100 [SwitchA-Vlanif100] mld limit 30 [SwitchA-Vlanif100] quit # Configurations of Switch B and Switch C are similar to those of Switch A, and are not mentioned here. Step 4 Verify the configuration. # Run the display mld interface command to view the configuration and running status of MLD on the switch interface. MLD information on VLANIF 100 of Switch B is as follows: [SwitchB] display mld interface vlanif 100 Interface information Vlanif100(FE80::200:5EFF:FE66:5100): MLD is enabled Current MLD version is 1 MLD state: up MLD group policy: none MLD limit: 30 Value of query interval for MLD (negotiated): Value of query interval for MLD (configured): 125 s Value of other querier timeout for MLD: 0 s Value of maximum query response time for MLD: 10 s Querier for MLD: FE80::200:5EFF:FE66:5100 (this router) Querier for MLD: FE80::200:5EFF:FE66:5100 (this router) From the display, you can see that the maximum number of MLD group members that the VLANIF 100 of Switch B can creat is 30. ----End Configuration Files l Configuration file of Switch A # sysname SwitchA # Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 388 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 10 MLD Configuration vlan batch 100 101 # ipv6 # mld global limit 50 # multicast ipv6 routing-enable # interface Vlanif100 ipv6 enable ipv6 address 3000::12/64 pim ipv6 sm mld enable mld limit 30 # interface Vlanif101 ipv6 enable ipv6 address 2001::1/64 pim ipv6 sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 100 port hybrid untagged vlan 100 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 pport hybrid pvid vlan 101 port hybrid untagged vlan 101 # mld limit 40 # return l Configuration file of Switch B # sysname SwitchB # vlan batch 200 201 # ipv6 # mld global limit 50 # multicast ipv6 routing-enable # interface Vlanif200 ipv6 enable ipv6 address 3001::10/64 pim ipv6 sm mld enable mld limit 30 # interface Vlanif201 ipv6 enable ipv6 address 2002::1/64 pim ipv6 sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 200 port hybrid untagged vlan 200 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 pport hybrid pvid vlan 201 port hybrid untagged vlan 201 # mld limit 40 # return Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 389 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast l 10 MLD Configuration Configuration file of Switch C # sysname SwitchC # vlan batch 300 101 # ipv6 # mld global limit 50 # multicast ipv6 routing-enable # interface Vlanif300 ipv6 enable ipv6 address 3001::12/64 pim ipv6 sm mld enable mld limit 30 # interface Vlanif301 ipv6 enable ipv6 address 2003::1/64 pim ipv6 sm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 300 port hybrid untagged vlan 300 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 pport hybrid pvid vlan 301 port hybrid untagged vlan 301 # mld limit 40 # return Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 390 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 11 MLD Snooping Configuration 11 MLD Snooping Configuration About This Chapter This chapter describes the implementation and configuration procedures of Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD) snooping on the S9700. 11.1 Overview of MLD Snooping When MLD snooping is enabled, the S9700 creates a Layer 2 forwarding table for multicast data packets by listening to MLD messages. In this manner, the S9700 manages and controls the forwarding of multicast data packets to ensure that these packets are sent only to the hosts that need the multicast data. 11.2 MLD Snooping Features Supported by the S9700 This section describes MLD snooping features supported by the S9700. 11.3 Configuring Basic Functions of MLD Snooping This section describes how to enable MLD snooping, add an interface to a multicast group statically, and configure an interface as a static router interface. 11.4 Configuring MLD Snooping Proxy This section describes how to configure MLD snooping proxy in a VLAN. 11.5 Configuring an IPv6 Layer 2 Multicast Policy This section describes how to configure an IPv6 Layer 2 multicast policy. 11.6 (Optional) Modifying Parameters of MLD Snooping This section describes how to optimize the performance of MLD snooping by modifying MLD snooping parameters, including the aging time of the router interface, interval for sending Last Member Query messages, interval for sending the General Query messages, maximum response time for MLD messages, MLD robustness variable, source IP address of the MLD message sent to respond to changes of Layer 2 network topology, MLD version, duration for suppressing the same Report messages, maximum number of MLD snooping entries, and whether the Router Alert option is contained in MLD messages. 11.7 Maintaining MLD Snooping This section describes how to maintain MLD snooping. 11.8 Configuration Examples This section provides several configuration examples of MLD snooping. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 391 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 11 MLD Snooping Configuration 11.1 Overview of MLD Snooping When MLD snooping is enabled, the S9700 creates a Layer 2 forwarding table for multicast data packets by listening to MLD messages. In this manner, the S9700 manages and controls the forwarding of multicast data packets to ensure that these packets are sent only to the hosts that need the multicast data. If MLD snooping is disabled, IPv6 multicast packets are broadcast in the VLAN, which wastes network bandwidth. MLD snooping has the following advantages: l Reducing broadcast packets on the Layer 2 network to save network bandwidth l Improving information security l Implementing separate accounting of each host 11.2 MLD Snooping Features Supported by the S9700 This section describes MLD snooping features supported by the S9700. Basic Features of MLD Snooping The S9700 supports VLAN-based MLD snooping. MLD snooping implements Layer 2 multicast of IPv6 and controls multicast data forwarding by listening to multicast protocol packets sent between an upstream router and a downstream host and maintaining downstream interface information. The S9700 supports the following basic features of MLD snooping: l Configuring an interface in a VLAN as a static router interface to enable users to receive multicast data steadily for a long time, because the static router interface never ages l Adding interfaces in a VLAN to a multicast group statically l Configuring an MLD snooping querier l Suppressing MLD messages MLD Snooping Proxy Configuring MLD snooping proxy on an edge device can reduce the number of MLD Report and Done messages received by an upstream Layer 3 device and improve performance of the upstream Layer 3 device. The device configured with MLD snooping proxy functions as a host for its upstream device and a querier for its downstream host. Layer 2 Multicast Policy The S9700 uses Layer 2 multicast policies according to networking requirements: l Configures an IPv6 multicast group policy to control the multicast groups that users can join. l Enables interfaces to quickly leave multicast groups. l Sets the maximum number of multicast groups that an interface can dynamically join to limit the multicast forwarding entries dynamically learned on the interface. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 392 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 11 MLD Snooping Configuration 11.3 Configuring Basic Functions of MLD Snooping This section describes how to enable MLD snooping, add an interface to a multicast group statically, and configure an interface as a static router interface. 11.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task Applicable Environment If MLD snooping is configured on the Layer 2 device on an IPv6 network, multicast data of a known group is forwarded to specified receivers (paid subscribers) but not broadcast at the data link layer. Pre-configuration Tasks Before enabling MLD snooping, complete the following tasks: l Creating a VLAN l Adding interfaces to the VLAN Data Preparation To enable MLD snooping, you need the following data. No. Data 1 ID of the VLAN 2 (Optional) Version of IGMP messages 3 (Optional) Types and numbers of interfaces 4 (Optional) Parameters of a querier: interval for sending MLD General Query messages, robustness variable, maximum response time, and interval for sending Last Member Query messages 5 (Optional) Suppression duration of MLD messages 6 (Optional) Aging time of the router interface 11.3.2 Enabling MLD snooping on the S9700 Context To enable MLD snooping globally, do as follows on the S9700. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 393 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 11 MLD Snooping Configuration Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 (Optional) Run: assign multicast-resource-mode optimize The multicast forwarding table is optimized. If a multicast forwarding table needs to contain more than 4096 entries, run this command to optimize the multicast forwarding table before enabling MLD snooping. Step 3 Run: mld-snooping enable MLD snooping is enabled globally. By default, MLD snooping is disabled on the S9700. Step 4 Run: vlan vlan-id The VLAN view is displayed. Step 5 Run: mld-snooping enable MLD snooping is enabled in a VLAN. Step 6 (Optional) Run: mld-snooping version version The version of MLD messages that MLD snooping can process is specified. By default, the S9700 can process MLDv1 messages. ----End 11.3.3 (Optional) Configuring an Interface as a Static Router Interface Context To configure an interface as a static router interface, do as follows on the S9700. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 394 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 11 MLD Snooping Configuration The interface can be an Ethernet interface, a GE interface, an XGE interface, or an Eth-Trunk interface. Step 3 Run: mld-snooping static-router-port vlan vlan-id The interface is configured as a static router interface. NOTE Before using the mld-snooping static-router-port vlan vlan-id command, ensure that the interface is added to the VLAN specified by vlan-id; otherwise, the configuration fails. ----End 11.3.4 (Optional) Adding an Interface to a Multicast Group Statically Context To add an interface to a multicast group statically, do as follows on the S9700. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run the following commands as required: l Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be an Ethernet interface, a GE interface, an XGE interface, or an Eth-Trunk interface. Step 3 Run: mld-snooping static-group vlan vlan-id } { group-ipv6-address [ source source-ipv6-address ] The interface is added to a multicast group statically. NOTE l Before using the mld-snooping static-group command, ensure that the interface is added to the VLAN specified by vlan-id; otherwise, the configuration fails. l If the source-address parameter is specified in the mld-snooping static-group command, the MLD version must be V2; otherwise, the configuration does not take effect even though the command can be run. ----End 11.3.5 Enabling the MLD Snooping Querier Context Do as follows on the S9700. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 395 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 11 MLD Snooping Configuration Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: vlan vlan-id The VLAN view is displayed. Step 3 Run: mld-snooping querier enable The MLD snooping querier is enabled. By default, the MLD snooping querier is disabled. NOTE MLD snooping querier cannot be enabled in a VLAN if the corresponding VLANIF interface has MLD enabled. MLD snooping querier and MLD snooping proxy cannot be enabled in the same VLAN. The MLD snooping querier does not participate in the election of the MLD querier; however, the MLD snooping querier on an IPv6 multicast network running MLD may affect the election result because the source IPv6 address of the Query message sent by the MLD snooping querier is small. Step 4 (Optional) Run: mld-snooping query-interval query-interval The interval at which a querier sends General Query messages is set. By default, the interval for sending General Query messages is 60 seconds. Step 5 (Optional) Run: mld-snooping robust-count robust-count The MLD robustness variable is set. By default, the MLD robustness variable is 2. Step 6 (Optional) Run: mld-snooping max-response-time max-response-time The maximum response time for General Query messages is set. By default, the maximum response time for an MLD Query message is 10 seconds. NOTE The maximum response time must be shorter than the interval at which General Query messages are sent. When receiving MLD Report messages from hosts, the S9700 sets the aging time of member interfaces using the following formula: Aging time = MLD robustness variable x Interval at which General Query messages are sent + Maximum response time. Step 7 (Optional) Run: mld-snooping last-listener-query-interval time-value The interval at which a querier sends Group-Specific Query messages is set. By default, the interval for sending Group-Specific Query messages is 1 second. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 396 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 11 MLD Snooping Configuration NOTE When receiving MLD Leave messages from hosts, the S9700 sets the aging time of member interfaces using the following formula: Aging time = Interval for sending Group-Specific Query messages x MLD robustness variable. When the S9700 runs MLDv1, hosts do not send MLD Done messages when leaving a multicast group. Therefore, this command is valid only when MLDv2 messages can be processed in a VLAN. ----End 11.3.6 (Optional) Configuring MLD Message Suppression Context Hosts running MLD in a VLAN use a snooping mechanism to suppress Report messages that member hosts send to join the same multicast group. However, many duplicate Report messages may be sent when the suppression time expires. In addition, hosts running MLDv2 send duplicate Done messages when they leave a multicast group. After a Layer 2 device is enabled to suppress Report and Done messages, it sends Membership Report messages only when the first member joins a multicast group or the last member of a multicast group leaves the group. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: vlan vlan-id The VLAN view is displayed. Step 3 Run: mld-snooping report-suppress MLD message suppression is enabled. NOTE l MLD message suppression cannot be configured in a VLAN if the corresponding VLANIF interface has MLD enabled. l MLD message suppression and MLD snooping proxy cannot be enabled in the same VLAN. ----End 11.3.7 Checking the Configuration Procedure Step 1 Run the display mld-snooping configuration command to check the configuration information of MLD snooping. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 397 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 11 MLD Snooping Configuration Step 2 Run the display mld-snooping [ vlan vlan-id ] command to check the status of MLD snooping in a VLAN. Step 3 Run the display mld-snooping port-info [ vlan vlan-id [ group group-ipv6-address [ sourceaddress source-ipv6-address ] | verbose ] ] command to check information about member interfaces of a multicast group and the router interface in a VLAN. Step 4 Run the display mld-snooping router-port [ vlan vlan-id ] command to check information about the router interface in a VLAN. NOTE The display mld-snooping port-info command displays only the information about the static member interface or static router interface in Up state. ----End 11.4 Configuring MLD Snooping Proxy This section describes how to configure MLD snooping proxy in a VLAN. Applicable Environment After the MLD snooping proxy function is configured on the S9700, the S9700 replaces the upstream router to send MLD Query messages to the downstream devices, and receives the MLD Report and MLD Done messages from the downstream devices. This function reduces the bandwidth used between the upstream router and the S9700 and the workload on the upstream router. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring the MLD snooping proxy, enable MLD snooping globally and in a specified VLAN. Data Preparation None Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: vlan vlan-id The VLAN view is displayed. Step 3 Run: mld-snooping proxy MLD snooping proxy is enabled. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 398 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 11 MLD Snooping Configuration NOTE l After MLD snooping proxy is enabled in a VLAN, the S9700 periodically broadcasts MLD Query messages to all the interfaces in the VLAN, including router interfaces. This may result in MLD snooping querier reelection. If an MLD snooping querier already exists on a multicast network, you are advised to enable the functions of MLD snooping querier and MLD message suppression to implement the MLD snooping proxy function. For detailed configurations of MLD snooping querier and MLD message suppression, see 11.3.5 Enabling the MLD Snooping Querier and 11.3.6 (Optional) Configuring MLD Message Suppression. l MLD snooping proxy cannot be enabled in a VLAN if the corresponding VLANIF interface has MLD enabled. l In a VLAN, the MLD snooping proxy function cannot be enabled together with the MLD snooping querier or MLD message suppression function. ----End Checking the Configuration Run the display mld-snooping configuration command to check the non-default MLD snooping configuration. If the command output shows that the MLD snooping proxy function has been enabled, the configuration succeeds. # View the non-default MLD snooping configuration in VLAN 10. <Quidway> display mld-snooping vlan 10 configuration MLD Snooping Configuration for VLAN 10 mld-snooping enable mld-snooping proxy 11.5 Configuring an IPv6 Layer 2 Multicast Policy This section describes how to configure an IPv6 Layer 2 multicast policy. 11.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task Applicable Environment A Layer 2 multicast policy controls the multicast programs that users can order on a switch with MLD snooping enabled. This policy improves multicast network controllability and security. S9700 supports the following Layer 2 multicast policies: l Configures multicast group policy, prohibiting multicast member interfaces from joining the specified multicast group. l Enables interfaces to quickly leave multicast groups. l Sets the maximum number of multicast groups that an interface can dynamically join. You can use Layer 2 multicast policies according to network requirements. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring a Layer 2 multicast policy, complete the following tasks: l Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Enabling MLD snooping globally and in a VLAN Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 399 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast l 11 MLD Snooping Configuration Creating VLANs and adding interfaces to these VLANs Data Preparation To configure a Layer 2 multicast policy, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Types and numbers of interfaces 2 ACL rules applied to a multicast group policy 3 ACL rules applied to prompt leave of multicast member interfaces 11.5.2 Configuring a Multicast Group Policy Context To configure a multicast group policy, perform the following operations on the S9700. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Use either of the following methods to configure a multicast group policy. l Configure a multicast group policy in a VLAN. 1. Run: vlan vlan-id The VLAN view is displayed. 2. Run: mld-snooping group-policy acl-number [ mld-version ] A multicast group policy is configured to prohibit the hosts in the specified VLANs from joining the specified multicast group. l Configure a multicast group policy on an interface. 1. Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface type can be Ethernet, GE, XGE, or Eth-Trunk interface. 2. Run: mld-snooping group-policy acl-number vlan vlan-id A multicast group policy is configured to prohibit the hosts in the specified VLANs from joining the specified multicast group. If you configure multicast group policies for the same VLAN in the interface view and VLAN view, only the policy configured in the interface view takes effect. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 400 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 11 MLD Snooping Configuration NOTE A multicast group policy does not apply to static multicast entries. ----End 11.5.3 Configuring Prompt Leave of Interfaces Context To configure the prompt leave function in a VLAN, do as follows on the S9700. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: vlan vlan-id The VLAN view is displayed. Step 3 Run: mld-snooping prompt-leave [ group-policy acl-number ] Prompt leave is enabled for interfaces in the VLAN. NOTE By default, no interface is allowed to promptly leave a multicast group. If group-policy acl-number is not specified in step 3, the S9700 deletes the forwarding entry of a member interface immediately when receiving a Done message from the interface. ----End 11.5.4 Setting the Maximum Number of Multicast Groups That an Interface Can Dynamically Join Context To restrict the number of multicast programs that a user can request, set the maximum number of multicast groups that an interface can dynamically join. This configuration limits the multicast data traffic volume on the interface. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 401 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 11 MLD Snooping Configuration The interface can be Ethernet, GE, or XGE or Eth-Trunk interface. Step 3 Run: mld-snooping table limit [ limit-num ] vlan vlan-id The maximum number of multicast groups that an interface can dynamically join is set. NOTE This command limits only the number of multicast groups that an interface can dynamically join. The number of static multicast groups is not limited on an interface. If the number of multicast groups that an interface has joined is larger than the configured limit, the current number of multicast groups on the interface does not change but the interface cannot join new multicast groups. ----End 11.5.5 Enabling IGMP Snooping Context To reject certain types of multicast data, a network administrator can filter UDP packets from a certain VLAN on an interface of the S9700. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. The interface can be an Ethernet interface, a GE interface, an XGE interface, or an Eth-Trunk interface. Step 3 Run: multicast-source-deny vlan { vlan-id1 [ to vlan-id2 ] } & <1-10> The Layer 2 multicast data from a certain VLAN on the interface is rejected. ----End 11.5.6 Checking the Configuration Procedure l Run the display mld-snooping configuration command to check the non-default MLD snooping configuration. You can view the configuration of a Layer 2 multicast policy in a VLAN by viewing the non-default MLD snooping configuration in the VLAN. ----End Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 402 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 11 MLD Snooping Configuration Example # View the non-default MLD snooping configuration in all VLANs. [Quidway] display mld-snooping configuration MLD Snooping Configuration for VLAN 11 mld-snooping enable mld-snooping group-policy 2000 2 MLD Snooping Configuration for VLAN 12 mld-snooping enable mld-snooping prompt-leave 11.6 (Optional) Modifying Parameters of MLD Snooping This section describes how to optimize the performance of MLD snooping by modifying MLD snooping parameters, including the aging time of the router interface, interval for sending Last Member Query messages, interval for sending the General Query messages, maximum response time for MLD messages, MLD robustness variable, source IP address of the MLD message sent to respond to changes of Layer 2 network topology, MLD version, duration for suppressing the same Report messages, maximum number of MLD snooping entries, and whether the Router Alert option is contained in MLD messages. 11.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task Applicable Environment You can modify parameters of MLD snooping to optimize the multicast performance on the S9700 according to the actual situation of the network. Pre-configuration Tasks Before modifying parameters of MLD snooping, complete the following task: l 11.3 Configuring Basic Functions of MLD Snooping Data Preparation To modify parameters of MLD snooping, you need the following data. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) No. Procedure 1 ID of the VLAN where you need to optimize the performance of MLD snooping 2 (Optional) Aging time of the router interface 3 Duration for suppressing the same MLD messages 4 (Optional) Source IPv6 address of the MLD General Query message that the MLD snooping module sends to respond to the change of the Layer 2 network topology Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 403 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 11 MLD Snooping Configuration 11.6.2 (Optional) Setting the Aging Time of the Router Interface Context To set the aging time of the router interface, do as follows on the S9700. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: vlan vlan-id The VLAN view is displayed. Step 3 Run: mld-snooping router-aging-time router-aging-time The aging time of the router interface is set. l By default, the S9700 sets the remaining aging time of router interface as follows: l If the router interface receives an MLD Query message, the S9700 sets the remaining aging time of the interface to 180 seconds. l If the router interface receives a PIM Hello message and the holdtime value of the Hello message is greater than the remaining aging time of the interface, the S9700 sets the remaining aging time of the interface to the holdtime value. ----End 11.6.3 Setting the Duration for Suppressing the Same MLD Messages Context To set the duration for suppressing the MLD Report messages with the same content, do as follows on the S9700. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: mld-snooping suppression-time time-value The duration for suppressing the same MLD Report messages is set. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 404 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 11 MLD Snooping Configuration NOTE l By default, the duration for suppressing the same MLD Report messages is 10 seconds. l The MLD snooping function is applicable to only the MLDv1 packets, but is invalid for the MLDv2 packets. ----End 11.6.4 (Optional) Configuring the Router Alert Option in MLD Messages Context To configure whether MLD messages contain the Router Alert option, do as follows on the S9700. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: vlan vlan-id The VLAN view is displayed. Step 3 Run: mld-snooping require-router-alert The S9700 is configured to process only the MLD messages that contain the Router Alert option in the IP header. Step 4 Run: mld-snooping send-router-alert The S9700 is configured to send only the MLD messages that contain the Router Alert option in the IP header. By default, the S9700 processes all MLD messages and sends the MLD messages with the Router Alert to the VLAN. Step 3 and Step 4 can be performed in a random order. ----End 11.6.5 Enabling the MLD Snooping Module to Respond to Changes of the Layer 2 Network Topology Context To enable the MLD snooping module to respond to changes of the Layer 2 network topology, do as follows on the S9700. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 405 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 11 MLD Snooping Configuration Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: mld-snooping send-query enable The MLD snooping module of the S9700 is enabled to respond to changes of the Layer 2 network topology. Step 3 Run: mld-snooping send-query source-address ipv6-address The source IPv6 address of the MLD General Query messages that the MLD snooping module sends to respond to changes of the Layer 2 network topology is set. By default, the source IPv6 address of the MLD General Query message sent by the S9700 is FE80::. After the S9700 is enabled to respond to changes of the Layer 2 network topology, it sends an MLD General Query message to the downstream S9700 when receiving a Topology Change message. Then the downstream S9700 can learn the new router interface. When a member interface receives the MLD General Query message, the member interface responds with an MLD Report message. Then the S9700 and its downstream S9700 can learn the new multicast forwarding entry. This function enables the S9700 to forward multicast data correctly after the Layer 2 topology changes. ----End 11.6.6 Checking the Configuration Procedure Step 1 Run the display mld-snooping [ vlan vlan-id ] command to check information about MLD snooping in a VLAN. ----End Example If the preceding configurations are successful, the following information is displayed: <Quidway> display mld-snooping vlan 10 MLD Snooping Vlan Information for VLAN 10 MLD Snooping is Enable MLD Version is Set to default 1 MLD Query Interval is Set to default 60 MLD Max Response Interval is Set to default 10 MLD Robustness is Set to default 2 MLD Last Member Query Interval is Set to default 1 MLD Router Port Aging Interval is Set to 180s or holdtime in hello MLD Filter Group-Policy is Set to default : Permit All MLD Prompt Leave Disable MLD Router Alert is Not Required MLD Send Router Alert Enable Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 406 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 11 MLD Snooping Configuration 11.7 Maintaining MLD Snooping This section describes how to maintain MLD snooping. 11.7.1 Clearing MLD Snooping Entries Context CAUTION Use this command with caution. After the MLD snooping entries, that is, the dynamic forwarding entries, of a VLAN are deleted from the multicast forwarding table, the multicast flows sent to hosts in the VLAN are interrupted. The hosts can receive multicast flows again only after the S9700 receives the MLD Membership Report messages from the hosts and generates new forwarding entries. To clear the dynamic forwarding entries from the multicast forwarding table, run the following command in the user view. Procedure Step 1 Run the reset mld-snooping group { vlan { vlan-id | all } | all } command to clear the dynamic forwarding entries from the multicast forwarding table. ----End 11.7.2 Clearing the Statistics on MLD Snooping Context CAUTION The statistics on MLD snooping cannot be restored after you clear them. So, confirm the action before you use the command. To clear the statistics on MLD snooping, run the following command in the user view. Procedure Step 1 Run the reset mld-snooping statistics [ vlan vlan-id ] command to clear the statistics on MLD snooping in a VLAN. ----End Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 407 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 11 MLD Snooping Configuration 11.7.3 Debugging MLD Snooping Context CAUTION Debugging affects the performance of the system. So, after debugging, run the undo debugging mld-snooping all command to disable it immediately. When a fault occurs in MLD Snooping, you can run the following debugging command in the user view to debug MLD snooping and locate the fault. Procedure Step 1 Run the debugging mld-snooping [ all | event | done [ basic-acl-number ] | packet [advanceacl-number ] | query [ advance-acl-number ] | report [ advance-acl-number ] | timer | general ] command in the user view to enable debugging of MLD snooping. ----End 11.8 Configuration Examples This section provides several configuration examples of MLD snooping. 11.8.1 Example for Configuring a Multicast Group Policy Networking Requirements As shown in Figure 11-1, three hosts are all in VLAN 3. All these three hosts need to receive data from multicast groups FF32::1 to FF32::10. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 408 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 11 MLD Snooping Configuration Figure 11-1 Networking diagram for configuring a multicast group policy on the Ethernet multicast source DHCP server IP/MPLS core GE1/0/6 SwitchA VLAN 3 Host 3 GE1/0/5 Host 4 Host 5 Configuration Roadmap The configuration roadmap is as follows: 1. Create VLAN 3 and add GE 1/0/5 and GE 1/0/6 to VLAN 3. 2. Enable MLD snooping globally on SwitchA. 3. Configure a multicast group policy in VLAN 3 on SwitchA. 4. Enable MLD snooping in VLAN 3 on SwitchA. Data Preparation To complete the configuration, you need the following data: l VLAN that Host 3, Host 4, and Host 5 belong to: VLAN 3 l Multicast groups that Host 3, Host 4, and Host 5 can join: FF32::1 to FF32::10 Procedure Step 1 Create VLAN 3 on SwitchA and add GE 1/0/5 and GE 1/0/6 to VLAN 3. The configuration procedure is not provided here. Step 2 Enable MLD snooping globally on SwitchA. [SwitchA]mld-snooping enable Step 3 Create an IPv6 ACL. [SwitchA]acl ipv6 3000 [SwitchA-acl6-adv-3000] rule permit ipv6 source FF32::3 128 [SwitchA-acl6-adv-3000] rule permit ipv6 source FF32::4 128 [SwitchA-acl6-adv-3000] rule permit ipv6 source FF32::5 128 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 409 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 11 MLD Snooping Configuration [SwitchA-acl6-adv-3000] rule permit ipv6 source FF32::6 128 [SwitchA-acl6-adv-3000] quit Step 4 Configure a multicast group policy in VLAN 3. [SwitchA] vlan 3 [SwitchA-vlan3] mld-snooping group-policy 3000 Step 5 Enable MLD snooping in VLAN 3. [SwitchA-vlan3] mld-snooping enable Step 6 Verify the configuration. # Verify that host 3, host 4 and host 5 can join multicast groups FF32::1 to FF32::10. Send Membership Report messages from Host 3, Host 4, or Host 5 to multicast group FF32::3, and then run the display mld-snooping port-info on SwitchA. You can view information about the outgoing interface of the multicast group. [Switch-vlan3] display mld-snooping port-info ----------------------------------------------------------------------(Source, Group) Port Flag Flag: S:Static D:Dynamic M: Ssm-mapping ----------------------------------------------------------------------VLAN 33, 1 Entry(s) ( *, ff32:0:0:0:0:0:0:3)GE1/0/5 D-1 port(s) ----------------------------------------------------------------------- The preceding output shows that GE 1/0/5 has joined multicast group FF32::3. # Verify that host 3, host 4 and host 5 cannot join multicast groups out of the range of FF32::1 to FF32::10. Send Membership Report messages from Host 15, Host 4, or Host 5 to multicast group FF32::15, and then run the display mld-snooping port-info on SwitchA. You can view information about the outgoing interface of the multicast group. [Switch-vlan3] display mld-snooping port-info ----------------------------------------------------------------------(Source, Group) Port Flag Flag: S:Static D:Dynamic M: Ssm-mapping ----------------------------------------------------------------------VLAN 33, 1 Entry(s) ( *, ff32:0:0:0:0:0:0:3)GE1/0/5 D-1 port(s) ----------------------------------------------------------------------- No information about the outgoing interface of multicast group FF32::15 is displayed. It indicates that GE 0/0/5 does not join the multicast group FF32::15. ----End Configuration Files # sysname SwitchA # mld-snooping enable # vlan batch 3 # vlan 3 mld-snooping enable mld-snooping group-policy 3000 # acl ipv6 number 3000 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 410 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 11 MLD Snooping Configuration rule 5 permit ipv6 source FF32::3/128 rule 10 permit ipv6 source FF32::4/128 rule 15 permit ipv6 source FF32::5/128 rule 20 permit ipv6 source FF32::6/128 # interface GigabitEthernet 1/0/5 port link-type trunk port trunk allow-pass vlan 3 # interface GigabitEthernet 1/0/6 port link-type trunk port trunk allow-pass vlan 3 # return 11.8.2 Example for Configuring Prompt Leave of Interfaces in a VLAN Networking Requirements As shown in Figure 11-2, GE 1/0/3 and GE 1/0/4 on of Switch A are connected to only one receiver respectively. Other hosts connected to GE 1/0/3 and GE 1/0/4 do not need to receive multicast packets. Therefore, when receiving MLD Leave messages from the two interfaces, Switch A deletes the forwarding entries of the multicast groups that the hosts leave without waiting for the timeout of the aging timer. This saves the bandwidth and system resources. Figure 11-2 Networking diagram for configuring prompt leave of interfaces in a VLAN multicast source DHCP server IP/MPLS core SwitchA GE1/0/3 VLAN 3 Host1 Host2 GE1/0/5 GE1/0/4 Host 3 Host 4 Host 5 Configuration Roadmap The configuration roadmap is as follows: 1. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Create VLAN 3 on Switch A and add GE 1/0/3, GE 1/0/4, and GE 1/0/5 to VLAN 3. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 411 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 11 MLD Snooping Configuration 2. Enable MLD snooping globally on Switch A. 3. Enable prompt leave of interfaces in VLAN 3 on Switch A. 4. Enable MLD snooping in VLAN 3 on Switch A. Data Preparation To complete the configuration, you need the following data: l ID of the VLAN where prompt leave is enabled: 3 Procedure Step 1 Create VLAN 3 on Switch A and add GE 1/0/3, GE 1/0/4, and GE 1/0/5 to VLAN 3. The configuration procedure is not provided here. Step 2 Enable MLD snooping globally on Switch A. [SwitchA] mld-snooping enable Step 3 Enable prompt leave of interfaces in VLAN 3. [SwitchA] vlan 3 [SwitchA-vlan3] mld-snooping prompt-leave Step 4 Enable MLD snooping in VLAN 3. [SwitchA-vlan3] mld-snooping enable Step 5 Verify the configuration. Run the display mld-snooping command on Switch A. [SwitchA] display mld-snooping vlan 3 MLD Snooping Vlan Information for VLAN 3 MLD Snooping is Enable MLD Version is Set to default 1 MLD Query Interval is Set to default 60 MLD Max Response Interval is Set to default 10 MLD Robustness is Set to default 2 MLD Last Listener Query Interval is Set to default 1 MLD Router Port Aging Interval is Set to 180s or holdtime in hello MLD Filter Group-Policy is Set to default : Permit All MLD Prompt Leave Enable MLD Router Alert is Not Required MLD Send Router Alert Enable As shown in the preceding output, "MLD Prompt Leave Enable" indicates that the configuration of prompt leave for interfaces in VLAN 3 is successful. ----End Configuration Files # sysname SwitchA # mld-snooping enable # vlan batch 3 # vlan 3 mld-snooping enable mld-snooping prompt-leave # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/3 port link-type access port default vlan 3 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 412 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 11 MLD Snooping Configuration # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/4 port link-type access port default vlan 3 # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/5 port link-type access port default vlan 3 # return 11.8.3 Example for Configuring a Static Router Interface Networking Requirements As shown in Figure 11-3, Switch A is connected to a router and several hosts. The router runs the MLD protocol. The Switch A needs to forward multicast data to the hosts. Figure 11-3 Networking diagram for configuring a static router interface DHCP server multicast source IP/MPLS core VLAN 2 GE1/0/2 Host 1 GE1/0/5 SwitchA GE1/0/3 Host 2 Configuration Roadmap The configuration roadmap is as follows: 1. Create VLAN 2 on Switch A and add GE 1/0/2, GE 1/0/3, and GE 1/0/5 to VLAN 2. 2. Enable MLD snooping globally on Switch A. 3. Configure GE 1/0/5 as a static router interface. 4. Enable MLD snooping in VLAN 2 on Switch A. Data Preparation To complete the configuration, you need the following data: Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 413 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 11 MLD Snooping Configuration l Interface to be configured as a static router interface: GE 1/0/5 l VLAN that Host 1 and Host 2 belongs to: VLAN 2 Procedure Step 1 Create VLAN 2 on Switch A and add GE 1/0/2, GE 1/0/3, and GE 1/0/5 to VLAN 2. The configuration procedure is not provided here. Step 2 Enable MLD snooping globally on Switch A. [SwitchA] mld-snooping enable Step 3 Enable MLD snooping in VLAN 2. [SwitchA] vlan 2 [SwitchA-vlan2] mld-snooping enable [SwitchA-vlan2] quit Step 4 Configure GE 1/0/5 as a static router interface. [SwitchA] interface gigabitethernet1/0/5 [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/5] mld-snooping static-router-port vlan 2 [SwitchA-GigabitEthernet1/0/5] quit Step 5 Verify the configuration. Run the display mld-snooping router-port command on Switch A. [SwitchA] display mld-snooping router-port vlan 2 Total Number of Router Port on Vlan 2 is 1 Port Name UpTime Expires GE1/0/5 00:00:32 -- Flags STATIC The preceding output shows that GE 1/0/5 is configured as a static router interface. ----End Configuration Files # sysname SwitchA # mld-snooping enable # vlan batch 2 # vlan 2 mld-snooping enable # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/2 port link-type access port default vlan 2 # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/3 port link-type access port default vlan 2 # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/5 port link-type access port default vlan 2 mld-snooping static-router-port vlan 2 # return 11.8.4 Example for Enabling the MLD Snooping Module to Respond to Changes of the Layer 2 Network Topology Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 414 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 11 MLD Snooping Configuration Networking Requirements As shown in Figure 11-4, four S9700s form a ring network to improve the network reliability. To prevent loops on the network, the S9700s run the Multiple Spanning Tree Protocol (MSTP). Host 1 and Host 2 need to receive multicast data from the multicast source. The IPv6 addresses of Host 1 and Host 2 are 2::3/112 and 3::1/64 respectively. Figure 11-4 Networking diagram for enabling the MLD snooping module to respond to changes of the Layer 2 network topology DHCP server multicast source IP/MPLS core SwitchA GE1/0/3 GE1/0/2 GE1/0/1 SwitchC MSTP GE1/0/5 GE1/0/7 GE1/0/6 GE1/0/8 SwitchB GE1/0/3 SwitchD GE1/0/2 GE1/0/4 GE1/0/1 3::1/64 Host2 VLAN 3 2::3/112 Host1 Configuration Roadmap The configuration roadmap is as follows: 1. Enable MSTP on all the S9700s. 2. Create VLAN 3 and add interfaces to VLAN 3 on all the S9700s. 3. Enable MLD snooping globally on all the S9700s. 4. Enable MLD snooping in VLAN 3 on all the S9700s. 5. Enable the MLD snooping module of SwitchA to respond to changes of the Layer 2 network topology. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 415 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 11 MLD Snooping Configuration Data Preparation To complete the configuration, you need the following data: l Source IP address contained in the MLD General Query message that the MLD snooping module sends to respond to changes of the Layer 2 network: FE80::1 Procedure Step 1 Enable MSTP on all the S9700s. The configuration procedure is not provided here. For the method of configuring MSTP, see the S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide Ethernet. Step 2 Create VLAN 3 and add interfaces to VLAN 3 on all the S9700s. The configuration procedure is not provided here. Step 3 Run the mld-snooping enable command to enable MLD snooping globally on all the S9700s. Step 4 Enable MLD snooping in VLAN 3 on all the S9700s. [SwitchA] vlan 3 [SwitchA-vlan3] mld-snooping enable [SwitchA-vlan3] quit The configurations of other S9700s are similar to the configuration of SwitchA, and are not provided here. Step 5 Enable the MLD snooping module of SwitchA to respond to changes of the Layer 2 network topology. [SwitchA]mld-snooping send-query enable [SwitchA] mld-snooping send-query source-address FE80::1 Step 6 Verify the configuration. l Verify that Host 1 and Host 2 can receive multicast data. l Run the display stp command on the S9700s to find the interfaces that are blocked and the transmission path of multicast data. l Assume that GE 1/0/1 is blocked and multicast data is transmitted to Host 1 through the path SwitchA -> SwitchC -> SwitchB and to Host 2 through the path SwitchA -> SwitchD. Run the shutdown command on GE 1/0/1 of SwitchC to shut down the interface so that the topology of the MSTP network changes. l Verify that Host 1 and Host 2 can still receive multicast data after the network topology changes. ----End Configuration Files Configuration file of SwitchA # sysname SwitchA # mld-snooping enable mld-snooping send-query enable mld-snooping send-query source-address FE80::1 # vlan batch 3 # stp enable # Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 416 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 11 MLD Snooping Configuration vlan 3 mld-snooping enable # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/1 port link-type trunk port trunk allow-pass vlan 3 bpdu enable # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/2 port link-type trunk port trunk allow-pass vlan 3 bpdu enable # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/3 port link-type trunk port trunk allow-pass vlan 3 bpdu enable # return Configuration file of SwitchB # sysname SwitchB # mld-snooping enable # vlan batch 3 # stp enable # vlan 3 mld-snooping enable # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/1 port link-type access port default vlan 3 bpdu enable # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/3 port link-type trunk port trunk allow-pass vlan 3 bpdu enable # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/4 port link-type trunk port trunk allow-pass vlan 3 bpdu enable # return Configuration file of SwitchC # sysname SwitchC # mld-snooping enable # vlan batch 3 # stp enable # vlan 3 mld-snooping enable # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/5 port link-type trunk port trunk allow-pass vlan 3 bpdu enable # Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 417 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 11 MLD Snooping Configuration interface GigabitEthernet1/0/6 port link-type trunk port trunk allow-pass vlan 3 bpdu enable # return Configuration file of SwitchD # sysname SwitchD # mld-snooping enable # vlan batch 3 # stp enable # vlan 3 mld-snooping enable # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/2 port link-type access port default vlan 3 bpdu enable # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/7 port link-type trunk port trunk allow-pass vlan 3 bpdu enable # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/8 port link-type trunk port trunk allow-pass vlan 3 bpdu enable # return Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 418 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration About This Chapter The PIM protocol can be used in an IPv6 network to implement multicast routing and data forwarding inside an AS. The PIM-DM protocol is a multicast routing protocol of dense node. It is applicable to a small-scale network with densely-distributed members. 12.1 PIM-IPv6 Overview In the IPv6 network where multicast group members are densely distributed and each network segment may have multicast group members, PIM-DM builds a unidirectional and loop-free SPT from the multicast source to the group member through periodical flooding and pruning. 12.2 PIM-DM Features Supported by the S9700 The system can work normally with default PIM-DM parameters. You are also allowed to adjust parameters related to neighbor discovery, prune, state refresh, graft, and assert according to specific scenarios. In addition, you can configure various filtering policies and the PIM silent function to enhance the IPv6 PIM-DM security. 12.3 Configuring Basic PIM-DM (IPv6) Functions Ensure that unicast routes are reachable before configuring IPv6 multicast routing and enable IPv6 PIM-DM on each interface of the multicast device. In this manner, the IPv6 PIM-DM network can work normally. 12.4 Adjusting Control Parameters of a Source A multicast device can control the forwarding of multicast data based on multicast sources. This helps to control multicast data flows and limit information that can be obtained by downstream receivers to enhance security. 12.5 Adjusting Control Parameters for Maintaining Neighbors Multicast devices establish PIM neighbor relationships and negotiate various control parameters by exchanging Hello messages. You can adjust the parameters carried in Hello messages as required. If there is no special requirement, adopt default values. 12.6 Adjusting Control Parameters for Prune When the last member leaves a group, the multicast device sends a Prune message upstream, requesting the upstream device to execute the prune operation. If other downstream devices on the same network segment need the multicast data for this group, they need to send Join messages to override the prune operation. You can adjust control parameters of Join/Prune messages as required. If there is no special requirement, adopt default values. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 419 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration 12.7 Adjusting Control Parameters for State-Refresh In a PIM-DM network, the periodic flooding-pruning wastes lots of network resources. To prevent the pruned interface from forwarding messages because the prune timer times out, you can enable the State-Refresh function to enable the multicast device to send State-Refresh messages periodically, refresh the prune state of the interface, and maintain SPT. 12.8 Adjusting Control Messages for Graft To enable new members in a network to quickly receive multicast data, a multicast device actively sends a Graft message through an upstream interface, requesting the upstream device to forward multicast data to this network segment. 12.9 Adjusting Control Messages for Assert If a multicast device can receive multicast data through the downstream interface, this indicates that other upstream devices exist in this network segment. The device then sends an Assert message through the downstream interface to take part in the election of the unique upstream device. 12.10 Configuring PIM-IPv6 Silent Function The interface directly connecting a multicast device to a user host needs to be enabled with PIM. In this case, some malicious hosts may simulate a large number of PIM Hello messages and send the messages to the interface for processing. As a result, the multicast device is suspended. To avoid the preceding case, you can set the interface to be in the PIM Silent state. 12.11 Maintaining PIM-DM Maintaining IPv6 PIM-DM involves resetting PIM statistics, and monitoring PIM running status. 12.12 Configuration Example Configuration examples are provided to show how to construct a basic IPv6 PIM-DM network. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 420 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration 12.1 PIM-IPv6 Overview In the IPv6 network where multicast group members are densely distributed and each network segment may have multicast group members, PIM-DM builds a unidirectional and loop-free SPT from the multicast source to the group member through periodical flooding and pruning. In IPv4 multicast applications, the Protocol Independent Multicast (PIM) is used to establish multicast routes between switchs to replicate and forward multicast packets. In IPv6 multicast applications, switchs run PIM-IPv6. The functions and principles of PIM-IPv6 are similar to those of PIM-IPv4. PIM-IPv6 consists of the following separate protocols: l PIM-DM: indicates the Protocol Independent Multicast-Dense Mode. PIM-DM is applicable to a small-scale network with densely-distributed members. The network adopts the Any-Source Multicast (ASM) model to implement multicast services. l PIM-SM: indicates the Protocol Independent Multicast-Sparse Mode. PIM-SM is applicable to a large-scale network with sparsely-distributed members. The network adopts the ASM and Source-Specific Multicast (SSM) models to implement multicast services. NOTE l This chapter is concerned only about the PIM-DM configuration in the IPv6 network. PIM-DM in this chapter refers to IPv6 PIM-DM, unless otherwise specified. l For details of PIM-SM (IPv6), refer to the chapter PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration. l For details of ASM and SSM models, refer to the chapter "IP Multicast Overview" in the S9700 Core Routing Switch Feature Description - IP Multicast. 12.2 PIM-DM Features Supported by the S9700 The system can work normally with default PIM-DM parameters. You are also allowed to adjust parameters related to neighbor discovery, prune, state refresh, graft, and assert according to specific scenarios. In addition, you can configure various filtering policies and the PIM silent function to enhance the IPv6 PIM-DM security. Controlling the Forwarding of a Multicast Source You can configure the Keepalive period of a multicast source and the filtering rules of the multicast source. Adjusting Control Parameters for Maintaining Neighbors You can set the following control parameters by using the related commands: l Interval for sending Hello messages l Period for keeping neighbors reachable l Whether the Hello messages without the Generation ID option are accepted l Maximum delay for triggering Hello messages Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 421 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast l 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration Neighbor filtering function: An interface sets up neighbor relationships with only the addresses matching the filtering rules and deletes the neighbors unmatched with the filtering rules Adjusting Control Parameters for Pruning You can adjust the following control parameters for pruning: l The interval for keeping the Prune state of the downstream interface l The delay from the time when the current switch receives a Prune message from a downstream switch to the time when the current switch performs the prune action in the LAN l The period for overriding the prune action Adjusting Control Parameters for State-Refresh You can enable or disable State-Refresh, set the interval for sending PIM State-Refresh messages, set the time for waiting to receive the next State-Refresh message, and set the TTL values of State-Refresh messages. Adjusting Control Parameters for Graft You can set the interval for retransmitting Graft messages. Adjusting Control Parameters for Assert You can set the period for switchs to keep the Assert state. The switchs that fail in the election forbid downstream interfaces to forward multicast data during this period. After the period expires, the downstream interfaces continue to forward multicast data. Configuring PIM Silent Some hosts may send a large number of malicious PIM Hello messages, which results in the suspension of the switch. By configuring the PIM Silent function on the interfaces of the switch connected with the host, you can protect the switch from being attacked. 12.3 Configuring Basic PIM-DM (IPv6) Functions Ensure that unicast routes are reachable before configuring IPv6 multicast routing and enable IPv6 PIM-DM on each interface of the multicast device. In this manner, the IPv6 PIM-DM network can work normally. 12.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task Before configuring basic IPv6 PIM-DM functions, configure a unicast IPv6 routing protocol. Applicable Environment PIM-DM is applicable to a small-scale network. Most of network segments have receivers. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 422 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration Pre-configuration Tasks Before configure basic PIM-DM functions, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol Data Preparation To configure basic PIM-DM functions, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Type and number of the interface to be enabled with PIM-DM (IPv6) 12.3.2 Enabling IPv6 Multicast Routing Prior to configuring all IPv6 multicast features, enable IPv6 multicast routing. Context Do as follows on the switch: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 (Optional) Run: assign multicast-resource-mode optimize The multicast replication capability of LPUs is improved. If each multicast packet needs to be replicated into more than 8192 copies, run this command to improve the multicast replication capability before enabling IP multicast routing. Step 3 Run: multicast ipv6 routing-enable The IPv6 multicast routing is enabled in the public network instance. ----End 12.3.3 Enabling Basic PIM-DM (IPv6) Functions An interface can set up IPv6 PIM neighbor relationship with other devices after IPv6 PIM-DM is enabled on it. Context Do as follows on the switch: Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 423 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The VLANIF interface view is displayed. Step 3 Run: pim ipv6 dm Basic PIM-DM (IPv6) functions are enabled. After PIM-DM (IPv6) is enabled on interfaces, switchs set up the PIM-IPv6 neighbor relationship with each other. The switchs can then process protocol packets received from PIMIPv6 neighbors. You can run the undo pim ipv6 dm command to disable PIM-DM (IPv6) on an interface. NOTE PIM-DM (IPv6) and PIM-SM (IPv6) cannot be enabled on an interface simultaneously. The PIM-IPv6 modes on all interfaces that belong to the same instance must be the same. When a switch is deployed in a PIM-DM (IPv6) domain, enable PIM-DM (IPv6) on all non-boundary interfaces. ----End 12.3.4 Checking the Configuration After IPv6 PIM-DM is configured successfully, you can check information about the PIM interface, PIM neighbor, and PIM routing table through commands.. Procedure l Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces. l Run the display pim ipv6 neighbor [ ipv6-link-local-address | interface interface-type interface-number | verbose ] * command to check information about PIM-IPv6 neighbors. l Run the following commands to check the PIM-IPv6 multicast routing table. – display pim ipv6 routing-table [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6group-address [ mask mask-length ] | flags { act | del | exprune | ext | loc | niif | nonbr | none | rpt | sg_rcvr | sgjoin | spt | swt | wc | upchg } | fsm | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | outgoing-interface { exclude | include | match } { interface-type interface-number | none | register } ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim ipv6 routing-table brief [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6-group-address [ mask mask-length ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } ] * ----End Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 424 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration 12.4 Adjusting Control Parameters of a Source A multicast device can control the forwarding of multicast data based on multicast sources. This helps to control multicast data flows and limit information that can be obtained by downstream receivers to enhance security. 12.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After basic functions of IPv6 PIM-DM are configured, you can configure the lifetime of a multicast source and source address-based filtering rules as required. Applicable Environment This configuration is applicable to all PIM-DM networks. PIM-IPv6 switchs check the passing multicast data packets. By checking whether the data packets match the filtering rule, the switchs determine whether to forward the packets. That is, the switchs in the PIM-IPv6 domain act as filters. The filters help to control data flows and limit information obtained by downstream receivers. Pre-configuration Tasks Before adjusting control parameters of a source, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol l Configuring Basic PIM-DM (IPv6) Functions Data Preparation To adjust control parameters of a source, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Keepalive period of a source 2 Filtering rules of multicast source addresses 12.4.2 Configuring the Keepalive Period of a Source A multicast device starts a timer for each (S, G) entry. If the multicast device does not receive any multicast packets from a multicast source within the set lifetime of the multicast source, it considers that the (S, G) entry becomes invalid and the multicast source stops sending multicast data to the multicast group. Context Do as follows on the PIM-IPv6 switch: NOTE If there is no special requirement, default values are recommended. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 425 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim-ipv6 The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed. Step 3 Run: source-lifetime interval The Keepalive period of a source is configured. If a switch does not receive any (S, G) packet in the Keepalive period of the source, the switch considers that the source stops sending multicast data to G, and the (S, G) entry becomes invalid. ----End 12.4.3 Configuring Filtering Rules Based on Source Addresses After ACL6 rules are configured, a multicast device can filter the received multicast packets based on source addresses or source/group addresses. Context Do as follows on the PIM-IPv6 switch: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim-ipv6 The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed. Step 3 Run: source-policy { acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name } A filter is configured. The nearer the filter to the source, the more obvious the effect of the filtering. If the basic ACL is configured, only the packets with the source addresses that pass the filtering are forwarded. If the advanced ACL is configured, only the packets with the source addresses and group addresses that pass the filtering are forwarded. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 426 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration NOTE l If acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name is specified in the source-policy command and ACL rules are created, only the multicast packets whose source addresses match the ACL rules are permitted. l If acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name is specified in the source-policy command and no ACL rule is created, the multicast packets with any source addresses are not forwarded. l The source-policy command does not filter the static (S, G) entries. ----End 12.4.4 Checking the Configuration After the control parameters of a multicast source are adjusted, you can run commands to check entries in the PIM routing table. Procedure l Run the following commands to check the PIM-IPv6 multicast routing table. – display pim ipv6 routing-table [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6group-address [ mask mask-length ] | flags { act | del | exprune | ext | loc | niif | nonbr | none | rpt | sg_rcvr | sgjoin | spt | swt | wc | upchg } | fsm | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | outgoing-interface { exclude | include | match } { interface-type interface-number | none | register } ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim ipv6 routing-table brief [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6-group-address [ mask mask-length ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } ] * ----End 12.5 Adjusting Control Parameters for Maintaining Neighbors Multicast devices establish PIM neighbor relationships and negotiate various control parameters by exchanging Hello messages. You can adjust the parameters carried in Hello messages as required. If there is no special requirement, adopt default values. 12.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After basic functions of IPv6 PIM-DM are configured, you can adjust related parameters of the Hello message for controlling the neighbor relationships and configure the neighbor filtering function to enhance security as required. Applicable Environment PIM-IPv6 switchs establish the neighbor relationship by exchanging Hello messages to negotiate various control parameters. Switchs under the control of default values can work normally. In the S9700, users can adjust related parameters according to the specific network environment. NOTE If there is no special requirement, default values are recommended. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 427 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration Pre-configuration Tasks Before adjusting control parameters for maintaining neighbors, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol l Configuring Basic PIM-DM (IPv6) Functions Data Preparation To adjust control parameters for maintaining neighbors, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Timeout period for waiting to receive Hello message from neighbors 2 Interval for sending Hello messages 3 Maximum delay for triggering Hello messages 4 Number or name of the ACL used to filter PIM neighbors 12.5.2 Configuring the Interval for Sending Hello Messages The interval for sending Hello messages can be set either globally or on an interface. The configuration in the interface view is prior to the configuration in the PIM view. When the interval is not configured in the interface view, the configuration in the PIM view takes effect. Context Do as follows on the PIM-IPv6 switch: NOTE The configuration of the control parameters for maintaining PIM-IPv6 neighbors involves the following cases: l Global configuration: It is valid on all the interfaces. l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not set, the global configuration is used. Procedure l Global Configuration 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: pim-ipv6 The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed. 3. Run: timer hello interval Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 428 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration The interval for sending Hello messages is configured. l Configuration on an Interface 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. 3. Run: pim ipv6 timer hello interval The interval for sending Hello messages is set. 4. Run: pim ipv6 triggered-hello-delay interval The maximum delay for triggering Hello messages is set. After the maximum delay is set, the conflict caused by multiple PIM-IPv6 switchs simultaneously sending Hello message is avoided. ----End 12.5.3 Configuring the Timeout Period of a Neighbor The timeout period of a neighbor can be set either globally or on an interface. If the multicast device does not receive any Hello message from a neighbor when the timeout period is expired, the device considers that the neighbor is unreachable. The timeout period of the neighbor must be longer than the interval for sending Hello messages. Context Do as follows on the PIM-IPv6 switch: NOTE The configuration of the control parameters for maintaining PIM-IPv6 neighbors involves the following cases: l Global configuration: It is valid on each interface. l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not set, the global configuration is used. Procedure l Global Configuration 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: pim-ipv6 The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 429 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 3. 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration Run: hello-option holdtime interval The timeout period for keeping a neighbor reachable is set. Each switch maintains a timer for each neighbor. When receiving a Hello message, a switch resets the timer. If the local switch does not receive any Hello message from a neighbor after the timer times out, the local switch considers that the neighbor is unreachable. l Configuration on an Interface 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. 3. Run: pim ipv6 hello-option holdtime interval The timeout period for keeping the neighbor reachable is set. If the local switch does not receive any Hello message from a neighbor after the timer times out, the local switch considers that the neighbor is unreachable. ----End 12.5.4 Refusing to Receive the Hello Message Without the Generation ID Option When the Generation ID option in the Hello message received from an upstream neighbor changes, it indicates that the status of the upstream neighbor changes. Therefore, you can configure a PIM interface to deny the Hello messages without Generation ID options to obtain the upstream neighbor status in real time. Context A switch assigns a random Generation ID to an interface enabled with PIM. The Hello messages sent by the interface carry the random Generation ID. If the status of the interface changes, the random Generation ID is updated. When the Generation ID option in the Hello message received from an upstream neighbor changes, it indicates that the status of the upstream neighbor changes. If a switch does not want to receive data from an upstream neighbor, the switch sends a Prune message after receiving a data packet from the upstream neighbor. Do as follows on the PIM-DM switch: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 430 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. Step 3 Run: pim ipv6 require-genid The Generation ID option is set in a Hello message. The Hello message without the Generation ID option is rejected. ----End 12.5.5 Configuring PIM Neighbor Filtering To prevent some unknown devices from being involved in PIM, filtering PIM neighbors is required. An interface sets up neighbor relationships with only the addresses matching the filtering rules and deletes the neighbors unmatched with the filtering rules. Context To prevent some switch from being involved in PIM, filtering PIM neighbors is required. Do as follows on the switch running IPv6 PIM-DM: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. Step 3 Run: pim ipv6 neighbor-policy { basic-acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name } PIM neighbor filtering is configured. An interface sets up neighbor relationships with only the addresses matching the filtering rules and deletes the neighbors unmatching the filtering rules. NOTE When configuring the neighbor filtering function on the interface, you must also configure the neighbor filtering function correspondingly on the switch that sets up the neighbor relationship with the interface. ----End 12.5.6 Checking the Configuration After the neighbor control parameters are adjusted, you can run commands to check information about the PIM interface and the PIM neighbor. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 431 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration Procedure l Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces. l Run the display pim ipv6 neighbor [ ipv6-link-local-address | interface interface-type interface-number | verbose ] * command to check information about PIM-IPv6 neighbors. ----End 12.6 Adjusting Control Parameters for Prune When the last member leaves a group, the multicast device sends a Prune message upstream, requesting the upstream device to execute the prune operation. If other downstream devices on the same network segment need the multicast data for this group, they need to send Join messages to override the prune operation. You can adjust control parameters of Join/Prune messages as required. If there is no special requirement, adopt default values. 12.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After basic IPv6 PIM-DM functions are configured, you can set the period for an interface to keep the prune state, delay for transmitting Prune messages in a LAN, and interval for overriding the prune action as required. Applicable Environment When the last member of a group on a switch leaves its group, the switch sends a Prune message through an upstream interface to request the upstream switch to perform the prune action. After receiving the Prune message, the upstream interface stops forwarding packets to this network segment. If other downstream switchs exist in this network segment, they must send the Join message to override the prune action. Switchs under the control of default values can work normally. In the S9700, users can adjust related parameters according to the specific network environment. Pre-configuration Tasks Before adjusting control parameters for prune, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol l Configuring Basic PIM-DM (IPv6) Functions Data Preparation To adjust control parameters for prune, you need the following data. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) No. Data 1 Timeout period of the Prune state 2 Delay for transmitting Prune messages 3 Period for overriding the prune action Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 432 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration 12.6.2 Configuring the Period for an Interface to Keep the Prune State The period for an interface to keep the prune state can be set either globally or on an interface. After the period expires, the pruned interface starts to forward messages again. If the multicast device receives a State-Refresh message before the period expires, it resets the timer, that is, it refreshes the prune state. Context Do as follows on the PIM-DM switch: NOTE The configuration of the control parameters of prune involves the following cases: l Global Configuration: It is valid on all the interfaces. l Configuration on the interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not set, the global configuration is used. Procedure l Global Configuration 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: pim-ipv6 The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed. 3. Run: holdtime join-prune interval The period during which the downstream interface is in the Prune state is set. After the period expires, the pruned interface continues to forward packets. Before the period expires, the switch resets the Holdtime timer after receiving a State-Refresh message. l Configuration on an Interface 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. 3. Run: pim ipv6 holdtime join-prune interval The period during which the downstream interface is in the Prune state is set. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 433 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration After the period expires, the pruned interface continues to forward packets. Before the period expires, the switch resets the Holdtime timer after receiving a State-Refresh message. ----End 12.6.3 Configuring the Delay for Transmitting Prune Messages in a LAN The delay for transmitting Prune messages in a LAN can be set either globally or on an interface. When the values of lan-delay on all devices along the same link are different, the maximum value of these values is preferred. Context The Hello message carries lan-delay and the override-interval. The relationship between landelay, override-interval, and Prune-Pending Timer (PPT) is that lan-delay + override-interval = PPT. PPT indicates the delay from the time when a switch receives the Prune message from a downstream interface to the time when the switch performs the prune action to suppress the forwarding on the downstream interface. If the switch receives a Join message from a downstream switch within the PPT, the switch does not perform the prune action. Do as follows on the PIM-DM switch: NOTE The configuration of control parameters for Prune involves the following two cases: l Global configuration: It is valid on each interface. l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used. Procedure l Global Configuration 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: pim-ipv6 The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed. 3. Run: hello-option lan-delay interval The delay for transmitting messages in a LAN is set. l Configuration on an Interface 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: interface interface-type interface-number Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 434 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration The interface view is displayed. 3. Run: pim ipv6 hello-option lan-delay interval The delay for transmitting messages in a LAN is set. ----End 12.6.4 Configuring the Interval for Overriding the Prune Action If a device receives a Prune message from the upstream interface, it indicates that other downstream devices still exist in the LAN. If these devices still needs to receive the multicast data, the device must send a Join message upstream within the override-interval. Context When a switch receives a Prune message from an upstream interface, it indicates that switch in the LAN. When a switch receives a Prune message from an upstream interface, it indicates that the switch still needs to receive multicast data. If the switch still requests the multicast data, it needs to send a Join message in the override-interval period to the upstream switch. Do as follows on the PIM-DM switch: NOTE The configuration of control parameters for Prune involves the following two cases: l Global configuration: It is valid on each interface. l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used. Procedure l Global Configuration 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: pim-ipv6 The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed. 3. Run: hello-option override-interval interval The interval for overriding the prune action is set. l Configuration on an Interface 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 435 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 3. 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration Run: pim ipv6 hello-option override-interval interval The interval for overriding the prune action is set. ----End 12.6.5 Checking the Configuration After the control parameters for prune are adjusted, you can check information about the PIM interface and the PIM routing table and statistics about PIM control messages through commands. Procedure l Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces. l Run the display pim ipv6 control-message counters [ message-type { assert | graft | graft-ack | hello | join-prune | state-refresh | bsr } | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * command to check the number of sent and received PIM-IPv6 control messages. l Run the following commands to check the PIM-IPv6 multicast routing table. – display pim ipv6 routing-table [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6group-address [ mask mask-length ] | flags { act | del | exprune | ext | loc | niif | nonbr | none | rpt | sg_rcvr | sgjoin | spt | swt | wc | upchg } | fsm | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | outgoing-interface { exclude | include | match } { interface-type interface-number | none | register } ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim ipv6 routing-table brief [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6-group-address [ mask mask-length ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } ] * ----End 12.7 Adjusting Control Parameters for State-Refresh In a PIM-DM network, the periodic flooding-pruning wastes lots of network resources. To prevent the pruned interface from forwarding messages because the prune timer times out, you can enable the State-Refresh function to enable the multicast device to send State-Refresh messages periodically, refresh the prune state of the interface, and maintain SPT. 12.7.1 Estalishing the Configuration Task After basic functions of IPv6 PIM-DM are configured, you can set the interval for sending StateRefresh messages, period for waiting to receive the next State-Refresh message, and TTL value carried in the State-Refresh message as required. Applicable Environment By default, a PIM-DM interface is in the forwarding state. The pruned interface continues to forward packets after the prune timer times out. In the PIM-DM network, periodically flooding State-Refresh messages can update the prune timer and maintain the suppressed state of the prune interface. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 436 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration Switchs under the control of default values can work normally. In the S9700, users can adjust related parameters according to the specific network environment. NOTE If there is no special requirement, default values are recommended. Pre-configuration Tasks Before adjusting control parameters for State-Refresh, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol l Configuring Basic PIM-DM (IPv6) Functions Data Preparation To adjust control parameters for State-Refresh, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Interval for sending PIM State-Refresh messages 2 Period for waiting to receive the next State-Refresh message 3 TTL value used to forward State-Refresh messages 12.7.2 Disabling State-Refresh After this function is disabled on the interface, the interface cannot forward any State-Refresh messages. Context Do as follows on all switchs in the PIM-DM domain: NOTE By default, PIM-DM State-Refresh is enabled on an interface. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. Step 3 Run: undo pim ipv6 state-refresh-capable State-Refresh is disabled. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 437 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration The interface on which PIM-DM State-Refresh is disabled cannot forward any State-Refresh message. NOTE You can run the pim ipv6 state-refresh-capable command to re-enable the PIM-DM State-Refresh on the interface. ----End 12.7.3 Configuring the Interval for Sending State-Refresh Messages To prevent pruned interfaces from forwarding messages after the prune state timer times out, you need to set the interval for sending State-Refresh messages to be shorter than the period for keeping the Prune state. Context Do as follows on all switchs in the PIM-DM domain: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim-ipv6 The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed. Step 3 Run: state-refresh-interval interval The interval for sending PIM-IPv6 State-Refresh messages is set. NOTE The interval for sending PIM State-Refresh messages should be shorter than the timeout period for keeping the Prune state. You can run the holdtime join-prune command to set the timeout period for keeping the Prune state. ----End 12.7.4 Configuring the Period for Receiving the Next State-Refresh Message A multicast device may receive PIM State-Refresh messages from multiple routers in a short period and some PIM State-Refresh messages are repeated. Before the state-refresh timer times out, the device discards the received repeated State-Refresh messages. The device is allowed to receive the next State-Refresh message only after the timer times out. Context Do as follows on all switchs in the PIM-DM domain: Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 438 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim-ipv6 The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed. Step 3 Run: state-refresh-rate-limit interval The period for waiting to receive the next State-Refresh message is set. ----End 12.7.5 Configuring the TTL Value of a State-Refresh Message After receiving the PIM State-Refresh message, a multicast device decrements the TTL value by 1 and then forwards the message downstream until the TTL value becomes 0. In a smallsized network, the PIM State-Refresh message is transmitted circularly on the network. You can adjust the TTL value according to the network scale. Context Do as follows on all switchs in the PIM-DM domain: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim-ipv6 The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed. Step 3 Run: state-refresh-ttl ttl-value The TTL value in the State-Refresh message is set. ----End 12.7.6 Checking the Configuration After the control parameters for state-refresh are adjusted, you can check information about the PIM interface and the PIM routing table and statistics about PIM control messages through commands. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 439 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration Procedure l Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces. l Run the display pim ipv6 control-message counters [ message-type { assert | graft | graft-ack | hello | join-prune | state-refresh | bsr } | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * command to check the number of sent and received PIM-IPv6 control messages. l Run the following commands to check the PIM-IPv6 multicast routing table. – display pim ipv6 routing-table [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6group-address [ mask mask-length ] | flags { act | del | exprune | ext | loc | niif | nonbr | none | rpt | sg_rcvr | sgjoin | spt | swt | wc | upchg } | fsm | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | outgoing-interface { exclude | include | match } { interface-type interface-number | none | register } ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim ipv6 routing-table brief [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6-group-address [ mask mask-length ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } ] * ----End 12.8 Adjusting Control Messages for Graft To enable new members in a network to quickly receive multicast data, a multicast device actively sends a Graft message through an upstream interface, requesting the upstream device to forward multicast data to this network segment. 12.8.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After basic functions of IPv6 PIM-DM are configured, you can set the interval for retransmitting Graft messages as required. Applicable Environment In the PIM-DM network, if State-Refresh is not enabled, the pruned interface can forward packets only after the Prune timer times out. If State-Refresh is enabled, the pruned interface may not continue to forward packets forever. To enable new members in the network to quickly receive multicast data, the PIM-DM switch sends a Graft message through an upstream interface. After receiving the Graft message, the upstream switch immediately replies a Graft-Ack message and restores the forwarding of the interface that receives the Graft message. switchs in the control of default values can work normally. In the S9700, users can adjust related parameters according to the specific network environment. NOTE If there is no special requirement, default values are recommended. Pre-configuration Tasks Before adjusting control parameters for graft, complete the following tasks: Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 440 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration l Configuring a unicast routing protocol l Configuring Basic PIM-DM (IPv6) Functions Data Preparation To adjust control parameters for graft, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Interval for retransmitting Graft messages 12.8.2 Setting the Interval for Retransmitting Graft Messages In PIM-DM mode, when a member joins a pruned group, the multicast device sends a Graft message and waits for an ACK message from the upstream device. If the downstream device does not receive any ACK message within a certain period, the device resends the Graft message until it receives an ACK message from the upstream device. Context If the local switch does not receive any Graft-Ack message from the upstream switch in the specified time, the local switch resends the Graft message. Do as follows on the PIM-DM switch: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. Step 3 Run: pim ipv6 timer graft-retry interval The interval for retransmitting Graft messages is set. ----End 12.8.3 Checking the Configuration After the control parameters for graft are adjusted, you can check information about the unacknowledged PIM-DM graft, PIM interface, and PIM routing table and statistics about PIM control messages through commands. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 441 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration Procedure l Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces. l Run the display pim ipv6 grafts command to check the unacknowledged PIM-DM Graft messages. l Run the display pim ipv6 control-message counters [ message-type { assert | graft | graft-ack | hello | join-prune | state-refresh | bsr } | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * command to check the number of sent and received PIM-IPv6 control messages. l Run the following commands to check the PIM-IPv6 multicast routing table. – display pim ipv6 routing-table [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6group-address [ mask mask-length ] | flags { act | del | exprune | ext | loc | niif | nonbr | none | rpt | sg_rcvr | sgjoin | spt | swt | wc | upchg } | fsm | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | outgoing-interface { exclude | include | match } { interface-type interface-number | none | register } ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim ipv6 routing-table brief [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6-group-address [ mask mask-length ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } ] * ----End 12.9 Adjusting Control Messages for Assert If a multicast device can receive multicast data through the downstream interface, this indicates that other upstream devices exist in this network segment. The device then sends an Assert message through the downstream interface to take part in the election of the unique upstream device. 12.9.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After basic functions of IPv6 PIM-DM are configured, you can set the period for holding the Assert state as required. Applicable Environment When a PIM-DM switch receives multicast data through a downstream interface, this indicates that other upstream switchs exist in this network segment. The switch sends an Assert message through the downstream interface to take part in the assert election. Switchs in the control of default values can work normally. In the S9700, users can adjust related parameters according to the specific network environment. NOTE If there is no special requirement, default values are recommended. Pre-configuration Tasks Before adjusting control parameters for Assert, complete the following tasks: l Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Configuring a unicast routing protocol Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 442 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast l 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration Configuring Basic PIM-DM (IPv6) Functions Data Preparation To adjust control parameters for asset, you need the following data. No. Data 1 The period for keeping the Assert state 12.9.2 Configuring the Period for Keeping the Assert State The device that fails in the election prevents its downstream interface from forwarding multicast data. After the holdtime of the Assert state expires, the downstream interface can forward multicast data. Context Do as follows on the PIM-DM switch: NOTE The configuration involves the following two cases: l Global configuration: It is valid on each interface. l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used. Procedure l Global Configuration 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: pim-ipv6 The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed. 3. Run: holdtime assert interval The period for keeping the Assert state is set. The switch that fails in the election prohibits its downstream interface from forwarding multicast data. After the Holdtime timer times out, the downstream interface continues to forward packets. l Configuration on an Interface 1. Run: system-view Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 443 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration The system view is displayed. 2. Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. 3. Run: pim ipv6 holdtime assert interval The period for keeping the Assert state is set. The switch that fails in the election prohibits its downstream interface from forwarding multicast data. After the Holdtime timer times out, the downstream interface continues to forward packets. ----End 12.9.3 Checking the Configuration After the control parameters for assert are adjusted, you can check information about the PIM interface and the PIM routing table and statistics about PIM control messages through commands. Procedure l Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces. l Run the display pim ipv6 control-message counters [ message-type { assert | graft | graft-ack | hello | join-prune | state-refresh | bsr } | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * command to check the number of sent and received PIM-IPv6 control messages. l Run the following commands to check the PIM-IPv6 multicast routing table. – display pim ipv6 routing-table [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6group-address [ mask mask-length ] | flags { act | del | exprune | ext | loc | niif | nonbr | none | rpt | sg_rcvr | sgjoin | spt | swt | wc | upchg } | fsm | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | outgoing-interface { exclude | include | match } { interface-type interface-number | none | register } ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim ipv6 routing-table brief [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6-group-address [ mask mask-length ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } ] * ----End 12.10 Configuring PIM-IPv6 Silent Function The interface directly connecting a multicast device to a user host needs to be enabled with PIM. In this case, some malicious hosts may simulate a large number of PIM Hello messages and send the messages to the interface for processing. As a result, the multicast device is suspended. To avoid the preceding case, you can set the interface to be in the PIM Silent state. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 444 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration 12.10.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After basic functions of IPv6 PIM-DM and MLD are configured, you can configure the PIM silent function on the interface connected with the user host. This interface should be enabled with IPv6 PIM-DM and MLD first. Applicable Environment At the access layer, the switch interface directly connected to hosts needs to be enabled with PIM-IPv6. You can establish a PIM-IPv6 neighbor on the switch interface to process various PIM packets. The configuration, however, has the security vulnerability. When a host maliciously generates PIM-IPv6 Hello packets and sends the packets in a large quantity, the switch may break down. To avoid the preceding case, you can set the status of the switch interface to PIM silent. When the interface is in the PIM-IPv6 silent state, the interface is prohibited from receiving and forwarding any PIM-IPv6 packet. All PIM-IPv6 neighbors and PIM-IPv6 state machines on the interface are deleted. The interface then acts as the static DR, which takes effect immediately. At the same time, MLD on the interface is not affected. PIM silent is applicable only to the switch interface directly connected to the host network segment that is connected only to this switch. CAUTION If PIM-IPv6 silent is enabled on the interface connected to a switch, the PIM-IPv6 neighbor cannot be established and a multicast fault may occur. If the host network segment is connected to multiple switchs and PIM-IPv6 silent is enabled on multiple switch interfaces, the interfaces become static DRs. Therefore, multiple DRs exist in this network segment, and a multicast fault occurs. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring PIM-IPv6 silent, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol to make the network layer reachable l Configuring PIM-DM l Configuring MLD Data Preparation To configure PIM-IPv6 silent, you need the following data. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) No. Data 1 Number of the switch interface connected to hosts Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 445 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration 12.10.2 Configuring PIM-IPv6 Silent After the interface is configured with PIM silent, it is forbidden to receive or forward any PIM protocol packet. All PIM neighbors and PIM state machines on this interface are deleted. Then, this interface automatically becomes the DR. MLD on the interface is not affected. Context CAUTION PIM silent is applicable only to the switch interface directly connected to the host network segment that can be connected to only one PIM switch. Do as follows on the switch interface connected to the host network segment: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. Step 3 Run: pim ipv6 silent PIM-IPv6 silent is enabled. After this function is enabled, the attacks from malicious hosts by sending Hello messages are effectively prevented and the switch is protected. ----End 12.10.3 Checking the Configuration After PIM silent is configured, you can run the command to check information about the PIM interface. Prerequisites All the configurations of PIM silent are complete. Procedure l Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces. ----End Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 446 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration 12.11 Maintaining PIM-DM Maintaining IPv6 PIM-DM involves resetting PIM statistics, and monitoring PIM running status. 12.11.1 Clearing Statistics of PIM Control Messages If you need to re-collect the statistics about IPv6 PIM control messages, you can reset the existent statistics. Note that the statistics cannot be restored after you reset them. This operation does not affect normal running of PIM. Context CAUTION The statistics of PIM-IPv6 control messages on an interface cannot be restored after you clear them. So, confirm the action before you use the command. Procedure l Run the reset pim ipv6 control-message counters [ interface interface-type interfacenumber ] command in the user view to clear statistics of PIM-IPv6 control messages on an interface. ----End 12.11.2 Monitoring Running Status of PIM-DM During IPv6 PIM routine maintenance, you can run the display commands in any view to know the running of PIM. Context In routine maintenance, you can run the following commands in any view to check the running status of PIM-DM. Procedure l Run the display pim ipv6 control-message counters [ message-type { assert | graft | graft-ack | hello | join-prune | state-refresh | bsr } | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * command in any view to check the statistics of sent and received PIM-IPv6 control messages. l Run the display pim ipv6 grafts command in any view to check the unacknowledged PIMDM Graft messages. l Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command in any view to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces. l Run the display pim ipv6 neighbor [ ipv6-link-local-address | interface interface-type interface-number | verbose ] * command in any view to check information about PIM-IPv6 neighbors. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 447 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast l 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration Run the following commands in any view to check the PIM-IPv6 multicast routing table. – display pim ipv6 routing-table [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6group-address [ mask mask-length ] | flags { act | del | exprune | ext | loc | niif | nonbr | none | rpt | sg_rcvr | sgjoin | spt | swt | wc | upchg } | fsm | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | outgoing-interface { exclude | include | match } { interface-type interface-number | none | register } ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim ipv6 routing-table brief [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6-group-address [ mask mask-length ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } ] * ----End 12.11.3 Debugging PIM-IPv6 When a fault occurs during the running of IPv6 PIM, run the debugging commands in the user view and check the contents of sent and received packets for fault location. Context CAUTION Debugging affects the performance of the system. So, after debugging, you need to run the undo debugging all command to disable the debugging immediately. Procedure l Run the debugging pim ipv6 all command in the user view to enable all the debugging of PIM-IPv6. l Run the debugging pim ipv6 event [ advanced-acl6-number ] command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIM-IPv6 event. l Run the debugging pim ipv6 routing-table [ advanced-acl6-number ] command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIM-IPv6 routing table. l Run the debugging pim ipv6 neighbor [ interface-based-acl6-number | basic-acl6number | [ receive | send ] ] * command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIMIPv6 neighbors. l Run the debugging pim ipv6 assert [ advanced-acl6-number | [ receive | send ] ] * command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIM-IPv6 Assert. l Run the debugging pim ipv6 join-prune [ interface-based-acl6-number | advanced-acl6number | [ receive | send ] ] * command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIMIPv6 Join/Prune. l Run the debugging pim ipv6 state-refresh [ advanced-acl6-number | [ receive | send ] ] command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIM-IPv6 State-Refresh. * ----End Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 448 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration 12.12 Configuration Example Configuration examples are provided to show how to construct a basic IPv6 PIM-DM network. 12.12.1 Example for Configuring the IPv6 PIM-DM Network Networking Requirements On the experiment network shown in Figure 12-1, multicast is deployed. IGP is also deployed on the network, and unicast routes work normally. The S9700s on the network need to be configured properly so that user hosts can receive the VoD information in multicast mode. Figure 12-1 Networking diagram for configuring basic IPv6 PIM-DM functions Host A GE1/0/0 2002::2 Source GE2/0/0 2002::1 GE1/0/0 2001::1 2001::5 Host B GE2/0/0 3001::1 SwitchB SwitchA GE3/0/0 2003::1 GE1/0/0 2003::2 SwitchC GE2/0/0 4001::1 Host C Host D Switch Physical interface VLANIF interface IP address SwitchA GE1/0/0 VLANIF100 2001::1 GE2/0/0 VLANIF101 2002::1 GE3/0/0 VLANIF102 2003::1 GE1/0/0 VLANIF200 2002::2 GE2/0/0 VLANIF201 3001::1 GE1/0/0 VLANIF300 2003::2 GE2/0/0 VLANIF301 4001::1 SwitchB SwitchC Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 449 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration Configuration Roadmap On a small-scale experiment network, PIM-DM is adopted to configure multicast. In this example, each host network segment is connected to only one S9700, so PIM silent can be used to prevent the Hello message attack. The configuration roadmap is as follows: 1. Enable multicast on the S9700s. 2. Enable an IPv6 unicast routing protocol on the three switches. 3. Enable IPv6 PIM-DM on each interface. 4. Enable PIM IPv6 silent and MLD on the router interfaces connected to hosts. Data Preparation To complete the configuration, you need the following data: l Create VLANs and VLANIF interfaces on the S9700s and assign IP addresses to the VLANIF interfaces. l Address of the multicast group G: FF0E::1 l Address of the multicast source S: 2001::5 l Version of the MLD protocol running between S9700s and user hosts: MLDv1 Procedure Step 1 Create VLANs and VLANIF interfaces on the S9700s and assign IP addresses to the VLANIF interfaces. The configuration procedure is not provided here. Step 2 Enable an IPv6 unicast routing protocol on the three switches. The configuration procedure is not provided here. Step 3 Enable IPv6 multicast on all S9700s and enable PIM-DM on all interfaces. # Enable IPv6 multicast on SwitchA and enable PIM-DM on all its interfaces. The configurations of SwitchB, SwitchC, and SwitchD are similar to the configuration of SwitchA, and are not provided here. [SwitchA] multicast [SwitchA] interface [SwitchA-Vlanif100] [SwitchA-Vlanif100] [SwitchA] interface [SwitchA-Vlanif101] [SwitchA-Vlanif101] [SwitchA] interface [SwitchA-Vlanif102] [SwitchA-Vlanif102] ipv6 routing-enable Vlanif 100 pim ipv6 dm quit Vlanif 101 pim ipv6 dm quit Vlanif 102 pim ipv6 dm quit Step 4 On SwitchB, enable PIM silent and MLD on the interface connected to the user host. [SwitchB] multicast [SwitchB] interface [SwitchB-Vlanif201] [SwitchB-Vlanif201] [SwitchB-Vlanif201] [SwitchB-Vlanif201] ipv6 routing-enable Vlanif 201 pim ipv6 silent mld enable mld version 1 quit The configuration of SwitchC is similar to the configuration of SwitchB, and is not provided here. Step 5 Verify the configuration. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 450 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration # Run the display pim ipv6 interface command, and you can view the configuration and running status of PIM-IPv6 on interfaces of each S9700. The display of the PIM-IPv6 configuration on SwitchA is as follows: <SwitchA> display pim ipv6 interface VPN-Instance: public net Interface State NbrCnt HelloInt Vlanif100 up 0 30 (local) Vlanif101 up 1 30 Vlanif102 up 1 30 DR-Pri 1 1 1 DR-Address FE80::200:AFF:FE01:109 FE80::A01:109:1(local) FE80::A01:109:2(local) # Run the display pim ipv6 neighbor command to check the PIM neighbor relationship between the S9700s. The display of the PIM-IPv6 neighbor relationship on SwitchA is as follows: <SwitchA> display pim ipv6 neighbor VPN-Instance: public net Total Number of Neighbors = 2 Neighbor Interface Uptime Expires FE80::A01:104:1 Vlanif101 00:04:16 00: 01:29 FE80::A01:105:1 Vlanif102 00:03:54 00 :01:17 Dr-Priority 1 1 BFD-Session N N # Run the display pim ipv6 routing-table command to view the PIM-IPv6 multicast routing table on an S9700. Assume that Host A joins multicast group G (FF0E::1). SwitchB generates a (*, G) entry. When multicast source S (2001::5) sends multicast packets to G, a Shortest Path Tree (SPT) is generated through flooding-prune. The (S, G) entry exists on each S9700 on the network, and the display is as follows: <SwitchA> display pim ipv6 routing-table VPN-Instance: public net Total 0 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry (2001::5, FF0E::1) Protocol: pim-dm, Flag: LOC ACT UpTime: 00:01:20 Upstream interface: Vlanif100 Upstream neighbor: NULL RPF prime neighbor: NULL Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: Vlanif101 Protocol: pim-dm, UpTime: 00:01:20, Expires: <SwitchB> display pim ipv6 routing-table VPN-Instance: public net Total 1 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry (*, FF0E::1) Protocol: pim-dm, Flag: WC UpTime: 01:46:23 Upstream interface: Vlanif200 Upstream neighbor: FE80::A01:109:1 RPF prime neighbor: FE80::A01:109:1 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: Vlanif201 Protocol: mld, UpTime: 01:46:23, Expires: never (2001::5, FF0E::1) Protocol: pim-dm, Flag: ACT UpTime: 00:02:19 Upstream interface: Vlanif200 Upstream neighbor: FE80::A01:109:1 RPF prime neighbor: FE80::A01:109:1 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 1 1: Vlanif201 Protocol: pim-dm, UpTime: 00:02:19, Expires: <SwitchC> display pim ipv6 routing-table VPN-Instance: public net Total 0 (*, G) entry; 1 (S, G) entry (2001::5, FF0E::1) Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 451 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration Protocol: pim-dm, Flag: ACT UpTime: 00:02:19 Upstream interface: Vlanif300 Upstream neighbor: FE80::A01:109:2 RPF prime neighbor: FE80::A01:109:2 Downstream interface(s) information: Total number of downstreams: 0 ----End Configuration Files l Configuration file of SwitchA # sysname SwitchA # vlan batch 100 to 102 # ipv6 # multicast ipv6 routing-enable # interface Vlanif100 ipv6 enable ipv6 address 2001::1/64 pim ipv6 dm # interface Vlanif101 ipv6 enable ipv6 address 2002::1/64 pim ipv6 dm # interface Vlanif102 ipv6 enable ipv6 address 2003::1/64 pim ipv6 dm # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 100 port hybrid untagged vlan 100 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 101 port hybrid untagged vlan 101 # interface GigabitEthernet3/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 102 port hybrid untagged vlan 102 # return l Configuration file of SwitchB # sysname SwitchB # vlan batch 200 201 # ipv6 # multicast ipv6 routing-enable # interface Vlanif200 ipv6 enable ipv6 address 2002::2/64 pim ipv6 dm # interface Vlanif201 ipv6 enable Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 452 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 12 PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration ipv6 address 3001::1/64 pim ipv6 dm pim ipv6 silent mld enable mld version 1 # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 200 port hybrid untagged vlan 200 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 201 port hybrid untagged vlan 201 # return l Configuration file of SwitchC # sysname SwitchC # vlan batch 300 301 # ipv6 # multicast ipv6 routing-enable # interface Vlanif300 ipv6 enable ipv6 address 2003::2/64 pim ipv6 dm # interface Vlanif301 ipv6 enable ipv6 address 4001::1/64 pim ipv6 dm pim ipv6 silent mld enable mld version 1 # interface GigabitEthernet1/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 300 port hybrid untagged vlan 300 # interface GigabitEthernet2/0/0 port hybrid pvid vlan 301 port hybrid untagged vlan 301 # return Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 453 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration About This Chapter The PIM protocol can be used in an IPv6 network to implement multicast routing and data forwarding inside an AS. The PIM-SM protocol is a multicast routing protocol of sparse mode. It is applicable to a large-scale network with sparsely-distributed members. 13.1 PIM-IPv6 Overview In an IPv6 PIM-SM network, group members are sparsely distributed and almost all the network segments do not have group members resided. Therefore, an RP is a forwarding core of the PIMSM network. All PIM devices in the PIM-SM network must know the location of the RP and the RP collects information about both group members and multicast sources. 13.2 PIM-SM Features Supported by the S9700 You are allowed to adjust parameters related to neighbor discovery, forwarding, DR, RP, join, register, and assert. In addition, you can configure various filtering policies and the PIM silent function to enhance the PIM-SM security. IPv6 PIM-SM supports SSM, PIM GR, and SPT switchover. 13.3 Configuring Basic PIM-SM (IPv6) Functions Ensure that unicast routes are reachable before configuring IPv6 multicast routing and enable IPv6 PIM-SM on each interface of the multicast device. In this manner, the IPv6 PIM-SM network can work normally. 13.4 Adjusting Control Parameters of a Source A multicast device can control the forwarding of multicast data based on multicast sources. This helps to control multicast data flows and limit information that can be obtained by downstream receivers to enhance security. 13.5 Adjusting Control Parameters of a C-RP and a C-BSR If a dynamic RP is used, you can adjust parameters of C-RPs and C-BSR as required. 13.6 Adjusting Control Parameters for Maintaining Neighbors Multicast devices establish PIM neighbor relationships and negotiate various control parameters by exchanging Hello messages. You can adjust the parameters carried in Hello messages as required. If there is no special requirement, adopt default values. 13.7 Adjusting Control Parameters of Source Registering Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 454 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration In a PIM-SM network, the DR directly connected to the multicast source encapsulates multicast data in a Register message and sends the message to the RP in unicast mode. The RP then decapsulates the message, and forwards the multicast data to receivers along the RPT. 13.8 Adjusting Control Parameters for Forwarding A multicast device sends Join messages upstream to require forwarding multicast data and Prune messages to require stopping the forwarding of multicast data. You can adjust control parameters for multicast data forwarding as required. If there is no special requirement, adopt default values. 13.9 Configuring Control Parameters for Assert If a multicast device can receive multicast data through the downstream interface, this indicates that other upstream devices exist in this network segment. The device then sends an Assert message through the downstream interface to take part in the election of the unique upstream device. 13.10 Adjusting Control Parameters for the SPT Switchover A high volume of multicast data traffic increases the load of an RP, and may result in a fault. To solve this problem, IPv6 PIM-SM allows the RP or the DR at the group member side to trigger the SPT switchover when the rate of multicast packets is high. 13.11 Configuring PIM GR (IPv6) In an IPv6 PIM-SM network, PIM GR can be applied to a device with dual main control boards to ensure normal multicast data forwarding during master-slave switchover. 13.12 Configuring PIM-IPv6 Silent The interface directly connecting a multicast device to a user host needs to be enabled with PIM. In this case, some malicious hosts may simulate a large number of PIM Hello messages and send the messages to the interface for processing. As a result, the multicast device is suspended. To avoid the preceding case, you can set the interface to be in the PIM Silent state. 13.13 Maintaining PIM-SM Maintaining IPv6 PIM-SM involves resetting PIM statistics, and monitoring PIM running status. 13.14 Configuration Example Configuration examples are provided to show how to construct a basic IPv6 PIM-SM network. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 455 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration 13.1 PIM-IPv6 Overview In an IPv6 PIM-SM network, group members are sparsely distributed and almost all the network segments do not have group members resided. Therefore, an RP is a forwarding core of the PIMSM network. All PIM devices in the PIM-SM network must know the location of the RP and the RP collects information about both group members and multicast sources. In the IPv4 multicast applications, the Protocol Independent Multicast (PIM) is used to set multicast routes between switchs to replicate and forward multicast packets. In IPv6 multicast applications, switchs run PIM-IPv6. The functions and principles of PIM-IPv6 are similar to the functions of PIM-IPv4. PIM-IPv6 consists of the following separate protocols: l PIM-DM: indicates the Protocol Independent Multicast-Dense Mode. PIM-DM is applicable to a small-scale network with densely-distributed members. The network adopts the Any-Source Multicast (ASM) model to implement multicast services. l PIM-SM: indicates the Protocol Independent Multicast-Sparse Mode. PIM-SM is applicable to a large-scale network with sparsely-distributed members. The network adopts the ASM and Source-Specific Multicast (SSM) models to implement multicast services. NOTE l This chapter describes only the PIM-SM configuration in the IPv6 network. PIM-SM in this chapter refers to the IPv6 PIM-SM, unless otherwise specified. l For the configuration of PIM-DM, refer to the chapter PIM-DM (IPv6) Configuration. l For details of ASM and SSM models, refer to the chapter "IP Multicast Overview" in the S9700 Core Routing Switch Feature Description - IP Multicast. 13.2 PIM-SM Features Supported by the S9700 You are allowed to adjust parameters related to neighbor discovery, forwarding, DR, RP, join, register, and assert. In addition, you can configure various filtering policies and the PIM silent function to enhance the PIM-SM security. IPv6 PIM-SM supports SSM, PIM GR, and SPT switchover. Embedded-RP Based on PIM-SM (IPv4), embedded-Rendezvous Point (Embedded-RP) is added in PIM-SM (IPv6). The embedded-RP is a method of obtaining an RP(Rendezvous Point). The function of the embedded-RP is the same as that of the static RP and the dynamic RP. Static RP You can specify the static RP on all switchs in the PIM-SM domain. When a dynamic RP exists in the domain, the dynamic RP is preferred by default, but you can configure the static RP to be preferred. Dynamic RP You can specify a C-RP in a BSR domain, adjust the priority for C-RP election, adjust the lifetime of the advertisement message on the BSR received from the C-RP, adjust the interval for the CIssue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 456 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration RP to advertise advertisement messages, and specify an Access Control List (ACL) to limit the range of the multicast groups served by the C-RP. BSR You can specify a Candidate-BSR (C-BSR) in a BSR domain, adjust the hash mask length used by the C-RP for C-RP election, adjust the priority for BSR election, and adjust the legal address range of BSRs. Controlling a Multicast Source You can configure the filtering rules based on multicast source addresses to control a multicast source. BSR Administrative Domain To provide precise management, a PIM-SM network is divided into multiple BSR administrative domains and a Global domain. This can reduce the workload of a single BSR and designate a group address for users in a specific domain. Adjusting Control Parameters for Maintaining PIM-SM Neighbors You can adjust such control parameters of a PIM-SM neighbor relationship as: l Interval for sending Hello messages l Time period for the neighbor to hold the reachable state l Whether to accept the Hello messages with Generation IDs l Maximum delay in triggering the sending of the Hello messages l Priority for DR election l DR switching delay l Neighbor filtering function: An interface sets up neighbor relationships with only the addresses matching the filtering rules and deletes the neighbors unmatched with the filtering rules. Adjusting Control Parameters for Source Registering You can configure the policy to filter Register messages, and set the timeout period for being in the register suppression state and interval for sending null Register messages by running related commands. Adjusting Control Parameters for Multicast Forwarding You can adjust the control parameters for multicast forwarding, including: l Interval for sending Join messages l Time period for the downstream interface to keep the forwarding state l Time for overriding the prune action l Filtering Join information in the Join/Prune messages l Neighbor check function: checks whether the sent or received Join/Prune and Assert messages are to or from a PIM neighbor. If not, stop sending these messages. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 457 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration Adjusting Control Parameters for Assert You can configure the period for keeping the Assert state of a switch interface. Adjusting Control Parameters for SPT Switchover You can adjust the conditions of the SPT switchover and the interval for checking the forwarding rate of multicast data. IPv6 BFD for PIM The S9700 supports IPv6 BFD for PIM for detecting the status of the link on the shared network segment within milliseconds and fast responding to the fault on the PIM neighbor. IPv6 BFD for PIM detects the current DR or Assert winner status on the shared network segment. When a fault occurs on the interface, BFD immediately instructs the PIM module to trigger a new DR election or Assert election rather than waits until the neighbor relationship or the Assert timer times out. This reduces the discontinue period of multicast data transmission and thus improves the reliability of multicast data transmission. Configuring PIM Silent On the access layer, the switch interface directly connected to hosts needs to be enabled with PIM. You can establish a PIM neighbor on the switch interface to process various PIM packets. The configuration, however, has the security vulnerability. When a host maliciously generates PIM Hello packets and sends the packets in large quantity, the switch may break down. To prevent the preceding case, you can set the status of the switch interface to PIM Silent (that is, PIM pasive state). When the interface is in the PIM silent state, the interface is prohibited from receiving and forwarding any PIM packet. Then all PIM neighbors and PIM state machines on the interface are deleted. The interface acts as the static DR and immediately takes effect. At the same time, MLD on the interface are not affected. PIM for Anycast RP Through PIM for Anycast RP in a PIM-SM domain, IP routing will automatically select the topologically closest RP for each source and receiver. This releases burdens on a single RP, implements RP backup, and optimizes multicast forwarding paths. IPv6 PIM IPSec IPv6 PIM IPSec provides a complete set of IPSec mechanisms to authenticate the sent and received IPv6 PIM protocol packets, thus protecting devices are protected against pseudo IPv6 PIM protocol packets. 13.3 Configuring Basic PIM-SM (IPv6) Functions Ensure that unicast routes are reachable before configuring IPv6 multicast routing and enable IPv6 PIM-SM on each interface of the multicast device. In this manner, the IPv6 PIM-SM network can work normally. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 458 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration 13.3.1 Establishing the Configuration Task Before configuring basic IPv6 PIM-SM functions, configure a unicast IPv6 routing protocol. Applicable Environment A PIM-SM network can adopt the ASM and SSM models to provide multicast services for hosts. The integrated components (including the RP) of the ASM model must be configured in the network first. The SSM group address range is then adjusted as required. NOTE The SSM model needs to be supported by the Multicast Listener Discovery version 2 (MLDv2). If a host must run MLDv1, configure MLD SSM mapping on the switch interface. Through MLD, a switch knows the multicast group G that a user wants to join. l If G is in the SSM group address range and the source S is specified when the user joins G through MLDv2, the SSM model is used to provide multicast services. l If G is in the SSM group address range and the switch is configured with the (S, G) SSM mapping rules, the SSM model is used to provide multicast services. l If G is not in the SSM group address range, the ASM model is used to provide multicast services. In the PIM-SM network, the ASM model supports the following methods used to obtain an RP. You can select at least one method to obtain an RP. l Embedded-RP: By default, the embedded-RP is started. The range of groups served by the embedded-RP is limited. l Dynamic RP: To obtain a dynamic RP, select several switchs in the PIM-SM domain and configure them as C-RPs and C-BSRs, and then configure the BSR boundary on the switch interface on the boundary of the domain. Each switch in the PIM-SM domain can then automatically obtain the RP. l Static RP: To obtain a static RP, manually configure the RP on each switch in the PIM-SM domain. For the large-scale PIM-IPv6 network, configuring a static RP is complicated. To enhance the robustness and the operation management of the multicast network, the static RP is usually used as the backup of the BSR-RP. A multicast group may be in the service range of the embedded-RP, dynamic -RP and static RP simultaneously. By default, the sequence used by switchs to select an RP is embedded-RP> dynamic RP > the static RP. If the static RP precedence is configured, the static RP is preferred. Compared with all groups corresponding to an RP, different multicast groups correspond to different RPs can reduce the load of a single RP and enhance the robustness of the network. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configure basic PIM-SM functions, complete the following task: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol l Enable IPv6 function globally Data Preparation To configure basic PIM-SM functions, you need the following data. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 459 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration No. Data 1 (Optional) The range of groups served by the embedded-RP 2 (Optional) The IP address of the static RP 3 (Optional) ACL6 that defines the range of multicast groups served by a static RP 4 (Optional) The priority of a C-RP 5 (Optional) ACL6 that defines the range of multicast groups served by a C-RP 6 (Optional) The interval taken by a C-RP to send advertisement messages 7 (Optional) Timeout period during which a BSR waits to receive the advertisement message from a C-RP 8 (Optional) Hash mask length of a C-BSR 9 (Optional) The priority of a C-BSR 10 (Optional) SSM group address range 13.3.2 Enabling IPv6 Multicast Routing Prior to configuring all IPv6 multicast features, enable IPv6 multicast routing. Context Do as follows on the PIM switch: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 (Optional) Run: assign multicast-resource-mode optimize The multicast replication capability of LPUs is improved. If each multicast packet needs to be replicated into more than 8192 copies, run this command to improve the multicast replication capability before enabling IP multicast routing. Step 3 Run: multicast ipv6 routing-enable IPv6 multicast routing is enabled in the public network instance. ----End 13.3.3 Enabling Basic PIM-SM (IPv6) Functions An interface can set up PIM neighbor relationship with other devices after IPv6 PIM-SM is enabled on it. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 460 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration Context Do as follows on the PIM switch: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The VLANIF interface view is displayed. Step 3 Run: pim ipv6 sm PIM-SM (IPv6) is enabled. After PIM-SM (IPv6) is enabled on interfaces, switchs set up PIM-IPv6 neighbor relationship with each other. The switchs can then process protocol packets received from PIM-IPv6 neighbors. NOTE PIM-DM (IPv6) and PIM-SM (IPv6) cannot be enabled on an interface simultaneously. The PIM mode on all interfaces that belong to the same instance must be the same. When a switch is deployed in a PIM-SM (IPv6) domain, enable PIM-SM (IPv6) on all non-boundary interfaces. ----End 13.3.4 (Optional) Configuring an Embedded-RP IPv6 PIM-SM supports the embedded-RP and the range of multicast groups that the embeddedRP serves set on all devices must be the same. Context Do as follows on all switchs in the PIM-SM (IPv6) domain: NOTE This configuration is optional. By default, the embedded-RP is enabled. The group address range of the embedded-RP is FF7x::/12, and the value of x ranges from 0, 3 to F. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim-ipv6 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 461 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed. Step 3 Run: embedded-rp [ basic-acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name ] The group address range of an embedded-RP is specified. If the address range defined by ACL6 is wider than the default group address range of an embedded-RP, the embedded-RP is valid for the intersection part of the two address ranges. NOTE The group address scope of the embedded-RP on all switchs in the PIM-SM (IPv6) domain must be the same. ----End 13.3.5 (Optional) Configuring a Static RP When only one RP exists in the network, you can manually configure a static RP rather than a dynamic RP. This can save the bandwidth occupied by message exchange between the C-RP and the BSR. The configurations about the static RP should be the same on all the devices in an IPv6 PIM-SM domain. Context CAUTION Configuring a static RP and a BSR-RP in the PIM-SM simultaneously may cause a network fault. Therefore, confirm the action before you perform this configuration. If the static RP is not required in this PIM-SM network, this configuration is not necessary. Do as follows on all switchs in the PIM-SM(IPv6) domain: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim-ipv6 The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed. Step 3 Run: static-rp rp-address [ basic-acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name ] [preferred ] A static RP is specified. The parameters of the command are explained as follows: l rp-address: specifies the static RP address. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 462 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration l basic-acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name: specifies the number of the ACL. This basic ACL defines the scope of groups served by the static RP. When the scopes of multicast groups that multiple static RP serves overlap, the static RP with the highest IP address acts as the RP. l preferred: indicates that the static RP takes precedence. The C-RP is configured in the network at the same time. After preferred is set, switchs prefer the static RP. Otherwise, switchs prefer the C-RP. Multiple static RPs can be configured by using this command repeatedly, but the same ACL cannot correspond to multiple static RPs. If the ACL is not configured, only one static RP can be configured. NOTE The same static-rp command must be used on all switchs in the PIM-SM domain. ----End 13.3.6 (Optional) Configuring a Dynamic RP In an PIM-SM(IPv6) domain, you can select several PIM devices and configure C-RPs on the devices. Then, the RP is elected from these C-RPs. The C-BSRs should also be configured and a BSR is elected from these C-BSRs. The BSR is responsible for collecting and advertising the C-RP information on the network. Context CAUTION This configuration is applicable only to the dynamic RP. If the dynamic RP is not used in this network, this configuration is not necessary. Do as follows on switchs that may become RP in the PIM-SM domain: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim-ipv6 The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed. Step 3 Run: c-rp ipv6-address [ advertisement-interval interval | [ group-policy { basic-acl6number | acl6-name acl6-name } | scope scope-id ] |holdtime interval | priority priority-value ] * The C-RP is configured. The parameters of this command are explained as follows: Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 463 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration l ipv6-address: specifies the IPv6 address of the interface where the C-RP resides. PM-SM must be enabled on that interface. l group-policy basic-acl6-number: specifies that the C-RP serves only the multicast group matching ACL6. basic-acl-number: specifies the number of the basic ACL6. By default, the C-RP serves all multicast groups. l priority priority: specifies the priority for electing the C-RP. The greater the value, the lower the priority. By default, the priority is 192. NOTE In the RP election, the C-RP with the highest priority (with the lowest priority value) succeeds. In case of the same priority, the hash function is calculated, and the C-RP with the greatest hash value succeeds. In case of the same priority and the same hash value, the C-RP with the highest IP address succeeds. l holdtime hold-interval: specifies the timeout period during which the BSR waits to receive the advertisement message from the C-RP. By default, the value is 150s. l advertisement-interval adv-interval: specifies the interval during which the C-RP sends advertisement messages. By default, the value is 60s. Step 4 Run: c-bsr ipv6-address [ hash-length [ priority ] ] A C-BSR is configured. The parameters of this command are explained as follows: l ipv6-address: specifies the IPv6 address of the interface where the C-BSR resides. The interface must be configured with PIM-SM. l hash-length: specifies the length of the hash mask. According to the group address G, C-RP address, and the value of hash-length, switchs calculate the C-RPs that have the same priority and want to serve G by operating hash functions, and compare the calculation results. The C-RP with the greatest calculated value acts as the RP that serves G. You can use the c-bsr hash-length hash-length command to set the global hash length of the C-BSRs. The set hash length then applies to all the C-BSRs configured on the switch. Step 5 (Optional) Run: bsm semantic fragmentation The BSR message fragmentation is enabled. It is recommended to enable BSR message fragmentation on all devices on the network because BSR message fragmentation can solve the problem faced by IP fragmentation that all fragments become unavailable due to loss of fragment information. ----End 13.3.7 (Optional) Configuring the SSM Group Address Range The default SSM group address range is FF3x::/32. You can manually configure the SSM group address range. Ensure that the SSM group address ranges configured on all devices in the network are identical. Context Do as follows on all switchs in the PIM-SM domain: Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 464 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration NOTE This configuration is optional. By default, the SSM group address range is FF3x::/32. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim-ipv6 The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed. Step 3 Run: ssm-policy { basic-acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name } The SSM group address range is configured. NOTE Ensure that the SSM group address ranges of all switchs in the network must be identical. ----End 13.3.8 Checking the Configuration After basic functions of IPv6 PIM-SM are configured, you can check information about the BSR, RP, PIM interface, PIM neighbor, and PIM routing table through commands. Procedure l Run the display pim ipv6 bsr-info command to check information about the BSR in the PIM-SM (IPv6) domain. l Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces. l Run the display pim ipv6 neighbor [ ipv6-link-local-address | interface interface-type interface-number | verbose ] * command to check information about PIM-IPv6 neighbors. l Run the display pim ipv6 rp-info [ ipv6-group-address ] command to check information about RPs in the PIM-SM domain. l Run the following commands to check the PIM-IPv6 multicast routing table. – display pim ipv6 routing-table [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6group-address [ mask mask-length ] | flags { act | del | exprune | ext | loc | niif | nonbr | none | rpt | sg_rcvr | sgjoin | spt | swt | wc | upchg } | fsm | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | outgoing-interface { exclude | include | match } { interface-type interface-number | none | register } ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim ipv6 routing-table brief [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6-group-address [ mask mask-length ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } ] * ----End Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 465 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration 13.4 Adjusting Control Parameters of a Source A multicast device can control the forwarding of multicast data based on multicast sources. This helps to control multicast data flows and limit information that can be obtained by downstream receivers to enhance security. 13.4.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After basic functions of IPv6 PIM-SM are configured, you can configure the lifetime of a multicast source and source address-based filtering rules as required. Applicable Environment All the configurations in this section are applicable to the ASM and SSM models. PIM-IPv6 switchs check the passing multicast data packets. By checking whether the data packets match the filtering rule, the switchs determine whether to forward the packets. That is, the switchs in the PIM domain act as filters. The filters help to control data flows, and limit information obtained by downstream receivers. NOTE Switchs under the control of default values can work normally. In the S9700, users can adjust related parameters according to the actual environment. If there is no special requirement from the actual network, it is recommended to use default values. Pre-configuration Tasks Before adjusting control parameters of a multicast source, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol l Configuring Basic PIM-SM (IPv6) Functions Data Preparation To adjust control parameters of a multicast source, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Keepalive period of a multicast source 2 Filtering rules of multicast source addresses 13.4.2 Configuring the Keepalive Period of a Source A multicast device starts a timer for each (S, G) entry. If the multicast device does not receive any multicast packets from a multicast source within the set lifetime of the multicast source, it considers that the (S, G) entry becomes invalid and the multicast source stops sending multicast data to the multicast group. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 466 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration Context Do as follows on the PIM-IPv6 switch: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim-ipv6 The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed. Step 3 Run: source-lifetime interval The Keepalive period of a source is configured. When the Keepalive period expires, the (S, G) entry becomes invalid. ----End 13.4.3 Configuring Filtering Rules Based on Source Addresses After ACL6 rules are configured, a multicast device can filter the received multicast packets based on source addresses or source/group addresses. Context Do as follows on the PIM-IPv6 switch: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim-ipv6 The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed. Step 3 Run: source-policy { acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name } A filter is configured. If the basic ACL6 is configured, only the packets with the source addresses that pass the filtering are forwarded. If the advanced ACL6 is configured, only the packets with the source addresses and group addresses that pass the filtering are forwarded. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 467 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration NOTE l If acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name is specified in the source-policy command and ACL rules are created, only the multicast packets whose source addresses match the ACL rules are permitted. l If acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name is specified in the source-policy command and no ACL rule is created, the multicast packets with any source addresses are not forwarded. l The source-policy command does not filter the static (S, G) entries. ----End 13.4.4 Checking the Configuration After the control parameters of a multicast source are adjusted, you can run commands to check entries in the PIM routing table. Procedure l Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces. l Run the following commands to check the PIM-IPv6 multicast routing table. – display pim ipv6 routing-table [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6group-address [ mask mask-length ] | flags { act | del | exprune | ext | loc | niif | nonbr | none | rpt | sg_rcvr | sgjoin | spt | swt | wc | upchg } | fsm | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | outgoing-interface { exclude | include | match } { interface-type interface-number | none | register } ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim ipv6 routing-table brief [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6-group-address [ mask mask-length ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } ] * ----End 13.5 Adjusting Control Parameters of a C-RP and a C-BSR If a dynamic RP is used, you can adjust parameters of C-RPs and C-BSR as required. 13.5.1 Establishing the Configuration Task In case that the dynamic RP is used, after basic functions of IPv6 PIM-SM are configured, you can adjust parameters of C-RPs and C-BSR, configure a BSR boundary, and set valid address ranges for BSRs and C-RPs. Applicable Environment To enhance the performance of an RP or a BSR, you can adjust control parameters of C-RPs and C-BSRs by using related commands. NOTE Switchs under the control of default values can work normally. In the S9700, users can adjust related parameters according to the actual environment. If there is no special requirement of the actual network, it is recommended to use default values. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 468 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration Pre-configuration Tasks Before adjusting control parameters of a C-RP and a C-BSR, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol l Configuring Basic PIM-SM (IPv6) Functions Data Preparation To adjust control parameters of a C-RP and C-BSR, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Priority of the C-RP 2 Interval during which the C-RP sending advertisement messages 3 Timeout period during which the BSR waits to receive the advertisement message from the C-RP 4 Hash mask length of the C-BSR 5 Priority of the C-BSR 6 Interval during which the C-BSR sends Bootstrap messages 7 Period for keeping the Boostrap message received from the BSR 8 ACL6 that defines the legal BSR address range 9 ACL6 that defines the legal C-RP address range 13.5.2 Adjusting Control Parameters of a C-RP C-RPs periodically send Advertisement messages to a BSR. The Advertisement messages carry C-RP priorities. You can adjust the C-RP priority, the interval for sending Advertisement messages, and the holdtime of Advertisement messages on a device configured with the C-RP. Context Do as follows on the switch on which the C-RP is configured: NOTE Do as follows on the switch that has been configured with a C-RP. This configuration is optional. If there is no special requirement, default values are recommended. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim-ipv6 Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 469 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed. Step 3 Run: c-rp priority priority The priority of the C-RP is configured. Step 4 Run: c-rp advertisement-interval interval The interval during which the C-RP sends advertisement messages is configured. Step 5 Run: c-rp holdtime interval The period for keeping the advertisement message received from the C-RP is configured. This period must be longer than the interval during the C-RP sends advertisement messages. The C-RP periodically sends advertisement messages to the BSR. After receiving the advertisement messages, the BSR obtains the Holdtime period from the messages. During the Holdtime period, the advertisement message is valid. When the Holdtime period expires, the CRP ages. No requirement is imposed on the sequence of the preceding steps. ----End 13.5.3 Adjusting Control Parameters of a C-BSR At first, each C-BSR considers itself as a BSR and sends Bootstrap messages to all devices in the network. You can adjust the hash mask length of the C-BSR carried in a Bootstrap message, the C-BSR priority, the interval for sending Bootstrap messages, and the holdtime of Bootstrap messages on a device configured with the C-BSR. Context Do as follows on the switch on which the C-BSR is configured: NOTE Do as follows on the switch that has been configured with a C-BSR. This configuration is optional. If there is no special requirement, default values are recommended. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim-ipv6 The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed. Step 3 Run: c-bsr hash-length hash-length The hash mask length of the C-BSR is configured. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 470 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration Step 4 Run: c-bsr priority priority The priority of the C-BSR is configured. Step 5 Run: c-bsr interval interval The interval during which the BSR sends Bootstrap messages is configured. Step 6 Run: c-bsr holdtime interval The period for keeping the Bootstrap received from the BSR is configured. The BSR periodically sends a Bootstrap message to the network. After receiving the Bootstrap message, the C-BSR keeps the message for a certain period. During the period, the BSR election stops temporarily. If the Holdtime period expires, a new round of BSR election is triggered among C-BSRs. NOTE Ensure that the period for keeping the Bootstrap message received from the BSR and the interval during which the BSR sends Bootstrap messages must be the same on all C-BSRs in the PIM-IPv6 domains. The period for keeping the Bootstrap message received from the BSR must be longer than the interval during which the BSR sending Bootstrap messages. No requirement is imposed on the sequence of the preceding steps. ----End 13.5.4 Configuring the BSR Service Boundary A BSR boundary can be configured on an interface. Bootstrap messages cannot pass the BSR boundary. Multiple BSR boundary interfaces divide the network into different PIM-SM domains. Context Do as follows the switchs that may become BSR boundaries: NOTE The BSR boundary is used to divide a PIM-SM (IPv6) domain. switchs outside the BSR boundary do not take part in the process of multicast forwarding in the PIM-SM (IPv6) domain. This configuration is optional. By default, all PIM-SM (IPv6) switchs in the network can receive BSR messages. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. Step 3 Run: pim ipv6 bsr-boundary Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 471 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration The BSR boundary is configured. BSR messages cannot pass the BSR boundary. ----End 13.5.5 (Optional) Configuring the Range of Legal BSR addresses ACL6-based policies can be set on all devices to filter C-BSR addresses. The devices then receive only the Bootstrap messages with the source addresses being in the valid C-BSR address range. Thus, BSR spoofing is avoided. Context Do as follows on all switchs in the PIM-SM domain: NOTE This configuration is optional. By default, source addresses of the received BSR packets are not checked, and all received BSR packets are received. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim-ipv6 The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed. Step 3 Run: bsr-policy { basic-acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name } The range of legal BSR addresses is limited. After receiving an IP packet carrying a Bootstrap message, a switch checks the source address of the IP packet. If the source address is not in the range of legal BSR addresses, the packet is discarded. The BSR spoofing is thus avoided. basic-acl6-number specifies the number of the basic ACL. The ACL defines the filtering policy for the source addresses of BSR messages. ----End 13.5.6 (Optional) Configuring the Range of Legal C-RP Addresses ACL6-based policies can be set on all C-BSRs to filter C-RP addresses and addresses of the groups that the C-RPs serve. The BSR adds C-RP information to the RP-set only when the addresses are in the set legal address range. Thus, C-RP spoofing is avoided. Context Do as follows on all C-BSRs in the PIM-SM domain: Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 472 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration NOTE This configuration is optional. By default, the C-RP address carried in the received advertisement message and the address of the group that the C-RP serves are not checked, and all received advertisement messages are received and added to the RP-set. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim-ipv6 The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed. Step 3 Run: crp-policy { advanced-acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name } The range of legal C-RP addresses and the range of groups that C-RPs serve are limited. When a switch receives an advertisement message, the switch checks the C-RP address and the address of the group that the C-RP serves in the message. The advertisement message is received and added to the RP-set only when the C-RP address and the group address are in the legal address range. The C-RP spoofing is thus avoided. { advanced-acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name }: specifies the number of the advanced ACL. The ACL defines the filtering policy to limit the range of legal C-RP and the range of groups that the C-RP serves. ----End 13.5.7 Checking the Configuration After the control parameters of C-RPs and C-BSRs are adjusted, you can check information about the BSR and RP and check whether a BSR boundary is configured on the interface through commands. Procedure l Run the display pim ipv6 bsr-info command to check information about BSRs in the PIMSM domain. l Run the display pim ipv6 rp-info [ ipv6-group-address ] command to check information about RPs in the PIM-SM domain. ----End 13.6 Adjusting Control Parameters for Maintaining Neighbors Multicast devices establish PIM neighbor relationships and negotiate various control parameters by exchanging Hello messages. You can adjust the parameters carried in Hello messages as required. If there is no special requirement, adopt default values. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 473 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration 13.6.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After basic functions of IPv6 PIM-SM are configured, you can adjust related parameters of Hello messages for controlling neighbor relationships and configure the downstream neighbor tracking function and the neighbor filtering function. Applicable Environment The configuration in this section is applicable to both the ASM model and the SSM model. The PIM switchs send Hello messages to each other to establish the neighbor relationship, negotiate the control parameters, and elect a DR. The switch can work normally by default. The S9700 allows the users to adjust the parameters as required. NOTE It is recommended to adopt the default value if there is no special requirement. Pre-configuration Tasks Before adjusting control parameters for maintaining neighbors, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol l Configuring Basic PIM-SM (IPv6) Functions Data Preparation To adjust control parameters for maintaining neighbors, you need the following data. No. Data 1 Priority for DR election 2 Timeout period for waiting to receive Hello message from neighbors 3 Interval for sending Hello messages 4 Maximum delay for triggering Hello messages 5 DR switching delay, that is, the remaining time for the entries to turn invalid after a DR interface no longer functions as a DR. 6 Number or name of the ACL6 used to filter PIM neighbors 13.6.2 Configuring Control Parameters for Maintaining PIM-IPv6 Neighbors Control Parameters for Maintaining PIM-IPv6 Neighbors can be set either globally or on an interface. The configuration in the interface view is prior to the configuration in the PIM view. When the interval is not configured in the interface view, the configuration in the PIM view takes effect. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 474 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration Context Perform the following steps on an PIM-SM (IPv6) switchto set the interval at which Hello packets are sent and the period for keeping the reachable state of a neighbor: NOTE The configuration of the control parameters for maintaining PIM neighbors involves the following cases: l Global configuration: It is valid on all the interfaces. l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used. Procedure l Global Configuration 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: pim-ipv6 The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed. 3. Run: timer hello interval The interval for sending Hello messages is configured. 4. Run: hello-option holdtime interval The period for keeping the reachable state of a neighbor is configured. If the local switch does not receive any Hello message from the neighbor after the period expires, the local switch considers that the neighbor is unreachable. l Configuration on an Interface 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. 3. Run: pim ipv6 timer hello interval The interval for sending Hello messages is set. 4. Run: pim ipv6 triggered-hello-delay interval The maximum delay for triggering Hello messages is set. After the maximum delay is set, the conflict caused by multiple PIM-IPv6 switchs simultaneously sending Hello message is avoided. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 475 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 5. 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration Run: pim ipv6 hello-option holdtime interval The period for keeping the reachable state of a neighbor is configured. If the local switch does not receive any Hello message from the neighbor after the period expires, the local switch considers that the neighbor is unreachable. 6. Run: pim ipv6 require-genid The Generation ID option is set in received Hello message. The Hello message without the Generation ID option is refused. ----End 13.6.3 Configuring Control Parameters for Electing a DR DR control parameters are used to direct the DR election. The greater the parameter value, the higher the priority. You can set the DR priority value either globally or on an interface as needed. Context Do as follows on the PIM-SM (IPv6) switch: NOTE The configuration of the control parameters for electing a DR involves the following cases: l Global configuration: It is valid on all the interfaces. l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used. Procedure l Global Configuration 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: pim-ipv6 The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed. 3. Run: hello-option dr-priority priority The priority for the DR election is configured. On the shared network segment where all PIM-IPv6 switchs support the DR priority, the switch interface with highest priority acts as the DR. In the case of the same priority, the switch interface with the highest IP address acts as the DR. If a minimum of one PIM-IPv6 switch does not support the DR priority, the switch interface with the highest IP address acts as the DR. l Configuration on an Interface 1. Run: system-view Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 476 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration The system view is displayed. 2. Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. 3. Run: pim ipv6 hello-option dr-priority priority-value The priority for the DR election is configured. On the shared network segment where all PIM-IPv6 switchs support the DR priority, the switch interface with highest priority acts as the DR. In the case of the same priority, the switch interface with the highest IP address acts as the DR. If a minimum of one PIM-IPv6 switch does not support the DR priority, the switch interface with the highest IP address acts as the DR. 4. Run: pim ipv6 timer dr-switch-delay interval The DR switching delay is configured and the value of the delay is set. When an interface changes from a DR to a non-DR, the existing routing entries are valid until the maximum delay expires. ----End 13.6.4 Enabling the Function of Tracking a Downstream Neighbor Enabling the function of tracking a downstream neighbor prevents the prune action from being overridden when Prune messages and Join messages are received from the same network segment. This reduces bandwidth consumption caused by message exchanges. Context Do as follows on the switch running IPv6 PIM-SM: NOTE The configuration involves the following cases: l Global configuration: It is valid on all the interfaces. l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used. Procedure l Global Configuration 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: pim-ipv6 The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed. 3. Run: hello-option neighbor-tracking Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 477 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration The function of tracking downstream neighbors is enabled. After this function is enabled, information about the downstream neighbor who has sent a Join message and whose Join state does not times out is recorded. NOTE The function of tracking downstream neighbors cannot be implemented unless all the switchs running IPv6 PIM-SM in the shared network segment are enabled with this function. l Configuration on an Interface 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. 3. Run: pim ipv6 hello-option neighbor-tracking The function of tracking downstream neighbors is enabled. After this function is enabled, information about the downstream neighbor who has sent a Join message and whose Join state does not times out is recorded. NOTE The function of tracking downstream neighbors cannot be implemented unless all the switchs running IPv6 PIM-SM in the shared network segment are enabled with this function. ----End 13.6.5 Configuring PIM Neighbor Filtering To prevent some unknown devices from being involved in PIM, filtering PIM neighbors is required. An interface sets up neighbor relationships with only the addresses matching the filtering rules and deletes the neighbors unmatched with the filtering rules. Context To prevent some switches from establishing unauthorized neighbor relationships through the PIM protocol, configure the local device to filter PIM neighbors. Do as follows on the switch enabled with IPv6 PIM-SM: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 478 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration Step 3 Run: pim ipv6 neighbor-policy { basic-acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name } PIM neighbor filtering is configured. An interface sets up neighbor relationships with only the addresses matching the filtering rules and deletes the neighbors unmatching the filtering rules. NOTE When configuring the PIM neighbor filtering function on the interface, you must also configure the neighbor filtering function correspondingly on the switch that sets up the neighbor relationship with the interface. ----End 13.6.6 Checking the Configuration After the neighbor control parameters are adjusted, you can run commands to check information about the PIM interface and the PIM neighbor. Procedure l Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces. l Run the display pim ipv6 neighbor [ ipv6-link-local-address | interface interface-type interface-number | verbose ] * command to check information about PIM-IPv6 neighbors. ----End 13.7 Adjusting Control Parameters of Source Registering In a PIM-SM network, the DR directly connected to the multicast source encapsulates multicast data in a Register message and sends the message to the RP in unicast mode. The RP then decapsulates the message, and forwards the multicast data to receivers along the RPT. 13.7.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After basic functions of IPv6 PIM-SM are configured, you can configure filtering policies and the checksumming mode for Register messages and configure PIM-SM Register suppression as required. Applicable Environment This section describes how to configure the control parameters of the source registering through commands in the ASM model. In a PIM-SM network, the DR directly connected to the source S encapsulates the received multicast data in a Register message and unicasts the Register message to the RP. The RP then decapsulates the message, and forwards the multicast data to receivers along the RPT. After the SPT switchover on the RP is complete, the multicast data reaches the RP along the source tree in the multicast mode. The RP sends a Register-Stop message to the DR at the source side. The DR then stops sending Register messages and enters the suppressed state. In the register suppression period, the DR periodically sends a Probe message (null Register message) to notify Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 479 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration the RP that the multicast source is still in the active state. After the register suppression expires, the DR resends the Register message carrying a multicast data packet. NOTE Switchs under the control of default values can work normally. In the S9700, users can adjust related parameters according to the specific network environment. If there is no special requirement, default values are recommended. Pre-configuration Tasks Before adjusting control parameters of source registering, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol l Configuring Basic PIM-SM (IPv6) Functions Data Preparation To adjust control parameters of source registering, you need the following data. No. Data 1 ACL6 rules used by the RP to filter Register messages 2 Timeout period for keeping the suppressed state of the source registering 3 Interval for sending null Register messages to the RP 4 IPv6 global unicast address for sending Register messages from the source's DR 13.7.2 Configuring Rules for Filtering PIM-SM (IPv6) Register Messages You can configure policies on filtering Register messages on all the routers that may become RPs. By default, the checksum is calculated based on the entire Register message. You can configure the device to calculate the checksum based on only the header of a Register message. Context Do as follows on switchs that may become RPs: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim-ipv6 The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed. Step 3 Run: Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 480 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration register-policy { advanced-acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name } The rules for filtering Register messages are set. The RP accepts or rejects to a Register message according to the rules. ----End 13.7.3 Configuring PIM-SM (IPv6) Registering Suppression You can set the timeout period for keeping the register suppression state and the interval for sending null Register messages on all the devices that may become DRs at the multicast source side. Context Do as follows on the switch that may become the DR at the source side: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim-ipv6 The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed. Step 3 Run: register-suppression-timeout interval The timeout period for keeping the suppressed state of the registering is set. Step 4 Run: probe-interval interval The interval for sending null Register messages is set. ----End 13.7.4 Checking the Configuration After control parameters for source registering are adjusted, you can run the corresponding command to check information about the PIM interface. Procedure l Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces. ----End Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 481 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration 13.8 Adjusting Control Parameters for Forwarding A multicast device sends Join messages upstream to require forwarding multicast data and Prune messages to require stopping the forwarding of multicast data. You can adjust control parameters for multicast data forwarding as required. If there is no special requirement, adopt default values. 13.8.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After basic functions of IPv6 PIM-DM are configured, you can adjust control parameters used to maintain the forwarding relationship, and configure the Join information filtering and neighbor filtering functions to enhance security as required. Applicable Environment Unless otherwise specified, the configurations in this section are applicable to both the ASM model and the SSM model. When the first member of a group appears on a switch, the switch sends a Join message through the upstream interface to require the upstream switch to forward packets to this network segment. When the last member of a group on the switch leaves its group, the switch sends the Prune message through the upstream interface to request the upstream switch to perform the prune action. After receiving the Prune message, the upstream interface stops forwarding packets to this network segment. If other downstream switchs exist in this network segment, they must send the Join message to override the prune action. In the ASM model, the switchs periodically send Join messages to the RP in case the RPT branch is deleted because of timeout. NOTE Switchs under the control of default values can work normally. In the S9700, users can adjust related parameters according to the specific network environment. If there is no special requirement, default values are recommended. Pre-configuration Tasks Before adjusting control parameters for forwarding, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol l Configuring Basic PIM-SM (IPv6) Functions Data Preparation To adjust control parameters for forwarding, you need the following data. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) No. Data 1 Interval for sending Join/Prune messages 2 The value of the Holdtime field in the sent Join/Prune message 3 Delay for transmitting messages Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 482 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration No. Data 4 Period of overriding the Prune action 5 Number or name of the ACL6 used to filter join information 6 Whether to perform neighbor check on the received or sent Join/Prune messages and Assert messages 13.8.2 Configuring Control Parameters for Keeping the Forwarding Relationship The control parameters of multicast data forwarding can be set either globally or on an interface. The parameters specify the interval for sending Join/Prune messages and the period for a downstream interface to keep the Join/Prune state. Context Do as follows on the PIM-SM (IPv6) switch: NOTE The configuration of the control parameters for maintaining the forwarding relationship involves the following cases: l Global configuration: It is valid on all the interfaces. l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used. Procedure l Global Configuration 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: pim-ipv6 The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed. 3. Run: timer join-prune interval The interval for sending Join/Prune messages is set. 4. Run: holdtime join-prune interval The value of the Holdtime field in the sent Join/Prune message is set. The Holdtime period is the period for keeping the Forwarding/Prune state of the downstream interface. l Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Configuration on an Interface Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 483 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 1. 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. 3. Run: pim ipv6 timer join-prune interval The interval for sending Join/Prune messages is set. 4. Run: pim ipv6 holdtime join-prune interval The value of the Holdtime field in the sent Join/Prune message is set. The Holdtime period is the period for keeping the Forwarding/Prune state of the downstream interface. 5. Run: pim ipv6 require-genid The Generation ID option is set in received Hello message. The Hello message without the Generation ID option is refused. NOTE The change of the Generation ID in the Hello message received from the upstream neighbor indicates that the upstream neighbor is lost or the status of the upstream neighbor has changed. ----End 13.8.3 Configuring Control Parameters for Prune The prune control parameters can be set either globally or on an interface. The parameters specify the delay for transmitting messages in a LAN and the interval for overriding the Prune action. Context The Hello message carries lan-delay ( which indicates the delay for transmitting prune message ) and override-interval ( which indicates the interval for overriding a prune ). The relationship between lan-delay, override-interval, and PPT is that lan-delay + override-interval = PPT. PrunePending Timer (PPT) indicates the delay from the time when a switch receives the Prune message from the downstream interface to the time when the switch performs the prune action to suppress the forwarding of the downstream interface. If the switch receives a Join message from a downstream switch within the PPT, the switch does not perform the prune action. Do as follows on the PIM-SM (IPv6) switch: NOTE The configuration of the control parameters of prune involves the following cases: l Global Configuration: It is valid on all the interfaces. l Configuration on the interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 484 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration Procedure l Global Configuration 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: pim-ipv6 The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed. 3. Run: hello-option lan-delay interval The delay of transmitting messages in a LAN is set. 4. Run: hello-option override-interval interval The period for overriding the prune action is set. When a switch receives a Prune message through an upstream interface, it indicates that another downstream switch exists in the LAN. If the switch still needs to receive the multicast data, the switch must send a Join message to the upstream within the override-interval. l Configuration on an Interface 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. 3. Run: pim ipv6 hello-option lan-delay interval The delay for transmitting messages in a LAN is set. 4. Run: pim ipv6 hello-option override-interval interval The period for overriding the prune action is set. ----End 13.8.4 Configuring Join Information Filtering A Join/Prune message received by an interface may contain both join information and prune information. You can configure the interface to filter join information based on ACL6 rules. Context You can configure the switch to filter join information based on ACL6 rules. The switch then creates PIM entries for only the join information matching ACL6 rules, which can prevent illegal users from accessing the group. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 485 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration Do as follows on the switch enabled with IPv6 PIM-SM: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. Step 3 Run: pim ipv6 join-policy { asm { basic-acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name } | ssm { advanced-acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name } | advanced-acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name } Join information filtering is configured. ----End 13.8.5 (Optional) Configuring Parameters for Join/Prune Messages The parameters such as the maximum message size and number of (S, G) entries, and the message package function can be configured for PIM Join/Prune messages. Context Perform the following steps on the PIM-SM-enabled switch: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim-ipv6 [ vpn-instance vpn-instance-name ] The IPv6 PIM view is displayed. Step 3 Run: join-prune max-packet-length packet-length The maximum size of each PIM-SM Join/Prune message to be sent is configured. The default size is 8100 bytes. Step 4 Run: join-prune periodic-messages queue-size queue-size The maximum number of entries carried in a PIM-SM Join/Prune message that is sent every second is configured. The default value is 1020. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 486 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration Step 5 Run: join-prune triggered-message-pack disable The function to package Join/Prune messages in real time is disabled. This function is enabled by default. ----End 13.8.6 Configuring Neighbor Check If PIM neighbor check is enabled, a device checks whether the Join/Prune and Assert messages are sent to or received from a PIM neighbor. If not, the device drops the messages. Context By default, checking whether the Join/Prune message and Assert messages are sent to or received from a PIM neighbor is not enabled. If PIM neighbor checking is required, it is recommended to configure the neighbor checking function on the devices connected with user devices rather than on the internal devices of the network. Then, the switch checks whether the Join/Prune and Assert messages are sent to or received from a PIM neighbor. If not, the switch drops the messages. Do as follows on the switch enabled with IPv6 PIM-SM: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim-ipv6 The IPv6 PIM view is displayed. Step 3 Run: neighbor-check { receive | send } The neighbor check function is configured. You can specify both receive and send to enable the IPv6 PIM neighbor check function for both the received and sent Join/Prune messages and Assert messages. ----End 13.8.7 Checking the Configuration After control parameters for multicast data forwarding are adjusted, you can check information about the PIM interface and the PIM routing table and statistics about PIM control messages through commands. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 487 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration Procedure l Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces. l Run the display pim ipv6 control-message counters [ message-type { assert | graft | graft-ack | hello | join-prune | state-refresh | bsr } | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * command to check the number of sent and received PIM-IPv6 control messages. l Run the following commands to check the PIM-IPv6 multicast routing table. – display pim ipv6 routing-table [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6group-address [ mask mask-length ] | flags { act | del | exprune | ext | loc | niif | nonbr | none | rpt | sg_rcvr | sgjoin | spt | swt | wc | upchg } | fsm | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | outgoing-interface { exclude | include | match } { interface-type interface-number | none | register } ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim ipv6 routing-table brief [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6-group-address [ mask mask-length ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } ] * ----End 13.9 Configuring Control Parameters for Assert If a multicast device can receive multicast data through the downstream interface, this indicates that other upstream devices exist in this network segment. The device then sends an Assert message through the downstream interface to take part in the election of the unique upstream device. 13.9.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After basic functions of IPv6 PIM-SM are configured, you can set the period for holding the Assert state as required. Applicable Environment The configurations in this section are applicable to both the ASM model and the SSM model. When a PIM-SM switch receives multicast data through the downstream interface, this indicates that other upstream switchs exist in this network segment. The switch sends an Assert message through the downstream interface to take part in the assert election. NOTE switchs under the control of default values can work normally. In the S9700, you can adjust related parameters according to the specific network environment. If there is no special requirement, default values are recommended. Pre-configuration Tasks Before adjusting control parameters for assert, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol l Configuring Basic PIM-SM (IPv6) Functions Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 488 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration Data Preparation To adjust control parameters for asset, you need the following data. No. Data 1 The period for keeping the Assert state 13.9.2 Configuring the Period for Keeping the Assert State The device that fails the election prevents its downstream interface from forwarding multicast data during the Assert state. After the holdtime of the Assert state expires, the downstream interface can forward multicast data. Context Do as follows on all switchs in the PIM-SM (IPv6) domain: NOTE The configuration of control parameters for Assert involves the following cases: l Global configuration: It is valid on all the interfaces. l Configuration on an interface: The configuration on an interface takes precedence over the global configuration. If the configuration on an interface is not done, the global configuration is used. Procedure l Global Configuration 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: pim-ipv6 The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed. 3. Run: holdtime assert interval The period for keeping the Assert state is configured. The switch that fails in the election prohibits the downstream interface from forwarding multicast data in this period. After the period expires, the switch restores the forwarding of the downstream interface. By default, the holdtime period in Assert messages is 180 seconds. l Configuration on an Interface 1. Run: system-view The system view is displayed. 2. Run: interface interface-type interface-number Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 489 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration The interface view is displayed. 3. Run: pim ipv6 holdtime assert interval The period for keeping the Assert state is set. The switch that fails in the election prohibits the downstream interface from forwarding multicast data in this period. After the period expires, the switch restores the forwarding of the downstream interface. By default, the holdtime period in Assert messages is 180 seconds. ----End 13.9.3 Checking the Configuration After the control parameters for assert are adjusted, you can check information about the PIM interface and the PIM routing table and statistics about PIM control messages through commands. Procedure l Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces. l Run the display pim ipv6 control-message counters [ message-type { assert | graft | graft-ack | hello | join-prune | state-refresh | bsr } | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * command to check the number of sent and received PIM-IPv6 control messages. l Run the following commands to check the PIM-IPv6 multicast routing table. – display pim ipv6 routing-table [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6group-address [ mask mask-length ] | flags { act | del | exprune | ext | loc | niif | nonbr | none | rpt | sg_rcvr | sgjoin | spt | swt | wc | upchg } | fsm | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | outgoing-interface { exclude | include | match } { interface-type interface-number | none | register } ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim ipv6 routing-table brief [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6-group-address [ mask mask-length ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } ] * ----End 13.10 Adjusting Control Parameters for the SPT Switchover A high volume of multicast data traffic increases the load of an RP, and may result in a fault. To solve this problem, IPv6 PIM-SM allows the RP or the DR at the group member side to trigger the SPT switchover when the rate of multicast packets is high. 13.10.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After basic functions of IPv6 PIM-SM are configured, you can adjust control parameters for SPT switchover as required. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 490 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration Applicable Environment This section describes how to configure the control parameters of the SPT switchover through commands in the ASM model. In PIM-SM forwarding, each multicast group corresponds to an RPT. At first, all multicast sources encapsulate data in Register messages, and send the messages to the RP in the unicast mode. The RP decapsulates the messages and forwards the data along the RPT. Forwarding multicast data by using the RPT has the following disadvantages: l The DR at the source side and the RP need to encapsulate and decapsulate packets. l The forwarding path may not be the shortest path from the source to receivers. l Heavy data traffic increases the load of the RP, and may cause a fault. The solution to the preceding disadvantages is that: l SPT switchover triggered by the RP: The RP sends a Join message to the source, and establishes a multicast route along the shortest path from the DR at the source side to the RP. The subsequent packets are forwarded along the path. l SPT switchover triggered by the DR at the receiver side: The DR at the receiver side checks the forwarding rate of multicast data. If the DR finds that the rate exceeds the threshold, the DR triggers the SPT switchover immediately. The DR sends a Join message to the source, and establishes a multicast route along the shortest path from the DR at the source side to the DR at the receiver side. The subsequent packets are forwarded along the path. NOTE switchs under the control of default values can work normally. In the S9700, users can adjust related parameters according to the specific network environment. If there is no special requirement, default values are recommended. Pre-configuration Tasks Before adjusting control parameters for the SPT switchover, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol l Configuring Basic PIM-SM (IPv6) Functions Data Preparation To adjust control parameters for the SPT switchover, you need the following data. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) No. Data 1 Forwarding rate threshold that the DR at the receiver side switches packets from the RPT to the SPT 2 Group filtering policy and sequence policy for the RPT-to-SPT switchover 3 Interval for checking the forwarding rate threshold of multicast data before RPT-toSPT switchover Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 491 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration 13.10.2 (Optional) Adjusting Conditions of the SPT Switchover You can configure SPT switchover conditions on the DR at the group member side. The DR then checks the forwarding rate of multicast data. If finding that the rate exceeds the threshold, the DR triggers the SPT switchover immediately. Context Do as follows on the switch that may become the DR at the receiver side: NOTE This configuration is optional. By default, the RP and the DR at the receiver side immediately perform the SPT switchover after receiving the first multicast data packet. Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim-ipv6 The PIM-IPv6 view is displayed. Step 3 Run: spt-switch-threshold { traffic-rate | infinity } [ group-policy { basic-acl6number | acl6-name acl6-name } [ order order-value ] ] Conditions of the SPT switchover are adjusted. The parameters of this command are explained as follows: l traffic-rate: specifies the rate threshold of SPT switchover. l infinity: indicates that the SPT switchover is not triggered. l group-policy { basic-acl6-number | acl6-name acl6-name } [ order order-value ]: specifies the range of the multicast groups that use the threshold. By default, the threshold is applicable to all multicast groups. ----End 13.10.3 (Optional) Configuring the Interval for Checking the Forwarding Rate of Multicast Data After conditions for the SPT switchover are configured, you can set the interval for checking the forwarding rate of multicast data. Context Do as follows on the switch that may become the DR at the receiver side: Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 492 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: pim-ipv6 The PIM view is displayed. Step 3 Run: timer spt-switch interval The interval for checking the forwarding rate of multicast data is set. By default, the DR at the receiver side performs SPT switchover after receiving the first multicast data packet. NOTE Before configuring the timer spt-switch command, run the spt-switch-threshold command to set the threshold of the rate that will trigger SPT switchover. Otherwise, timer spt-switch does not take effect. ----End 13.10.4 Checking the Configuration After the control parameters for SPT switchover are adjusted, you can run commands to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces. Procedure l Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces. ----End 13.11 Configuring PIM GR (IPv6) In an IPv6 PIM-SM network, PIM GR can be applied to a device with dual main control boards to ensure normal multicast data forwarding during master-slave switchover. 13.11.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After basic functions of IPv6 PIM-SM are configured, you can configure PIM GR to improve PIM network reliability. Applicable Environment In some multicast applications, the switch may need to perform active/standby switchover. After active/standby switchover, the new active main control board deletes the forwarding entries on the interface board and re-learns the PIM routing table and multicast routing table. During this process, multicast traffic is interrupted. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 493 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration In the PIM-SM/SSM network, PIM Graceful Restart (GR) can be applied to the switch with dual main control boards to ensure normal multicast traffic forwarding during active/standby switchover. The active main control board of the switch backs up PIM routing entries and Join/Prune information to be sent upstream to the standby main control board. The interface board keeps forwarding entries. Therefore, after active/standby switchover, the switch can actively and fast send Join messages upstream to maintain the Join state of the upstream. Then, the PIM protocol sends Hello messages carrying new Generation ID to all switchs enabled with PIM-SM. When the downstream switch finds that the Generation ID of its neighbor changes, it sends a Join/ Prune message to the neighbor for re-creating routing entries, thereby ensuring non-stop forwarding of multicast data on the forwarding plane. If a dynamic RP is used on the network, after receiving a Hello message with the Generation ID being changed, the DR or candidate DR unicasts a BSM message to the switch performing active/ standby switchover and the switch learns and restores RP information based on the received BSM message. If the switch has not leant any RP information from the BSM messages, it obtains the RP information from the Join/Prune message received from the downstream router and recreates multicast routing table. NOTE PIM GR is applicable to PIM-SM/SSM networks. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring PIM GR, complete the following task: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol and enabling unicast GR l Configuring Basic PIM-SM (IPv6) Functions Data Preparation To enable PIM GR, you need the following data. No. Data 1 PIM-IPv6 GR period 13.11.2 Enabling PIM GR (IPv6) After PIM GR is enabled on a device, you can set the PIM GR period as required. Context Do as follows on the switch enabled with PIM SM (IPv6). Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 494 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration Step 2 Run: pim-ipv6 The IPv6 PIM view is displayed. Step 3 Run: graceful-restart PIM GR is enabled. Step 4 (Optional) Run: graceful-restart period period The PIM GR period is set. By default, the PIM GR period is 120 seconds. ----End 13.11.3 Checking the Configuration After PIM GR is configured, you can run the command to check whether the PIM routing table is the same as that before master-slave switchover. Procedure Step 1 Run the following commands to check IPv6 PIM routing table. l display pim ipv6 routing-table [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6-groupaddress [ mask mask-length ] | flags { act | del | exprune | ext | loc | niif | nonbr | none | rpt | sg_rcvr | sgjoin | spt | swt | wc | upchg } | fsm | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | outgoing-interface { exclude | include | match } { interface-type interface-number | none | register } ] * [ outgoinginterface-number [ number ] ] l display pim ipv6 routing-table brief [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6group-address [ mask mask-length ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interfacenumber | register } ] * ----End 13.12 Configuring PIM-IPv6 Silent The interface directly connecting a multicast device to a user host needs to be enabled with PIM. In this case, some malicious hosts may simulate a large number of PIM Hello messages and send the messages to the interface for processing. As a result, the multicast device is suspended. To avoid the preceding case, you can set the interface to be in the PIM Silent state. 13.12.1 Establishing the Configuration Task After basic functions of IPv6 PIM-SM and MLD are configured, you can configure the PIM silent function on the interface connected with the user host. This interface should be enabled with IPv6 PIM-SM and MLD first. Applicable Environment At the access layer, the switch interface directly connected to hosts needs to be enabled with PIM-IPv6. You can establish the PIM-IPv6 neighbor relationship on the switch interface to Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 495 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration process various PIM-IPv6 packets. The configuration, however, has the security vulnerability. When a host maliciously generates PIM-IPv6 Hello packets and sends the packets in large quantity, the switch may break down. To avoid the preceding case, you can set the status of the switch interface to PIM-IPv6 silent. When the interface is in the PIM-IPv6 silent state, the interface is prohibited from receiving and forwarding any PIM-IPv6 packet. All PIM-IPv6 neighbors and PIM-IPv6 state machines on the interface are deleted. The interface acts as the static DR and immediately takes effect. At the same time, MLD on the interface is not affected. To enable PIM-IPv6 silent, the network environment must meet the following conditions: l The network supports IPv4 and IPv6. l The PIM-IPv6 silent is applicable only to the switch interface directly connected to the host network segment that is connected only to this switch. CAUTION If PIM-IPv6 silent is enabled on the interface connected to a switch, the PIM-IPv6 neighbor cannot be established and a multicast fault may occur. If the host network segment is connected to multiple switchs and PIM-IPv6 silent is enabled on multiple switch interfaces, the interface become static DRs. Therefore, multiple DRs exist in this network segment, and a multicast fault occurs. Pre-configuration Tasks Before configuring PIM-IPv6 silent, complete the following tasks: l Configuring a unicast routing protocol to make the network layer reachable l Configuring PIM-SM l Configuring MLD Data Preparation To configure PIM-IPv6 silent, you need the following data. No. Data 1 The number of the switch interface connected to hosts 13.12.2 Configuring PIM-IPv6 Silent After the interface is configured with PIM silent, it is forbidden to receive or forward any PIM protocol packet. All PIM neighbors and PIM state machines on this interface are deleted. Then, this interface automatically becomes the DR. MLD on the interface is not affected. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 496 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration Context CAUTION PIM-IPv6 silent is applicable only to the switch interface connected to the host network segment that can be connected to only one PIM-IPv6 switch. Do as follows on the switch interface connected to the host network segment: Procedure Step 1 Run: system-view The system view is displayed. Step 2 Run: interface interface-type interface-number The interface view is displayed. Step 3 Run: pim ipv6 silent PIM-IPv6 silent is enabled. After this function is enabled, the Hello packet attack of malicious hosts is effectively prevented and the connected switchs are protected. ----End 13.12.3 Checking the Configuration After PIM silent is configured, you can run the command to check information about the PIM interface. Prerequisites All the configurations of PIM silent are complete. Procedure l Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces. ----End 13.13 Maintaining PIM-SM Maintaining IPv6 PIM-SM involves resetting PIM statistics, and monitoring PIM running status. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 497 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration 13.13.1 Clearing Statistics of PIM-IPv6 Control Messages If you need to re-collect the statistics about IPv6 PIM control messages, you can reset the existent statistics. Note that the statistics cannot be restored after you reset them. This operation does not affect normal running of PIM. Context CAUTION The statistics of PIM-IPv6 control messages on an interface cannot be restored after you clear it. Therefore, confirm the action before you use the command. Procedure l Run the reset pim ipv6 control-message counters [ interface interface-type interfacenumber ] command in the user view to clear statistics of PIM-IPv6 control messages on an interface. ----End 13.13.2 Clearing the PIM Status of the Specified Downstream Interfaces of PIM Entries You can clear the PIM Join/Prune state and Assert state on the specified downstream interface of an IPv6 PIM entry. MLD status and static multicast groups on this interface are not affected. Context CAUTION Clearing PIM status of the downstream interfaces may trigger the sending of corresponding Join/ Prune messages, which affects multicast services. Using the following command can clear join information about illegal users, and clear the PIM status of the specified interface in a specified entry, such as PIM Join/Prune status and Assert status. The command cannot be used to clear the MLD or static group join status on a specified interface. Procedure Step 1 After confirming that PIM status of the specified downstream interfaces of the specified PIM entry need to be cleared, run the reset pim ipv6 routing-table group ipv6-group-address mask ipv6-group-mask-length source ipv6-source-address interface interface-type interfacenumber command in the user view. ----End Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 498 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration 13.13.3 Monitoring the Running Status of PIM-SM During IPv6 PIM routine maintenance, you can run the display commands in any view to know the running of PIM. Context In routine maintenance, you can run the following commands in any view to check the running status of PIM-SM. Procedure l Run the display pim ipv6 control-message counters [ message-type { assert | graft | graft-ack | hello | join-prune | state-refresh | bsr } | interface interface-type interfacenumber ] * command in any view to check the number of sent and received PIM-IPv6 control messages. l Run the display pim ipv6 bsr-info command in any view to check information about the BSR. l Run the display pim ipv6 claimed-route [ ipv6-source-address ] command in any view to check unicast routing information used by (S, G) and (*, G) entries in the PIM-SM routing table. l Run the display pim ipv6 rp-info [ ipv6-group-address ] command in any view to check information about the RP to which the multicast group corresponds. l Run the display pim ipv6 grafts command in any view to check the unacknowledged PIMIPv6 Graft messages. l Run the display pim ipv6 interface [ interface-type interface-number | up | down ] [ verbose ] command in any view to check information about PIM-IPv6 interfaces. l Run the display pim ipv6 neighbor [ ipv6-link-local-address | interface interface-type interface-number | verbose ] * command in any view to check information about PIM-IPv6 neighbors. l Run the following commands in any view to check the PIM-IPv6 multicast routing table. – display pim ipv6 routing-table [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6group-address [ mask mask-length ] | flags { act | del | exprune | ext | loc | niif | nonbr | none | rpt | sg_rcvr | sgjoin | spt | swt | wc | upchg } | fsm | incominginterface { interface-type interface-number | register } | mode { dm | sm | ssm } | outgoing-interface { exclude | include | match } { interface-type interface-number | none | register } ] * [ outgoing-interface-number [ number ] ] – display pim ipv6 routing-table brief [ ipv6-source-address [ mask mask-length ] | ipv6-group-address [ mask mask-length ] | incoming-interface { interface-type interface-number | register } ] * l Run the display pim ipv6 invalid-packet [ interface interface-type interface-number | message-type { assert | bsr | hello | join-prune | graft | graft-ack | state-refresh } ] * command in any view to check the statistics about invalid IPv6 PIM messages received by a device. ----End 13.13.4 Debugging PIM-IPv6 When a fault occurs during the running of IPv6 PIM, run the debugging commands in the user view and check the contents of sent and received packets for fault location. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 499 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration Context CAUTION Debugging affects the performance of the system. So, after debugging, run the undo debugging all command to disable it immediately. Procedure l Run the debugging pim ipv6 all command in the user view to enable all the PIM-IPv6 debugging. l Run the debugging pim ipv6 event [ advanced-acl6-number ] in the user view to enable the debugging of PIM-IPv6 events. l Run the debugging pim ipv6 routing-table [ advanced-acl6-number ] command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIM-IPv6 routing table. l Run the debugging pim ipv6 neighbor [ interface-based-acl6-number | basic-acl6number | [ receive | send ] ] * command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIMIPv6 neighbors. l Run the debugging pim ipv6 assert [ advanced-acl6-number | [ receive | send ] ] * command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIM-IPv6 Assert. l Run the debugging pim ipv6 join-prune [ interface-based-acl6-number | advanced-acl6number | [ receive | send ] ] * command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIMIPv6 Join/Prune. l Run the debugging pim ipv6 rp [ receive | send ] command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIM-IPv6 RP. l Run the debugging pim ipv6 register [ advanced-acl6-number ] command in the user view to enable the debugging of PIM-IPv6 Register. ----End 13.14 Configuration Example Configuration examples are provided to show how to construct a basic IPv6 PIM-SM network. 13.14.1 Example for Configuring the IPv6 PIM-SM Network Networking Requirements As shown in Figure 13-1, multicast is deployed on the network of an Internet service provider (ISP). The network is deployed with IGP and is connected to the Internet. The unicast routing routes work normally. The S9700s on the network need to be configured properly so that user hosts can receive the VoD information in multicast mode. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 500 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration Figure 13-1 Networking diagram for configuring basic IPv6 PIM-DM functions SwitchB GE1/0/0 2002::2 GE2/0/0 3001::1 GE3/0/0 2004::1 SwitchA Source 2001::5 GE1/0/0 2001::1 GE2/0/0 2002::1 GE3/0/0 2003::1 GE1/0/0 GE4/0/0 2003::2 2006::1 Internet HostA HostB GE2/0/0 2004::2 SwitchD GE3/0/0 2005::1 GE1/0/0 2005::2 SwitchC GE2/0/0 4001::2 HostC HostD Switch Physical interface VLANIF interface IP address SwitchA GE1/0/0 VLANIF100 2001::1 GE2/0/0 VLANIF101 2002::1 GE3/0/0 VLANIF102 2003::1 GE4/0/0 VLANIF103 2006::1 GE1/0/0 VLANIF101 2002::2 GE2/0/0 VLANIF201 3001::1 GE3/0/0 VLANIF202 2004::1 GE1/0/0 VLANIF300 2005::2 GE2/0/0 VLANIF301 4001::2 GE1/0/0 VLANIF102 2003::2 GE2/0/0 VLANIF202 2004::2 GE3/0/0 VLANIF300 2005::1 SwitchB SwitchC SwitchD Configuration Roadmap The ISP network is connected to the Internet. Therefore, to facilitate service expansion, IPv6 PIM-SM protocol is used to configure the multicast function and ASM and SSM models are adopted to provide multicast services. In this example, each host network segment is connected to only one S9700, so PIM silent can be used to prevent the Hello message attack. The configuration roadmap is as follows: 1. Create VLANs and VLAN interfaces on the S9700s and assign IPv6 addresses to the VLAN interfaces. The configuration procedure is not provided here. 2. Enable an IPv6 unicast routing protocol on the four switches. Issue 01 (2012-03-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 501 S9700 Core Routing Switch Configuration Guide - Multicast 13 PIM-SM (IPv6) Configuration 3. Enable multicast on the S9700s. 4. Enable IPv6 PIM-SM on all router interfaces. 5. Configure the C-BSR and C-RP on SwitchD. 6. Configure the BSR boundary on the interface connecting SwitchA to the Internet. 7. Configure the SSM address range on each S9700. 8. Enable PIM IPv6 silent and MLD on the interfaces connected to hosts. Data Preparation To complete the configuration, you need the following data: l MLD version running on the interfaces of S9700s connected to user hosts: MLDv2 l Global unicast IPv6 address of the C-BSR and C-RP: 2004::2 l SSM group a